Disclaimer
All
of the für
following
PDF document for
this sich
vehicle
model
Daslanguage
folgende versions
PDF-Dokument
dieses Fahrzeugmodell
bezieht
in allen
relate
solely toversion
vehicles
intended
for sale
on the
German
which
Sprachversionen
nur aufofdie
die für
den
deutschen
Marktand
bestimmt
The
following
theFahrzeuge,
Owner‘s
Manual
describes
allmarket
models,
series
and
correspond
to German
regulations.
sind undequipment
die den
deutschen
Vorschriften
entsprechen. Bitte
wenden
Sie sich an
special
of your
vehicle. Country-specific
language
variations
are
Ihren autorisierten
Mercedes-Benz
Servicestützpunkt,
um equipped
ein gedrucktes
possible.
Please note
that your vehicle
might not be
withExemplar
all the
Please
contact
your authorised
Mercedes-Benz
Service
Centreand
to obtain
für andere
Fahrzeugmodelle
und affects
Fahrzeugmodelljahre
zu erhalten.
described
functions.
This also
safety-relevant
systems
functions.
a printed
version
forauthorised
other vehicle
models and vehicle
model
years.
Thislike
PDF
Please
contact
your
Mercedes-Benz
dealership
if you
would
document
the latest
version.
Possible
variations
to your
vehicle
mayzu
not
Dieses
PDF-Dokument
stellt
die Manual
aktuelle
Version
dar.
Mögliche
Abweichungen
to
receive
aisprinted
Owner‘s
for other
vehicle
models
and vehicle
be
taken
into account
askönnten
Mercedes-Benz
constantlysein,
updates
their vehicles to
Ihrem
konkreten
Fahrzeug
nicht berücksichtigt
da Mercedes-Benz
model
years.
the
state
of the art
and introduces
changes
design
andanpasst,
equipment.
seine
Fahrzeuge
ständig
dem neuesten
Standinder
Technik
sowiePlease
therefore
that this
PDF is
document
in no
way
replaces
the
version
Änderungen
in Form
und
Ausstattung
vornimmt.
Bitte
beachten
Sie
daher,
dass
The
onlinenote
Owner‘s
Manual
the current
and
valid
version.
Itprinted
is
possible
that
which
was affecting
deliveredyour
with
yourFall
vehicle.
dieses PDF-Dokument
in keinem
das gedruckte
ersetzt,
mit
deviations
specific
vehicle
could Exemplar
not be taken
intodas
account
dem
Fahrzeug ausgeliefert
wurde.
as
Mercedes-Benz
constantly
adapts its vehicles according to the latest
technology and makes changes to the form and the equipment.
Please also read the printed Owner‘s Manual, supplementary documents and
the digital Owner‘s Manual in the vehicle.
Copyright
All rights reserved. All texts, images and graphics are subject to copyright
and other laws for the protection of intellectual property. They may not be
copied or changed for any commercial use or for the purpose of being passed
on nor used on other webistes.
Internal use only
Welcome to the world of Mercedes-Benz
Before you first drive off, read this Owner's Manual carefully and familiarise yourself with your
vehicle. For your own safety and a longer vehicle
life, follow the instructions and warning notices
in this manual. Disregarding them may lead to
damage to the vehicle or personal injury.
The equipment or model designation of your
vehicle may vary according to:
Rmodel
Rorder
Rcountry variant
Ravailability
The illustrations in this manual show a left-handdrive vehicle. On right-hand-drive vehicles, the
layout of components and controls differs
accordingly.
Mercedes-Benz is constantly updating its vehicles to the state of the art.
Mercedes-Benz therefore reserves the right to
introduce changes in the following areas:
Rdesign
Requipment
Rtechnical features
The equipment in your vehicle may therefore
differ from that shown in the descriptions and
illustrations.
The following are integral components of the
vehicle:
RDigital Owner's Manual
RPrinted Owner's Manual
RService Booklet
REquipment-dependent Supplements
Keep these documents in the vehicle at all
times. If you sell the vehicle, always pass all of
the documents on to the new owner.
Your Owner's Manuals:
Digital - in the vehicle
The Digital Owner's Manual provides comprehensive and specifically adapted information on the equipment in your vehicle
and your multimedia system. You will find
informative animations, individual language selection options and an intuitive
search function.
Printed manual - in the vehicle
In addition to the vehicle Owner's Manual,
the full multimedia system Supplement is
also available from your Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Digital - on the Internet
The online version of the Owner's Manual
provides convenient access to comprehensive information on your vehicle and
your multimedia system. It also provides
helpful animations, interesting background information and various search
options.
Digital - as an App
You can access comprehensive information on your vehicle and your multimedia
system online on the go or download it,
even while offline. Available for smartphones or tablets.
Please note that the Mercedes-Benz Guides App
may not yet be available in your country.
2315842001Z102 É2315842001Z102DËÍ
2
Contents
Index ....................................................... 3
Introduction ......................................... 23
Digital Owner's Manual ...................... 22
At a glance ........................................... 30
Safety ................................................... 39
Opening and closing ........................... 77
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors .. 101
Lights and windscreen wipers ......... 113
Climate control ................................. 122
Driving and parking .......................... 131
On-board computer and displays .... 199
Multimedia system ........................... 253
Stowing and features ....................... 262
Maintenance and care ...................... 276
Breakdown assistance ..................... 287
Wheels and tyres .............................. 304
Technical data ................................... 320
Index
1, 2, 3 ...
12 V socket
see Sockets
A
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Display message ............................ 217
Function/notes ................................ 62
Important safety notes .................... 62
Warning lamp ................................. 246
Accident
Automatic measures after an accident ................................................. 54
Activating media mode
General notes ................................ 260
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode .................................... 128
Activating/deactivating cooling
with air dehumidification ................. 124
Active Blind Spot Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 208
Display message ............................ 233
Function/notes ............................. 193
Active Body Control (ABC)
CURVE ........................................... 177
Vehicle level .................................. 175
Active Body Control (ABC) (except
Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Comfort ......................................... 177
Driving dynamics display ............... 177
Normal level .................................. 176
Operation/notes ............................ 175
Raised level ................................... 176
Sport .............................................. 177
Sport Plus ...................................... 177
Vehicle level .................................. 175
Active Body Control (ABC)
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Comfort ......................................... 179
Driving dynamics display ............... 180
Normal level .................................. 179
Operation/notes ............................ 178
Raised level ................................... 178
Sport .............................................. 179
Vehicle level .................................. 178
Active Body Control (except
Mercedes-AMG Vehicles)
Display message ............................ 231
Active Body Control (MercedesAMG Vehicles)
Display message ............................ 231
Active Brake Assist
Activating or deactivating .............. 207
Display message ............................ 222
Function/notes ................................ 64
Active Brake Assist with crosstraffic function
Activating or deactivating .............. 207
Display message ............................ 223
Function/notes ................................ 72
Important safety notes .................... 72
Warning lamp ................................. 251
Active Driving Assistance package .. 193
Active Lane Keeping Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 208
Display message ............................ 233
Function/notes ............................. 195
Active light function ......................... 116
Active Parking Assist
Detecting parking spaces .............. 184
Exiting a parking space .................. 186
Function/notes ............................. 183
Important safety notes .................. 183
Parking .......................................... 185
Adaptive adjustable damping
Driving dynamics display ............... 175
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ................................. 72
Adaptive Brake Assist
Function/notes ................................ 66
Adaptive brake lights .......................... 67
Adaptive Damping System
Function/notes ............................. 174
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus
Display message ............................ 228
Function/notes ............................. 116
Switching on/off ........................... 117
Additives (engine oil) ........................ 325
Address book
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
Adjusting the volume
COMAND Online ............................ 254
3
4
Index
Adjusting volume
Audio 20 ........................................ 254
Air conditioning
General notes ................................ 122
AIR FLOW ........................................... 125
Air pressure
see Tyre pressure
Air vents
Glove compartment ....................... 130
Important safety notes .................. 129
Setting ........................................... 129
Setting the blower output of the
AIRSCARF vents ............................. 130
Setting the centre air vents ........... 129
Setting the side air vents ............... 130
Switching AIRSCARF on/off .......... 105
Air-conditioning system
see Climate control
Airbag
Automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation .......................... 46
Headbag .......................................... 46
Introduction ..................................... 43
PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator
lamps ............................................... 40
Airbags
Display message ............................ 226
Front airbag (driver, front
passenger) ....................................... 45
Important safety guidelines ............. 43
Sidebag ............................................ 45
Triggering ......................................... 51
AIRSCARF
Switching on/off ........................... 105
AIRSCARF vents
Setting the blower output .............. 130
Alarm
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 74
Switching off (ATA) .......................... 74
Switching the function on/off
(ATA) ................................................ 74
Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Ambient lighting
Setting the brightness (on-board
computer) ...................................... 210
Setting the colour (on-board computer) ............................................. 210
AMG menu (on-board computer) ..... 213
Anti-glare film .................................... 275
Anti-lock braking system
see ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Anti-Theft Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Aquaplaning ....................................... 158
Ashtray ............................................... 267
Assistance display (on-board computer) .................................................. 207
Assistance menu (on-board computer) .................................................. 207
ASSYST PLUS
Displaying a service message ........ 281
Hiding a service message .............. 281
Resetting the service interval display ................................................ 281
Service message ............................ 280
Special service requirements ......... 281
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Activating/deactivating ................... 74
Function ........................................... 74
Switching off the alarm .................... 74
ATTENTION ASSIST
Activating/deactivating ................. 208
Display message ............................ 232
Function/notes ............................. 190
Audio 20
Switching on/off ........................... 253
Audio menu (on-board computer) .... 204
Authorised workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
AUTO lights
Display message ............................ 228
see Lights
Automatic engine start (ECO start/
stop function) .................................... 136
Automatic engine switch-off (ECO
start/stop function) .......................... 135
Automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation
Display message ............................ 226
Automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation system
Operation ......................................... 46
Problems ......................................... 50
System self-test ............................... 48
Index
Automatic headlamp mode ..............
Automatic transmission
Accelerator pedal position .............
Changing gear ...............................
Display message ............................
Drive program display ....................
Drive programs ..............................
Driving tips ....................................
DYNAMIC SELECT button (all vehicles except Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ...............................................
DYNAMIC SELECT controller
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ..............
Emergency running mode ..............
Engaging drive position ..................
Engaging neutral ............................
Engaging park position automatically ...............................................
Engaging reverse gear ...................
Engaging the park position ............
Gearshift recommendation ............
Kickdown .......................................
Manual shifting ..............................
Oil temperature (on-board computer, Mercedes-AMG vehicles) .....
Overview ........................................
Problem (fault) ...............................
Pulling away ...................................
Selector lever ................................
Starting the engine ........................
Steering wheel gearshift paddles ...
Transmission position display ........
Transmission positions ..................
Automatic transmission emergency running mode .........................
113
144
144
239
142
145
144
139
140
151
143
143
143
143
142
149
145
147
213
141
151
134
141
134
147
142
144
151
B
Back button ....................................... 254
BAS (Brake Assist System) ................. 62
Battery (key)
Checking .......................................... 80
Important safety notes .................... 79
Replacing ......................................... 80
Battery (vehicle)
Charging ........................................ 295
Display message ............................ 230
Important safety notes .................. 293
Jump starting ................................. 296
Overview ........................................ 293
Belt
see Seat belts
Belt tensioner
Activation ......................................... 51
Blind Spot Assist
see Active Blind Spot Assist
Bluetooth®
Connecting another mobile
phone ............................................ 257
Searching for a mobile phone ........ 256
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
Telephony ...................................... 256
Bonnet
Active bonnet (pedestrian protection) ............................................... 276
Closing ........................................... 277
Display message ............................ 241
Important safety notes .................. 276
Opening ......................................... 277
Boot
Emergency release .......................... 89
Important safety notes .................... 85
Locking separately ........................... 89
Opening/closing (automatically
from inside) ...................................... 88
Opening/closing (automatically
from outside) ................................... 86
Opening/closing (from the outside, HANDS-FREE ACCESS) ............ 87
Opening/closing (manually from
outside) ............................................ 85
Overview .......................................... 85
Power closing .................................. 84
Boot lid
Display message ............................ 240
Opening dimensions ...................... 327
Boot load (maximum) ........................ 327
Boot separator
Display message ............................ 241
Fitting .............................................. 96
General notes .................................. 95
Opening/closing .............................. 95
Removing ......................................... 96
Bottle holders .................................... 267
5
6
Index
Brake
EBD .................................................. 71
Brake Assist
see BAS (Brake Assist System)
Brake Assist with cross-traffic
function
Function/notes ................................ 63
Important safety notes .................... 63
Brake fluid
Display message ............................ 221
Notes ............................................. 325
Brake force distribution
see EBD (electronic brake force
distribution)
Brake lamps
Adaptive ........................................... 67
Display message ............................ 228
Brakes
ABS .................................................. 62
Adaptive Brake Assist ...................... 66
BAS .................................................. 62
Brake Assist with cross-traffic
function ........................................... 63
Brake fluid (notes) ......................... 325
Display message ............................ 217
Driving tips .................................... 157
High-performance brake system .... 158
Important safety notes .................. 157
Parking brake ................................ 154
Warning lamp ................................. 245
Breakdown
Where will I find...? ........................ 287
see Flat tyre
see Towing away
Brightness control (instrument
cluster lighting) ................................... 32
C
Calling up a fault
see Display messages
Capacities (technical data) ...............
Car
see Vehicle
Car wash (care) .................................
Care
Automatic car wash .......................
Exhaust pipe ..................................
322
282
282
285
CD
Exterior lighting .............................
High-pressure cleaner ....................
Matt paintwork ..............................
Notes .............................................
Paint ..............................................
Reversing camera ..........................
Sensors .........................................
Washing by hand ...........................
Wheels ...........................................
Windows ........................................
Wiper blades ..................................
285
283
283
281
283
285
285
282
284
284
284
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
CD player (on-board computer) ........ 205
Central locking
Automatic locking (on-board computer) ............................................. 211
Locking/unlocking (key) .................. 77
Centre console
Lower section .................................. 35
Lower section (AMG vehicles) .......... 36
Upper section .................................. 34
Child
Restraint system .............................. 55
Child seat
Forward-facing restraint system ...... 57
ISOFIX .............................................. 56
On the front-passenger seat ............ 56
Rearward-facing restraint system .... 57
Recommendations ........................... 60
Suitable positions ............................ 58
Cigarette lighter ................................ 268
Cleaning
Mirror turn signal ........................... 285
Climate control
Controlling automatically ............... 125
Convenience opening/closing
(air-recirculation mode) ................. 128
Cooling with air dehumidification .. 124
Demisting the windows .................. 127
Demisting the windscreen ............. 126
Indicator lamp ................................ 125
Information on using
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control .................................. 123
Overview of systems ...................... 122
Problem with the rear window
heating .......................................... 128
Index
Problems with cooling with air
dehumidification ............................ 125
Setting the air distribution ............. 126
Setting the air vents ...................... 129
Setting the airflow ......................... 126
Setting the climate mode (AIR
FLOW) ............................................ 125
Setting the temperature ................ 125
Switching air-recirculation mode
on/off ............................................ 128
Switching on/off ........................... 124
Switching residual heat on/off ...... 129
Switching the rear window heating on/off ...................................... 127
Switching the ZONE function on/
off .................................................. 126
THERMOTRONIC (2-zone) automatic climate control ..................... 123
Cockpit
Overview .......................................... 30
see Instrument cluster
Collapsible emergency spare
wheel
see Emergency spare wheel
COMAND Online
Driving dynamics display (except
Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ....... 175, 177
Driving dynamics display
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles) .............. 180
Switching on/off ........................... 253
Combination switch .......................... 115
Connecting a USB device
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
Consumption statistics (on-board
computer) .......................................... 202
Controller ........................................... 254
Convenience closing feature .............. 91
Convenience opening/closing (airrecirculation mode) ........................... 128
Coolant (engine)
Checking the level ......................... 279
Display message ............................ 229
Important safety notes .................. 325
Temperature (on-board computer,
Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ............... 213
Temperature gauge ........................ 200
Warning lamp ................................. 249
Cooling
see Climate control
Copyright .............................................
Cornering light function
Display message ............................
Function/notes .............................
Cruise control
Cruise control lever .......................
Deactivating ...................................
Display message ............................
Driving system ...............................
Important safety notes ..................
LIM indicator lamp .........................
Selecting ........................................
Setting a speed ..............................
Storing and maintaining current
speed .............................................
Cup holder
Centre console ..............................
Important safety notes ..................
29
228
116
160
161
236
159
159
160
160
161
160
266
266
D
Data
see Technical data
Data carrier
Selecting ........................................ 205
Data modem mode
Telephone with Bluetooth® (SAP
profile) ........................................... 259
Daytime driving lights
Display message ............................ 228
Function/notes ............................. 113
Switching on/off (on-board computer) ............................................. 209
Dealership
see Qualified specialist workshop
Declarations of conformity ................. 25
Delayed switch-off
Exterior lighting (on-board computer) ............................................. 210
Interior lighting .............................. 211
Diagnostics connection ...................... 27
Digital Owner's Manual
Help ................................................. 22
Introduction ..................................... 22
Digital speedometer ......................... 203
7
8
Index
Dipped-beam headlamps
Display message ............................ 228
Setting for driving abroad (symmetrical) ........................................ 113
Setting for driving on the right/
left ................................................. 210
Switching on/off ........................... 114
Display message
Driving systems ............................. 231
KEYLESS-GO .................................. 243
Display messages
ASSYST PLUS ................................ 280
Calling up (on-board computer) ..... 216
Engine ............................................ 229
General information ....................... 216
Hiding (on-board computer) ........... 216
Key ................................................ 243
Lights ............................................. 228
Safety systems .............................. 217
Tyres .............................................. 237
Vehicle ........................................... 239
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
Activating ....................................... 163
Calling up the speed ...................... 164
Cruise control lever ....................... 163
Deactivating ................................... 167
Display Message ............................ 234
Displays in the multifunction display ................................................ 166
Driving tips .................................... 167
Function/notes ............................. 161
Important safety notes .................. 162
Selecting ........................................ 163
Setting the specified minimum
distance ......................................... 165
Stopping ........................................ 165
Storing the speed .......................... 164
Warning lamp ................................. 251
Distance warning function
Function/notes ................................ 65
Distance warning signal (warning
lamp) .................................................. 251
Door
Automatic locking (on-board computer) ............................................. 211
Automatic locking (switch) ............... 84
Central locking/unlocking (key) ...... 77
Control panel ................................... 38
Display message ............................ 241
Emergency locking ........................... 84
Emergency unlocking ....................... 84
Important safety notes .................... 82
Opening (from the inside) ................ 83
Power closing .................................. 84
Doors
Overview .......................................... 82
Draught stop
Electrical draught stop ..................... 98
Manual draught stop ........................ 97
Drive program
Display ........................................... 142
Drive programs
Automatic transmission ................. 145
Driver's door
see Door
Driving abroad
Mercedes-Benz Service ................. 281
Symmetrical dipped beam ............. 113
Driving on flooded roads .................. 158
Driving safety system
Active Brake Assist .......................... 64
EBD (electronic brake force distribution) ............................................. 71
STEER CONTROL ............................. 74
Driving safety systems
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ....... 62
Active Brake Assist with crosstraffic function ................................. 72
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ............................. 72
Adaptive Brake Assist ...................... 66
Adaptive brake lights ....................... 67
BAS (Brake Assist System) .............. 62
Brake Assist with cross-traffic
function ........................................... 63
Distance warning function ............... 65
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) ............................................... 67
Important safety guidelines ............. 62
Overview .......................................... 61
Driving system
Active Body Control (ABC) (except
Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ............... 175
Active Body Control (ABC)
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles) .............. 178
Adaptive Damping System ............. 174
Index
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC with
Steering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot ...
RACE START (Mercedes-AMG
vehicles) ........................................
Speed limiter .................................
Driving systems
Active Blind Spot Assist .................
Active Driving Assistance package .................................................
Active Lane Keeping Assist ............
Active Parking Assist .....................
ATTENTION ASSIST ........................
Cruise control ................................
Display message ............................
Distronic Plus ................................
HOLD function ...............................
PARKTRONIC .................................
Reversing camera ..........................
Traffic Sign Assist ..........................
Driving tips
AMG ceramic brakes .....................
Aquaplaning ...................................
Automatic transmission .................
Brakes ...........................................
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC .............
Downhill gradient ...........................
Driving abroad ...............................
Driving in winter .............................
Driving on flooded roads ................
Driving on wet roads ......................
Fuel ................................................
General ..........................................
Icy road surfaces ...........................
Limited braking efficiency on salted roads .......................................
New brake pads/linings ................
Running-in tips ...............................
Snow chains ..................................
Subjecting brakes to a load ...........
Symmetrical dipped beam .............
Wet road surface ...........................
DVD video
Operating (on-board computer) .....
See also Digital Owner's Manual ...
DYNAMIC SELECT button (all vehicles except Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ....................................................
168
173
170
193
193
195
183
190
159
231
161
172
180
187
191
158
158
144
157
167
157
113
159
158
158
156
155
159
158
158
131
307
157
113
157
205
253
139
DYNAMIC SELECT controller
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ................. 140
E
EASY-ENTRY feature
Activating/deactivating ................. 211
Function/notes ............................. 106
EASY-EXIT feature
Crash-responsive ........................... 108
Function/notes ............................. 106
Switching on/off ........................... 211
EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
Display message ............................ 219
Function/notes ................................ 71
ECO display
Function/notes ............................. 156
On-board computer ....................... 202
ECO start/stop function
Automatic engine start .................. 136
Automatic engine switch-off .......... 135
Deactivating/activating ................. 136
General information ....................... 135
Important safety notes .................. 135
Introduction ................................... 135
Electromagnetic compatibility
Declaration of conformity ................ 25
Electronic Stability Program
see ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
Emergency
Automatic measures after an accident ................................................. 54
Emergency key
Unlocking the driver's door .............. 84
Emergency key element
Function/notes ................................ 79
General notes .................................. 79
Inserting .......................................... 79
Locking vehicle ................................ 84
Removing ......................................... 79
Emergency release
Driver's door .................................... 84
Emergency spare wheel
General notes ................................ 318
Important safety notes .................. 318
Inflating the collapsible spare
wheel ............................................. 319
9
10
Index
Removing ....................................... 318
Storage location ............................ 318
Technical data ............................... 318
Emergency unlocking
Vehicle ............................................. 84
Engine
Display message ............................ 229
ECO start/stop function ................ 135
Jump-starting ................................. 296
Running irregularly ......................... 138
Starting problems .......................... 138
Starting the engine with the key .... 134
Starting with KEYLESS GO ............. 134
Stopping ........................................ 153
Tow-starting (vehicle) ..................... 301
Warning lamp (engine diagnostics) ............................................... 249
Engine electronics
Notes ............................................. 320
Problem (fault) ............................... 138
Engine oil
Additives ........................................ 325
Checking the oil level ..................... 277
Checking the oil level using the
dipstick .......................................... 278
Display message ............................ 230
Filling capacity ............................... 325
General notes ................................ 324
Notes about oil grades ................... 324
Notes on oil level/consumption .... 277
Temperature (on-board computer,
Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ............... 213
Topping up ..................................... 278
Entering an address
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
Environmental protection
Returning an end-of-life vehicle ....... 23
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
AMG menu (on-board computer) ... 213
Characteristics ................................. 67
Deactivating/activating (button
in Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ............. 70
Deactivating/activating (except
Mercedes‑AMG vehicles) ................. 69
Display message ............................ 217
Function/notes ................................ 67
General notes .................................. 67
Important safety guidelines ............. 67
Warning lamp ................................. 246
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System) ...................................................... 67
Exhaust pipe (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 285
Exterior lighting
Settings options ............................. 113
see Lights
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting ....................................... 108
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) ........ 109
Folding in when locking (on-board
computer) ...................................... 212
Folding in/out (automatically) ....... 109
Folding in/out (electrically) ........... 109
Out of position (troubleshooting) ... 109
Parking position ............................. 110
Resetting ....................................... 109
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 111
F
Fault message
see Display messages
Favourites
Overview ........................................
Filler cap
see Fuel filler flap
Fire extinguisher ...............................
First-aid kit .........................................
Fitting a wheel
Fitting a wheel ...............................
Lowering the vehicle ......................
Preparing the vehicle .....................
Raising the vehicle .........................
Removing a wheel ..........................
Securing the vehicle against rolling away ........................................
Flat tyre
MOExtended tyres .........................
Preparing the vehicle .....................
TIREFIT kit ......................................
see Emergency spare wheel
Floormat .............................................
Foglamps
Extended range ..............................
254
287
287
316
316
313
313
315
313
289
289
290
274
116
Index
Frequencies
Garage door opener ....................... 272
Mobile phone ................................. 320
Two-way radio ................................ 320
Front-passenger front airbag deactivation
Display message ............................ 226
Front-passenger front airbag deactivation system
Operation ......................................... 46
Problems ......................................... 50
System self-test ............................... 48
Front-passenger seat
Adjusting from the driver's seat ..... 103
Fuel
Additives ........................................ 324
Consumption statistics .................. 202
Displaying the current consumption ................................................ 202
Displaying the range ...................... 202
Driving tips .................................... 156
Fuel gauge ....................................... 32
Grade (petrol) ................................ 323
Important safety notes .................. 322
Notes for Mercedes‑AMG vehicles ................................................ 324
Problem (malfunction) ................... 153
Refuelling ....................................... 151
Tank content/reserve fuel ............. 323
Fuel filler flap
Opening ......................................... 152
Fuel level
Calling up the range (on-board
computer) ...................................... 202
Gauge .............................................. 32
Fuel tank
Capacity ........................................ 323
Problem (malfunction) ................... 153
Fuse allocation chart (vehicle tool
kit) ...................................................... 288
Fuses
Allocation chart ............................. 301
Before changing ............................. 301
Dashboard fuse box ....................... 301
Fuse box in the engine compartment .............................................. 302
Fuse box in the rear compartment .. 302
Important safety notes .................. 301
G
Garage door opener
Clearing the memory ..................... 271
Frequencies ................................... 272
General notes ................................ 269
Important safety notes .................. 270
Opening/closing the garage door .. 271
Problems when programming ........ 271
Programming (button in the rearview mirror) ................................... 270
Synchronising the rolling code ....... 271
Gear indicator (on-board computer, Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ....... 213
Gearshift paddles
see Steering wheel gearshift paddles
Gearshift program
SETUP (on-board computer) .......... 213
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts ........... 23
Glove compartment .......................... 262
Google™ Local Search
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
H
HANDS-FREE ACCESS .......................... 87
Hazard warning lamps
Display message ............................ 242
Switching on/off ........................... 115
Head level heating (AIRSCARF) ........ 105
Head restraints
Adjusting ....................................... 103
see NECK-PRO head restraints
Headbag
Display message ............................ 225
Operation ......................................... 46
Headlamp flasher .............................. 115
Headlamps
see Automatic headlamp mode
Heating
see Climate control
High-pressure cleaners .................... 283
Hill start assist .................................. 135
HOLD function
Activating ....................................... 173
Activation conditions ..................... 173
Deactivating ................................... 173
Display message ............................ 232
11
12
Index
General notes ................................ 172
Home address
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
Horn ...................................................... 30
I
Ignition lock
see Key positions
Immobiliser .......................................... 74
Indicator and warning lamp
Restraint system ............................ 248
Indicator and warning lamps
Coolant .......................................... 249
Engine diagnostics ......................... 249
SPORT handling mode ................... 248
Indicator lamps
Display message ............................ 228
see Warning and indicator lamps
Indicators
see Turn signals
Instrument cluster
Overview .......................................... 32
Instrument cluster lighting .............. 199
Intelligent Light System
Activating/deactivating ................. 209
Display message ............................ 228
Overview ........................................ 115
Setting the dipped-beam headlamps for driving on the right/left .. 210
Interior lighting
Automatic control system .............. 118
Delayed switch-off (on-board
computer) ...................................... 211
Overview ........................................ 117
Reading lamp ................................. 117
Setting the ambient lighting
brightness (on-board computer) .... 210
Setting the ambient lighting colour (on-board computer) ................ 210
Interior motion sensor
Deactivating ..................................... 76
Function ........................................... 75
Priming ............................................ 75
Switching off .................................... 76
iPod®
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
ISOFIX child seat securing system .... 56
J
Jack
Storage location ............................ 288
Using ............................................. 313
Jump starting (engine) ...................... 296
K
Key
Changing the battery ....................... 80
Checking the battery ....................... 80
Display message ............................ 243
Door central locking/unlocking ....... 77
Emergency key element ................... 79
Important safety notes .................... 77
Loss ................................................. 81
Modifying the programming ............. 78
Opening/closing the roof ................ 95
Overview .......................................... 77
Positions (ignition lock) ................. 132
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 81
Starting the engine ........................ 134
Key positions
Key ................................................ 132
KEYLESS GO .................................. 132
KEYLESS-GO
Activating ......................................... 78
Convenience closing ........................ 91
Deactivation ..................................... 78
Display message ............................ 243
Locking ............................................ 78
Removing the Start/Stop button ... 133
Start/Stop button .......................... 132
Starting the engine ........................ 134
Unlocking ......................................... 78
Kickdown
Driving tips .................................... 145
Manual gearshifting ....................... 150
L
Lamps
see Warning and indicator lamps
Lane Keeping Assist
see Active Lane Keeping Assist
Lap time (RACETIMER) ...................... 213
Licence plate lamp (display message) ................................................... 228
Index
Light sensor (display message) .......
Lighting
see Lights
Lights
Activating/deactivating the Intelligent Light System ........................
Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off .......
Active light function .......................
Adaptive Highbeam Assist PLUS ....
Automatic headlamp mode ............
Cornering light function .................
Dipped-beam headlamps ...............
Driving abroad ...............................
Foglamps (extended range) ...........
Hazard warning lamps ...................
Headlamp flasher ...........................
Light switch ...................................
Main-beam headlamps ...................
Motorway mode .............................
Parking lamps ................................
Rear foglamp .................................
Setting the ambient lighting
brightness (on-board computer) ....
Setting the ambient lighting colour (on-board computer) ................
Side lamps .....................................
Switching the daytime driving
lights on/off (on-board computer) .............................................
Switching the exterior lighting
delayed switch-off on/off (onboard computer) ............................
Switching the surround lighting
on/off (on-board computer) ..........
Turn signals ...................................
see Interior lighting
see Replacing bulbs
LIM indicator lamp
Cruise control ................................
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC .............
Variable limiter ..............................
Limiter
Calling up the speed ......................
Deactivating, variable ....................
Function/notes .............................
LIM indicator lamp .........................
Permanent .....................................
228
209
211
116
116
113
116
114
113
116
115
115
113
115
116
114
114
210
210
114
209
210
210
115
160
163
170
171
172
170
170
172
Setting a speed .............................. 171
Storing the current speed .............. 171
Switching to passive ...................... 171
Variable ......................................... 170
Limiting the speed
Speed limiter ................................. 170
LINGUATRONIC
see Separate operating instructions
Loading aid (boot)
Raising/lowering the roof .............. 264
Locking
see Central locking
Locking (doors)
Automatic ........................................ 84
Emergency locking ........................... 84
From inside (central locking button) .................................................. 83
Locking centrally
see Central locking
Locking verification signal (onboard computer) ............................... 211
Luggage cover
see Boot separator
M
M+S tyres ........................................... 306
MAGIC SKY CONTROL ......................... 98
Main-beam headlamps
Adaptive Highbeam Assist PLUS .... 116
Display message ............................ 228
Switching on/off ........................... 115
Matt finish (cleaning instructions) .. 283
Media Interface
see Separate operating instructions
Memory card (audio) ......................... 205
Memory function ............................... 111
Mercedes connect me
Display message ............................ 222
Mercedes-Benz Intelligent Drive
Active Blind Spot Assist ................. 193
Active Lane Keeping Assist ............ 195
Active Parking Assist ..................... 183
ATTENTION ASSIST ........................ 190
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC with
Steering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot ... 168
PRE-SAFE® PLUS (anticipatory
occupant protection PLUS) .............. 53
13
14
Index
Reversing camera .......................... 187
Traffic Sign Assist .......................... 191
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
see Qualified specialist workshop
Message memory (on-board computer) .................................................. 216
Messages
see Display messages
Mirrors
see Exterior mirrors
see Rear-view mirror
Mobile phone
Connecting (Bluetooth® interface) .............................................. 256
Connecting another mobile
phone ............................................ 257
Connecting the telephone module
with Bluetooth® (SAP profile) ......... 259
Frequencies ................................... 320
Installation ..................................... 320
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 205
Notes/placing in the bracket ......... 268
Transmission output (maximum) .... 320
Modifying the programming (key) ..... 78
MOExtended tyres ............................. 289
Motorway mode ................................ 116
MP3
Operating ....................................... 205
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
Multifunction display
Function/notes ............................. 201
Permanent display ......................... 209
Multifunction steering wheel
Operating the on-board computer .. 200
Overview .......................................... 33
Music files
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
N
Navigation
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 203
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
NECK-PRO head restraints
Important safety notes .................... 52
Operation ......................................... 53
Resetting triggered .......................... 53
Notes on running in a new vehicle .. 131
O
Occupant safety
Airbags ............................................ 43
Automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation .......................... 46
Automatic measures after an accident ................................................. 54
Children in the vehicle ..................... 54
Important safety notes .................... 39
PASSENGER AIRBAG indicator
lamp ................................................. 40
Pets in the vehicle ........................... 61
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant protection) ............................... 53
PRE-SAFE® PLUS (anticipatory
occupant protection PLUS) .............. 53
Restraint system introduction .......... 39
Restraint system warning lamp ........ 40
Odometer
see Total distance recorder
see Trip meter
Oil
see Engine oil
On-board computer
AMG menu ..................................... 213
Assistance menu ........................... 207
Audio menu ................................... 204
Convenience submenu .................. 211
Display messages .......................... 216
Displaying a service message ........ 281
Factory setting submenu ............... 212
Important safety notes .................. 199
Instrument cluster submenu .......... 209
Light submenu ............................... 209
Menu overview .............................. 202
Message memory .......................... 216
Navigation menu ............................ 203
Operating the TV ............................ 205
Operating video DVD ..................... 205
Operation ....................................... 200
RACETIMER ................................... 213
Service menu ................................. 208
Settings menu ............................... 208
Standard display ............................ 202
Telephone menu ............................ 205
Trip menu ...................................... 202
Vehicle submenu ........................... 211
Index
Operating instructions
Vehicle equipment ........................... 24
Operating safety
Declaration of conformity ................ 25
Important safety note ...................... 24
Operating system
see On-board computer
Operation
Digital Owner's Manual .................... 22
Outside temperature display ........... 199
Overhead control panel ...................... 37
P
Paint code .......................................... 321
Paintwork (cleaning instructions) ... 283
Panic alarm .......................................... 39
Panoramic roof
Operating the roller sunblind ........... 98
Parking
Important safety notes .................. 153
Parking brake ................................ 154
Position of exterior mirror, frontpassenger side ............................... 110
Reversing camera .......................... 187
see PARKTRONIC
Parking aid
Active Parking Assist ..................... 183
see Exterior mirrors
see PARKTRONIC
Parking assistance
see PARKTRONIC
Parking brake
Applying automatically ................... 155
Applying or releasing manually ...... 154
Display message ............................ 219
Electric parking brake .................... 154
Emergency braking ........................ 155
General information ....................... 154
Releasing automatically ................. 155
Warning lamp ................................. 248
Parking lamps
Display message ............................ 228
Switching on/off ........................... 114
Parking Pilot
Display Message ............................ 233
PARKTRONIC
Deactivating/activating ................. 182
Driving system ............................... 180
Function/notes ............................. 180
Important safety notes .................. 180
Problem (fault) ............................... 183
Sensor range ................................. 180
Warning display ............................. 181
PASSENGER AIR BAG
Display message ............................ 226
Indicator lamps ................................ 40
Problems (malfunctions) ................ 226
Pets in the vehicle ............................... 61
Phone book
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
Power closing ...................................... 84
Power socket
Boot ............................................... 268
Power windows
see Side windows
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant
protection)
Operation ......................................... 53
PRE-SAFE® (preventive occupant
safety system)
Display message ............................ 222
PRE-SAFE® PLUS (anticipatory
occupant protection PLUS)
Operation ......................................... 53
Protection against theft
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 74
Immobiliser ...................................... 74
Interior motion sensor ..................... 75
Tow-away protection ........................ 75
Protection of the environment
General notes .................................. 23
Pulling away
General notes ................................ 134
Pulling away (automatic transmission) .................................................... 134
Q
QR code
Mercedes-Benz Guide App ................. 1
Rescue card ..................................... 28
Qualified specialist workshop ........... 27
15
16
Index
R
RACE START
important safety notes ................... 173
RACE START (Mercedes-AMG vehicles) .................................................... 173
RACETIMER (on-board computer) .... 213
Radio
Selecting a station ......................... 204
see separate operating instructions
Radio mode
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
Radio-based vehicle components
Declaration of conformity ................ 25
Reading lamp ..................................... 117
Rear foglamp
Display message ............................ 228
Switching on/off ........................... 114
Rear lamps
see Lights
Rear window heating
General notes ................................ 127
Problem (fault) ............................... 128
Switching on/off ........................... 127
Rear-view mirror
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) ........ 109
Dipping (manual) ........................... 108
Refuelling
Fuel gauge ....................................... 32
Important safety notes .................. 151
Notes for Mercedes‑AMG vehicles ................................................ 324
Refuelling process ......................... 152
see Fuel
Remote control
Programming (garage door
opener) .......................................... 270
Replacing bulbs
General notes ................................ 118
Rescue card ......................................... 28
Reserve (fuel tank)
see Fuel
Reserve fuel
Display message ............................ 231
Warning lamp ................................. 249
Residual heat (climate control) ........ 129
Restraint system
Display message ............................ 224
Introduction ..................................... 39
Warning lamp ................................. 248
Warning lamp (function) ................... 40
Rev counter ........................................ 199
Reverse gear (selector lever) ........... 143
Reversing camera
Cleaning instructions ..................... 285
Display in the multimedia system .. 187
Function/notes ............................. 187
Switching on/off ........................... 187
Reversing feature
Side windows ................................... 90
Reversing function
Boot lid ............................................ 85
Reversing lamp (display message) .. 228
Roll bar
Display message ............................ 224
Operation ......................................... 50
Roller sunblind .................................... 98
Roof
Display message ............................ 242
Important safety notes .................... 93
Opening/closing (with key) .............. 95
Opening/closing (with roof
switch) ............................................. 94
Overview .......................................... 93
Problem (malfunction) ................... 100
Relocking ......................................... 95
Roof switch .......................................... 94
Route guidance
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
S
Safety
Children in the vehicle ..................... 54
see Occupant safety
Safety system
see Driving safety systems
SD memory card
Ejecting .......................................... 260
Inserting ........................................ 260
Inserting/removing ........................ 260
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
Selecting ........................................ 205
Seat belt
Correct usage .................................. 42
Seat belt guide ............................... 103
Index
Switching belt adjustment on/off
(on-board computer) ...................... 212
Seat belts
Adjusting the driver's and frontpassenger seat belt ......................... 43
Fastening ......................................... 42
Important safety guidelines ............. 41
Introduction ..................................... 41
Releasing ......................................... 43
Warning lamp ................................. 244
Warning lamp (function) ................... 43
Seats
Adjusting (electrically) ................... 102
Adjusting the head restraint .......... 103
Belt guide ...................................... 103
Correct driver's seat position ........ 101
Important safety notes .................. 101
Overview ........................................ 101
Seat heating problem .................... 105
Seat ventilation problem ................ 105
Sliding forward/back ..................... 104
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 111
Switching AIRSCARF on/off .......... 105
Switching seat heating on/off ....... 104
Switching the seat ventilation on/
off .................................................. 105
Selector lever
Positions ........................................ 141
Sensors (cleaning instructions) ....... 285
Service
see ASSYST PLUS
Service Centre
see Qualified specialist workshop
Service menu (on-board computer) .................................................. 208
Service message
see ASSYST PLUS
Service products
Brake fluid ..................................... 325
Coolant (engine) ............................ 325
Engine oil ....................................... 324
Fuel ................................................ 322
Important safety notes .................. 322
Washer fluid ................................... 326
Setting the air distribution ............... 126
Setting the airflow ............................ 126
Setting the date/time format
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
Setting the language
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
Setting the time
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
Settings
Factory (on-board computer) ......... 212
On-board computer ....................... 208
SETUP (on-board computer) ............. 213
Side lamps
Switching on/off ........................... 114
Side windows
Convenience closing ........................ 91
Important safety notes .................... 89
Opening/closing (front) ................... 90
Opening/closing (rear) .................... 91
Opening/closing all ......................... 91
Overview .......................................... 89
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 93
Resetting ......................................... 92
Reversing feature ............................. 90
Sidebag ................................................ 45
SIM card
Inserting ........................................ 258
SMS
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
Snow chains ...................................... 307
Socket
Front-passenger footwell ............... 268
Sockets
General notes ................................ 268
Sound
Switching on/off ........................... 254
Specialist workshop ............................ 27
Spectacles compartment ................. 263
Speed limiter
Display message ............................ 235
Important safety notes .................. 170
Selecting ........................................ 171
Speed, controlling
see Cruise control
Speedometer
Digital ............................................ 203
In the Instrument cluster ................. 32
Segments ...................................... 199
Selecting a display unit .................. 209
17
18
Index
SPORT handling mode
Deactivating/activating
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ................ 70
Warning lamp ................................. 248
Start/stop function
see ECO start/stop function
Starting (engine) ................................ 133
STEER CONTROL .................................. 74
Steering
Display message ............................ 241
Steering Assist and Stop&Go Pilot
(DISTRONIC PLUS)
Activating/deactivating ................. 207
Steering assistant STEER CONTROL
see STEER CONTROL
Steering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot
Display message ............................ 235
Steering wheel
Adjusting (electrically) ................... 106
Button overview ............................... 33
Buttons (on-board computer) ......... 200
Important safety notes .................. 106
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 111
Steering wheel gearshift paddles .... 147
Stopwatch (RACETIMER) ................... 213
Stowage areas ................................... 262
Stowage compartments
Armrest (under) ............................. 262
Centre console .............................. 263
Centre console (rear) ..................... 263
Cup holder ..................................... 266
Glove compartment ....................... 262
Important safety information ......... 262
Rear ............................................... 264
Spectacles compartment ............... 263
Stowage net ....................................... 264
Stowage space
Display message ............................ 241
Stowage net ................................... 264
Umbrella holder ............................. 263
Stowage well beneath the boot
floor .................................................... 266
Summer tyres .................................... 306
Sun visor ............................................ 267
Surround lighting (on-board computer) ..................................................
Suspension settings
Active Body Control (ABC) (except
Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ...............
Active Body Control (ABC)
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ..............
SETUP (on-board computer) ..........
Switching on media mode
Via the device list ..........................
210
176
179
213
260
T
Tail lamps
Display message ............................
see Lights
Technical data
Capacities ......................................
Emergency spare wheel .................
Information ....................................
Tyres/wheels .................................
Vehicle data ...................................
Telephone
Accepting a call (multifunction
steering wheel) ..............................
Authorising a mobile phone (connecting) .........................................
Connecting a Mobile phone (general information) ............................
Display message ............................
Menu (on-board computer) ............
Number from the phone book ........
Redialling .......................................
Rejecting/ending a call .................
See also Digital Owner's Manual ...
Switching between mobile
phones ...........................................
Telephone compartment ................
Telephone module with Bluetooth®
(SAP profile)
Activating and connecting the
module ...........................................
Charging a mobile phone ...............
Connecting the mobile phone ........
Connecting the module using a
USB cable ......................................
Data modem mode ........................
Installing the module .....................
228
322
318
320
317
327
206
256
256
241
205
206
206
206
253
257
262
258
260
259
258
259
258
Index
Introduction ................................... 257
Saving/deleting the PIN for the
SIM card ........................................ 259
Settings ......................................... 259
SIM card mode .............................. 258
Text messages ............................... 260
Transferring the phone book .......... 259
Temperature
Coolant .......................................... 200
Coolant (on-board computer,
Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ............... 213
Engine oil (on-board computer,
Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ............... 213
Outside temperature ...................... 199
Setting (climate control) ................ 125
Transmission oil (on-board computer, Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ..... 213
TEMPOMAT
Function/notes ............................. 159
Text messages
Telephone module with Bluetooth® (SAP profile) ....................... 260
Timing (RACETIMER) ......................... 213
TIREFIT kit .......................................... 290
Declaration of conformity ................ 26
Important safety notes .................. 290
Storage location ............................ 288
Tyre pressure not reached ............. 291
Tyre pressure reached ................... 292
Total distance recorder .................... 202
Tow-away protection
Activating ......................................... 75
Deactivating ..................................... 75
Function ........................................... 75
Tow-starting
Emergency engine starting ............ 301
Important safety notes .................. 298
Towing
Important safety notes .................. 298
Transporting the vehicle ................ 300
With the rear axle raised ................ 300
Towing away
Fitting the towing eye .................... 299
Removing the towing eye ............... 299
With both axles on the ground ....... 300
Traffic Sign Assist
Activating/deactivating the warning function ....................................
Display message ............................
Function/notes .............................
Important safety notes ..................
Instrument cluster display .............
Transmission
Selector lever ................................
see Automatic transmission
Transmission position display .........
Transporting the vehicle ..................
Trip computer (on-board computer) ..................................................
Trip meter
Calling up .......................................
Resetting (on-board computer) ......
Turn signals
Switching on/off ...........................
TV
Operating (on-board computer) .....
see Separate operating instructions
Two-way radio
Frequencies ...................................
Installation .....................................
Transmission output (maximum) ....
Type identification plate
see Vehicle identification plate
Tyre changing tool kit .......................
Tyre inflation compressor
see TIREFIT kit
Tyre pressure
Calling up (on-board computer) .....
Display message ............................
Not reached (TIREFIT) ....................
Reached (TIREFIT) ..........................
Recommended ...............................
Tyre pressure loss warning
General notes ................................
Important safety notes ..................
Restarting ......................................
Tyre pressure monitor
Checking the tyre pressure electronically ........................................
Function/notes .............................
General notes ................................
Important safety notes ..................
207
232
191
192
192
141
142
300
202
202
203
115
205
320
320
320
288
309
237
291
292
307
308
309
309
310
309
309
310
19
20
Index
Radio type approval for the tyre
pressure monitor ...........................
Restarting ......................................
Warning lamp .................................
Warning message ..........................
Tyres
Changing a wheel ..........................
Checking ........................................
Direction of rotation ......................
Display message ............................
Important safety notes ..................
Information on driving ....................
M+S tyres ......................................
MOExtended tyres .........................
Overview ........................................
Replacing .......................................
Service life .....................................
Storing ...........................................
Summer tyres ................................
Tyre size (data) ..............................
Tyre tread ......................................
Wheel and tyre combinations ........
see Flat tyre
311
311
252
311
312
304
312
237
304
304
306
306
304
312
305
313
306
317
305
317
U
Umbrella holder ................................. 263
Unlocking
Emergency unlocking ....................... 84
From inside the vehicle (central
unlocking button) ............................. 83
Upshift indicator (on-board computer, Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ....... 213
USB devices
Connecting to the Media Interface ............................................... 261
V
Vehicle
Correct use ...................................... 28
Data acquisition ............................... 28
Display message ............................ 239
Electronics ..................................... 320
Equipment ....................................... 24
Implied warranty .............................. 28
Individual settings .......................... 208
Leaving parked up ......................... 155
Locking (in an emergency) ............... 84
Locking (key) ................................... 77
Lowering ........................................ 316
Pulling away ................................... 134
Raising ........................................... 313
Registration ..................................... 27
Securing from rolling away ............ 313
Tow-starting ................................... 298
Towing away .................................. 298
Transporting .................................. 300
Unlocking (in an emergency) ........... 84
Unlocking (key) ................................ 77
Vehicle data ................................... 327
Vehicle battery
see Battery (vehicle)
Vehicle data ....................................... 327
Vehicle dimensions ........................... 327
Vehicle emergency locking ................ 84
Vehicle identification number
see VIN
Vehicle identification plate .............. 321
Vehicle level
Active Body Control (ABC) (except
Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ............... 175
Active Body Control (ABC)
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles) .............. 178
Display message ............................ 231
Vehicle tool kit .................................. 288
Video
Operating the DVD ......................... 205
See also Digital Owner's Manual ... 253
VIN
Seat ............................................... 322
Type plate ...................................... 321
W
Warning and indicator lamps
ABS ................................................
Active Brake Assist ........................
Brake Assist ...................................
Brakes ...........................................
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC .............
Distance warning signal .................
ESP® ..............................................
ESP® OFF .......................................
Fuel tank ........................................
General notes ................................
LIM (cruise control) ........................
246
251
251
245
251
251
246
247
249
244
160
Index
LIM (Distance Pilot DISTRONIC) ....
LIM (variable limiter) ......................
Parking brake ................................
PASSENGER AIR BAG ......................
Reserve fuel ...................................
Seat belt ........................................
Tyre pressure monitor ...................
Warning triangle ................................
Washer fluid
Display message ............................
Wheel and tyre combinations
Tyres ..............................................
Wheel bolt tightening torque ...........
Wheel chock ......................................
Wheels
Changing a wheel ..........................
Changing/replacing .......................
Checking ........................................
Cleaning .........................................
Emergency spare wheel .................
Fitting a new wheel ........................
Fitting a wheel ...............................
Important safety notes ..................
Information on driving ....................
Overview ........................................
Removing a wheel ..........................
Storing ...........................................
Tightening torque ...........................
Wheel size/tyre size ......................
Windows
Cleaning .........................................
see Side windows
Windscreen
Demisting ......................................
Windscreen washer fluid
see Windscreen washer system
Windscreen washer system
Important safety notes ..................
Topping up .....................................
Windscreen wipers
Display message ............................
Problem (malfunction) ...................
Replacing the wiper blades ............
Switching on/off ...........................
Winter operation
Important safety notes ..................
Overview ........................................
Slippery road surfaces ...................
163
170
248
40
249
244
252
287
242
317
316
313
312
312
304
284
318
316
313
304
304
304
315
313
316
317
284
126
326
280
242
121
119
118
306
306
159
Snow chains ..................................
Winter tyres
Limiting the speed (on-board computer) .............................................
M+S tyres ......................................
Wiper blades
Cleaning .........................................
Important safety notes ..................
Replacing .......................................
Workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
307
211
306
284
119
119
Z
ZONE function
Switching on/off ........................... 126
21
Digital Owner's Manual
22
Introduction
The printed Owner's Manual provides information about the safe operation of your vehicle.
The Digital Owner's Manual provides comprehensive and specifically adapted information on
the equipment in your vehicle and your multimedia system. You can call up the Digital Owner's Manual using the multimedia system.
i You will not incur any costs when calling up
the Digital Owner's Manual. The Digital Owner's Manual works without connecting to the
Internet.
There are three ways to access the topics of the
Digital Owner's Manual:
RVisual search
The visual search allows you to explore your
vehicle "virtually". Starting from either the
vehicle exterior view or interior view, you can
access many of the different topics covered
by the Digital Owner's Manual. To access the
vehicle interior section, select the "Vehicle
interior" view.
RKeyword search
The keyword search allows you to search for a
keyword by entering characters.
RContents
You can select individual sections in the contents.
i The Digital Owner's Manual is deactivated
for safety reasons while driving.
Operation
Calling up the Digital Owner's Manual
Press the Ø button in the centre console.
The overview relating to the vehicle appears.
X Select the "Owner's Manual" menu item by
turning 3 or pressing 7 the controller.
X Confirm 7 the message about the warning
and safety notes.
The basic menu for the Digital Owner's Manual appears.
X
Operating the Digital Owner's Manual
General notes
Please observe the information about the operation of the controller (Y page 254).
Content pages
You can access the content pages by means of
a visual search, a keyword search or using the
contents.
To scroll forwards/backwards: turn 3
the controller.
X To display in full-screen or animation: slide
8 the controller to the left :.
X
To select information texts or save bookmarks: slide 9 the controller to the
right ;.
X To select a link: slide 6 the controller
downwards =.
X To exit a content page: select the %
symbol ?.
X To call up the basic menu of the Digital
Owner's Manual: select the Þ symbol
A.
X To switch functions to the multimedia
system using the buttons on the centre
console: press the $, %, Õ or Ø
button.
The selected menu appears. The Digital Owner's Manual remains open in the background.
X
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
General notes
H Environmental note
Daimler's declared policy is one of comprehensive environmental protection.
Our objectives are to use the natural resources which form the basis of our existence on
this planet sparingly and in a manner which
takes the requirements of both nature and
humanity into consideration.
You too can help to protect the environment
by operating your vehicle in an environmentally-responsible manner.
Fuel consumption and the rate of engine,
transmission, brake and tyre wear depend on
the following factors:
Roperating
conditions of your vehicle
personal driving style
You can influence both factors. Therefore,
please bear the following in mind:
Operating conditions:
Ryour
Ravoid
short trips, as these increase fuel
consumption.
Robserve the correct tyre pressure.
Rdo not carry any unnecessary weight in the
vehicle.
Rremove the roof rack once you no longer
need it.
Ra regularly serviced vehicle will contribute
to environmental protection. You should
therefore adhere to the service intervals.
Rall maintenance work should be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Personal driving style:
Rdo not depress the accelerator pedal when
starting the engine.
Rdo not warm up the engine when the vehicle
is stationary.
Rdrive carefully and maintain a safe distance
from the vehicle in front.
frequent, sudden acceleration and
braking.
Ravoid
Rchange gear in good time and use each gear
only up to Ô of its maximum engine speed.
off the engine in stationary traffic.
Rmonitor the vehicle's fuel consumption.
Rswitch
Returning an end-of-life vehicle
EU countries only:
Mercedes-Benz will take back your old vehicle to
dispose of it in an environmentally-responsible
manner in accordance with the European Union
(EU) End of Life Vehicles Directive.
There is a network of return points and disassembly plants available. You can return your
vehicle to these plants free of charge. This
makes a valuable contribution to the recycling
process and the conservation of resources.
For further information on recycling old vehicles, recovery and the terms of the policy, visit
the Mercedes-Benz homepage.
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
H Environmental note
Daimler AG also supplies reconditioned
assemblies and parts which are of the same
quality as new parts. For these, the same warranty applies as for new parts.
! Airbags and seat belt tensioners, as well as
control units and sensors for these restraint
systems, may be installed in the following
areas of your vehicle:
Rdoors
Rdoor pillars
Rdoor sills
Rseats
Rdashboard
Rinstrument cluster
Rcentre console
Do not install accessories such as audio systems in these areas. Do not carry out repairs
or welding. You could impair the operating
efficiency of the restraint systems.
Have accessories retrofitted at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Z
Introduction
Protection of the environment
23
Introduction
24
Operating safety
You could jeopardise the operating safety of
your vehicle if you use parts, tyres and wheels as
well as accessories relevant to safety which
have not been approved by Mercedes-Benz. This
could lead to malfunctions in safety-relevant
systems, e.g. the brake system. Only use genuine Mercedes-Benz parts or parts of equal quality. Only use tyres, wheels and accessories that
have been specifically approved for your vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz tests genuine parts and conversion parts and accessories that have been specifically approved for your vehicle for their reliability, safety and suitability. Despite ongoing
market research, Mercedes-Benz is unable to
assess other parts. Mercedes-Benz therefore
accepts no responsibility for the use of such
parts in Mercedes-Benz vehicles, even if they
have been officially approved or independently
approved by a testing centre.
In Germany, certain parts are only officially
approved for installation or modification if they
comply with legal requirements. This also
applies to some other countries. All genuine
Mercedes-Benz parts meet the approval
requirements. The use of non-approved parts
may invalidate the vehicle's general operating
permit.
This is the case:
Rif they cause a change of the vehicle type from
that for which the vehicle's general operating
permit was granted
Rif other road users could be endangered
Rif the emission or noise levels are adversely
affected
Always specify the vehicle identification number
(VIN) (Y page 321) when ordering genuine
Mercedes-Benz parts.
Owner's Manual
Vehicle equipment
i This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available for your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Note that your
vehicle may not be fitted with all features
described. This is also the case for systems
and functions relevant to safety. Therefore,
the equipment on your vehicle may differ from
that in the descriptions and illustrations.
The original purchase contract documentation
for your vehicle contains a list of all of the systems in your vehicle.
Should you have any questions concerning
equipment and operation, please consult a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
The Owner's Manual and Service Booklet are
important documents and should kept in the
vehicle.
Operating safety
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you do not have the prescribed service/
maintenance work or necessary repairs carried out, this could result in malfunctions or
system failures. There is a risk of an accident.
Always have the prescribed service/maintenance work as well as necessary repairs carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Flammable material such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact with
hot parts of the exhaust system. There is a risk
of fire.
When driving off road or on unpaved roads,
check the vehicle's underside regularly. In
particular, remove parts of plants or other
flammable materials which have become
trapped. In the case of damage, contact a
qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Modifications to electronic components, their
software as well as wiring could affect their
function and/or the operation of other networked components. This could in particular
also be the case for systems relevant to
safety. They might not function properly anymore and/or jeopardise the operational
safety of the vehicle. There is an increased
risk of an accident and injury.
Do not attempt to modify the wiring as well as
electronic components or their software.
Operating safety
If you make any changes to the vehicle electronics, the general operating permit is rendered invalid.
Electromagnetic compatibility
The electromagnetic compatibility of the vehicle
components has been checked and certified
according to the currently valid version of Regulation ECE-R 10.
! There is a risk of damage to the vehicle if:
Rthe
vehicle becomes stuck, e.g. on a high
kerb or an unpaved road
Ryou drive too fast over an obstacle, e.g. a
kerb or a pothole in the road
Ra heavy object strikes the underbody or
parts of the chassis
In situations like this, the body, the underbody, chassis parts, wheels or tyres could be
damaged without the damage being visible.
Components damaged in this way can unexpectedly fail or, in the case of an accident, no
longer withstand the strain they are designed
for.
If the underbody panelling is damaged, combustible materials such as leaves, grass or
twigs can gather between the underbody and
the underbody panelling. If these materials
come in contact with hot parts of the exhaust
system, they can catch fire.
In such situations, have the vehicle checked
and repaired immediately at a qualified specialist workshop. If, upon continuing your
journey, you notice that driving safety is
impaired, pull over and stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic
conditions. In such cases, consult a qualified
specialist workshop.
Declarations of conformity
Wireless vehicle components
The following information applies to all components of the vehicle and the information systems and communication devices integrated
into the vehicle which receive and/or transmit
radio waves:
The components of this vehicle that receive
and/or transmit radio waves are compliant with
the basic requirements and all other relevant
conditions of Directive 1999/5/EC. You can
obtain further information from any MercedesBenz Service Centre.
Z
Introduction
Always have work on electrical and electronic
components carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
25
26
Operating safety
Introduction
TIREFIT kit
Copy and translation of the original declaration of conformity:
CE
EC declaration of conformity
in accordance with EC Directive with regard to
2006/42/EC on machinery, Annex II B
The equipment / machinery
Make:
Integrated kit
Type/model:
10-300-0002
Serial numbers:
Year of manufacture:
was developed, designed and manufactured in accordance with EC Directives
2006/42/EC on machinery and 2004/108/EC on Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC)
as sole responsibility of
active Tools Europe GmbH
Otto-Hahn-Str. 72
32108 Bad Salzuflen
Germany
The following harmonised standards were applied:
Designation
Track
Edition
IEC 61000-1
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC), interference immunity 2005
IEC 61000-2
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC), interference emission
2005
EN ISO 12100-1
Safety of machinery
2009
DIN EN 1012-1
Compressors and vacuum pumps - Safety requirements Part 2010
1: Compressors
DIN EN 894-1
Safety of machinery - Ergonomics requirements for the
design of displays and control actuators - Part 1: General
principles
2008
DIN EN 894-2
Safety of machinery - Ergonomics requirements for the
design of displays and control actuators - Part 2: Displays
2008
DIN EN 55014-1
Electromagnetic compatibility - Requirements for household 2011
appliances, electric tools and similar apparatus - Part 1:
Emission
DIN EN 55014-2
Electromagnetic compatibility - Requirements for household 2008
appliances, electric tools and similar apparatus - Part 2:
Immunity
The applicable safety and health protection requirements for the design and construction of machinery based on Annex I of the Directive on Machinery are complied with.
Complete technical documentation is available
1 in the original version
Operating safety
27
In the eventuality of modifications made to the machinery/equipment after delivery which have not
been cleared with active Tools Europe GmbH, this declaration loses its validity.
Authorised representative(s) for the compilation of the technical documentation, CE commissioner(s)
22.6.2015
[Name signatory]
[Stamp]
Date
Signatory and details of signatory
Signature
Diagnostics connection
The diagnostics connection is only intended for
the connection of diagnostic equipment at a
qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If you connect equipment to a diagnostics
connection in the vehicle, it may affect the
operation of vehicle systems. As a result, the
operating safety of the vehicle could be affected. There is a risk of an accident.
Only connect equipment to a diagnostics connection in the vehicle, which is approved for
your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz.
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
! If the engine is switched off and equipment
on the diagnostics connection is used, the
starter battery may discharge.
Connecting equipment to the diagnostics connection can lead to emissions monitoring information being reset, for example. This may lead
to the vehicle failing to meet the requirements of
the next emissions test during the main inspection.
Qualified specialist workshop
A qualified specialist workshop has the necessary special skills, tools and qualifications to
correctly carry out any necessary work on your
vehicle. This particularly applies to work relevant to safety.
Observe the notes in the Service Booklet.
Always have the following work carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop:
Rwork relevant to safety
Rservice and maintenance work
Rrepair work
Rmodifications, installations and conversions
Rwork on electronic components
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Vehicle registration
Mercedes-Benz may ask its Service Centres to
carry out technical inspections on certain vehicles. The quality or safety of the vehicle is
improved as a result of the inspection.
Mercedes-Benz can only inform you about vehicle checks if it has your registration data.
It is possible that your vehicle has not yet been
registered in your name in the following cases:
Rif your vehicle was not purchased at an
authorised specialist dealer.
Rif your vehicle has not yet been examined at a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
It is advisable to register your vehicle with a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Z
Introduction
The operating instructions for the machinery/machine part are available
1 in the language of the user's country: German
Introduction
28
Data stored in the vehicle
Inform Mercedes-Benz as soon as possible
about any change in address or vehicle ownership. You can do this at a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, for example.
Correct use
If you remove any warning stickers, you or others could fail to recognise certain dangers.
Leave warning stickers in position.
Observe the following information when driving
your vehicle:
Rthe safety notes in this manual
Rthe vehicle technical data
Rtraffic rules and regulations
Rlaws and safety standards pertaining to motor
vehicles
Implied warranty
! Follow the instructions in this manual about
the proper operation of your vehicle as well as
about possible vehicle damage. Damage to
your vehicle that arises from culpable contraventions against these instructions are not
covered either by Mercedes-Benz implied
warranty or by the New or Used-Vehicle Warranty.
QR code for rescue card
The QR code is secured in the fuel filler flap and
on the opposite side on the B-pillar. In the event
of an accident, rescue services can use the QR
code to quickly find the appropriate rescue card
for your vehicle. The current rescue card contains, in a compact form, the most important
information about your vehicle, e.g. the routing
of the electric cables.
You can find more information under http://
portal.aftersales.i.daimler.com/public/
content/asportal/en/communication/
informationen_fuer/QRCode.html.
Data stored in the vehicle
A wide range of electronic components in your
vehicle contain data memories.
These data memories temporarily or permanently store technical information about:
Rthe vehicle's operating state
Revents
Rfaults
In general, this technical information documents the state of a component, a module, a
system or the surroundings.
These include, for example:
Roperating conditions of system components,
e.g. fluid levels
Rthe vehicle's status messages and those of its
individual components, e.g. number of wheel
revolutions/speed, deceleration in movement, lateral acceleration, accelerator pedal
position
Rmalfunctions and defects in important system
components, e.g. lights, brakes
Rvehicle reactions and operating conditions in
special driving situations, e.g. airbag deployment, intervention of stability control systems
Rambient conditions, e.g. outside temperature
This data is of an exclusively technical nature
and can be used to:
Rassist in detecting and rectifying faults and
defects
Ranalyse vehicle functions, e.g. after an accident
Roptimise vehicle functions
The data cannot be used to trace the vehicle's
movements.
When your vehicle is serviced, technical information can be read from the event data memory
and fault data memory.
Services include, for example:
Rrepair services
Rservice processes
Rwarranty events
Rquality assurance
The vehicle is read out by employees of the service network (including the manufacturer) using
special diagnostic testers. You can obtain more
information there, if required.
After a fault has been rectified, the information
is deleted from the fault memory or is continually overwritten.
When operating the vehicle, situations are conceivable in which this technical data, in connec-
Copyright information
Introduction
tion with other information (if necessary, after
consultation with an authorised expert), could
be traced to a person.
Examples include:
Raccident reports
Rdamage to the vehicle
Rwitness statements
Further additional functions that have been contractually agreed upon with the customer allow
certain vehicle data to be conveyed by the vehicle as well. The additional functions include, for
example, vehicle location in case of an emergency.
29
Copyright information
General notes
Information on licences for free and opensource software used in your vehicle and its
electronic components is available on the following website:
http://www.mercedes-benz.com/opensource
Z
30
Cockpit
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
:
Steering wheel gearshift paddles
147
;
Combination switch
115
=
To adjust the steering wheel
electrically
106
?
Horn
A
Instrument cluster
B
PARKTRONIC warning display
C
Overhead control panel
32
180
37
Function
Page
D
Climate control systems
122
E
Ignition lock
Start/Stop button
132
132
F
Cruise control lever
160
G
Electric parking brake
154
H
Light switch
113
I
Diagnostics connection
J
To open the bonnet
27
277
31
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
:
Overhead control panel
;
PARKTRONIC warning display
180
=
Combination switch
115
?
To adjust the steering wheel
electrically
106
A
Horn
B
Instrument cluster
C
Steering wheel gearshift paddles
37
32
147
Function
Page
D
To open the bonnet
E
Diagnostics connection
F
Light switch
113
G
Electric parking brake
154
H
Ignition lock
Start/Stop button
132
132
I
Cruise control lever
160
J
Climate control systems
122
277
27
32
Instrument cluster
At a glance
Instrument cluster
i Instrument cluster with speedometer
Function
(km/h)
Function
:
Page
Speedometer with segments
Warning and indicator lamps:
! Electric parking brake
(red)
! Electric parking brake
(yellow)
J Brakes (yellow)
· Distance warning
å ESP® OFF
! ABS
J Brakes (red)
L Dipped-beam headlamps
T Side lamps
K Main-beam headlamps
÷ ESP®
199
;
#! Turn signals
115
=
Multifunction display
201
?
248
248
245
251
246
246
245
114
114
115
246
Information on displaying the outside temperature in the multifunction display can be found
under "Outside temperature display"
(Y page 199).
A
B
C
Page
Rev counter
Warning and indicator lamps:
M SPORT handling mode
in Mercedes-AMG vehicles
R Rear foglamp
N This lamp has no function
; Engine diagnostics
h Tyre pressure monitor
6 Restraint system
ü Seat belts
199
Coolant temperature gauge
Warning and indicator lamps:
? Coolant
200
248
114
249
252
40
244
249
Fuel gauge display
Warning and indicator lamps:
8 Reserve fuel with fuel
filler cap location indicator
(right-hand side)
249
Instrument cluster lighting
199
Multifunction steering wheel
33
At a glance
Multifunction steering wheel
Function
:
Multifunction display
;
Multimedia system display
=
?
Switches on LINGUATRONIC
8
Mutes
WX
Adjusts the volume
~
Rejects or ends a call
Exits the telephone book/
redial memory
6
Makes or accepts a call
Switches to the redial memory
Page
201
205
i In vehicles with the COMAND Online multi-
media system you can find further information:
Ron the multimedia system in the Digital
Owner's Manual
Ron LINGUATRONIC in the separate operating instructions
Function
?
=;
Selects a menu
9:
Selects a submenu or scrolls
through lists
a
Confirms the selection
Hides display messages
%
Back
Switches off LINGUATRONIC
Page
200
200
200
216
200
34
Centre console
Centre console
At a glance
Centre console, upper section
Function
Page
:
COMAND Online
;
c Seat heating
104
=
s Seat ventilation
105
?
Ò AIRSCARF
105
A
c PARKTRONIC
180
B
£ Hazard warning lamps
115
i In vehicles with the COMAND Online multi-
media system you can find further information:
Ron the multimedia system in the Digital
Owner's Manual
Ron LINGUATRONIC in the separate operating instructions
Function
C
a PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF indicator lamp
D
å ESP® (except
Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
è ECO start/stop button
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Page
40
67
135
Centre console
35
At a glance
Centre console, lower section (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Function
Page
:
Stowage compartment
Cup holders
Ashtray
;
COMAND controller
=
Seat adjustment
?
Favourites button
A
Roof switch
94
B
Opens/closes the side windows
91
C
Extends/retracts the
draught stop
98
D
Stowage compartment with
Media Interface
Cigarette lighter
262
E
Selects park position
141
F
è ECO start/stop button
135
263
266
267
Function
G
Page
Shows the driving conditions
menu in the COMAND display (vehicles with Active
Body Control)
175
É Adjusts the vehicle
level (vehicles with Active
Body Control)
175
Adjusts the suspension settings
Adjusts the suspension settings (vehicles with Active
Body Control)
176
Ú Selects the drive program/program selector button
147
K
Transmission positions
144
L
Selector lever
141
H
I
J
36
Centre console
At a glance
Centre console, lower section (Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Function
:
Stowage compartment
Cup holders
Ashtray
Page
263
266
267
;
COMAND controller
=
Seat adjustment
?
Favourites button
A
Roof switch
94
B
Opens/closes the side windows
91
C
Extends/retracts the
draught stop
98
D
Stowage compartment with
Media Interface
Cigarette lighter
262
Function
Page
E
Selects park position
141
F
Drive program selector
140
G
ß AMG button (calls up/
stores drive program or suspension setting)
140
H
à Adjusts the suspension
setting
140
I
å ESP®
J
Transmission positions
144
K
Selector lever
141
67
Overhead control panel
37
At a glance
Overhead control panel
Function
Page
:
p Switches the left-hand
reading lamp on/off
117
;
c Switches the interior
lighting on/off
117
=
µ Operates MAGIC SKY
CONTROL
98
?
| Switches the automatic
interior lighting control
on/off
117
p Switches the righthand reading lamp on/off
117
A
Function
Page
B
ë Deactivates tow-away
protection
C
Rear-view mirror
109
D
Buttons for the garage door
opener
271
E
ê Deactivates the interior
motion sensor
75
F
Spectacles compartment
75
263
38
Door control panel
At a glance
Door control panel
Function
Page
Function
Page
:
Opens the door
83
A
;
% & Unlocks/locks
the vehicle
o Opens/closes the boot
lid
88
83
B
=
Adjusts the seats
7Zö\
Adjusts and folds the exterior
mirrors in/out electrically
108
?
r45=
Stores seat, exterior mirror
and steering column adjustment settings
w Adjusts the frontpassenger seat from the
driver’s seat
W Opens/closes the side
windows
89
101
C
111
103
Panic alarm
To activate: press ! button : for
approximately one second.
A visual and audible alarm is triggered if the
alarm system is primed.
X To deactivate: press the ! button :
again.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
or
X Press the KEYLESS-GO Start/Stop button.
The KEYLESS-GO key must be in the vehicle.
The panic alarm function is only available in certain countries.
X
Occupant safety
The various components of the restraint system
work complementary to one another. They can
only perform their intended protective function
if all vehicle occupants:
Rhave correctly fastened their seat belt
(Y page 42)
Rhave correctly adjusted their seat and head
restraint (Y page 101).
As the driver, you must also ensure that the
steering wheel is correctly adjusted. Observe
the information relating to the correct driver's
seat position (Y page 101).
Additionally, you must ensure that an airbag can
deploy freely (Y page 43).
The airbag is supplementary to a correctly fastened seat belt. As an additional safety device,
the airbag increases the level of protection for
vehicle occupants in the event of an accident. If
the protection provided by the seat belt is sufficient, the airbags do not deploy. Furthermore,
in the event of an accident, only airbags which
provide greater protection in the given accident
situation deploy. However, seat belts and airbags generally do not protect against objects
penetrating the vehicle from the outside.
Information on how the restraint system operates can be found in "Deployment of the seat
belt tensioner and airbags" (Y page 51).
See "Children in the vehicle" for information on
infants and children traveling with you in the
vehicle restraint systems for infants and children(Y page 54).
Introduction to the restraint system
The restraint system can reduce the risk of vehicle occupants coming into contact with parts of
the vehicle's interior in the event of an accident.
Furthermore, the restraint system can also
reduce the forces to which vehicle occupants
are subjected during an accident.
The restraint system includes:
RSeat belt system
RAirbags
RChild restraint system
RChild seat securing system
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the restraint system is modified, it may no
longer work as intended. The restraint system
may then not perform its intended protective
function by failing in an accident or triggering
unexpectedly, for example. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Never modify parts of the restraint system. Do
not attempt to modify the wiring as well as
electronic components or their software.
If it is necessary to modify an airbag system to
accommodate a person with disabilities, contact a qualified specialist workshop for details.
Z
39
Safety
Occupant safety
40
Occupant safety
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Safety
Restraint system warning lamp
The functions of the restraint system are
checked after the ignition is switched on and at
regular intervals while the engine is running.
Therefore, malfunctions can be detected in
good time.
The 6 restraint system warning lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up when the ignition is
switched on. It goes out no later than a few seconds after the vehicle is started. The components of the restraint system are in operational
readiness.
A malfunction has occurred if the 6 restraint
system warning lamp:
Rdoes not light up after the ignition is switched
on
Rdoes not go out after a few seconds with the
engine running
Rlights up again while the engine is running
G WARNING
If the restraint system is malfunctioning,
restraint system components may be triggered unintentionally or may not deploy as
intended during an accident. This may affect
the seat belt tensioner or airbag, for example.
This poses an increased risk of injury or even
fatal injury.
Have the restraint system checked and
repaired immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop.
PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lamp
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp : and
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp ; are
part of the automatic deactivation system of the
front-passenger front airbag.
The indicator lamps display the status of the
front-passenger front airbag.
RPASSENGER AIR BAG ON lights up: the frontpassenger front airbag is enabled. If, in the
event of an accident, all deployment criteria
are met, the front-passenger front airbag is
deployed.
RPASSENGER AIR BAG OFF lights up: the frontpassenger front airbag is disabled. It will then
not be deployed in the event of an accident.
Depending on the person in the front-passenger
seat, the front-passenger front airbag must
either be disabled or enabled; see the following
points. You must make sure of this both before
and during a journey.
RChildren in a rearward-facing child
restraint system: the PASSENGER AIR BAG
OFF indicator lamp must be lit. The frontpassenger front airbag is disabled. It is imperative to observe the notes on the "Automatic
front-passenger front airbag deactivation system" (Y page 46) and on "Children in the
vehicle" (Y page 54).
RChildren in a forward-facing child
restraint system: depending on the installed
child restraint system and the age and size of
the child, the front-passenger front airbag is
either disabled or enabled. Therefore, it is
imperative to observe the notes on the "Automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system" (Y page 46) and on "Children in
the vehicle" (Y page 54).
RAll other persons: the PASSENGER AIR BAG
ON indicator lamp must be lit. The frontpassenger front airbag is enabled. Depending
on the build of the person on the frontpassenger seat, the PASSENGER AIR BAG
OFF indicator lamp may light up. The frontpassenger front airbag is disabled. It will then
not be deployed in the event of an accident. In
this case, the front-passenger seat should not
be used.
It is imperative to observe the notes on the
"Automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system" (Y page 46) as well as
on "Seat belts" (Y page 41) and "Airbags"
(Y page 43). There you can also find information on the correct seat position.
Occupant safety
Introduction
A correctly worn seat belt is the most effective
means of restraining the movement of vehicle
occupants in the event of a collision or if the
vehicle overturns. This reduces the risk of vehicle occupants coming into contact with parts of
the vehicle interior or being ejected from it. The
seat belt also helps to keep the vehicle occupants in the best position in relation to the airbag being deployed.
The seat belt system consists of:
Rseat belts
Rbelt tensioners and belt force limiters
If the seat belt is pulled quickly or sharply by the
seat belt guide, the inertia reel locks. The belt
strap cannot be pulled out any further.
The belt tensioner tightens the seat belt in the
event of a collision so that it fits tightly across
your body. However, it does not pull the vehicle
occupants back in the direction of the seat
backrest.
The belt tensioner does not, however, correct an
incorrect seat position or correct the routing of
a seat belt that is worn incorrectly.
When triggered, seat belt force limiters help to
reduce the peak force exerted by the seat belt
on the vehicle occupant.
The belt force limiters are synchronised with the
front airbags, which take on a part of the deceleration force. This can reduce the forces to
which the vehicle occupants are subjected during an accident.
! If the co-driver's seat is not occupied, do not
engage the seat belt tongue in the buckle on
the co-driver's seat. Otherwise, the belt tensioner could be triggered in the event of an
accident and would have to be replaced.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the seat belt is worn incorrectly, it cannot
perform its intended protective function. Furthermore, an incorrectly worn seat belt can
cause additional injuries, e.g. in the event of
an accident, heavy braking or sudden
changes of direction. There is an increased
risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Always ensure that all vehicle occupants have
their seat belts fastened correctly and are sitting properly.
G WARNING
The seat belt does not offer the intended level
of protection if you have not moved the backrest to an almost vertical position. When braking or in the event of an accident, you could
slide underneath the seat belt and sustain
abdomen or neck injuries, for example. This
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
Adjust the seat properly before beginning
your journey. Always ensure that the backrest
is in an almost vertical position and that the
shoulder section of your seatbelt is routed
across the centre of your shoulder.
G WARNING
Persons under 1.50 m tall cannot wear the
seat belts correctly without an additional suitable restraint system. If the seat belt is worn
incorrectly, it cannot perform its intended
protective function. Furthermore, an incorrectly worn seat belt can cause additional
injuries, e.g. in the event of an accident, heavy
braking or sudden changes of direction. There
is an increased risk of injury, possibly even
fatal.
Always secure persons less than 1.50 m tall in
additional suitable restraint systems.
If a child younger than twelve years old and
under 1.50 m in height is travelling in the vehicle:
Ralways secure the child in a child restraint
system suitable for this Mercedes-Benz vehicle. The child restraint system must be appropriate to the age, weight and size of the child.
Ralways observe the instructions and safety
notes on the "Automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system"
(Y page 46)
Ralways observe the instructions and safety
notes on "Children in the vehicle"
(Y page 54) in addition to the child restraint
Z
Safety
Seat belts
41
42
Occupant safety
system manufacturer's installation and operating instructions.
G WARNING
Seat belts cannot protect as intended, if:
Safety
Rthey are damaged, have been modified, are
extremely dirty, bleached or dyed
seat belt buckle is damaged or
extremely dirty
Rmodifications have been made to the belt
tensioners, belt anchorages or inertia reels
Seat belts may sustain non-visible damage in
an accident, e.g. due to glass splinters. Modified or damaged seat belts can tear or fail, for
example in the event of an accident. Modified
seat belt tensioners may be deployed unintentionally or not function as intended. There
is an increased risk of injury, possibly even
fatal.
Never modify seat belts, seat belt tensioners,
seat belt anchorages and inertia reels. Ensure
that seat belts are not damaged or worn and
are clean. After an accident, have the seat
belts checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
Rthe
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use
seat belts which have been approved specifically for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz. Otherwise, your vehicle's general operating permit
could be invalidated.
Correct seat belt use
Pay attention to the safety notes about the seat
belt (Y page 41).
All vehicle occupants must fasten their seat
belts correctly before you start driving. You
must also make sure that all vehicle occupants
have fastened their seat belts correctly during
the journey.
When fastening your seat belt, always make
sure that:
Rthe seat belt tongue is inserted into the belt
buckle that belongs to the seat.
Rthe seat belt is tightened across your body.
Avoid wearing bulky clothing, e.g. a winter
coat.
Rthe seat belt is not twisted.
Only then can the forces which occur be distributed over the area of the belt.
Rthe shoulder section of the belt is always
routed across the centre of your shoulder.
The shoulder section of the belt must not
come into contact with your neck or be routed
under your arm.
RThe lap belt must be taut and as low as possible over your lap.
The lap belt must always be routed across
your hip joints and not across your abdomen.
Pregnant women must take particular care
with this. If necessary, push the lap belt down
to your hip joint and pull it tight using the
shoulder section of the belt.
RThe seat belt is not routed over sharp, pointed
or fragile objects.
If such objects are located on or in your clothing, e.g. pens, keys, spectacles, etc. stow
these in a suitable location.
ROnly one person should use each seat belt at
any one time.
Babies and children must never travel sitting
on the lap of another vehicle occupant. In the
event of an accident, they could be crushed
between the vehicle occupant and seat belt.
RDo not secure any objects with a seat belt if
the seat belt is being used by one of the vehicle's occupants.
You must also make sure that objects, e.g.
cushions, are never placed between a person
and the seat.
Seat belts are solely intended to secure and
restrain persons. To secure objects, luggage or
loads, always observe the information under
"Stowage options/compartments"
(Y page 262).
Fastening seat belts
Observe the safety notes on the seat belt
(Y page 41) and the information on the correct
use of the seat belt (Y page 42).
The belt strap is tightened slightly when:
Rthe seat belt tongue is engaged in the belt
buckle and
Rthe ignition is switched on
The seat-belt adjustment will apply a certain
tightening force if any slack is detected between
the vehicle occupant and the seat belt. Do not
hold on to the seat belt tightly while it is adjusting.
You can switch the seat-belt adjustment on and
off in the on-board computer (Y page 212).
Belt warning for the driver and front
passenger
Basic illustration
Adjust the seat (Y page 101).
The seat backrest must be in an almost vertical position.
X Pull the seat belt smoothly out of seat belt
guide = and engage belt tongue ; into belt
buckle :.
The seat belt on the driver's seat and the
front-passenger seat may be tightened automatically; see "Belt adjustment"
(Y page 43).
X If necessary, pull upwards on the shoulder
section of the seat belt to tighten the belt
across your body.
X
Releasing the seat belts
! Make sure that the seat belt is fully rolled up.
Otherwise, the seat belt or belt tongue will be
trapped in the door or in the seat mechanism.
This could damage the door, the door trim
panel and the seat belt. Damaged seat belts
can no longer fulfil their protective function
and must be replaced. Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X Press release button in belt buckle, hold belt
tongue firmly and guide the seat belt back.
Seat belt adjustment
The seat-belt adjustment is an integral part of
the PRE-SAFE® convenience function. This function adjusts the driver's and front-passenger
seat belt to the upper body of the occupants.
The 7 seat belt warning lamp in the instrument cluster reminds you that all vehicle occupants must fasten their seat belts. It may light up
continuously or flash. A warning tone may also
sound.
The 7 seat belt warning lamp goes out and
the warning tone stops as soon as the driver's
and the co-driver's seat belts have been fastened.
Airbags
Introduction
The airbag installation location is identified by
the label AIRBAG.
An airbag supplements a correctly fastened seat
belt. It is not a substitute for seat belts. The airbag provides additional protection in the corresponding accident situations.
Not all airbags are deployed in an accident. The
various airbag systems work independently of
one another (Y page 51).
However, no system available today can completely eliminate injuries and fatalities.
Due to the required speed of the airbag after
deployment, it is also not possible to entirely
rule out the risk of injuries caused by the airbag.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you deviate from the correct seat position,
the airbag cannot perform its intended protective function and can even cause addiZ
43
Safety
Occupant safety
44
Occupant safety
tional injuries when deployed. There is an
increased risk of serious or even fatal injuries.
In order to avoid such risks, always ensure
that all vehicle occupants:
Safety
Rfasten
their seatbelts correctly, including
pregnant women
Rare seated correctly and maintain the furthest possible distance from the airbags
Robserve the following notes
Always ensure that there are no objects located between the airbag and the vehicle occupant.
RAdjust
the seats properly before beginning
your journey. Always make sure that the seat
is in an almost upright position. The centre of
the head restraint must support the head at
about eye level.
RMove the driver's and front-passenger seats
as far back as possible. The driver's seat position must allow the vehicle to be driven safely.
ROnly hold the steering wheel on the outside.
This allows the airbag to be fully deployed.
RAlways lean against the backrest while driving. Do not lean forwards or lean against the
door or side window. You may otherwise be in
the deployment area of the airbags.
RAlways keep your feet in the footwell in front
of the seat. Do not put your feet on the dashboard, for example. Your feet may otherwise
be in the deployment area of the airbag.
RAlways secure persons less than 1.50 m tall in
suitable restraint systems. Up to this height,
the seat belt cannot be worn correctly.
If a child is travelling in your vehicle, also
observe the following notes:
RAlways secure children under twelve years of
age and less than 1.50 m tall in suitable child
restraint systems.
ROnly secure a child to the front-passenger
seat when the front-passenger front airbag is
disabled, and only then in a rearward-facing
child restraint system. If the PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator lamp is permanently lit, the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled
(Y page 40).
RAlways observe the instructions and safety
notes on the "Automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system"
(Y page 46) and on "Children in the vehicle"
(Y page 54) in addition to the manufacturer's operating and installation instructions for
the child restraint system.
Objects in the vehicle interior may prevent
the airbag from functioning correctly. Before
starting your journey and to avoid risks resulting
from the speed of the airbag as it deploys, make
sure that:
Rthere are no people, animals or objects
between the vehicle occupants and an airbag.
Rthere are no objects between the seat, door
and B-pillar.
Rno hard objects, e.g. coat hangers, are hanging on the grab handles or coat hooks.
Rno accessories, such as cup holders, are
attached to the vehicle within the deployment
area of an airbag, e.g. to doors or side windows.
Rno heavy, sharp-edged or fragile objects are in
the pockets of your clothing. Store such
objects in a suitable place.
G WARNING
If you modify an airbag cover or affix objects
such as stickers to it, the airbag can no longer
function correctly. There is an increased risk
of injury.
Never modify an airbag cover or affix objects
to it.
G WARNING
Sensors to control the airbags are located in
the doors. Modifications or work not performed correctly to the doors or door panelling, as well as damaged doors, can lead to the
function of the sensors being impaired. The
airbags might therefore not function properly
any more. Consequently, the airbags cannot
protect vehicle occupants as they are
designed to do. This poses an increased risk
of injury.
Never modify the doors or parts of the doors.
Always have work on the doors or door panelling carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Occupant safety
Front airbags
! Do not place heavy objects on the front-
impaired. There is an increased risk of injury,
possibly even fatal.
Use only seat covers which have been specifically approved for the respective seat by
Mercedes-Benz.
Safety
passenger seat. This could cause the system
to identify the seat as being occupied. In the
event of an accident, the restraint systems on
the front-passenger side may be triggered
and have to be replaced.
45
Driver's airbag : deploys in front of the steering wheel. Front-passenger front airbag ;
deploys in front of and above the glove compartment.
When deployed, the front airbags offer additional head and thorax protection for the occupants in the driver's and front-passenger seats.
The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and PASSENGER
AIR BAG ON indicator lamps inform you about
the status of the front-passenger front airbag
(Y page 40).
The front-passenger front airbag will only deploy
if:
Rthe automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system has detected that the
front-passenger seat is occupied
(Y page 46). The PASSENGER AIR BAG ON
indicator lamp is lit (Y page 46)
Rthe restraint system control unit predicts a
high accident severity
Sidebags
G WARNING
Unsuitable seat covers may obstruct or even
prevent deployment of the airbags integrated
into the seats. The airbags may then fail to
protect the vehicle occupants as intended.
Operation of the automatic co-driver's front
airbag deactivation system may also be
Sidebags : deploy next to the outer bolster of
the seat backrest.
When deployed, the sidebag offers additional
thorax protection. However, it does not protect
the:
Rhead
Rneck
Rarms
In the event of a side impact, the sidebag is
deployed on the side on which the impact
occurs.
The sidebag on the front-passenger side deploys
under the following conditions:
Rthe automatic front-passenger airbag deactivation system detects that the frontpassenger seat is occupied or
Rthe belt tongue is engaged in the belt buckle
of the front-passenger seat
If the belt tongue is engaged in the belt buckle,
the sidebag on the front-passenger side deploys
if an appropriate accident situation occurs. In
this case, deployment is independent of
whether the front-passenger seat is occupied or
not.
Z
46
Occupant safety
Safety
Headbags
Headbags : deploy in the area of the side windows at the front.
When deployed, the headbag enhances the level
of protection for the head. However, it does not
protect the:
Rchest
Rarms
In the event of a side impact, the headbag is
deployed on the side on which the impact
occurs.
If the system determines that they can offer
additional protection to that provided by the
seat belt, a headbag may be deployed in other
accident situations (Y page 51).
correct positioning of the child restraint system.
Never place objects under or behind the child
restraint system, e.g. cushions. Fully retract the
seat cushion length. The entire base of the child
restraint system must always rest on the seat
cushion of the front-passenger seat. The backrest of the forward-facing child restraint system
must, as far as possible, be resting on the backrest of the front-passenger seat. The child
restraint system must not touch the roof or be
put under strain by the head restraint. Adjust the
angle of the seat backrest and the head restraint
position accordingly. Only then is the correct
function of the automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation system guaranteed. Always
observe the information on suitable positioning
of the child restraint system (Y page 58) in
addition to the child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
Operation of automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation
Automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation
Introduction
In order to recognise a child restraint system on
the front-passenger seat, the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system categorises the person in the front-passenger seat.
Depending on that result, the front-passenger
front airbag is either enabled or disabled. If a
rearward-facing child restraint system is fitted
to the front-passenger seat, the PASSENGER
AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp must light up after
the system self-test and remain lit. The frontpassenger front airbag is disabled.
The system does not disable:
Rthe sidebag
Rthe front-passenger headbag
Rthe seat belt tensioner
If you install a child restraint system on the
front-passenger seat, be sure to observe the
: PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp
; PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
The indicator lamps inform you whether the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled or enabled.
X Press the Start/Stop button once or twice, or
turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
The system carries out a self-diagnosis.
The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and PASSENGER
AIR BAG ON indicator lamps must light up simultaneously for approximately six seconds.
The indicator lamps display the status of the
front-passenger front airbag:
RPASSENGER AIR BAG ON lights up: the frontpassenger front airbag is enabled. If, in the
event of an accident, all deployment criteria
are met, the front-passenger front airbag is
deployed.
RPASSENGER AIR BAG OFF lights up: the frontpassenger front airbag is disabled. It will then
not be deployed in the event of an accident.
If the status of the front-passenger front airbag
changes while the vehicle is in motion, an airbag
display message appears in the instrument cluster (Y page 226). When the front-passenger
seat is occupied, always pay attention to the
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON and PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator lamps. Be aware of the status
of the front-passenger front airbag both before
and during the journey.
If a person sits in the passenger seat, they must
be:
Rwith the seat belt fastened correctly
Rin an almost upright position with their back
against the seat backrest
Rwith their feet resting on the floor, if possible
If the front passenger does not observe these
conditions, the automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation system may be influenced,
e.g. because the front passenger:
Rtransfers their weight by supporting themselves on a vehicle armrest
Rsits in such a way that their weight is raised
from the seat cushion
The front-passenger front airbag may be disabled by mistake as a result of these or similar
actions. In this case, the PASSENGER AIR BAG
OFF indicator lamp lights up permanently. The
front-passenger front airbag does not then
deploy during an accident.
G WARNING
If the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
is lit, the front-passenger front airbag is disabled. It will not be deployed in the event of an
accident and cannot perform its intended protective function. A person in the frontpassenger seat could then, for example, come
into contact with the vehicle's interior, especially if the person is sitting too close to the
dashboard. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
When the front-passenger seat is occupied,
always make sure that:
Rthe classification of the person in the front-
passenger seat is correct and that the front-
passenger front airbag is enabled or disabled in accordance with the person in the
front-passenger seat.
Rthe front-passenger seat has been moved
back as far back as possible.
Rthe person is seated correctly.
Make sure, both before and during the journey, that the status of the front-passenger
front airbag is correct.
G WARNING
If you secure a child on the co-driver's seat in
a rearward-facing child restraint system and
the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp
lights up, the co-driver's airbag could be
deployed in the event of an accident. The child
could be struck by the airbag. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
In this case, always ensure that the co-driver's
airbag is disabled. The PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF indicator lamp must light up.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
remains off and/or the PASSENGER AIR BAG
ON indicator lamp lights up, do not install a rearward-facing child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat. Further information can be
found under "Problems with the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system"
(Y page 50).
G WARNING
If you secure a child in a forward-facing child
restraint system on the front-passenger seat
and you position the front-passenger seat too
close to the dashboard, in the event of an
accident, the child could:
Rcome
into contact with the vehicle's interior if the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is lit, for example
Rbe struck by the airbag if the PASSENGER
AIR BAG ON indicator lamp is lit up.
This poses an increased risk of injury or even
fatal injury.
Always move the front-passenger seat as far
back as possible and fully retract the seat
cushion length. Always make sure that the
Z
47
Safety
Occupant safety
48
Occupant safety
Safety
shoulder belt strap is correctly routed from
the vehicle seat belt guide to the shoulder belt
guide on the child restraint system. The shoulder belt strap must be routed forwards and
downwards from the belt guide. Always
observe the child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
If the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system detects that:
Rthe front-passenger seat is unoccupied, the
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
lights up after the system self-test and
remains lit. This indicates that the frontpassenger front airbag is disabled.
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied by a
child in a rearward-facing child restraint system, the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp lights up after the system self-test and
remains lit. This indicates that the frontpassenger front airbag is disabled.
But in the case of a child in a rearward-facing
child restraint, the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON
indicator lamp can light up after the system
self-test and remain lit. This indicates that the
front-passenger front airbag is enabled. The
result of the classification is dependent on,
among other factors, the child restraint system and the child's build. Make sure that the
conditions for a correct classification are met.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp
remains on, do not install a child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat.
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied by a
child in a forward-facing child restraint system, either the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON or
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
lights up and remains lit after the system selftest depending on the result of the classification. The result of the classification is dependent on, among other factors, the child
restraint system and the child's build.
Move the front-passenger seat as far back as
possible. Always observe the information in
"Child restraint systems on the frontpassenger seat" (Y page 56) and in "Suitable positioning of the child restraint system"
(Y page 58).
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied by a person with a smaller build (e.g. a teenager or
small adult), either the PASSENGER AIR BAG
ON or PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp lights up and remains lit after the system
self-test depending on the result of the classification.
- If the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator
lamp lights up, move the front-passenger
seat as far back as possible.
- If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp is lit, a person with a smaller build
should not use the front-passenger seat.
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied by an
adult or a person with a build corresponding
to that of an adult, the PASSENGER AIR BAG
ON indicator lamp lights up after the system
self-test and remains lit. This indicates that
the front-passenger front airbag is enabled.
If children are travelling in the vehicle, be sure to
observe the notes on "Children in the vehicle"
(Y page 54).
If the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system is malfunctioning, the red
6 restraint system warning lamp in the
instrument cluster and the PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator lamp light up simultaneously.
The front-passenger front airbag is disabled in
this case and does not deploy during an accident. Have the system checked as soon as possible by qualified technicians. Consult a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre. The frontpassenger seat should only be repaired at a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
If the front-passenger seat, the seat cover or the
seat cushion is damaged, have the necessary
repair work carried out at a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use a child restraint system
which has been tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz in combination with the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation
system.
System self-test
G DANGER
If both the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamps do
not light up during the system self-test, the
system is malfunctioning. The frontpassenger front airbag might be triggered
unintentionally or might not be triggered at all
in the event of an accident with high deceleration. This poses an increased risk of injury or
even fatal injury.
In this case the front-passenger seat may not
be used. Do not install a child restraint system
on the front-passenger seat. Have the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system checked and repaired immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
remains lit after the system self-test, the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled. It will
not be deployed in the event of an accident. In
this case, the front-passenger front airbag
cannot perform its intended protective function, e.g. when a person is seated in the frontpassenger seat.
That person could, for example, come into
contact with the vehicle's interior, especially
if the person is sitting too close to the dashboard. This poses an increased risk of injury or
even fatal injury.
When the front-passenger seat is occupied,
always ensure that:
in the front-passenger front airbag not functioning as intended during an accident. This
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
Do not place any objects between the seat
surface and the child restraint system. The
entire base of the child restraint system must
always rest on the seat cushion of the frontpassenger seat. The backrest of the forwardsfacing child restraint system must, as far as
possible, be resting on the backrest of the
rear reclining seat. Always comply with the
child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
After the system self-test, the PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF or PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator
lamp displays the status of the front-passenger
front airbag (Y page 46).
Further information can be found under "Problems with the automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation system" (Y page 50).
Rthe classification of the person in the front-
passenger seat is correct and the frontpassenger front airbag is enabled or disabled in accordance with the person in the
front-passenger seat.
Rthe person is seated properly with a correctly fastened seat belt.
Rthe front-passenger seat has been moved
as far back as possible.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp remains lit when it should not, the frontpassenger seat may not be used. Do not
install a child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat. Have the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system
checked and repaired immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Objects between the seat surface and the
child restraint system could affect the function of the automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation system. This could result
Z
49
Safety
Occupant safety
50
Occupant safety
Problems with automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation
Be sure to observe the notes on "System self-test" (Y page 48).
Safety
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The PASSENGER AIR
The classification of the person on the front-passenger seat is false.
BAG OFF indicator lamp X Make sure the conditions for a correct classification of the person
lights up and remains lit,
on the front-passenger seat are met (Y page 46).
even though the frontX If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp remains lit, the frontpassenger seat is occupassenger seat may not be used.
pied by an adult or a perX
Have
the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation sysson with a build corretem checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
sponding to that of an
adult.
The PASSENGER AIR
The automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system is
BAG OFF indicator lamp malfunctioning.
does not light up and/or X Make sure there is nothing between the seat and the child restraint
does not stay on.
system.
The front-passenger seat X Make sure that the entire base of the child restraint system rests on
is:
the seat cushion of the front-passenger seat.
Rempty
X Make sure that the seat cushion length is fully retracted.
Roccupied with a rearX When installing the child restraint system, make sure that the seat
ward-facing child
belt is tight. Do not pull the seat belt tight with the front-passenger
restraint system
seat adjustment. This could result in the seat belt and the child
restraint system being pulled too tightly.
X Check that the child restraint system is installed correctly.
X Make sure that no objects are applying additional weight to the
seat.
X If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp remains off and/or
the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp lights up, do not install
a rearward-facing child restraint system on the front-passenger
seat.
X Have the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
Roll bars
G DANGER
If the roll bar has developed a fault, it may not
function, e.g. in the event of an accident. The
roll bars may then not protect the vehicle
occupants as intended. This poses an
increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Have roll bars checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If you place objects or clothing on the roll bar
covers, these could impair roll bar extension.
The roll bars may then not protect the vehicle
occupants as intended. In addition, objects
could endanger the vehicle occupants when
the roll bar is extending. This poses an
increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Ensure that the movement area of the roll bar
covers is kept clear. Always stow all objects in
the vehicle correctly.
The roll bars are located in the rear area of the
vehicle under the two outer rear compartment
trim covers.
They extend if systems detect that the vehicle is
in danger of overturning. The two outer rear
compartment trim covers are opened and the
roll bars are extended within fractions of a second.
Once the roll bars are extended, you can no longer lower them. An open roof can no longer be
closed. In this case, visit the nearest qualified
specialist workshop.
Deployment of belt tensioners and airbags
Important safety notes
G WARNING
After the airbag deploys, the airbag parts are
hot. There is a risk of injury.
Do not touch the airbag parts. Have a
deployed airbag replaced at a qualified specialist workshop as soon as possible.
G WARNING
Pyrotechnical belt tensioners which have
been triggered are no longer operational and
therefore cannot protect as intended. There is
an increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Have pyrotechnic belt tensioners which have
been triggered replaced at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have the
vehicle towed to a qualified specialist workshop
after an accident. Take this into account, par-
ticularly if a seat belt tensioner was triggered or
an airbag was deployed.
An electric motor is used by PRE-SAFE® to trigger the tightening of the seat belt in hazardous
situations. This procedure is reversible.
If the belt tensioners are triggered or an airbag is
deployed, you will hear a bang, and a small
amount of powder may also be released. The
6 restraint system warning lamp lights up.
Only in rare cases will the bang affect your hearing. In general, the powder released is not hazardous to health but may cause short-term
breathing difficulties to persons suffering from
asthma or other pulmonary conditions. Provided
it is safe to do so, you should leave the vehicle
immediately or open the window in order to prevent breathing difficulties.
Operation
During the first stage of a collision, the restraint
system control unit evaluates important physical data relating to vehicle deceleration or acceleration, such as:
Rduration
Rdirection
Rintensity
Based on the evaluation of this data, the
restraint system control unit triggers the seat
belt tensioners in the event of a head-on or rear
collision.
A seat belt tensioner can only be triggered if:
Rthe ignition is switched on
Rthe components of the restraint system are
operational. You can find further information
under: "Restraint system warning lamp"
(Y page 40)
Rthe belt tongue has engaged in the belt buckle
of the respective seat
If the restraint system control unit detects a high
severity accident, in certain head-on collisions,
additional components of the restraint system
are deployed independently of each other:
Rfront airbags
Depending on the person in the front-passenger
seat, the front-passenger front airbag is either
disabled or enabled. The front-passenger front
airbag can only be deployed in an accident if the
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp is lit.
Observe the information on the PASSENGER AIR
BAG indicator lamps (Y page 40).
Z
51
Safety
Occupant safety
Safety
52
Occupant safety
Your vehicle has two-stage front airbags. In the
first deployment stage, the front airbag is filled
with propellant gas to reduce the risk of injuries.
The front airbag is fully deployed if the second
deployment stage is activated within a few milliseconds.
The activation threshold for the seat belt tensioners and airbags is determined based on the
evaluation of the vehicle's rate of deceleration
or acceleration at various points in the vehicle.
This process is pre-emptive in nature. The triggering/deployment process should take place
in good time at the start of the collision.
The rate of vehicle deceleration or acceleration
and the direction of the force are essentially
determined by:
Rthe distribution of forces during the collision
Rthe collision angle
Rthe deformation characteristics of the vehicle
Rthe characteristics of the object with which
the vehicle has collided
Factors which can only be seen and measured
after a collision has occurred do not play a decisive role in the deployment of an airbag, nor do
they provide an indication of airbag deployment.
The vehicle may be deformed significantly without an airbag being deployed. This is the case if
only parts which are relatively easily deformed
are affected and the rate of deceleration is not
high. Conversely, an airbag may be deployed
even though the vehicle suffers only minor
deformation. This is the case if, for example,
very rigid vehicle parts such as longitudinal body
members are hit, and sufficient deceleration
occurs as a result.
If the restraint system control unit detects a side
impact or if the vehicle overturns, the applicable
components of the restraint system are activated independently of each other depending on
the apparent type of accident.
RSidebag on the side on which an impact
occurs, independent from the seat belt tensioner and seat belt usage
The sidebag on the front-passenger side
deploys under the following conditions:
- an occupant is detected on the frontpassenger seat or
- the belt tongue is engaged in the belt
buckle of the front-passenger seat
RHeadbag on the side on which an impact
occurs, independent of seat belt usage and
regardless of whether the front-passenger
seat is occupied
RSeat belt tensioners, if the system determines
that deployment can offer additional protection for the vehicle occupants in this situation
RHeadbags on the driver's and front-passenger
side in certain situations if the vehicle overturns and if the system determines that
deployment can offer additional protection to
that provided by the seat belt
i Not all airbags are deployed in an accident.
The different airbag systems work independently of each other.
How the airbag system works is determined
by the severity of the accident detected,
especially the vehicle deceleration or acceleration, and the apparent type of accident:
Rfrontal collision
Rside impact
Roverturn
NECK-PRO head restraints
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The function of the head restraint may be
impaired if you:
Rattach
objects such as coat hangers to the
head restraints, for example
Ruse unsuitable head restraint covers
If you do so, the head restraints cannot fulfil
their intended protective function in the event
of an accident. In addition, objects attached
to the head restraints could endanger other
vehicle occupants. This poses an increased
risk of injury.
Do not attach any objects to the head
restraints and only use suitable head restraint
covers.
Consult a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
regarding the availability of suitable seat or head
restraint covers.
Occupant safety
NECK-PRO head restraints reduce the likelihood
of head and chest injuries. The NECK-PRO head
restraints on the driver's and front-passenger
seats are moved forwards and upwards in the
event of a rear-end collision of a certain severity.
This provides better head support.
If the NECK-PRO head restraints have been triggered in an accident, you must reset the NECKPRO head restraints on the driver's and frontpassenger seat (Y page 53). Otherwise, the
additional protection will not be available in the
event of another rear-end collision. You can recognise when NECK-PRO head restraints have
been triggered by the fact that they have moved
forwards and can no longer be adjusted.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have the
NECK-PRO head restraints checked for functionality at a qualified specialist workshop after
a rear-end collision.
Resetting triggered NECK-PRO head
restraints
Do not place your fingers between the upholstery of the head restraint and the seat. Pay particular attention while resetting the NECK-PRO
head restraints.
X Tilt the top of the NECK-PRO head restraint
cushion forwards in the direction of arrow :.
X Push the NECK-PRO head restraint cushion
down as far as it will go in the direction of
arrow ;.
X Firmly push the NECK-PRO head restraint
cushion back in the direction of arrow = until
the cushion engages.
X Repeat this procedure for the second NECKPRO head restraint.
i Resetting the NECK-PRO head restraints
resetting the NECK-PRO head restraints, have
this work carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant
protection)
PRE-SAFE® informs you of certain critical driving
situations and takes pre-emptive measures to
protect the vehicle occupants.
PRE-SAFE® can take the following measures
independently of each other:
Rpre-tensioning the driver's and frontpassenger seatbelt.
Rclosing the side windows.
Rsetting a more favourable seat position for the
front-passenger seat.
Rvehicles with a multicontour seat: increasing
the air pressure in the side bolsters of the seat
backrest.
! Make sure that there are no objects in the
footwell or behind the seats. There is a risk
that the seats and/or the objects could be
damaged when PRE-SAFE® is activated.
Should an accident not occur, the preventative
measures taken are cancelled. Certain settings
must be made yourself.
X If the seat belt pre-tensioning is not reduced,
move the seat backrest back slightly.
Seat belt pre-tensioning is released.
PRE-SAFE® PLUS (anticipatory occupant protection PLUS)
Introduction
PRE-SAFE® PLUS is only available in vehicles
with the Driving Assistance package.
Using the radar sensor system, PRE-SAFE®
PLUS is able to detect that a head-on or rear-end
collision is imminent. In certain hazardous situations, PRE-SAFE® PLUS takes pre-emptive
measures to protect the vehicle occupants.
Important safety notes
The intervention of PRE-SAFE® PLUS cannot
prevent an imminent collision.
requires a lot of strength. If you have difficulty
Z
Safety
Operation
53
54
Children in the vehicle
Safety
The driver is not warned before the intervention
of PRE-SAFE® PLUS.
PRE-SAFE® PLUS does not intervene when
reversing.
When driving, or when parking or exiting a parking space with assistance from Active Parking
Assist, PRE-SAFE® PLUS will not apply the
brakes.
Function
PRE-SAFE® PLUS intervenes in certain situations if the radar sensor system detects an
imminent head-on or rear-end collision.
PRE-SAFE® PLUS takes the following measures
depending on the hazardous situation detected:
Rif the radar sensor system detects that a
head-on collision is imminent, the seat belts
are pre-tensioned
Rif the radar sensor system detects that a rearend collision is imminent:
- the rear hazard warning lamps are activated and flash at a higher frequency
- the brake pressure is increased if the driver
applies the brakes when the vehicle is stationary
- the seat belts are pre-tensioned
The PRE-SAFE® PLUS braking application is cancelled:
Rif the accelerator pedal is depressed when a
gear is engaged
Rif the risk of a collision passes or is no longer
detected
Rif Distance Pilot DISTRONIC indicates an
intention to pull away
If the hazardous situation passes without resulting in an accident, the original settings are
restored.
Automatic measures after an accident
Immediately after an accident, the following
measures may be implemented, depending on
the type and severity of the impact:
Rthe hazard warning lamps are activated
Rthe emergency lighting is activated
Rthe vehicle doors are unlocked
Rthe front side windows are lowered
Rthe
electrically adjustable steering wheel is
raised
Rthe engine is switched off and the fuel supply
is cut off
Rvehicles with the Mercedes-Benz emergency
call system: automatic emergency call
Children in the vehicle
Important safety notes
If a child younger than twelve years old and
under 1.50 m in height is travelling in the vehicle:
Ralways secure the child in a child restraint
system suitable for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
The child restraint system must be appropriate to the age, weight and size of the child.
Rbe sure to observe the instructions and safety
notes in this section in addition to the child
restraint system manufacturer's installation
instructions.
Ralways pay attention to the instructions and
safety notes on the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system
(Y page 46).
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P
the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
Rstart
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
Children in the vehicle
Always ensure that all vehicle occupants have
their seat belts fastened correctly and are sitting
properly. Particular attention must be paid to
children.
Observe the safety notes on the seat belt
(Y page 41) and the information on the correct
use of the seat belt (Y page 42).
Child restraint system
Observe the instructions for correct use of the
child restraint system (Y page 58).
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use a child restraint system
recommended by Mercedes-Benz
(Y page 60).
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is incorrectly fitted on the seat position suitable for this purpose, it cannot perform its intended protective function. In the event of an accident,
sharp braking or a sudden change in direction,
the child may not be held securely. There is an
increased risk of serious or even fatal injuries.
Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions and the correct use for the child
restraint system. Make sure that the entire
surface of the child restraint system is resting
on the seat surface. Never place objects
under or behind the child restraint system,
e.g. cushions. Only use child restraint sys-
tems with the original cover designed for
them. Only replace damaged covers with genuine covers.
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is fitted incorrectly or is not secured, it can come loose in
the event of an accident, heavy braking or a
sudden change in direction. The child
restraint system could be thrown about, striking vehicle occupants. There is an increased
risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Always fit child restraint systems properly,
even if they are not being used. Make sure
that you observe the child restraint system
manufacturer's installation instructions.
Further information on stowing objects, luggage
and loads securely can be found under "Stowing
options/stowage compartments"
(Y page 262).
G WARNING
Child restraint systems or their securing systems that have been damaged or subjected to
a load in an accident cannot perform their
intended protective function. In the event of
an accident, sharp braking or a sudden
change in direction, the child may not be held
securely. There is an increased risk of serious
or even fatal injuries.
Immediately replace child restraint systems
that have been damaged or subjected to a
load in an accident. Have the child restraint
securing systems checked in a qualified specialist workshop before fitting a child restraint
system again.
The securing systems of child restraint systems
are:
Rthe seat belt system
Rthe ISOFIX securing rings
If you fit a child restraint system to the frontpassenger seat, always observe the information
on "Child restraint systems on the frontpassenger seat" (Y page 56). There you will
also find information on disabling the frontpassenger front airbag.
Z
Safety
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is placed in direct
sunlight, the parts could become very hot.
Children could be suffer burns by touching
these parts, in particular on the metallic parts
of the child restraint system. There is a risk of
injury.
If you and your child leave the vehicle, always
make sure that the child restraint system is
not in direct sunlight. Cover it with a blanket,
for example. If the child restraint system has
been exposed to direct sunlight, leave it to
cool down before securing the child in it.
Never leave children unattended in the vehicle.
55
Children in the vehicle
56
Observe the warning labels in the vehicle interior and on the child restraint system.
i It is advisable to use Mercedes-Benz care
Safety
products to clean child restraint systems recommended by Mercedes-Benz. Information
can be obtained at a qualified specialist workshop.
ISOFIX child seat securing system
G WARNING
ISOFIX child restraint systems do not offer
sufficient protective effect for children whose
weight is greater than 22 kg who are secured
using the safety belt integrated in the child
restraint system. The child could, for example,
not be restrained correctly in the event of an
accident. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
If the child weighs more than 22 kg, only use
ISOFIX child restraint systems with which the
child is also secured with the vehicle seat belt.
Also secure the child restraint system with the
Top Tether belt, if available.
When fitting a child restraint system, be sure to
observe the manufacturer's installation and
operating instructions and the instructions for
correct use of the child restraint system
(Y page 58).
Before every trip, make sure that the ISOFIX
child restraint system is engaged correctly in
both ISOFIX securing rings.
X
Install the ISOFIX child restraint system on
both ISOFIX securing rings :.
ISOFIX is a standardised securing system for
specially designed child restraint systems. ISO-
FIX securing rings : for an ISOFIX child
restraint system are fitted to the frontpassenger seat.
If you are using an ISOFIX child restraint system
on the front-passenger seat, where the child is
not secured using the seat belt of the frontpassenger seat, the belt warning may be activated.
In this case, insert the seat belt buckle tongue
into the belt buckle of the front-passenger seat.
Pass the seat belt between the ISOFIX child
restraint system and the backrest of the frontpassenger seat.
Non-ISOFIX child seats may also be used and
can be installed using the vehicle's seat belt
system. When fitting a child restraint system, be
sure to observe the manufacturer's installation
and operating instructions and the instructions
for correct use of the child restraint system
(Y page 58).
Child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat
General notes
Vehicles with the automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system: if you fit a child
restraint system to the front-passenger seat,
always observe the information on the "Automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation
system" (Y page 46).
You can thus avoid the risks that could arise as
a result of:
Ra child restraint system that is not detected
by the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system
Rthe unintentional disabling of the frontpassenger front airbag
Rthe unsuitable positioning of the child
restraint system, e.g. too close to the dashboard
Please observe the warning notice on the frontpassenger sun visor; see the illustration.
G WARNING
If you secure a child on the co-driver's seat in
a rearward-facing child restraint system and
the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp
lights up, the co-driver's airbag could be
deployed in the event of an accident. The child
could be struck by the airbag. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
In this case, always ensure that the co-driver's
airbag is disabled. The PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF indicator lamp must light up.
NEVER use a rearward-facing child restraint on a
seat protected by an ACTIVE AIRBAG in front of
it; DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to the CHILD can
occur.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp is
lit, the front-passenger front airbag is enabled
(Y page 40).
Vehicles without the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation
system
If the front-passenger seat of your vehicle is not
equipped with the automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system, this is indicated by a special sticker. The sticker is affixed to
the side of the dashboard on the frontpassenger side. The sticker is visible when you
open the front-passenger door.
In this case, never fit a rearward-facing child
restraint system on the front passenger seat
(Y page 58).
Observe the following information under "Rearward-facing child restraint system" and
"Forward-facing child restraint system" as well
as information on the suitable positioning of the
child restraint system (Y page 58).
Rearward-facing child restraint system
If you secure a child in a rearward-facing child
restraint system on the front-passenger seat,
always make sure that the front-passenger front
airbag is disabled. Only if the PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator lamp is lit continuously
(Y page 40) is the front-passenger front airbag
disabled.
Always observe the information on suitable
positioning of the child restraint system
(Y page 58) in addition to the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation and operating instructions.
Forward-facing child restraint system
If you secure a child in a forward-facing child
restraint system on the front-passenger seat,
always move the front-passenger seat as far
back as possible. Fully retract the seat cushion
length. The entire base of the child restraint system must always rest on the seat cushion of the
front-passenger seat. The backrest of the child
restraint system must, as far as possible, lie flat
against the backrest of the front-passenger
seat. The child restraint system must not touch
the roof or be put under strain by the head
restraint. Adjust the angle of the seat backrest
and the head restraint position accordingly.
Always make sure that the shoulder belt strap is
correctly routed from the front-passenger seat
belt guide to the shoulder belt guide on the child
restraint system. The shoulder belt strap must
be routed forwards and downwards from the
front-passenger seat belt guide. If necessary,
adjust the front-passenger seat accordingly.
Z
57
Safety
Children in the vehicle
58
Children in the vehicle
Safety
Always observe the information on suitable
positioning of the child restraint system
(Y page 58) in addition to the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation and operating instructions.
Suitable positioning of the child
restraint system
Introduction
Only child restraint systems which are approved
in accordance with the ECE standard ECE R44
are permitted for use in the vehicle.
"Universal" category child restraint systems can
be recognised by their orange approval label and
the text "Universal".
Example: approval label on the child restraint system
"Universal" category child restraint systems can
be used on the seats indicated with U, UF or IUF
in accordance with the "Suitability of the front
passenger seat for attaching belt-secured child
restraint systems" or "Suitability of the frontpassenger seat for attaching an ISOFIX child
restraint system" table.
Semi-universal child restraint systems are indicated by the text "semi-universal" on the
approval label. These can be used if the vehicle
and the seat are listed in the child restraint system manufacturer's vehicle model list. For more
information, contact the child restraint system
manufacturer or visit their website.
If you install a child restraint system on the
front-passenger seat:
X Always pay attention to the instructions under
"Child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat" (Y page 56).
There you will find instructions on how to correctly route the shoulder belt strap from the
front-passenger seat belt guide to the shoulder belt guide on the child restraint system
(Y page 57).
X Move the front-passenger seat as far back as
possible and into the highest position.
X Fully retract the seat cushion length.
X Move the backrest to an almost vertical position.
The entire base of the child restraint system
must always rest on the seat cushion of the
front-passenger seat. The backrest of the
forward-facing child restraint system must, as
far as possible, be resting on the backrest of
the front-passenger seat. The child restraint
system must not touch the roof. Adjust the
backrest angle accordingly. Also observe the
child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
X Move the seat cushion angle to the highest,
most vertical position.
Children in the vehicle
59
Legend for the table:
X Seat which is unsuitable for children in this weight category.
U Suitable for child restraint systems in the "Universal" category that are approved for use in this
weight category.
UF Suitable for forward-facing child restraint systems that belong to the "Universal" category and
are approved for use in this weight category.
L Suitable for child restraint systems as recommended; see "Recommended child restraint systems" (Y page 60). Suitable for semi-universal child restraint systems if the vehicle and the
seat are listed in the child restraint system manufacturer's vehicle model list.
Front-passenger seat
Weight category
Front-passenger
front airbag enabled
Front-passenger
front airbag disabled1
0
up to 10 kg
X
U, L
0+
up to 13 kg
X
U, L
I
9 kg to 18 kg
UF, L
U, L
II
15 kg to 25 kg
UF, L
U, L
III
22 kg to 36 kg
UF, L
U, L
Suitability of the front-passenger seat for fitting an ISOFIX child restraint system:
Legend for the table:
X ISOFIX position that is not suitable for ISOFIX child restraint systems in this weight category
and/or size category.
IUF Suitable for forward-facing ISOFIX child restraint systems that belong to the "Universal" category, which are approved for use in this weight category.
IL Suitable for ISOFIX child restraint systems as recommended; see the "Recommended child
restraint systems" table (Y page 60).
The child restraint system manufacturer will also recommend a suitable ISOFIX child restraint
system. For this, your vehicle and the seat must be listed in the child restraint system manufacturer's model list. For more information, contact the child restraint system manufacturer or
visit their website.
Weight category
Carry cot
Size category
Equipment
Frontpassenger
seat2
F
ISO/L1
X
G
ISO/L2
X
The vehicle is equipped with an automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system. The PASSENGER
AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp must be lit.
2 Move the front-passenger seat to the rearmost and lowest position.
1
Z
Safety
Suitability of the front-passenger seat for attaching belt-secured child restraint
systems
Children in the vehicle
60
Safety
Weight category
Size category
Equipment
Frontpassenger
seat2
0
up to 10 kg
up to approximately 6 months
E
ISO/R1
IL
0+
up to 13 kg
up to approximately 15 months
E
ISO/R1
IL
D
ISO/R2
IL
C
ISO/R3
IL
D
ISO/R2
IL
C
ISO/R3
IL
B
ISO/F2
IL
B1
ISO/F2X
IL
A
ISO/F3
IL
I
9 kg to 18 kg
between approximately 9 months
and 4 years
Recommended child restraint systems
General notes
Always observe the information in "Child restraint systems on the front-passenger seat" (Y page 56)
and in "Suitable positioning of the child restraint system" (Y page 58).
You can obtain further information about the correct child restraint system from any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Recommended child restraint systems for attaching with the vehicle seat belt
Weight categories
Manufacturer
Type
Category 0:
up to 10 kg
up to approximately
6 months
Britax
Römer
BABY SAFE plus II 04 301146
970 20 00
970 36 00
Category 0+:
up to 13 kg
up to approximately
15 months
Britax
Römer
BABY SAFE plus II 04 301146
970 20 00
970 36 00
DUO plus
04 301133
970 16 00
04 301133
970 21 00
970 37 00
Category I:
Britax
Römer
9 kg to 18 kg
between approximately 9 months and
4 years
2
3
Approval number (E1 ...)
Move the front-passenger seat to the rearmost and lowest position.
Colour code 9H95.
Order number
(A 000 ...)3
Weight categories
Manufacturer
Type
Approval number (E1 ...)
Order number
(A 000 ...)3
Category II/III:
15 kg to 36 kg
between approximately 4 years and
12 years
Britax
Römer
KIDFIX
04 301198
970 18 00
970 22 00
04 301198
970 19 00
970 38 00
04 301304
970 61 00
Britax
Römer
KIDFIX XP
Recommended "Universal"/"Semi-Universal" category ISOFIX child restraint systems
Weight categories
Size cat- Manufac- Type
egory
turer
Approval number Order number
(E1 ...)
(A 000 ...)4
Category I:
9 kg to 18 kg
B1
03 301133
04 301133
970 11 00
04 301133
970 16 00
04 301133
970 21 00
970 37 00
Britax
Römer
DUO plus
Pets in the vehicle
G WARNING
If you leave animals unsupervised or unsecured in the vehicle, they may push a button
or a switch, for example.
They could:
Ractivate
vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
Rswitch vehicle systems on or off, thus
endangering other road users
In the event of an accident, sudden braking or
abrupt changes of direction, unsecured animals could be flung around the vehicle, injuring the vehicle occupants. There is a risk of an
accident and injury.
Never leave animals unattended in the vehicle. Always secure animals correctly during a
journey, e.g. in an animal transport box.
3
4
Driving safety systems
Driving safety systems overview
In this section, you will find information about
the following driving safety systems:
RABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
(Y page 62)
RBAS (Brake Assist System) (Y page 62)
RBrake Assist with Cross-Traffic Assist
(Y page 63)
RActive Brake Assist (Y page 64)
RAdaptive brake lights (Y page 67)
RESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
(Y page 67)
REBD (electronic brake force distribution)
(Y page 71)
RADAPTIVE BRAKE (Y page 72)
RActive Brake Assist with Cross-Traffic Assist
(Y page 72)
RSTEER CONTROL (Y page 74)
Colour code 9H95.
Colour code 9H95.
Z
61
Safety
Driving safety systems
62
Driving safety systems
Safety
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style or if you are
inattentive, the driving safety systems can neither reduce the risk of an accident nor override
the laws of physics. Driving safety systems are
merely aids designed to assist driving. You are
responsible for maintaining the distance to the
vehicle in front, for vehicle speed, for braking in
good time, and for staying in lane. Always adapt
your driving style to suit the prevailing road and
weather conditions and maintain a safe distance
from the vehicle in front. Drive carefully.
The driving safety systems described only work
as effectively as possible when there is adequate contact between the tyres and the road
surface. Pay particular attention to the information regarding tyres, recommended minimum
tyre tread depths etc. in the "Wheels and tyres"
section (Y page 304).
In wintry driving conditions, always use winter
tyres (M+S tyres) and, if necessary, snow
chains. Only in this way will the driving safety
systems described in this section work as effectively as possible.
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
General notes
ABS regulates brake pressure in such a way that
the wheels do not lock when you brake. This
allows you to continue steering the vehicle when
braking.
The ! ABS warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the ignition is switched
on. It goes out when the engine is running.
ABS works from a speed of about 8 km/h,
regardless of road-surface conditions. ABS
works on slippery surfaces, even when you only
brake gently.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 62).
G WARNING
If ABS is faulty, the wheels could lock when
braking. The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely impaired. Additionally, further driving safety systems are deac-
tivated. There is an increased danger of skidding and accidents.
Drive on carefully. Have ABS checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
If ABS is malfunctioning, other systems, including driving safety systems, will also become
inoperative. Observe the information on the ABS
warning lamp (Y page 246) and display messages which may be shown in the instrument
cluster (Y page 217).
Brakes
If ABS intervenes: continue to depress the
brake pedal with force until the braking situation is over.
X To make a full brake application: depress
the brake pedal with full force.
If ABS intervenes when braking, you will feel a
pulsing in the brake pedal.
The pulsating brake pedal can be an indication
of hazardous road conditions; this serves as a
reminder to take extra care while driving.
X
BAS (Brake Assist)
General notes
BAS operates in emergency braking situations.
If you depress the brake pedal quickly, BAS
automatically boosts the braking force, thus
shortening the stopping distance.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 62).
G WARNING
If BAS is malfunctioning, the braking distance
in an emergency braking situation is
increased. There is a risk of accident.
In an emergency braking situation, depress
the brake pedal with full force. ABS prevents
the wheels from locking.
Driving safety systems
Keep the brake pedal depressed firmly until
the emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will function as usual once you
release the brake pedal. BAS is deactivated.
X
Brake Assist with cross-traffic function
General notes
Brake Assist with cross-traffic function can help
you to minimise the risk of a collision with a
vehicle or a pedestrian and reduce the effects of
such a collision. If Brake Assist with cross-traffic
function detects a danger of collision, you are
assisted when braking.
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
tion (Y page 62).
Brake Assist with cross-traffic function is only
available in vehicles with the Driving Assistance
package.
For Brake Assist with cross-traffic function to
assist you when driving, the radar sensor system
and the camera system must be operational.
The sensor system and camera system help
Brake Assist with cross-traffic function detect
obstacles:
Rthat are in the path of your vehicle for an
extended period of time
Rthat cross the path of your vehicle
In addition, pedestrians in the path of your vehicle can be detected.
Brake Assist with cross-traffic function detects
pedestrians using typical characteristics such
as body contours and the posture of a person
standing upright.
If the radar sensor system or the camera system
is malfunctioning, Brake Assist with cross-traffic
function is restricted or no longer available. The
brake system is still available with complete
brake boosting effect and BAS.
i Observe the restrictions described in the
"Important safety notes" section
(Y page 63).
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Brake Assist with cross-traffic function cannot always clearly identify objects and complex traffic situations.
In such cases, the Brake Assist with crosstraffic function might:
Rintervene
unnecessarily
intervene
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake. Terminate the
intervention in a non-critical driving situation.
Rnot
G WARNING
Brake Assist with cross-traffic function cannot always clearly identify people, particularly
if they are moving. Brake Assist with crosstraffic function cannot intervene in these
cases. There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
G WARNING
Brake Assist with cross-traffic function does
not react:
Rto
small people, e.g. children
animals
Rto oncoming vehicles
Rwhen cornering
As a result, Brake Assist with cross-traffic
function may not intervene in all critical conditions. There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Rto
In the event of snowfall or heavy rain, detection
can be impaired.
Detection by the radar sensor system is also
impaired in the event of:
Rdirt on the sensors or obscured sensors
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rstrong radar reflections, for example, in multistorey car parks
Z
Safety
Brakes
63
64
Driving safety systems
Safety
Ra
narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle
Ra vehicle travelling in front on a different line
Rvehicles quickly moving into the radar sensor
system detection range
Detection by the camera system is also impaired
in the event of:
Rdirt on the camera or if the camera is covered
Rglare on the camera system, e.g. from the sun
being low in the sky
Rdarkness
Rif:
- pedestrians move quickly, e.g. into the path
of the vehicle
- the camera system no longer detects a
pedestrian as a person due to special clothing or other objects
- a pedestrian is concealed by other objects
- the typical outline of a person is not distinguishable from the background
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle,
have the radar sensor settings and operation
checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This
also applies to collisions at slow speeds where
there is no visible damage to the front of the
vehicle.
Following damage to the windscreen, have the
configuration and operation of the camera system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
vehicles in front within a speed range between
7 km/h and 250 km/h.
Up to a speed of approximately 70 km/h, Brake
Assist with cross-traffic function may react to:
Rstationary objects in the path of your vehicle,
e.g. stopped or parked vehicles
Rpedestrians in the path of your vehicle
Robstacles crossing your path, which move in
the detection range of the sensors and are
detected
i If Brake Assist with cross-traffic function
requires a particularly high braking force, preventative passenger protection measures
(PRE-SAFE®) are activated at the same time
(Y page 53).
X Keep the brake pedal depressed until the
emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
Brake Assist with cross-traffic function is deactivated and the brakes function as usual again if:
Ryou release the brake pedal
Rthere is no longer a risk of collision
Rno obstacle is detected in front of your vehicle
Ryou depress the accelerator pedal
Ryou activate kickdown
Active Brake Assist
Function
General notes
To avoid a collision, Brake Assist with crosstraffic function calculates the brake force necessary if:
Ryou approach an obstacle and
RBrake Assist with cross-traffic function has
detected a risk of collision
When driving at a speed under 30 km/h: if
you depress the brake pedal, Brake Assist with
cross-traffic function is activated. Braking assistance from Brake Assist with cross-traffic function is carried out at the last possible moment.
When driving at a speed above 30 km/h: if
you depress the brake pedal sharply, Brake
Assist with cross-traffic function automatically
increases the brake pressure to a degree suited
to the traffic situation.
Brake Assist with cross-traffic function provides
braking assistance in hazardous situations with
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
tion (Y page 62).
Active Brake Assist consists of a distance warning function with an autonomous braking function and Adaptive Brake Assist.
Active Brake Assist can help you to minimise the
risk of a collision with the vehicle in front or
reduce the effects of such a collision.
If Active Brake Assist detects that there is a risk
of collision, you will be warned visually and
acoustically. If you do not react to the visual and
audible collision warning, autonomous braking
can be initiated in critical situations. If you apply
the brake yourself in a critical situation, Adaptive Brake Assist of the Active Brake Assist system supports you.
Driving safety systems
In particular, the detection of obstacles can be
impaired in the case of:
Rdirt on the sensors or obscured sensors
Rsnow or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rstrong radar reflections, for example, in multistorey car parks
Ra narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle
Ra vehicle travelling in front on a different line
Rnew vehicles or after servicing is carried out
on the Active Brake Assist system
Observe the important safety notes in the
"Running-in notes" section (Y page 131).
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle,
have the configuration and operation of the
radar sensor checked at a qualified specialist
workshop. This also applies to collisions at slow
speeds where there is no visible damage to the
front of the vehicle.
Activating/deactivating
Active Brake Assist is automatically active after
switching on the ignition.
You can activate or deactivate Active Brake
Assist using the on-board computer
(Y page 207). When deactivated, the distance
warning function and the autonomous braking
function are also deactivated.
If Active Brake Assist is deactivated, the æ
symbol appears in the assistance graphic display.
Distance warning function
General notes
The distance warning function can help you to
minimise the risk of a collision with the vehicle in
front or reduce the effects of such a collision. If
the distance warning function detects that there
is a risk of a collision, you will be warned visually
and acoustically.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section for driving safety systems (Y page 62).
G WARNING
The distance warning function does not react:
Rto
people or animals
oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
Thus, the distance warning function cannot
provide a warning in all critical situations.
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Rto
G WARNING
The distance warning function cannot always
clearly identify objects and complex traffic
situations.
In such cases, the distance warning function
may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning
give a warning
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation; do not rely on the distance warning
function alone.
Rnot
Function
The distance warning function issues a warning
at speeds:
Rof approximately 30 km/h or more, if, over
several seconds, the distance maintained to
the vehicle travelling in front is insufficient.
The · distance warning lamp then lights
up in the instrument cluster.
Rof approximately 7 km/h or more, if you rapidly approach a vehicle in front. An intermittent warning tone will then sound, and the
· distance warning lamp will light up in the
instrument cluster.
X Brake immediately in order to increase the
distance from the vehicle in front.
or
X Take evasive action provided it is safe to do
so.
Due to the nature of the system, particularly
complicated but non-critical driving conditions
may also cause the system to display a warning.
Z
Safety
Important safety notes
65
66
Driving safety systems
Safety
With the help of the radar sensor system, the
distance warning function can detect obstacles
that are in the path of your vehicle for an extended period of time.
Up to a speed of approximately 70 km/h, the
distance warning function can also react to stationary obstacles, such as stopped or parked
vehicles.
Autonomous braking function
If the driver does not react to the distance warning signal in a critical situation, Active Brake
Assist can assist with the autonomous braking
function.
If the autonomous braking function demands
particularly high braking force, preventative
passenger protection measures (PRE-SAFE®)
are activated simultaneously.
The autonomous braking function is available in
the following speed ranges:
R7 - 105 km/h for moving objects
R7 - 50 km/h for stationary objects
Due to the nature of the system, complicated
but non-critical driving conditions may also
cause the autonomous braking function to intervene.
If the autonomous braking function demands a
particularly high braking force, preventative
passenger protection measures (PRE-SAFE®)
are activated simultaneously (Y page 53).
Adaptive Brake Assist
General notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
tion (Y page 62).
With the help of Adaptive Brake Assist, the distance warning signal can detect obstacles that
are in the path of your vehicle for an extended
period of time.
If Adaptive Brake Assist detects a risk of a collision with the vehicle in front, it calculates the
braking force necessary to avoid a collision. If
you apply the brakes forcefully, Adaptive Brake
Assist will automatically increase the braking
force to a level suitable for the traffic conditions.
Adaptive Brake Assist provides braking assistance in hazardous situations at speeds above
7 km/h. It uses radar sensor technology to
assess the traffic situation.
Up to a speed of approximately 250 km/h,
Adaptive Brake Assist is capable of reacting to
moving objects that have already been detected
as such at least once over the period of observation.
Up to a speed of approximately 70 km/h, Adaptive Brake Assist reacts to stationary obstacles.
If Adaptive Brake Assist demands a particularly
high braking force, preventative passenger protection measures (PRE-SAFE®) are activated
simultaneously (Y page 53).
X Keep the brake pedal depressed until the
emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will work normally again if:
Ryou release the brake pedal
Rthere is no longer any danger of a collision
Rno obstacle is detected in front of your vehicle
Adaptive Brake Assist is then deactivated.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Adaptive Brake Assist cannot always clearly
identify objects and complex traffic situations.
In such cases, Adaptive Brake Assist can:
Rintervene
unnecessarily
intervene
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake. Terminate the
intervention in a non-critical driving situation.
Rnot
G WARNING
Adaptive Brake Assist does not react:
Rto
people or animals
oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
As a result, the Adaptive Brake Assist may not
intervene in all critical conditions. There is a
risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Rto
Driving safety systems
Adaptive brake lights
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
tion (Y page 62).
If you brake sharply from a speed of more than
50 km/h or if braking is assisted by BAS or
Brake Assist with Cross-Traffic Assist, the brake
lamps flash rapidly. In this way, traffic travelling
behind you is warned in an even more noticeable
manner.
If you brake sharply from a speed of more than
70 km/h to a standstill, the hazard warning
lamps are activated automatically. If the brakes
are applied again, the brake lamps light up continuously. The hazard warning lamps switch off
automatically if you travel faster than 10 km/h.
You can also switch off the hazard warning
lamps using the hazard warning button
(Y page 115).
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
General notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 62).
ESP® monitors driving stability and traction, i.e.
power transmission between the tyres and the
road surface.
If ESP® detects that the vehicle is deviating from
the direction desired by the driver, one or more
wheels are braked to stabilise the vehicle. The
engine output is also modified to keep the vehicle on the desired course within physical limits.
ESP® assists the driver when pulling away on
wet or slippery roads. ESP® can also stabilise
the vehicle during braking.
ETS traction control is part of ESP®.
ETS brakes the drive wheels individually if they
spin. This enables you to pull away and accelerate on slippery surfaces, e.g. if the road surface
is slippery on one side. In addition, more drive
torque is transferred to the wheel or wheels with
traction.
ETS remains active when you deactivate ESP®.
i Mercedes-AMG vehicles: your vehicle may
be equipped with 20-inch tyres on the rear
axle. If replaced with 19-inch tyres, ETS may
intervene noticeably sooner for the first few
kilometres. After approximately 10 km ETS
will function as usual again. Information on
the dimensions and types of wheels and tyres
for your vehicle can be found under "Wheel/
tyre combinations" (Y page 317).
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If ESP® is malfunctioning, ESP® is unable to
stabilise the vehicle. In addition, other driving
safety systems are switched off. This increases the risk of skidding and an accident.
Drive on carefully. Have ESP® checked at a
qualified specialist workshop.
When towing away your vehicle with the rear
axle raised, observe the notes on ESP®
(Y page 300).
If the å ESP® OFF warning lamp lights up
continuously, then ESP® is deactivated.
If the ÷ ESP® warning lamp and the å
ESP® OFF warning lamp are lit continuously,
ESP® is not available due to a malfunction.
Observe the information on warning lamps
(Y page 246) and display messages which may
be shown in the instrument cluster
(Y page 217).
i Only use wheels with the recommended tyre
sizes. Only then will ESP® function properly.
Characteristics of ESP®
ETS (Electronic Traction System)
General notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
If the ÷ ESP warning lamp goes out before
beginning the journey, ESP® is automatically
active.
tion (Y page 62).
Z
Safety
Due to the nature of the system, particularly
complicated but non-critical driving conditions
may also cause Brake Assist to intervene.
If Adaptive Brake Assist is not available due to a
malfunction in the radar sensor system, the
brake system remains available with full brake
boosting effect and BAS.
67
Driving safety systems
68
If ESP® intervenes, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp
flashes in the instrument cluster.
If ESP® intervenes:
Do not deactivate ESP® under any circumstances.
X When pulling away, only depress the accelerator pedal as far as is necessary.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing
road and weather conditions.
Safety
X
Driving safety systems
69
The influence of drive programs on ESP®
Drive program
ESP® mode
Characteristics
C Comfort
E Economy
ESP® on
This drive program offers an ideal compromise
between traction and stability.
Select drive program E or C in difficult road conditions such as snow and ice or on wet roads.
S Sport
ESP® on
This drive program offers an ideal compromise
between traction and stability.
S+ Sport Plus
ESP® Sport
The vehicle's own oversteering and understeering characteristics are emphasised. This enables
a more active driving style.
This drive program requires more interaction
from the driver.
Select this drive program only when road conditions are good, e.g. the roads are dry and the
route is clear.
Always adapt your driving style and drive program to the prevailing road and weather conditions.
Additional information for drive programs (Y page 145).
ECO start/stop function
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle stops
moving. When pulling away again, the engine
starts automatically. ESP® remains in its previously selected status, e.g. if ESP® was deactivated before the engine was automatically
switched off.
Deactivating/activating ESP® (except
Mercedes‑AMG vehicles)
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
tion (Y page 62).
You can select between the following statuses
of ESP®:
RESP®
RESP®
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Rwhen using snow chains
Rin deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Spinning the wheels results in a cutting action
which provides better grip.
i Activate ESP® as soon as the situations
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
otherwise not be able to stabilise the vehicle
if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel starts to
spin.
is activated
is deactivated
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Z
Safety
The drive programs allow ESP® to adapt to different weather conditions, road conditions and the
desired driving style. The drive programs can be set using the DYNAMIC SELECT button
(Y page 139) or on AMG vehicles using the DYNAMIC SELECT controller (Y page 140).
Driving safety systems
70
Deactivating/activating ESP®
Deactivating/activating ESP®
(Mercedes‑AMG vehicles)
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
Safety
tion (Y page 62).
You can select between the following statuses
of ESP®:
RESP®
is activated
handling mode is activated
RESP® is deactivated
ESP® is activated every time the engine is
switched on, regardless of whether ESP® was
deactivated before the engine was switched off.
RSPORT
X
To deactivate: press button :.
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X
To activate: press button :.
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
Characteristics when ESP® is deactivated
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in the
instrument cluster flashes. In such situations,
ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle.
If you deactivate ESP®:
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability
torque is no longer limited and the
drive wheels are able to spin
RTraction control is still activated
RActive Brake Assist is not available and is not
activated even if you brake firmly with assistance from ESP®
RPRE-SAFE® is no longer available, it is not
activated even if you brake firmly with assistance from ESP®
RActive Brake Assist with Cross-Traffic Assist
is not available and is not activated even if you
brake firmly with assistance from ESP®
RESP® continues to provide assistance when
you brake firmly
REngine
G WARNING
When SPORT handling mode is activated,
there is a greater risk of skidding and accidents.
Only activate SPORT handling mode in the situations described in the following.
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
In the following situations, it may be better to
activate SPORT handling mode or deactivate
ESP®:
Rwhen using snow chains
Rin deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Ron specially designated roads when the vehicle's own oversteering and understeering
characteristics are desired
Spinning the wheels results in a cutting action
which provides better grip.
Driving in SPORT handling mode or without
ESP® requires an extremely qualified and experienced driver.
i Activate ESP® as soon as the situations
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
otherwise not be able to stabilise the vehicle
Driving safety systems
if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel starts to
spin.
Deactivating/activating
ESP®
71
Characteristics when ESP® is deactivated
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in the
instrument cluster flashes. In such situations,
ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle.
If you deactivate ESP®:
no longer improves driving stability
torque is no longer limited and the
drive wheels are able to spin
RTraction control is still activated
RActive Brake Assist is no longer available and
is not activated even if you brake firmly with
assistance from ESP®
RPRE-SAFE® is no longer available, it is not
activated even if you brake firmly with assistance from ESP®
RActive Brake Assist with Cross-Traffic Assist
is not available and is not activated even if you
brake firmly with assistance from ESP®
RESP® continues to provide assistance when
you brake firmly
REngine
To activate SPORT handling mode: briefly
press button :.
The M handling mode warning lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up. The SPORT han‐
dling mode message appears in the multifunction display.
X To deactivate SPORT handling mode:
briefly press button :.
The M handling mode warning lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
X
To deactivate ESP®: press button : until
the å ESP® OFF warning lamp lights up in
the instrument cluster.
The ÷ OFF message appears in the multifunction display.
X To activate ESP®: briefly press button :.
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out. The ÷ ESP®
ON message appears in the multifunction display.
X
Characteristics of activated SPORT handling mode
If SPORT handling mode is activated and one or
more wheels start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in the instrument cluster flashes. ESP®
only stabilises the vehicle to a limited degree.
When SPORT handling mode is activated:
RESP®
only improves driving stability to a limited degree
RTraction control is still activated
REngine torque is no longer limited and the
drive wheels are able to spin
RESP® continues to provide assistance when
you brake firmly
EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
General notes
EBD monitors and controls the brake pressure
on the rear wheels to improve driving stability
while braking.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section for driving safety systems (Y page 62).
G WARNING
If EBD is malfunctioning, the rear wheels can
lock, e.g. under full braking. This increases the
risk of skidding and an accident.
You should therefore adapt your driving style
to the different handling characteristics. Have
the brake system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Observe information regarding indicator and
warning lamps (Y page 246) as well as display
messages (Y page 219).
Z
Safety
RESP®
72
Driving safety systems
ADAPTIVE BRAKE
Safety
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
tion (Y page 62).
ADAPTIVE BRAKE enhances braking safety and
offers increased braking comfort. In addition to
the braking function, ADAPTIVE BRAKE also has
the HOLD function (Y page 172) and hill start
assist (Y page 135).
Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic
function
General notes
Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function
can help you to minimise the risk of a collision
with a vehicle in front or a pedestrian and reduce
the effects of such a collision. If Active Brake
Assist with cross-traffic function has detected a
risk of collision, you will be warned visually and
acoustically as well as by automatic braking.
i Pay attention to the important safety notes
in the "Driving safety systems" section
(Y page 62).
Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function is
only available in vehicles with the Driving Assistance Plus package.
For Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function to assist you when driving, the radar sensor
system and the camera system must be operational.
The radar sensor system and camera system
help Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function to detect obstacles that are in the path of
your vehicle for an extended period of time.
In addition, pedestrians in the path of your vehicle can be detected.
Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function
detects pedestrians using typical characteristics such as body contours and the posture of a
person standing upright.
i Observe the restrictions described in the
"Important safety notes" section
(Y page 72).
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function
will initially brake your vehicle by a partial
application of the brakes if a danger of collision is detected. There may be a collision
unless you brake yourself. Even after subsequent full application of the brakes a collision
cannot always be avoided, particularly when
approaching at too high a speed. There is a
risk of an accident.
Always apply the brakes yourself and try to
take evasive action, provided it is safe to do
so.
In the event of a partial application of the brakes,
the vehicle is braked with up to 50% of the full
braking pressure.
G WARNING
Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function
cannot always clearly identify objects and
complex traffic situations.
In such cases, Active Brake Assist with crosstraffic function might:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning and then
brake the vehicle
Rneither give a warning nor intervene
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay particular attention to the traffic
situation and be prepared to brake, especially
if Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function alerts you. Terminate the intervention in a
non-critical driving situation.
G WARNING
Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function
cannot always clearly identify people, particularly if they are moving. Active Brake Assist
with cross-traffic function cannot intervene in
these cases. There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay particular attention to the traffic
situation and be prepared to brake, especially
if Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function alerts you.
Driving safety systems
G WARNING
Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function
does not react:
Rto
small people, e.g. children
Rto animals
Rto oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
As a result, Active Brake Assist with crosstraffic function may not intervene in all critical
situations. There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
In the event of snowfall or heavy rain, detection
can be impaired.
Detection by the radar sensor system is also
impaired in the event of:
Rdirt on the sensors or obscured sensors
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rstrong radar reflections, for example, in multistorey car parks
Ra narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle
Ra vehicle travelling in front on a different line
Detection by the camera system is also impaired
in the event of:
Rdirt on the camera or if the camera is covered
Rglare on the camera system, e.g. from the sun
being low in the sky
Rdarkness
Rif:
- pedestrians move quickly, e.g. into the path
of the vehicle
- the camera system no longer detects a
pedestrian as a person due to special clothing or other objects
- a pedestrian is concealed by other objects
- the typical outline of a person is not distinguishable from the background
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle,
have the radar sensor settings and operation
checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This
also applies to collisions at slow speeds where
there is no visible damage to the front of the
vehicle.
Following damage to the windscreen, have the
configuration and operation of the camera system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Function
To activate or deactivate: activate or deactivate Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic
function using the on-board computer
(Y page 207).
When Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic
function is deactivated, the æ symbol
appears in the assistance graphic display of
the multifunction display.
This function will issue a warning if:
Rat a speed of approximately 30 km/h or
higher, the distance maintained to the vehicle
travelling in front is insufficient for several
seconds.
The · distance warning lamp then lights
up in the instrument cluster.
Rat a speed of approximately 7 km/h or higher,
you rapidly approach a vehicle in front.
An intermittent warning tone will then sound
and the · distance warning lamp will light
up in the instrument cluster.
X Brake immediately to defuse the situation.
or
X Take evasive action provided it is safe to do
so.
Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function
can also brake the vehicle automatically under
the following conditions:
Rthe driver and front passenger have their seat
belts fastened
and
Rthe vehicle speed is between approximately
7 km/h and 200 km/h
Up to a speed of approximately 70 km/h, Active
Brake Assist with cross-traffic function may
react to:
Rstationary objects in the path of your vehicle,
e.g. stopped or parked vehicles
Rpedestrians in the path of your vehicle
X
i If there is an increased risk of a collision,
preventive passenger protection measures
(PRE-SAFE®) are triggered (Y page 53).
Z
Safety
In order to maintain the appropriate distance to
the vehicle in front and thus prevent a collision,
you must apply the brakes yourself.
73
Safety
74
Protection against theft
If the risk of a collision with the vehicle in front
remains and you do not brake, take evasive
action or accelerate significantly, the vehicle
may perform automatic emergency braking up
to the point of full brake application. Automatic
emergency braking is not performed until immediately prior to an imminent accident.
You can prevent the intervention of Active Brake
Assist with cross-traffic function at any time by:
Rdepressing the accelerator pedal further
Ractivating kickdown
Rreleasing the brake pedal
The braking application of Active Brake Assist
with cross-traffic function is ended automatically if:
Ryou manoeuvre to avoid the obstacle
Rthere is no longer a risk of collision
Rthere is no longer an obstacle detected in
front of your vehicle
Protection against theft
Immobiliser
To activate with the key: remove the key
from the ignition lock.
X To activate with KEYLESS-GO: switch the
ignition off and open the driver's door.
X To deactivate: switch on the ignition.
X
The immobiliser prevents your vehicle from
being started without the correct key.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. The engine can be
started by anyone with a valid key that is left
inside the vehicle.
i The immobiliser is always deactivated when
you start the engine.
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
STEER CONTROL
General notes
STEER CONTROL helps you by transmitting a
noticeable steering force to the steering wheel
in the direction required for vehicle stabilisation.
This steering support is provided in particular if:
Rboth right wheels or both left wheels are on a
wet or slippery road surface when you brake
Rthe vehicle starts to skid
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
tion (Y page 62).
No steering support is provided from STEER
CONTROL, if:
RESP®
is deactivated
RESP® is malfunctioning
Rthe steering is faulty
If ESP® is malfunctioning, you will be assisted
further by the electrical power steering.
To prime: lock the vehicle with the key or
KEYLESS-GO.
Indicator lamp : flashes. The alarm system
is primed after approximately 15 seconds.
X To switch off: unlock the vehicle with the key
or KEYLESS-GO.
X
A visual and audible alarm is triggered if the
alarm system is primed and you open:
Ra door
Rthe vehicle with the emergency key element
Rthe boot lid
Rthe bonnet
Rthe glove compartment
Rthe stowage space under the armrest
Ra stowage compartment in the rear
Protection against theft
X
or
To deactivate the alarm with the key: press
the % or & button on the key.
The alarm stops.
Insert the key into the ignition lock.
The alarm stops.
X To stop the alarm using KEYLESS-GO:
grasp the outside door handle. The key must
be outside the vehicle.
The alarm stops.
or
X Press the Start/Stop button on the dashboard. The key must be inside the vehicle.
The alarm stops.
The alarm does not switch off, even if you close
the open door that has triggered it, for example.
75
Deactivating
Tow-away protection
Function
An audible and visual alarm is triggered if your
vehicle's angle of inclination is altered while
tow-away protection is primed. This can occur if
the vehicle is jacked up on one side, for example.
Activating
Make sure that:
doors are closed
Rthe boot lid is closed
Only then is tow-away protection activated.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESS-GO.
Tow-away protection is primed after approximately 30 seconds.
X
Rthe
Switching off
X
To switch off: unlock the vehicle with the key
or KEYLESS-GO.
Tow-away protection is switched off automatically.
Safety
X
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up briefly.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESS-GO.
Tow-away protection is deactivated.
Tow-away protection remains deactivated until:
Rthe vehicle is unlocked again
Ra door is opened and closed again
Rthe vehicle is locked again
To prevent a false alarm, deactivate tow-away
protection if you lock your vehicle and it:
Ris being transported
Ris being loaded onto a ferry or car transporter,
for example
Ris parked on a movable surface, e.g. in a splitlevel garage
X
X
Interior motion sensor
Function
When the interior motion sensor is primed, a
visual and audible alarm is triggered if movement is detected in the vehicle interior. This can
occur if someone reaches into the vehicle interior, for example.
Priming
Make sure that:
Rthe side windows are closed
Rthe roof is closed
Rthe stowage compartment under the armrest is closed
This will prevent false alarms.
X Make sure that:
X
Z
Protection against theft
76
Rthe
doors are closed
boot lid is closed
Only then is the interior motion sensor activated.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESS-GO.
The interior motion sensor is primed after
approximately 30 seconds.
Safety
Rthe
Switching off
X
Unlock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
The interior motion sensor is automatically
switched off.
Deactivating
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; flashes several times in
rapid succession.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESS-GO.
The interior motion sensor is deactivated.
To prevent a false alarm, deactivate the interior
motion sensor if you lock your vehicle and:
Rpeople or animals remain in the vehicle
Rthe side windows remain open
The interior motion sensor remains deactivated
until:
Rthe vehicle is unlocked again
Ra door is opened and closed again
Rthe vehicle is locked again
UK only: your vehicle is equipped with a doublelock function. The doors cannot be opened from
the inside if the vehicle has been locked with the
key or with KEYLESS-GO. Deactivate the interior
motion sensor before you lock the vehicle. The
doors can then be opened from the inside after
the vehicle has been locked from the outside.
X
X
Observe the "Important safety notes"
(Y page 82).
Key
Important safety notes
United Kingdom only:
G WARNING
When the double locks are activated, the
doors can no longer be opened from the
inside. People in the vehicle can no longer get
out, e.g. in hazardous situations. There is a
risk of injury.
Therefore, do not leave any people unsupervised in the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance. Do not activate the double lock when
people are in the vehicle.
If the vehicle has been locked from the outside,
the double lock function is activated as standard. It is then not possible to open the doors
from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the
double lock function by deactivating the interior
motion sensor (Y page 76). The doors can then
be opened from the inside after the vehicle has
been locked from the outside. The anti-theft
alarm system is triggered if the door is opened
from the inside. Switch off the alarm
(Y page 74).
All countries:
children unattended in the vehicle. Always
keep the key out of reach of children.
G WARNING
If you attach heavy or large objects to the key,
the key could be unintentionally turned in the
ignition lock. This could cause the engine to
be switched off. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not attach any heavy or large objects to the
key. Remove any bulky keyrings before inserting the key into the ignition lock.
! Keep the key away from strong magnetic
fields. Otherwise, the remote control function
could be affected.
Strong magnetic fields can occur in the vicinity of powerful electrical installations.
Do not keep the key:
Rwith electronic devices, e.g. a mobile phone
or another key
Rwith metallic objects, e.g. coins or metal film
Rinside metallic objects, e.g. a metal case
This can affect the key's functionality.
Key functions
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they can:
Ropen doors and endanger other persons or
road users
out and be injured by the traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and, for example, trap themselves.
Children could also set the vehicle in motion,
for example by:
Rclimb
Rreleasing
: & Locks the vehicle
; F Opens/closes the boot lid
= % Unlocks the vehicle
Rshifting
X
To unlock centrally: press the % button.
If you do not open the vehicle within approximately 40 seconds of unlocking:
Rthe vehicle locks again
Rprotection against theft is reactivated
X
To lock centrally: press the & button.
the parking brake
the automatic transmission out of
park position P
Rstarting the engine.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
Z
Opening and closing
Key
77
78
Key
The key centrally locks/unlocks:
doors
Rthe boot lid
Rthe glove compartment
Rthe stowage compartment under the armrest
Rthe stowage compartment in the rear compartment
Rthe fuel filler flap
When unlocking, the turn signals flash once.
When locking, they flash three times.
You can also set an audible signal to confirm
that the vehicle has been locked. The audible
signal can be activated or deactivated using the
on-board computer (Y page 211).
When it is dark, the surround lighting also comes
on if it is activated in the on-board computer
(Y page 210).
Opening and closing
Rthe
KEYLESS-GO
General notes
Bear in mind that the engine can be started by
any of the vehicle occupants if there is a KEYLESS-GO key in the vehicle (Y page 134).
Locking and unlocking centrally
You can start, lock or unlock the vehicle using
KEYLESS-GO. To do this, you need to carry the
key with you. You can combine the KEYLESS-GO
functions with the functions of a conventional
key. Unlock the vehicle by using KEYLESS-GO,
for instance, and lock it using the & button
on the key.
The driver's door and the door at which the handle is used must both be closed. The key must be
outside the vehicle. When locking or unlocking
with KEYLESS-GO, the distance between the key
and the corresponding door handle must not be
greater than 1 m.
A check which periodically establishes a radio
connection between the vehicle and the key
determines whether a valid key is in the vehicle.
This occurs, for example:
Rwhen starting the engine
Rwhilst driving
Rwhen using HANDS-FREE ACCESS
Rwhen the external door handles are touched
To unlock the vehicle: touch the inner surface of the door handle.
X To lock the vehicle: touch sensor surface :
or ;.
Make sure that you do not touch the inner
surface of the door handle.
X Convenience closing feature: touch
recessed sensor surface ; for an extended
period.
For further information on the convenience
closing feature (Y page 91).
X
Deactivating and activating
If you do not intend to use a key for an extended
period of time, you can deactivate the KEYLESSGO function of the key. The key will then use very
little power, thereby conserving battery power.
For the purposes of activation or deactivation,
the vehicle does not have to be nearby.
X To deactivate: press the & button on the
key twice in rapid succession.
The battery check lamp (Y page 80) of the
key flashes twice briefly and lights up once,
then KEYLESS-GO is deactivated.
X To activate: press any button on the key.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
KEYLESS-GO and all of its associated features
are available again.
Changing the settings of the locking
system
You can change the settings of the locking system. This means that only the driver's door, the
lockable stowage compartment in the vehicle
interior and the fuel filler flap are unlocked when
Key
the vehicle is unlocked. This is useful if you frequently travel alone.
X To change the setting: press and hold down
the % and & buttons simultaneously
for about six seconds until the battery indicator lamp flashes twice (Y page 80).
If the setting of the locking system is changed
within the signal range of the vehicle, pressing
the & or % button:
Removing the emergency key element
or
Runlocks
the vehicle
The key now functions as follows:
X To unlock: press the % button once.
X To unlock centrally: press the % button
twice.
X To lock centrally: press the & button.
The KEYLESS-GO function is changed as follows:
X To unlock the driver's door: touch the inner
surface of the door handle on the driver's
door.
X To unlock centrally: touch the inner surface
of the driver or front-passenger door handle.
X To lock centrally: touch the outer sensor
surface on one of the door handles.
X
To restore the factory settings: press and
hold down the % and & buttons simultaneously for approximately six seconds until
the battery check lamp flashes twice
(Y page 80).
X
Push release catch : in the direction of the
arrow and, at the same time, remove emergency key element ; from the key.
Further information about:
RUnlocking the driver's door (Y page 84)
RUnlocking the boot (Y page 89)
RLocking the vehicle (Y page 84)
Inserting the emergency key element
X
Push emergency key element ; completely
into the key until it engages and release
catch : is back in its basic position.
Battery of the key
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Emergency key element
General notes
If the vehicle can no longer be locked or
unlocked with the key or with KEYLESS-GO, use
the emergency key element.
If you use the emergency key element to unlock
and open the driver's door or the boot lid, the
anti-theft alarm system will be triggered. Switch
off the alarm (Y page 74).
Batteries contain toxic and corrosive substances. If batteries are swallowed, it can result in
severe health problems. There is a risk of fatal
injury.
Keep batteries out of the reach of children. If
a battery is swallowed, seek medical attention
immediately.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
Z
Opening and closing
Rlocks
79
Key
80
Opening and closing
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have the
batteries replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Checking the battery
Press the & or % button.
The battery is OK if battery check lamp :
lights up briefly.
The battery is discharged if battery check
lamp : does not light up briefly.
X Replace the battery (Y page 80).
If the battery of the key is checked within the
signal reception range of the vehicle, pressing
the & or % button:
Press emergency key element ; into the
opening in the key in the direction of the arrow
until battery compartment cover : opens.
When doing so, do not hold battery compartment cover : shut.
X Remove battery compartment cover :.
X
X
Rlocks
or
Runlocks the vehicle
i You can obtain a battery from any qualified
specialist workshop.
Replacing the battery
You require a CR 2025 3 V cell battery.
Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 79).
X
Repeatedly tap the key against your palm until
battery = falls out.
X Insert the new battery with the positive terminal facing upwards. Use a lint-free cloth to
do so.
X Make sure that the surface of the battery is
free of lint, grease and other contamination.
X
X
Insert the front tabs of battery compartment
cover : into the housing and then press to
close it.
Insert emergency key element ; into the key
(Y page 79).
X Check the function of all key buttons on the
vehicle.
X
Key
81
Problems with the key
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
You can no longer lock or The key battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
unlock the vehicle using X Check the key battery (Y page 80) and replace if necessary
the key.
(Y page 80).
If this does not work:
X Unlock (Y page 84) or lock (Y page 84) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
Opening and closing
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
Unlock (Y page 84) or lock (Y page 84) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X
The key is faulty.
Unlock (Y page 84) or lock (Y page 84) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X Have the key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
You can no longer lock or KEYLESS-GO has been deactivated.
unlock the vehicle using X Reactivate KEYLESS-GO (Y page 78).
KEYLESS-GO.
The key battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
X Check the key battery (Y page 80) and replace if necessary
(Y page 80).
If this does not work:
X Unlock (Y page 84) or lock (Y page 84) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
Unlock (Y page 84) or lock (Y page 84) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X
There is a fault with KEYLESS-GO.
Lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of the
key.
X Have the vehicle and key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
If the vehicle cannot be locked/unlocked even using the remote control function:
X Unlock (Y page 84) or lock (Y page 84) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X Have the vehicle and key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Z
82
Doors
Opening and closing
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine can no longer The on-board voltage is too low.
be started using the key. X Switch off non-essential consumers, e.g. seat heating or interior
lighting, and try to start the engine again.
If this does not work:
X Check the starter battery and charge it if necessary (Y page 295).
or
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 296).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The engine cannot be
started using KEYLESSGO. The key is in the
vehicle.
The vehicle is locked.
Unlock the vehicle and try to start the vehicle again.
X
The key battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
Check the key battery (Y page 80) and replace if necessary
(Y page 80).
If this does not work:
X Start your vehicle with the key in the ignition lock.
X
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
Start your vehicle with the key in the ignition lock.
X
You have lost a key.
Have the key deactivated at a qualified specialist workshop.
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
X If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
X
X
You have lost the emergency key element.
X
X
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
Doors
Important safety notes
United Kingdom only:
G WARNING
When the double locks are activated, the
doors can no longer be opened from the
inside. People in the vehicle can no longer get
out, e.g. in hazardous situations. There is a
risk of injury.
Therefore, do not leave any people unsupervised in the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance. Do not activate the double lock when
people are in the vehicle.
If the vehicle has been locked from the outside,
the double lock function is activated as standard. It is then not possible to open the doors
from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the
double lock function by deactivating the interior
motion sensor (Y page 76). The doors can then
be opened from the inside after the vehicle has
been locked from the outside. The anti-theft
alarm system is triggered if the door is opened
from the inside. Switch off the alarm
(Y page 74).
All countries:
Doors
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they can:
83
from the inside. Switch off the alarm
(Y page 74).
Ropen doors and endanger other persons or
road users
out and be injured by the traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and, for example, trap themselves.
Children could also set the vehicle in motion,
for example by:
Rreleasing
the parking brake
the automatic transmission out of
park position P
Rstarting the engine.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle. Always
keep the key out of reach of children.
Rshifting
Unlocking and opening the doors
from the inside
! The side windows will not open/close if the
battery is discharged or if the side windows
have iced up. It will then not be possible to
close the door. Do not attempt to force the
door to close. You could otherwise damage
the door or the side window.
For all countries except the United Kingdom:
you can open a door from inside the vehicle even
if it has been locked.
If the vehicle has previously been locked from
the outside, opening a door from the inside will
trigger the anti-theft alarm system. Switch off
the alarm (Y page 74).
Only for the United Kingdom: if the vehicle
has been locked with the key from the outside,
the double lock function is activated as standard. It is then not possible to open the doors
from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the
double lock function by deactivating the interior
motion sensor (Y page 75). The doors can then
be opened from the inside after the vehicle has
been locked from the outside. The anti-theft
alarm system is triggered if the door is opened
Pull door handle ;.
If the door is locked, locking knob : pops up.
The door is unlocked and can be opened.
When a door is opened, the side window on that
side opens slightly. When the door is closed, the
side window is raised again.
X
Centrally locking and unlocking the
vehicle from the inside
You can centrally lock or unlock the vehicle from
the inside. For example, you can unlock the
front-passenger door from the inside or lock the
vehicle before you pull away.
To unlock: press button :.
To lock: press button ;.
If the front-passenger door is closed, the vehicle locks.
The central locking button does not lock or
unlock the fuel filler flap or the stowage compartments, such as the glove compartment.
You cannot unlock the vehicle centrally from the
inside if the vehicle has been locked with the key
or KEYLESS-GO.
X
X
Z
Opening and closing
Rclimb
Doors
Opening and closing
84
For all countries except the United Kingdom:
you can open a door from inside the vehicle even
if it has been locked.
United Kingdom only: you can only open a
door from inside the vehicle if the double-lock
function has been deactivated. You can deactivate the double lock function by deactivating the
interior motion sensor (Y page 75).
When a locked door is opened from inside the
vehicle, the previous unlocking process will be
observed if the vehicle has been:
Rlocked with the locking button for the central
locking or
Rlocked automatically
The vehicle will be fully unlocked if it had previously been fully unlocked. Only the door which
has been opened from the inside is unlocked if
only the driver's door had been previously
unlocked.
Automatic locking feature
You can also activate and deactivate the automatic locking function using the on-board computer (Y page 211).
Power closing
Power closing pulls the doors and boot lid into
their locks automatically even if they are only
partly closed.
X Power closing feature (doors): push the
door past the first detent position into the
lock.
Power closing will pull the door fully closed.
X To power close the boot lid: lightly push the
boot lid closed.
The power closing function pulls the boot lid
closed.
Unlocking/locking the driver's door
using the emergency key element
i In order to lock all of the vehicle's locks,
begin by pressing the button for locking the
vehicle from the inside while the driver's door
is open. Then proceed to unlock the driver's
door using the emergency key element.
To deactivate: press and hold button : for
about five seconds until a tone sounds.
X To activate: press and hold button ; for
about five seconds until a tone sounds.
If you press one of the two buttons and do not
hear a tone, the relevant setting has already
been selected.
The vehicle is locked automatically when the
ignition is switched on and the wheels are turning.
You could therefore be locked out if:
Rthe vehicle is being pushed
Rthe vehicle is being towed
Rthe vehicle is being tested on a dynamometer
X
To unlock: turn the emergency key element
anti-clockwise as far as it will go to position
1.
X To lock: turn the emergency key element
clockwise as far as it will go to position 1.
X
Right-hand-drive vehicle: turn the emergency
key element in the opposite direction in both
cases.
If you use the emergency key element to unlock
and open the driver's door, the anti-theft alarm
system will be triggered. Switch off the alarm
(Y page 74).
Boot
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If objects, luggage or loads are not secured or
not secured sufficiently, they could slip, tip
over or be flung around and thereby hit vehicle
occupants. There is a risk of injury, especially
when braking or abruptly changing directions.
Always store objects so that they cannot be
flung around. Secure objects, luggage or
loads against slipping or tipping before the
journey.
! The boot lid swings upwards when opened.
Therefore, make sure that there is sufficient
clearance above the boot lid.
! Only close the boot once the roof is lowered
completely. Otherwise, you could damage the
roof.
The opening dimensions of the boot lid can be
found in the "Vehicle data" section
(Y page 327).
When the roof is open, you can use the loading
aid to raise the folded roof in the boot to make
loading easier (Y page 264). The boot separator
opens automatically.
You can unlock the boot lid when the vehicle is
stationary and the roof is fully opened or closed.
Do not leave the key in the boot. You could otherwise lock yourself out.
The boot lid can be:
Ropened and closed from outside
Ropened and closed automatically from outside (vehicles with boot lid remote closing
feature)
Ropened and closed automatically from inside
(vehicles with boot lid remote closing feature)
Ropened, closed or stopped during operation
without the use of your hands (vehicles with
KEYLESS-GO and HANDS-FREE ACCESS)
Rlocked separately
Runlocked with the emergency key element
Stow luggage or loads preferably in the boot.
Boot lid reversing function
The boot lid is equipped with an automatic
reversing function. It reacts if a solid object
obstructs or restricts the boot lid during the
closing procedure. The boot lid opens again
automatically. The automatic reversing function
is only an aid and is not a substitute for your
attentiveness to the boot lid while it is closing.
G WARNING
The reversing function does not react:
Rto
soft, light and thin objects, e.g. fingers
the last 8 mm of the closing path
The reversing feature cannot prevent someone being trapped in these situations in particular. There is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no body parts
are in the closing area.
If someone is trapped:
Rover
Rpress
the F button on the key or
the remote operating switch on the
driver’s door, or
Rpress the closing or locking button on the
boot lid, or
Rpull the boot lid handle
Rpress
Opening/closing from the outside
Opening
Press the % button on the key.
Pull handle :.
X Raise the boot lid.
If the boot separator was previously closed,
the boot separator opens and remains open.
X
X
Z
Opening and closing
Boot
85
Boot
86
When the roof is open, you can use the loading
aid to raise the folded roof and load the boot
more easily (Y page 264). The boot separator
then opens automatically.
Closing
! The boot lid swings upwards when opened.
Therefore, make sure that there is sufficient
clearance above the boot lid.
The opening dimensions of the boot lid can be
found in the "Vehicle data" section
(Y page 327).
Opening and closing
Opening automatically
You can automatically open the boot lid using
the boot lid handle.
X If the boot is unlocked, pull the boot lid handle
and release it again immediately.
When the roof is open, the boot separator
closes automatically.
If the boot separator was closed, it opens
automatically and remains open.
Pull the boot lid down using recess :.
X Lock the vehicle if necessary using the &
button on the key or with KEYLESS-GO.
If KEYLESS-GO detects a key in the boot, it does
not lock.
X
Vehicles with the boot lid remote closing
feature: the boot lid can also be opened automatically with the key.
X Press and hold the F button on the key
until the boot lid opens.
Closing automatically
Opening/closing automatically from
the outside
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Parts of the body could become trapped during automatic closing of the boot lid. Moreover, people, e.g. children, may be standing in
the closing area or may enter the closing area
during the closing process. There is a risk of
injury.
Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity of the
closing area during the closing process.
Use one of the following options to stop the
closing process:
Rpress
the F button on the key
or press the remote operating switch
on the driver's door
Rpress the closing or locking button on the
boot lid
Rpull the boot lid handle
Rpull
X
Press and release closing button : on the
boot lid.
Vehicles with the boot lid remote closing
feature and KEYLESS-GO: when the driver's
door is closed you can simultaneously close the
boot lid and lock the vehicle. The KEYLESS-GO
key must be in the rear detection range of the
vehicle.
X Press locking button ; in the boot lid.
The boot separator, the loading aid and the
boot lid are closed.
If a KEYLESS-GO key is detected outside the
vehicle, the boot lid closes and the vehicle locks.
Boot
87
If a key with KEYLESS-GO is detected in the
boot, the boot lid opens again after it is closed.
It does not lock.
HANDS-FREE ACCESS
G WARNING
The vehicle exhaust system can become very
hot. If you use HANDS-FREE ACCESS, you
could burn yourself by touching the exhaust
system. There is a risk of injury. Always
ensure that you only make a leg movement
within the detection range of sensors.
! If the key is within the rear detection range
of KEYLESS-GO, the following situations, for
example, could lead to the boot lid opening
unintentionally:
Rusing a car wash
Rusing a high-pressure cleaner
Make sure that the key is at least 3 m away
from the vehicle.
General notes
With KEYLESS-GO and HANDS-FREE ACCESS,
you can open or close the boot lid or stop the
procedure without using your hands. This is useful if you have your hands full. To do this, make
a kicking movement under the bumper with your
foot.
Observe the following points:
RCarry your KEYLESS-GO key about your person. The KEYLESS-GO key must be in the rear
detection range of the vehicle.
RWhen making the kicking movement, make
sure that you are standing firmly on the
ground and that there is sufficient clearance
to the rear of the vehicle. You could otherwise
lose your balance, e.g. on ice.
RAlways
ensure that you only make a kicking
movement within the detection range of sensors :.
RStand at least 30 cm away from the rear area
while doing so.
RDo not come into contact with the bumper
while making the kicking movement. Otherwise, the sensors may not function correctly.
RHANDS-FREE ACCESS does not function
when the engine is started.
RDirt caused by road salt around sensors :
may restrict functionality.
RUsing HANDS-FREE ACCESS with a prosthetic leg may restrict functionality.
RIf a KEYLESS-GO key is within the rear detection range of KEYLESS-GO, HANDS-FREE
ACCESS could be triggered. The boot lid could
thus be opened or closed unintentionally, for
example, if you:
- sit on the edge of the boot
- set down or lift up an object behind the
vehicle
- polish the rear of the vehicle
Do not carry the KEYLESS-GO key about your
person in such situations. This will prevent the
unintentional opening/closing of the boot.
Z
Opening and closing
Important safety notes
Boot
88
Operation
Opening and closing automatically
from the inside
Opening and closing
Important safety notes
To open/close: kick into sensor detection
range : under the bumper with your foot.
A warning tone will sound while the boot lid is
opening or closing.
X If the boot lid does not open after several
attempts: wait at least ten seconds then kick
under the bumper once again.
If you hold your foot under the bumper for too
long, the boot lid does not open or close. Repeat
the kicking movement more quickly if this
occurs.
To stop the opening or closing procedure, you
have the following options:
RKick with your foot in sensor detection
range : under the bumper.
RPull the handle on the outside of the boot lid.
RPress the closing button on the boot lid.
RPull or press the remote operating switch on
the driver's door.
RPress the F button on the key.
If the boot lid closing procedure has been stopped:
Rmove your foot under the bumper again and
the boot lid will open
If the boot lid opening procedure has been stopped:
Rmove your foot under the bumper again and
the boot lid will close
X
G WARNING
Parts of the body could become trapped during automatic closing of the boot lid. In addition, people may be standing in the closing
area or may enter the closing area, e.g. children, during the closing procedure. There is a
risk of injury.
Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity of the
closing area during the closing process.
Release the remote operating switch immediately if somebody becomes trapped. To reopen the boot lid, pull on the remote operating
switch.
G WARNING
The boot lid can be automatically opened or
closed even if the key is not in the vehicle. If
children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could activate the functions. There is a
risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
! The boot lid swings upwards when opened.
Therefore, make sure that there is sufficient
clearance above the boot lid.
The opening dimensions of the boot lid can be
found in the "Vehicle data" section
(Y page 327).
Opening and closing
Side windows
If the boot cannot be unlocked with the key or
KEYLESS-GO, use the emergency key element.
If you use the emergency key element to unlock
and open the boot lid, the anti-theft alarm system will be triggered. Switch off the alarm
(Y page 74).
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 79).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
boot lid lock as far as the stop.
Locking the boot separately
The separate boot locking function is only available in certain countries.
You can lock the boot separately. If you then
unlock the vehicle centrally, the boot remains
locked and cannot be opened.
X Close the boot lid.
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 79).
Turn the emergency key element from position 1 anti-clockwise as far as it will go to
position 2. When doing so, also pull the boot
lid handle.
The boot is unlocked.
X Turn the emergency key element back to position 1 and remove it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
X
Side windows
Insert the emergency key element into the
boot lid lock as far as the stop.
X Turn the emergency key element clockwise
from position 1 to position 2.
X Pull out the emergency key element.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
X
Unlocking the boot (emergency key
element)
Important safety notes
G WARNING
While opening the side windows, body parts
could become trapped between the side window and the door frame as the side window
moves. There is a risk of injury.
Make sure that nobody touches the side window during the opening procedure. If somebody becomes trapped, release the switch or
pull the switch to close the side window again.
! The boot lid swings upwards when opened.
Therefore, make sure that there is sufficient
clearance above the boot lid.
Z
Opening and closing
To open: pull remote operating switch : for
the boot lid until the boot lid opens.
If the boot separator was closed, it opens
automatically and remains open.
X To close: press remote operating switch :
for the boot lid until the boot lid is closed.
When the roof is open, the boot separator
closes automatically.
You can open and close the boot lid from the
driver's seat when the vehicle is stationary and
unlocked.
X
89
90
Side windows
Opening and closing
G WARNING
While closing the side windows, body parts in
the closing area could become trapped. There
is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area. If somebody
becomes trapped, release the switch or press
the switch to open the side window again.
G WARNING
Children could become trapped if they operate the side windows, particularly when unattended. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
Opening and closing the side windows
Opening and closing the side windows
in the front
The switches for the side windows are located
on the driver's door. There is also a switch for
the front-passenger side window on the frontpassenger door.
The switches on the driver's door take precedence.
Side window reversing feature
The front side windows are equipped with an
automatic reversing feature. If a solid object
blocks or restricts the upward movement of one
of the front side windows during the closing
process, the side window opens again automatically. During the manual closing process, the
side window only opens again automatically
after the corresponding switch is released. However, the automatic reversing feature is only an
aid, not a substitute for your attention when
closing the side window.
G WARNING
The reversing function does not react:
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
gers
Rover the last 4 mm of the closing movement
Rduring
resetting
closing the side window again manually immediately after automatic reversing
This means that the reversing function cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area. If someone
becomes trapped, press the switch to open
the side window again.
Rwhen
: Left
; Right
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To open manually: press and hold the corresponding button.
X To open fully: press the button beyond the
point of resistance and release it.
Automatic operation is started.
X To close manually: pull the corresponding
button and hold it.
X To close fully: pull the button beyond the
point of resistance and release it.
Automatic operation is started.
X To interrupt automatic operation: press or
pull the corresponding switch again.
You can continue to operate the side windows
after you switch off the engine. This function
remains active for five minutes or until the driver's or front-passenger door is opened.
X
Side windows
To open: open the front side window on the
corresponding side (Y page 90).
X Press the corresponding switch again and
release.
The corresponding rear side window opens
fully.
X To stop the rear side windows: briefly pull
the corresponding switch up and release.
X To close: close the front side window on the
corresponding side (Y page 90).
X Pull the respective switch and hold it.
The corresponding rear side window will continue to close until you release the switch.
X
Opening and closing all side windows
Using the switch on the centre console
G WARNING
When a side window is closed, body parts may
become trapped in the closing range. There is
a risk of injury.
Ensure that there are no body parts in the
closing range of the window when closing it. If
somebody becomes trapped, release the button immediately or press the lower section of
the button to open the side window again.
Using the switch on the centre console, you can
close all side windows simultaneously.
X Open the cover on the lower centre console.
The switch for all side windows is under the
cover.
To open all side windows: press button :
to the point of resistance.
X To open all side windows fully: press button : beyond the point of resistance.
X To close all side windows: pull button :.
All side windows begin the closing procedure
simultaneously. The rear side windows close
after the front side windows.
If, after opening the windows, you close one side
window using the button in the door control
panel:
Rthe front side window closes first and
Rthen the corresponding rear side window
closes
X
Convenience closing with KEYLESS-GO
G WARNING
When using convenience closing, you could
become trapped within the sweep of the closing window. There is a risk of injury.
Monitor the entire closing procedure when
using convenience closing. When closing,
make sure that no one has any parts of the
body within the closing area.
Proceed as follows if someone is trapped:
Release the recessed sensor surface on the
door handle.
X Immediately pull and hold the door handle
and keep the door handle pulled.
The side windows open.
With KEYLESS-GO you can close all side windows simultaneously. The KEYLESS-GO key
must be outside the vehicle. All the doors must
be closed.
X
Z
Opening and closing
Opening/closing the rear side windows
91
Side windows
92
Touch recessed sensor surface : on the
door handle until the side windows are fully
closed.
i Make sure you only touch recessed sensor
surface :.
X
Opening and closing
X
To interrupt convenience closing: release
recessed sensor surface : on the door handle.
Resetting the side windows
If a side window can no longer be closed fully,
you must reset it.
X Close all doors.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Pull the corresponding switch on the door
control panel until the side window is completely closed (Y page 90).
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
If the side window opens again slightly:
X Immediately pull the corresponding switch on
the door control panel until the side window is
completely closed (Y page 90).
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
If the corresponding side window remains
closed after the button has been released, the
side window has been reset correctly. If this is
not the case, repeat the steps above again.
Roof
93
Problems with the side windows
G WARNING
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
A side window cannot be
closed because it is
blocked by objects, e.g.
leaves in the window
guide.
X
X
Remove the objects.
Close the side window.
A side window cannot be If a side window is obstructed during closing and reopens again
closed and you cannot
slightly:
see the cause.
X Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding switch
again until the side window has closed.
The side window is closed with increased force.
If a side window is obstructed again during closing and reopens again
slightly:
X Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding switch
again until the side window has closed.
The side window is closed without the automatic reversing feature.
Roof
Important safety notes
Only have the soft top closed manually at a
qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
! Never sit on the rear compartment trim or
If you do not fully open/close the soft top, the
soft-top hydraulics depressurise after a short
time. This causes the soft top to lower unexpectedly and may cause you or others to be
trapped. There is a risk of injury.
Always open or close the soft top completely.
! Do not forget that the weather can change
G WARNING
! When opening and closing the roof, make
Closing the roof manually is a complex, technically challenging procedure that requires
considerable effort during certain phases.
You or others could be trapped while performing this task. There is a risk of injury.
stow heavy objects there. You will otherwise
damage the roof and rear compartment trim
of the vehicle.
abruptly. Make certain that the roof is closed
when you leave the vehicle. The vehicle electronics can be damaged if water enters the
vehicle interior.
sure that:
Rthere is sufficient upward clearance, as the
roof swings upwards.
Rthere is sufficient clearance behind the
vehicle, as the boot lid swings backwards
beyond the bumper.
Z
Opening and closing
If you close a side window again immediately after it has been blocked or reset, the side window
closes with increased or maximum force. The reversing function is then not active. Parts of the
body could be trapped in the closing area in the process. This poses an increased risk of injury or
even fatal injury.
Make sure that no parts of the body are in the closing area. To stop the closing process, release
the switch or push the switch again to reopen the side window.
94
Roof
Opening and closing
Rthe
boot is only loaded to below the boot
separator.
Rthe boot separator is not pushed up by the
load.
Rthe boot separator is closed.
Rthe boot lid is closed.
Rthe outside temperature is above Ò15 †.
You could otherwise damage the roof, boot
and other parts of the vehicle.
The vehicle dimensions for opening/closing the
roof can be found in the "Vehicle data" section
(Y page 327).
Make sure that the roof and rear window are dry
and clean before opening the roof. Otherwise,
water or dirt could enter the vehicle interior or
boot.
Opening and closing using the roof
switch
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When opening or closing the roof, body parts
could be trapped by, for example, the roof
mechanism, boot lid or side windows. There is
a risk of injury.
When raising or lowering the roof, make sure
that no body parts are in the vicinity of moving
components. If someone becomes trapped,
release the button.
For safety reasons, the roof can only be opened
or closed when the vehicle is stationary.
Opening and closing
Close the boot lid (Y page 85).
If the boot is loaded correctly, the boot separator is automatically closed.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Open the cover on the lower centre console.
Roof switch : is located under the cover.
X To open: pull roof switch : until the entire
roof is stowed away in the boot.
You see the Vario-roof in operation
message in the multifunction display. As soon
as the opening procedure has ended, the
message disappears and you hear a tone.
The front side windows close. The rear side
windows open.
X To close: press and hold soft-top switch :
until the soft top is fully closed.
You see the Vario-roof in operation
message in the multifunction display. As soon
as the closing procedure has ended, the message disappears and you hear a tone.
All of the side windows close.
X Make sure that all the side windows are fully
closed.
X
! Operating the roof while pulling away:
RObserve
the following traffic carefully.
not drive faster than 40 km/h.
RAvoid abrupt braking and swerving
manoeuvres.
Do not operate the roof when cornering, driving on uneven surfaces or during strong
winds. The vehicle could otherwise be damaged.
RDo
i If the traffic conditions mean that you have
to drive off while opening/closing the roof,
the procedure which was started while stationary can be continued at speeds of up to
approx. 40 km/h.
Opening and closing with the key
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When opening or closing the roof, body parts
could be trapped by, for example, the roof
mechanism, boot lid or side windows. There is
a risk of injury.
When raising or lowering the roof, make sure
that no body parts are in the vicinity of moving
Roof
Opening and closing
This function is only available on vehicles with
KEYLESS-GO or with roof comfort operation.
X Close the boot lid (Y page 85)
If the boot has been correctly loaded the boot
separator is automatically closed.
X Vehicles with comfort operation: point the
tip of the key at the driver's door handle.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: the key must
be within 2 m of the vehicle.
X To open: press and hold the % button on
the key until the roof is fully opened.
The roof and the rear side windows open. The
front side windows close.
X To interrupt the opening procedure:
release the % button.
X To open the front side windows: press the
% button on the key again.
X To close: press and hold the & button on
the key until the roof is fully closed.
The roof and the side windows close.
X To interrupt the closing procedure: release
the & button.
Locking the roof again
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Locking
You can lock the roof again if it is not locked
fully.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon
as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X Press the roof switch (Y page 94).
Boot separator
General notes
! To avoid damaging the roof or luggage when
folding back the roof, you should:
load the boot to below the boot separator
Rnot place any objects on or in front of the
boot separator
Rnot place any objects on the cover behind
the roll bars
Rnot allow the load to push up the boot separator
Ronly
! Make sure that the boot separator is fully
closed. Otherwise, the roof could be blocked
when opening or closing.
The boot separator can be used to cover luggage
and loads in the boot.
Opening and closing
If you do not fully open/close the soft top, the
soft-top hydraulics depressurise after a short
time. This causes the soft top to lower unexpectedly and may cause you or others to be
trapped. There is a risk of injury.
Always open or close the soft top completely.
The roof is not locked if:
Rthe
K symbol and the Vario-roof in
operation message appears in the multifunction display
Rthe K symbol and the Open/close
vario-roof completely message appear
and you hear a warning tone
Ryou hear a warning tone for up to ten seconds
when pulling away or while driving
Boot separator : can be opened and closed
using button ;, e.g. to check correct loading.
Z
Opening and closing
components. If someone becomes trapped,
release the button.
95
Roof
96
To open: press button ;.
To close: press button ;.
If the boot is loaded correctly, boot separator : is automatically closed to the full
extent.
When the boot lid is opened, boot separator :
opens automatically.
X
X
Opening and closing
Removing and fitting
Turn catch lever A downwards in the direction of the arrow on both sides.
Boot separator : is unlocked.
X Slide boot separator cover : forwards.
X Pull boot separator : out of the two guides in
the direction of arrow B.
X
To remove: close boot separator :
(Y page 95).
X To disconnect the electric plug connector,
press the release catch on connector ; and
remove connector ;.
X
To fit: insert boot separator : into the two
guides in the direction of arrow C to the stop.
X Turn catch lever A upwards in the direction
of the arrow on both sides.
Boot separator : is locked.
X Pull the net forwards and hook into the retainers on both sides.
X Push boot separator cover : back against
the spring pressure and insert to the end stop
on both sides.
X
X
Unhook net = from holders ? on both sides
and guide it to the rear until it is completely
rolled up.
Roof
97
after you have stopped the vehicle, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X
Reconnect connector ; of the electric plug
connector.
Draught stop
Manual draught stop
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you use the draught stop in darkness or in
other conditions offering poor visibility, your
view to the rear is further impaired. There is a
risk of an accident.
Only use the draught stop when visibility conditions are good.
G WARNING
If the draught stop is incorrectly fitted, it could
detach itself during a journey and endanger
other road users. There is a risk of an accident
and injury.
Fit the draught stop as described. Do not
place any objects on top of the fitted draught
stop.
! Fit or remove the draught stop only when
the roof is open. You could otherwise damage
the draught stop or the vehicle interior.
The draught stop offers protection from the
wind when driving with the roof down.
The draught stop can be fitted or removed from
the driver's side or passenger side. We recommend that a second person assists you when
doing this.
Perform operations involving the draught stop
preferably on the side facing away from traffic,
To fit: open the roof (Y page 94).
Press the mark on cover : and push in the
direction of the arrow.
X Repeat the procedure with cover ;.
The rear brackets for draught stop = are visible.
X
X
Make sure that draught stop = is folded
back.
X Push the upper half of cover B on draught
stop =.
X Repeat the procedure with the cover on the
driver's side.
Draught stop = is unlocked.
X
Hold draught stop = at an angle and insert
pins ? into the rear brackets.
Make sure that pins ? sit correctly in the
brackets.
X Insert draught stop = into front brackets A.
X Check whether draught stop = is correctly
seated in all four brackets.
X
Z
Opening and closing
Fitting/removing
Roof
98
Push the lower half of cover B on draught
stop =.
Draught stop = is locked.
X Fold draught stop = forward if necessary.
X
To remove: make sure that draught stop =
is folded back.
X Push the upper half of cover B on draught
stop =.
Draught stop = is unlocked.
X First remove draught stop = from front
brackets A.
X Hold draught stop = at an angle and then
remove from the rear brackets.
Opening and closing
X
X
Slide covers : and ; of the rear brackets
against the direction of the arrow until they
are fully closed.
X
X
To extend: press button :.
To retract: press button : again.
Roller sunblind for the panorama roof
Electric draught stop
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you use the draught stop in darkness or in
other conditions offering poor visibility, your
view to the rear is further impaired. There is a
risk of an accident.
Only use the draught stop when visibility conditions are good.
! When extending or retracting the draught
stop, make sure there are no objects on the
rear compartment trim. Otherwise, the
objects could damage the draught stop.
The draught stop offers protection from the
wind when driving with the roof down. The roof
must be fully open before the draught stop can
be extended.
Extending and retracting
Open the roof (Y page 93).
X Open the cover on the lower centre console.
The switch for the electrical draught stop is
under the cover.
X
The roller sunblind protects you from excessive
glare and heat caused by the sun shining
through the panorama glass roof.
X To close: pull the roller sunblind in the direction of the arrow using handle :.
X To open: slide the roller sunblind in the opposite direction to the arrow using handle :.
MAGIC SKY CONTROL
General notes
MAGIC SKY CONTROL is a panorama roof, the
transparency of which can be changed by applying electrical voltage.
MAGIC SKY CONTROL can be switched between
darkened and transparent states.
MAGIC SKY CONTROL darkens automatically
after a short period when you turn the key to
position 0 or remove the key.
Roof
99
Risk of electric shock
Opening and closing
G DANGER
MAGIC SKY CONTROL operates using high
voltage. If the trim behind the overhead control panel is damaged or removed, electrical
components will be exposed. If you touch
these components, you could get an electric
shock. There is a risk of fatal injury.
RNever remove the trim behind the overhead
control panel.
RIf the trim is damaged, never touch the
electrical components behind it.
RAlways have work on the MAGIC SKY CONTROL carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
The electrical components of MAGIC SKY CONTROL are protected by a covering behind the
overhead control panel.
The MAGIC SKY CONTROL control unit has a
yellow high-voltage warning sticker. The electric
cables of the high-voltage section are coloured
orange.
MAGIC SKY CONTROL operation
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
MAGIC SKY CONTROL switches to the state it
was set to before the engine was switched off.
X To change the degree of transparency:
press button :.
X
At temperatures below freezing, the change is
slower and uneven. The entire process may take
some time.
Z
100
Roof
Problems with the roof
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The roof will not open or The boot separator is not closed.
close.
X Close the boot separator (Y page 95).
The net on the boot separator is not attached.
Attach the net (Y page 95).
Opening and closing
X
The electrical plug connector on the boot separator is disconnected.
X Connect the electrical plug connector to the boot separator
(Y page 95).
The boot is incorrectly loaded.
X Only load the boot to below the boot separator
The boot lid is open.
X Close the boot lid (Y page 85)
The on-board voltage is too low.
Leave the engine running.
X
The roof has been opened and closed several times in a row. The roof
drive has switched off automatically.
You can open and close the roof again after approximately ten
minutes.
X Switch the ignition off and then on again.
X Repeat the opening or closing procedure.
The automatic roof system is faulty.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Correct driver's seat position
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
Observe the safety guidelines on seat adjustment (Y page 101).
X Make sure that seat = is correctly adjusted.
Electrical seat adjustment (Y page 102)
When adjusting the seat, make sure that:
Ryou are as far away from the driver's airbag as
possible
Ryou are sitting in a normal upright position
Ryou can fasten the seat belt properly
Ryou have moved the backrest to an almost
vertical position
Ryou have set the seat angle so that your thighs
are gently supported
Ryou can depress the pedals properly
X Check whether the head restraint is adjusted
correctly.
When doing so, make sure that you have
adjusted the head restraint so that the back of
X
your head is supported at eye level by the
centre of the head restraint.
X Observe the safety notes on steering column
adjustment (Y page 106).
X Make sure that steering wheel : is adjusted
correctly.
Adjusting the steering wheel electrically
(Y page 106)
When adjusting the steering wheel column,
make sure that:
Ryou can hold the steering wheel with your
arms slightly bent
Ryou can move your legs freely
Ryou can see all the displays in the instrument
cluster clearly
X Observe the safety guidelines for seat belts
(Y page 41).
X Check whether you have fastened seat
belt ; properly (Y page 42).
The seat belt should:
Rfit snugly across your body
Rbe routed across the middle of your shoulder
Rbe routed across your hips in the pelvic area
X Before starting off, adjust the rear-view mirror
and the exterior mirrors (Y page 108) in such
a way that you have a good view of road and
traffic conditions.
X Store the seat, steering wheel and exterior
mirror settings using the memory function
(Y page 111).
Seats
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children adjust the seats, they could
become trapped, especially if they are unattended. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
The seats can still be adjusted when there is no
key in the ignition lock.
Z
101
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Seats
102
Seats
G WARNING
When adjusting a seat, you or another vehicle
occupant could become trapped by the guide
rail of the seat, for instance. There is a risk of
injury.
Make sure that no one has any part of their
body within the sweep of the seat when
adjusting it.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Observe the safety notes on "Airbags"
(Y page 43) and "Children in the Vehicle"
(Y page 54).
G WARNING
If you adjust the seat height carelessly, you or
other vehicle occupants could be trapped and
thereby injured. Children in particular could
accidentally press the electrical seat adjustment buttons and become trapped. There is a
risk of injury.
While moving the seats, make sure that your
hands or other body parts do not get under the
lever assembly of the seat adjustment system.
G WARNING
The head restraints cannot provide the intended protection unless they are fitted and
adjusted correctly. There is an increased risk
of injury to the head and neck in the event of
an accident or sudden braking, for example.
Always drive with the head restraints fitted.
Ensure that the centre of the head restraints
support the back of each vehicle occupant's
head at eye level before driving off.
! To avoid damage to the seats and the seat
heating, observe the following information:
Rdo not spill any liquids on the seats. If liquid
is spilled on the seats, dry them as soon as
possible.
Rif the seat covers are damp or wet, do not
switch on the seat heating. The seat heating should also not be used to dry the seats.
Rclean the seat covers as recommended;
see the "Interior care" section.
Rdo not transport heavy loads on the seats.
Do not place sharp objects on the seat
cushions, e.g. knives, nails or tools. The
seats should only be occupied by passengers, if possible.
Rwhen the seat heating is in operation, do
not cover the seats with insulating materials, e.g. blankets, coats, bags, seat covers,
child seats or booster seats.
! Make sure that there are no objects in the
footwell under or behind the seats when moving the seats back. There is a risk that the
seats and/or the objects could be damaged.
i The head restraints cannot be removed.
For more information, contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Adjusting the seats electrically
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
:
;
=
?
A
B
Head restraint height
Seat height
Seat cushion angle
Seat cushion length
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
Backrest angle
Seats
RYou
can store the seat settings using the
memory function (Y page 111).
RIf PRE-SAFE® is triggered, the frontpassenger seat will be moved to a better
position if it was previously in an unfavourable position (Y page 53).
Adjusting the front-passenger seat
from the driver's seat
G WARNING
If the front seats are positioned too closely to
the dashboard or steering wheel, the front
airbags could cause additional injuries to
vehicle occupants in the front. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Always adjust the front seats so that they are
as far away as possible from the front airbags.
In addition, observe the instructions on how to
adjust the seats correctly.
! Do not move the front-passenger seat fully
forwards if there are objects in the luggage
net in the front-passenger footwell. The
objects could otherwise be damaged.
You can use the seat switches on the driver's
side to adjust the front-passenger seat.
X To switch on/off: press button :.
When the indicator lamp in button : lights up,
for the front-passenger seat you can:
Radjust the seat
Rcall up the memory function
Removing the seat belt from the seat
belt guide
G WARNING
When driving off-road, your body is subject to
forces from all directions due to the uneven
surface. You could be thrown from your seat,
for instance. There is a danger of injury.
Always wear a seat belt, even when driving offroad.
Both the driver's seat belt and the frontpassenger seat belt can be removed from the
seat belt guide. This makes it easier to move the
seats forward.
Before you drive off, the seat belt must be inserted into the seat belt guide.
Observe the safety guidelines for seat belts
(Y page 41).
X To remove: open up magnetic head ; and
fold the tab up in the direction of the arrow.
X Take the seat belt out of seat belt guide :.
X To insert: fold the tab up in the direction of
the arrow.
X Insert the seat belt back into the seat belt
guide and fold the tab back down.
Adjusting the head restraints
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
i Further related subjects:
103
Seats
104
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
X
To adjust the head restraint height: slide
the switch for the head restraint adjustment : up or down in the direction of the
arrow.
Sliding the seats forward/back
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
G WARNING
When adjusting a seat, you or another vehicle
occupant could become trapped by the guide
rail of the seat, for instance. There is a risk of
injury.
Make sure that no one has any part of their
body within the sweep of the seat when
adjusting it.
! Make sure that there are no containers in
the cup holder and no objects in the footwell
or behind the seats when adjusting the seats.
Otherwise, you could damage the seats and
the objects.
You can move the seat forwards, in order to gain
better access to the rear compartment, e.g. to
reach the stowage compartment in the rear .
X Remove the seat belt from the seat belt guide
(Y page 103).
X To move the seat forwards: press : on
switch :.
The seat moves automatically to the foremost
position.
To move the seat backwards: press 9
on switch :.
The seat moves back to the previous position.
X To stop seat movement: press : or
9 in the opposite direction.
X
Adjusting the multicontour seat
You can adjust the multicontour seat using
COMAND Online .
Adjusting the active multicontour
seat
You can adjust the active multicontour seat
using COMAND Online .
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support
You can adjust the 4-way lumbar support using
COMAND Online .
Switching the seat heating on/off
Switching on/off
G WARNING
If you repeatedly switch on seat heating, the
seat cushion and backrest padding may
become very hot. The health of vehicle occupants with limited temperature sensitivity or a
limited ability to react to excessively high
temperatures may be affected or they may
even suffer burn-like injuries. There is a risk of
injury.
Therefore, do not switch on the seat heating
repeatedly.
Seats
105
Switching the seat ventilation on/off
Switching on/off
The three red indicator lamps in the button indicate the heating level you have selected.
The system automatically switches down from
level 3 to level 2 after approximately eight
minutes.
The system automatically switches from level 2
to level 1 after approximately ten minutes.
The system automatically switches off approximately 20 minutes after it is set to level 1.
X Make sure that the key is in position 1 or 2 in
the ignition lock.
X To switch on: press button : repeatedly
until the desired heating level is set.
X To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat
heating may switch off.
Problems with the seat heating
The seat heating has switched off prematurely
or cannot be switched on. The vehicle's electrical system voltage is too low because too many
electrical consumers are switched on.
X Switch off electrical consumers that you do
not need, such as the rear window heating or
interior lighting.
X Once the battery is sufficiently charged,
switch the seat heating on again.
The three blue indicator lamps in the buttons
indicate the ventilation level you have selected.
X Make sure that the key is in position 1 or 2 in
the ignition lock.
X To switch on: press button : repeatedly
until the desired ventilation level is set.
X To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat
ventilation may switch off.
i If you open the roof using the key
(Y page 95), the driver's seat ventilation is
automatically switched on and the side windows open.
Problems with the seat ventilation
The seat ventilation has switched off prematurely or cannot be switched on. The vehicle's
electrical system voltage is too low because too
many electrical consumers are switched on.
X Switch off electrical consumers that you do
not need, such as the rear window heating or
interior lighting.
X Once the battery is sufficiently charged,
switch the seat heating on again.
AIRSCARF
Switching on/off
G WARNING
When AIRSCARF is switched on, very hot air
can flow from the vents in the head restraints.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Driver's and front-passenger seat
106
Steering wheel
This could result in burns in the immediate
vicinity of the air vents. There is a risk of injury.
Reduce the heater output before it becomes
too hot.
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
G WARNING
Children could become trapped by the steering wheel if they adjust it. There is a risk of
injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
The AIRSCARF function warms the head and
neck area of vehicle occupants with warm air.
The warm air flows out of the holes in the head
restraints.
The three red indicator lamps in the button indicate the heating level you have selected.
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X To switch on: press button :.
Three red indicator lamps in the button light
up. The blower starts up after a preheating
phase of seven seconds.
X Press button : repeatedly until the desired
heating level is set.
X To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
i The blower continues running for seven seconds to cool down the heating elements.
i If the battery voltage is too low, AIRSCARF
may switch off.
Steering wheel
Important safety notes
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
The electrically adjustable steering wheel can
still be adjusted when there is no key in the ignition lock.
Adjusting the steering wheel electrically
: To adjust the steering wheel height
; To adjust the steering wheel position (fore-
and-aft adjustment)
i Further related subjects:
REASY-ENTRY/EXIT
RStoring
feature (Y page 106)
settings (Y page 111)
EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you drive off while the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT
feature is making adjustments, you could lose
Steering wheel
G WARNING
When the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature adjusts
the steering wheel, you and other vehicle
occupants – particularly children – could
become trapped. There is a risk of injury.
While the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature is making adjustments, make sure that no one has
any body parts in the sweep of the steering
wheel.
If someone is trapped:
Rpress
one of the memory function position
buttons, or
Rmove the switch for steering wheel adjustment in the opposite direction to that in
which the steering wheel is moving.
The adjustment process is stopped.
G WARNING
When the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature adjusts
the steering wheel and the driver's seat, you
and other vehicle occupants – particularly
children – could become trapped. There is a
risk of injury.
While the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature is making adjustments, make sure that no one has
any body parts in the sweep of the seat and
the steering wheel.
If someone is trapped:
Rpress
one of the memory function position
buttons, or
Rpress one of the memory function memory
buttons, or
Rmove the switch for steering wheel adjustment in the opposite direction to that in
which the steering wheel is moving.
The adjustment process is stopped.
G WARNING
If you use openings in the bodywork or
detachable parts as steps, you could:
Rslip
and/or fall
the vehicle and cause yourself to
Rdamage
fall.
There is a danger of injury.
Always use secure climbing aids, e.g. a suitable ladder.
The EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature makes getting in
and out of your vehicle easier.
You can activate and deactivate the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature in the on-board computer
(Y page 211).
Position of the steering wheel when the
EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature is active
The steering wheel tilts upwards if you:
Rremove the key from the ignition lock
Ropen the driver's door and KEYLESS-GO is in
position 1
Ropen the driver's door and the key is in position 0 or 1 in the ignition lock
i The steering wheel only moves upwards if it
has not already reached the upper end stop.
Position of the steering wheel for driving
The steering wheel is moved to the previously
set position if:
Rthe driver's door is closed and
Ryou insert the key into the ignition lock
or
Ryou press the Start/Stop button once on vehicles with KEYLESS-GO
If you close the driver's door with the key inserted in the ignition lock, the steering wheel is
automatically moved to the previously set position.
The last position of the steering wheel is stored
when you switch off the ignition or when you
store the setting with the memory function
(Y page 111).
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
control of the vehicle. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always wait until the adjustment process is
complete before driving off.
107
Mirrors
108
Crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
If the crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature is triggered in an accident, the steering column will
move upwards when the driver's door is opened.
This occurs irrespective of the position of the
key in the ignition lock. This makes it easier to
exit the vehicle and rescue the occupants.
The crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature is only
operational if the EASY-EXIT/ENTRY feature is
activated in the on-board computer
(Y page 211).
G WARNING
The exterior mirrors reduce the size of the
image. Objects visible in the mirrors are
closer than they appear. You could misjudge
the distance from road users driving behind
you when changing lanes, for instance. There
is a risk of an accident.
You should therefore always look over your
shoulder to determine the actual distance
from road users driving behind you.
Mirrors
Rear-view mirror
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or 2 in
the ignition lock.
X Press button : for the left exterior mirror or
button ; for the right exterior mirror.
The indicator lamp in the corresponding button lights up in red.
The indicator lamp goes out again after some
time. You can adjust the selected mirror using
adjustment button = as long as the indicator
lamp is lit.
X Press adjustment button = up, down, to the
right or to the left.
The exterior mirror must be set to a position
that provides you with a good overview of
traffic conditions.
The convex exterior mirrors provide a larger field
of vision.
After the engine has been started, the exterior
mirrors are automatically heated if the rear window heating is switched on and the outside temperature is low. Heating takes a maximum of 10
minutes.
X
X
Anti-dazzle mode: move anti-dazzle lever :
forwards or back.
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting the exterior mirrors
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
i The exterior mirrors can also be heated
manually by switching on the rear window
heating.
Mirrors
Folding the exterior mirrors in/out electrically
109
Folding the exterior mirrors in/out
automatically
If the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function is
activated in the on-board computer
(Y page 212):
Rthe exterior mirrors fold in automatically as
soon as you lock the vehicle from the outside
Rthe exterior mirrors fold out again automatically as soon as you unlock the vehicle and
then open the driver's or front-passenger
door
have been folded in manually.
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or 2 in
the ignition lock.
X Briefly press button :.
Both exterior mirrors fold in or out.
X
i Make sure that the exterior mirrors are
always folded out fully while driving. They
could otherwise vibrate.
Resetting the exterior mirrors
Exterior mirror pushed out of position
If an exterior mirror has been pushed out of
position, proceed as follows:
X Vehicles without electrically folding exterior mirrors: manually move the exterior mirror into the correct position.
X Vehicles with electrically folding exterior
mirrors: press and hold mirror-folding button
until you hear the mirror click into place
(Y page 109).
The mirror housing is engaged again and you
can adjust the exterior mirrors as usual
(Y page 108).
Automatic anti-dazzle mirrors
G WARNING
If the battery has been disconnected or completely discharged, the exterior mirrors must be
reset. The exterior mirrors will otherwise not
fold in when you select the "Fold in mirrors when
locking" function in the on-board computer
(Y page 212).
X Make sure that the key is in position 1 in the
ignition lock.
X Briefly press :.
Electrolyte may escape if the glass of an automatic anti-dazzle mirror breaks. Electrolyte is
harmful and causes irritation. It must not
come into contact with your skin, eyes, respiratory organs or clothing or be swallowed.
There is a risk of injury.
If you come into contact with electrolyte,
observe the following:
Rimmediately
rinse off electrolyte from your
skin with water.
Rimmediately and thoroughly rinse electrolyte out of eyes using clean water.
Rif electrolyte is swallowed, immediately
rinse out your mouth thoroughly. Do not
induce vomiting.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
i The exterior mirrors do not fold out if they
110
Mirrors
electrolyte comes into contact with skin
or eyes or is swallowed, seek medical attention immediately.
Rimmediately change out of clothing that has
been in contact with electrolyte.
Rif an allergic reaction occurs, seek medical
attention immediately.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Rif
The rear-view mirror and the exterior mirror on
the driver's side automatically go into anti-dazzle mode if the following conditions are met
simultaneously:
Rthe ignition is switched on and
Rincident light from headlamps strikes the sensor in the rear-view mirror
The mirrors do not dip if reverse gear is engaged
or if the interior lighting is switched on.
Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the preset parking position.
X Use adjustment button = to adjust the exterior mirror to a position that allows you to see
the rear wheel and the kerb.
The parking position is stored.
i If you shift the transmission to another position, the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side returns to the driving position.
X
Using the memory button
Parking position of the exterior mirror
on the front-passenger side
Setting and storing the parking position
Using reverse gear
You can store the parking position of the exterior mirror on the front-passenger side using
memory button M ?. The reverse gear must not
be engaged during the process.
X Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and
that the key is in position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Press button ; for the exterior mirror on the
front-passenger side.
You can set the front-passenger side exterior
mirror so that you can see the rear wheel on that
side as soon as you engage reverse gear. This
setting can be stored using memory button
M ?.
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X With the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side activated, use adjustment
button = to adjust the exterior mirror. The
rear wheel and the kerb should be visible in
the exterior mirror.
X Press memory button M ? and one of the
arrows on adjustment button = within three
seconds.
The parking position is stored if the exterior
mirror does not move.
X If the mirror moves out of position, repeat the
steps.
Memory function
Calling up a stored parking position
111
diately release the memory function position
button. The adjustment process is stopped.
G WARNING
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Adjust the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side using button ;.
X Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the stored parking position.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger side
moves back to its original position:
Ras soon as you exceed a speed of 15 km/h
Rif you press button : for the exterior mirror
on the driver's side
X
The memory function can be used at any time,
e.g. even when the key is not in the ignition lock.
With the memory function, you can store up to
three different settings, e.g. for three different
people.
The following settings are stored as a single
memory preset:
Rposition of the seat, backrest and head
restraint
Rdriver's side: steering wheel position
Rdriver's side: position of the exterior mirrors
on the driver's and front-passenger sides
Memory function
Storing settings
G WARNING
If you use the memory function on the driver's
side while driving, the adjustments could
cause you to lose control of the vehicle. There
is a risk of an accident.
Only use the memory function on the driver's
side while the vehicle is stationary.
G WARNING
When the memory function adjusts the seat or
steering wheel, you and other vehicle occupants – particularly children – could become
trapped. There is a risk of injury.
While the memory function is making adjustments, make sure that no one has any body
parts in the sweep of the seat or steering
wheel. If somebody becomes trapped, imme-
Adjust the seat electrically (Y page 102).
On the driver's side, adjust the steering wheel
(Y page 106) and the exterior mirrors
(Y page 108).
X Press memory button M and then press save
position button 1, 2 or 3 within three seconds.
The settings are stored in the selected memory position. A tone sounds when the settings
have been completed.
X
X
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
If children activate the memory function, they
could become trapped, especially if they are
unattended. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
Memory function
112
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Calling up a stored setting
Press and hold the relevant storage position
button 1, 2 or 3 until the seat, steering wheel
and exterior mirrors are in the stored position.
i The setting procedure is interrupted as soon
as you release the stored position button.
X
Exterior lighting
Exterior lighting
Light switch
General notes
Operation
113
For reasons of safety, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you drive with the lights switched on
even during the daytime. In some countries,
operation of the headlamps varies due to legal
requirements and self-imposed obligations.
Driving abroad
If your journey takes you to countries where
vehicles are driven on the opposite side of the
road to the country in which the vehicle is registered, your headlamps must be switched to
symmetrical dipped beam. This prevents
oncoming traffic from being dazzled. Symmetrical lights do not illuminate as large an area of the
edge of the carriageway.
Convert the headlamps as close to the border as
possible before driving in these countries
(Y page 210).
Asymmetrical dipped-beam headlamps
Convert the headlamps back to asymmetrical
dipped beam as soon as possible after crossing
the border (Y page 210).
If the headlamps are converted to symmetrical
dipped beam, the "motorway mode" and "extended range foglamps" functions (Intelligent Light
System) are not available.
1 W Left-hand parking lamps
2 X Right-hand parking lamps
3 T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment cluster lighting
4 Ã Automatic headlamp mode, controlled
by the light sensor
5 L Dipped-beam/main-beam headlamps
B R Rear fog lamp
If you hear a warning tone when you leave the
vehicle, the lights may still be switched on.
X Turn the light switch to Ã.
The exterior lighting (except the side lamps/
parking lamps) switches off automatically if you:
Rremove the key from the ignition lock
Ropen the driver's door with the key in position
0.
Automatic headlamp mode
G WARNING
Setting the exterior lighting
Setting options
Exterior lighting can be set by:
Rusing the light switch
Rusing the combination switch (Y page 115)
Rusing the on-board computer (Y page 209)
When the light switch is set to Ã, the
dipped-beam headlamps may not be switched
on automatically if there is fog, snow or other
causes of poor visibility due to the weather
conditions such as spray. There is a risk of an
accident.
In such situations, turn the light switch to
L.
The automatic headlamp feature is only an aid.
The driver is responsible for the vehicle lighting
at all times.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Symmetrical dipped-beam headlamps
Lights and windscreen wipers
114
Exterior lighting
à is the preferred light switch position. The
light setting is automatically selected according
to the brightness of the ambient light (exception: poor visibility due to weather conditions
such as fog, snow or spray):
RKey in position 1 in the ignition lock: the side
lamps are switched on or off automatically
depending on the brightness of the ambient
light
RWith the engine running: if you have switched
on the daytime driving lights function in the
on-board computer, the daytime driving lights
or the side lamps and dipped-beam headlamps are switched on or off automatically
depending on the brightness of the ambient
light
X To switch on automatic headlamp mode:
turn the light switch to Ã.
The daytime driving lights improve the detectability of your vehicle during the day. Here, the
daytime driving lights function must be switched
on via the on-board computer (Y page 209).
When the dipped-beam headlamps are switched
on, the green L indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up and the daytime driving
lights are switched off or dimmed.
Dipped-beam headlamps
G WARNING
When the light switch is set to Ã, the
dipped-beam headlamps may not be switched
on automatically if there is fog, snow or other
causes of poor visibility due to the weather
conditions such as spray. There is a risk of an
accident.
In such situations, turn the light switch to
L.
When the ignition is switched on and the light
switch is in the L position, the side lamps
and dipped-beam headlamps are switched on
even if the light sensor does not sense dark
ambient light conditions. This is advantageous
when there is fog or rain.
X To switch on the dipped-beam headlamps:
turn the key in the ignition lock to position 2
or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L.
The green L indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
Rear fog lamp
The rear foglamp improves the visibility of your
vehicle in heavy fog for the following traffic.
Please observe the country-specific laws on the
use of rear foglamps.
X To switch on the rear foglamp: turn the key
in the ignition lock to position 2 or start the
engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
X Press the R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
X To switch off the rear foglamp: press the
R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
Side lamps
! If the battery has been discharged to a low
charge level, the side lamps or parking lamps
are automatically switched off to enable the
next engine start. Always leave your vehicle in
a safe position and adequately lit in accordance with traffic regulations. Avoid using the
side lamps T for a period of several hours.
If possible, switch on the right X or left
W parking lamp.
X
To switch on: turn the light switch to T.
The green T indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
Parking lamps
Switching on the parking lamps ensures that the
corresponding side of the vehicle is illuminated.
X To switch on the parking lamps: the key is
not in the ignition lock or it is in position 0.
X Turn the light switch to W (left-hand side of
the vehicle) or X (right-hand side of the
vehicle).
Exterior lighting
:
;
=
?
Main-beam headlamps
Turn signal, right
Headlamp flasher
Turn signal, left
To indicate briefly: press the combination
switch briefly to the pressure point in the
direction of arrow ; or ?.
The corresponding turn signal flashes three
times.
X To indicate: press the combination switch
beyond the pressure point in the direction of
arrow ; or ?.
X To switch on the main-beam headlamps:
turn the light switch to L or Ã.
X Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of arrow :.
In the à position, the main-beam headlamps are only switched on when it is dark and
the engine is running.
The blue K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up when the main-beam
headlamps are switched on.
X To switch off the main-beam headlamps:
move the combination switch back to its normal position.
The blue K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
X
Hazard warning lamps
To switch on the hazard warning lamps:
press button :.
All turn signals flash. If you now switch on a
turn signal using the combination switch, only
the turn signal lamp on the corresponding
side of the vehicle will flash.
X To switch off the hazard warning lamps:
press button :.
X
The hazard warning lamps switch on automatically if:
Ran airbag is deployed or
Rthe vehicle decelerates rapidly from a speed
of above 70 km/h and comes to a standstill
The hazard warning lamps switch off automatically if the vehicle reaches a speed of above
10 km/h again after a full brake application.
i The hazard warning lamps continue to operate even if the ignition is switched off.
Intelligent Light System
General notes
The Intelligent Light System is a system that
adjusts the headlamps automatically to suit the
prevailing driving and weather conditions. It
offers advanced functions for improved illumination of the road surface, e.g. depending on the
vehicle speed or weather conditions. The system includes the active light function, cornering
light function, motorway mode and extended
range foglamps. The system is only active when
it is dark.
You can activate or deactivate the "Intelligent
Light System" function using the on-board computer (Y page 209).
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Combination switch
115
Lights and windscreen wipers
116
Exterior lighting
Active light function
Extended range foglamps
The active light function is a system that moves
the headlamps according to the steering movements of the front wheels. In this way, relevant
areas remain illuminated while you are driving.
This allows you to recognise pedestrians,
cyclists and animals.
Active: when the lights are switched on.
Vehicles with Lane Keeping Assist: the active
light function evaluates the course of the lane in
which you are driving and adjusts the light in
advance.
The extended range foglamps reduce the glare
experienced by the driver and improve the illumination of the edge of the carriageway.
Active: if you are driving at speeds below
70 km/h and you switch on the rear foglamp.
Not active: if, following activation, you are driving at speeds above 100 km/h or if you switch
off the rear foglamp.
Cornering light function
General notes
The cornering light function improves the illumination of the road over a wide angle in the
direction you are turning, enabling better visibility in tight bends, for example. The cornering
light function can only be activated when the
dipped-beam headlamps are switched on.
Active:
With Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus, you can
automatically switch between dipped-beam,
partial main-beam and main-beam headlamps.
Partial main-beam illumination is a form of illumination whereby the main beam is directed
past other road users. Other road users are kept
out of the main-beam. This prevents glare. If
there is a vehicle in front, for example, the mainbeam headlamps illuminate the areas to its right
and left, and the vehicle in front is illuminated by
the dipped-beam headlamps.
The system automatically adapts the dippedbeam headlamp range depending on the distance to the other vehicle. Once the system no
longer detects any other vehicles, it switches on
the main-beam headlamps again.
If the main-beam or partial main-beam headlamps are causing too much reflection from traffic signs, the lights are automatically dimmed
and glare for the driver caused by the reflections
is thus avoided.
The system's optical sensor is located behind
the windscreen near the overhead control
panel.
Vehicles with drive program S+ (Sport Plus): the
speed at which Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus
switches between full beam and dipped beam is
increased when the drive program is switched
on.
Rif
you are driving at speeds below 40 km/h
and switch on the turn signal or turn the steering wheel
Rif you are driving at speeds between 40 km/h
and 70 km/h and turn the steering wheel
The cornering light function may remain lit for a
short time, but is automatically switched off
after no more than three minutes.
Cornering light function with roundabout
function:
The cornering light function is activated on both
sides before entering a roundabout through an
evaluation of the current GPS position of the
vehicle. It remains active until after the vehicle
has left the roundabout. In this way, pedestrians
crossing the road, for example, are illuminated
by your vehicle in good time.
Motorway mode
Motorway mode increases the range of the
beam.
Active:
Rif
you are driving at speeds above 110 km/h
and do not make any large steering movements for at least 1,000 m
Rif you are driving at speeds above 130 km/h
Not active: if you are driving at speeds below
80 km/h following activation.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus
Interior lighting
G WARNING
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus does not recognise road users:
Rwho
have no lights, e.g. pedestrians
have poor lighting, e.g. cyclists
Rwhose lighting is blocked, e.g. by a barrier
In very rare cases, Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Plus may not recognise road users who do
have lights, or may recognise them too late. In
this, or in similar situations, the automatic
main-beam headlamps will not be deactivated
or will be activated despite the presence of
other road users. There is a risk of an accident.
Always carefully observe the traffic conditions
and switch off the main-beam headlamps in
good time.
Rwho
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus cannot take into
account road, weather or traffic conditions.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus is only an aid.
You are responsible for adjusting the vehicle's
lighting to the prevailing light, visibility and traffic conditions.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can be
restricted if there is:
Rpoor visibility, e.g. due to fog, heavy rain or
snow
Rdirt on the sensors or if the sensors are
obscured
At speeds above approximately 30 km/h:
Rif
no other road users are detected, the
main-beam headlamps are automatically
switched on
Rif other road users are detected, the partial
main-beam headlamps are automatically
switched on
The K indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster also lights up.
At speeds below approximately 25 km/h
or when there is sufficient street lighting:
Rthe
partial main-beam headlamps are
switched off automatically
Rthe main-beam headlamps are switched off
automatically
The K indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out. The _ indicator lamp in
the multifunction display remains lit.
X To switch off: move the combination switch
back to its normal position or move the light
switch to another position.
The _ indicator lamp in the multifunction
display goes out.
Interior lighting
Overview of interior lighting
Switching Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Plus on/off
X
X
To switch on: turn the light switch to Ã.
Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of arrow :.
The _ indicator lamp in the multifunction
display lights up when it is dark and the light
sensor switches on the dipped-beam headlamps.
At speeds above approximately 25 km/h:
the headlamp range is automatically controlled according to the distance to other road
users.
Overhead control panel
: p Switches the left-hand reading lamp
on/off
; c Switches the interior lighting on
= | Switches the interior lighting/auto-
matic interior lighting control off
? p Switches the right-hand reading lamp
on/off
A Switches the automatic interior lighting con-
trol on
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Important safety notes
117
Windscreen wipers
118
Interior lighting control
General notes
In order to prevent the vehicle's battery from
discharging, the interior lighting functions are
automatically deactivated after some time,
unless the key is in position 2 in the ignition lock.
The colour and brightness of the ambient lighting are set using the multimedia system
(Y page 210).
Automatic interior lighting control
To switch on: set the switch to centre position A.
X To switch off: set the switch to the |
position.
The interior lighting automatically switches on if
you:
Runlock the vehicle
Ropen a door
Rremove the key from the ignition lock
The interior lighting is activated for a short time
when the key is removed from the ignition lock.
You can activate this delayed switch-off using
the on-board computer (Y page 211).
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
glass if wiping takes place when the windscreen is dry.
If it is necessary to switch on the windscreen
wipers in dry weather conditions, always
operate them using washer fluid.
! If the windscreen wipers leave smears on
the windscreen after the vehicle has been
washed in an automatic car wash, this may be
due to wax or other residue. Clean the windscreen with washer fluid after an automatic
car wash.
! Intermittent wiping with rain sensor: due to
optical influences and the windscreen becoming dirty in dry weather conditions, the windscreen wipers may be activated inadvertently.
This could damage the windscreen wiper
blades or scratch the windscreen.
For this reason, you should always switch off
the windscreen wipers in dry weather.
Replacing bulbs
The front and rear lamps of your vehicle are
equipped with LED bulbs. Do not replace the
bulbs yourself. Contact a qualified specialist
workshop, which has the necessary specialist
knowledge and tools to carry out the work
required.
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times. Have
the headlamp setting checked regularly.
Windscreen wipers
Switching the windscreen wipers on/
off
! Do not operate the windscreen wipers when
the windscreen is dry, as this could damage
the wiper blades. Moreover, dust that has collected on the windscreen can scratch the
Combination switch
1 $ Windscreen wipers off
2 Ä Intermittent wipe, low (rain sensor set
to low sensitivity)
3 Å Intermittent wipe, high (rain sensor
set to high sensitivity)
4 ° Continuous wipe, slow
5 ¯ Continuous wipe, fast
B í Single wipe/î wipes the wind-
screen using washer fluid
If the wiper blades are worn, the windscreen will
no longer be wiped properly. This could prevent
you from observing the traffic conditions.
Windscreen wipers
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers begin to move while
you are changing the wiper blades, you can be
trapped by the wiper arm. There is a risk of
injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
ignition before changing the wiper blades.
! To avoid damaging the windscreen wiper
blades, make sure that you touch only the
wiper arm of the windscreen wiper.
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO:
Switch off the engine.
Remove your foot from the brake pedal.
X Set the windscreen wipers to the ° position.
X Press the Start/Stop button repeatedly until
the windscreen wipers start.
X When the wiper arms have reached the vertical position, press the Start/Stop button.
X Fold the wiper arm away from the windscreen
until it engages.
X
X
Removing the wiper blades
! Never open the bonnet if a windscreen
wiper arm has been folded away from the
windscreen.
Never fold a windscreen wiper arm without a
wiper blade back onto the windscreen.
Hold the windscreen wiper arm firmly when
you change the wiper blade. If you release the
windscreen wiper arm without a wiper blade
and it falls onto the windscreen, the windscreen may be damaged by the force of the
impact.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the wiper blades changed at a qualified specialist workshop.
! Always position the windscreen wiper arms
vertically before folding them away from the
windscreen. By doing so, you will avoid damage to the bonnet.
Replacing the windscreen wiper blades
Moving the wiper blades to a vertical position
To bring the wiper blade into position to
be removed: hold the wiper arm firmly with
one hand. With the other hand, turn the wiper
blade in the direction of arrow = beyond the
point of resistance.
The wiper blade engages in the removal position with an audible click.
X To remove a wiper blade: firmly press
release knob ; and pull the wiper blade
upwards :.
X
Fitting the wiper blades
On vehicles without KEYLESS-GO:
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Set the windscreen wipers to position °.
X When the wiper arms have reached the vertical position, turn the key to position 0 and
remove it from the ignition lock.
X Fold the wiper arm away from the windscreen
until it engages.
X
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Replacing the wiper blades
119
Windscreen wipers
120
Push the new wiper blade in the direction of
arrow : onto the wiper arm until lug ;
engages.
X Push the wiper blade out of the removal position in the direction of arrow = beyond the
point of resistance.
The wiper blade disengages with an audible
click and is freely movable again.
X Make sure that the wiper blade sits correctly.
X Fold the wiper arm back onto the windscreen.
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
Windscreen wipers
121
Problems with the windscreen wipers
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The windscreen wipers
are jammed.
Leaves or snow, for example, may be obstructing windscreen wiper
movement. The wiper motor has been deactivated.
X For safety reasons, you should remove the key from the ignition
lock.
or
X Switch off the engine using the Start/Stop button and open the
driver's door.
X Remove the cause of the obstruction.
X Switch the windscreen wipers back on.
The windscreen wiper drive is malfunctioning.
Select another wiper speed on the combination switch.
X Have the windscreen wipers checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
The windscreen wipers
fail completely.
122
Overview of climate control systems
Overview of climate control systems
Climate control
General notes
Observe the settings recommended on the following pages. The windows could otherwise
mist up.
To prevent the windows from misting up:
Rswitch off climate control only briefly
Ractivate air-recirculation mode only briefly
Rswitch on "Cooling with air dehumidification"
Ractivate the windscreen demisting function
briefly, if required
Climate control regulates the temperature and
the humidity in the vehicle interior and filters
undesirable substances out of the air.
Climate control is only operational when the
engine is running. Optimum operation is only
achieved when the side windows and the roof
are closed.
i Ventilate the vehicle for a brief period during
warm weather. This will speed up the cooling
process, and the desired vehicle interior temperature will be reached more quickly.
i It is possible that the residual heat function
may be activated automatically an hour after
the key has been removed in order to dry the
air-conditioning system. The vehicle is then
ventilated for 30 minutes to dry the air-conditioning system.
Overview of climate control systems
123
Climate control
Control panel for THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control (2-zone)
:
;
=
?
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
To set the temperature, left (Y page 125)
To set climate control to automatic mode (Y page 125)
To demist the windscreen (Y page 126)
To switch the residual heat on/off (Y page 129)
To activate/deactivate cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 124)
To switch the rear window heating on/off (Y page 127)
To switch the ZONE function on/off (Y page 126)
To set the temperature, right (Y page 125)
To switch the climate control on/off (Y page 124)
To set the air distribution (Y page 126)
To set the airflow (Y page 126)
To set the climate mode (Y page 125)
To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode (Y page 128)
Information on using THERMOTRONIC
automatic climate control
Automatic climate control
The following contains instructions and recommendations to enable you to get the most out of
your THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control.
RActivate climate control using the à and
¿ buttons on the climate control panel.
The indicator lamps in the à and
¿ buttons light up.
RIn automatic mode, the ñ button on the
climate control panel may be used to additionally adjust the airflow (FOCUS/MEDIUM/
DIFFUSE). The MEDIUM level is recommended.
RSet the temperature to 22 †.
ROnly use the "Windscreen demisting" function
briefly until the windscreen is clear again.
ROnly use air-recirculation mode briefly, e.g. if
there are unpleasant outside odours or when
in a tunnel. The windows could otherwise mist
up as no fresh air is drawn into the vehicle in
air-recirculation mode.
RUse the ZONE function to adopt the temperature settings on the driver's side for the
front-passenger side as well. The indicator
lamp in the á button goes out.
RUse the residual heat function if you want to
heat or ventilate the vehicle interior when the
ignition is switched off. The residual heat
Operating the climate control system
Climate control
124
function can only be activated or deactivated
with the ignition switched off.
RVehicles with COMAND Online: if you
change the settings of the climate control
system, the climate status display appears for
three seconds at the bottom of the screen in
the COMAND display. You will see the current
settings of the various climate control functions.
ECO start/stop function
During automatic engine switch-off, the climate
control only operates at a reduced capacity. If
you require full climate control capacity, the
ECO start/stop function can be deactivated by
pressing the ECO button (Y page 136).
Operating the climate control system
Switching the climate control on/off
General notes
When climate control is switched off, the air
supply and air circulation are also switched off.
The windows could mist up. Therefore, only
switch off climate control briefly.
i Switch on climate control primarily using
the à button (Y page 125).
Switching on/off
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
X To switch on: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Airflow and air distribution are set to automatic mode.
or
X Press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button goes
out. The previous settings are reactivated.
X To switch off: press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button lights
up.
X
Activating/deactivating cooling with
air dehumidification
General notes
If you deactivate the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function, the air inside the vehicle will
not be cooled. The air inside the vehicle will also
not be dehumidified. The windows can mist up
more quickly. Therefore, deactivate the "Cooling
with air dehumidification" function only briefly.
The "Cooling with air dehumidification" function
is only available when the engine is running. The
air inside the vehicle is cooled and dehumidified
according to the temperature selected.
Condensation may drip from the underside of
the vehicle when cooling mode is active. This is
normal and not a sign that there is a malfunction.
Switching on/off
To activate: press the ¿ or Á button.
To activate: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ or Á button
lights up.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button lights
up.
X To deactivate: press the ¿ or Á button.
To deactivate: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ or Á button
goes out. The cooling with air dehumidification function has a delayed switch-off feature.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button goes
out. The cooling with air dehumidification
function has a delayed switch-off feature.
X
Operating the climate control system
125
Problems with the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The indicator lamp in the The cooling with air dehumidification function has been deactivated
¿ button flashes
due to a malfunction.
three times or remains
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
off. The cooling with air
dehumidification function cannot be activated.
Setting climate control to automatic
mode
General notes
In automatic mode, the set temperature is maintained automatically at a constant level. The
system automatically regulates the temperature
of the dispensed air, the airflow and the air distribution.
The automatic mode functions optimally when
the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function
is activated. If desired, cooling with air dehumidification can be deactivated.
If you deactivate the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function, the air inside the vehicle will
not be cooled. The air inside the vehicle will also
not be dehumidified. The windows can mist up
more quickly. Therefore, deactivate the "Cooling
with air dehumidification" function only briefly.
Automatic control
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
X Set the desired temperature.
X To activate: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Automatic air distribution and airflow are
activated.
i When automatic mode is enabled, the climate mode can be selected (Y page 125).
X To switch to manual mode: press the _
button.
or
X Press the I or K button.
The indicator lamp in the à button goes
out.
X
Setting the climate mode
In automatic mode you can select the following
climate modes:
FOCUS high airflow, slightly cooler setting
MEDIUM medium airflow, standard setting
DIFFUSE low airflow, slightly warmer and
draught-free setting
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
X Press the à button.
X Press the ñ button repeatedly until the
desired climate mode appears in the display.
X
Setting the temperature
Switching on/off
Different temperatures can be set for the driver's and front-passenger sides.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
X Turn control : or ; anti-clockwise or clockwise.
Only change the temperature setting in small
increments. Start at 22 †.
i If you turn controls : and ; anti-clockwise to the lowest temperature setting, airrecirculation mode may switch on automatically, depending on the outside temperature.
Climate control
Problem
Operating the climate control system
126
Setting the air distribution
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
X Press the _ button repeatedly until the
desired symbol appears in the display.
Climate control
X
Air distribution settings
The air distribution can be set to the following
positions:
P Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents
O Directs the airflow through the footwell
air vents
S Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents as well as the footwell
air vents
¯ Directs the airflow through the demister
vents
b Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents as well as the demister
vents
a Directs the airflow through the footwell
and demister vents
_ Directs the airflow through the demister
vents, the centre and side air vents as
well as the footwell air vents
i Regardless of the air distribution setting,
airflow is always directed through the side air
vents. The side air vents can only be closed
when the adjuster in the side air vent is turned
clockwise.
Setting the airflow
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
X To increase: press the K button.
X To reduce: press the I button.
side is not adopted for the front-passenger
side.
X To switch off: press the á button.
The indicator lamp in the á button goes
out. The temperature setting for the driver's
side is adopted for the front-passenger side.
Demisting the windscreen
General notes
You can use this function to defrost the windscreen or to demist the inside of the windscreen
and the side windows.
Switch off the windscreen demisting function as
soon as the windscreen is clear again.
Switching the "Windscreen demisting"
function on or off
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
X To switch on: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button lights
up.
The climate control system switches to the
following functions:
Rhigh airflow
Rhigh temperature
Rair distribution to the windscreen and front
side windows
Rair-recirculation mode off
X
X
or
X
X
or
X
or
Switching the ZONE function on/off
X
To switch on: press the á button.
The indicator lamp in the á button lights
up. The temperature setting for the driver's
X
To switch off: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. The previous settings are reactivated.
Air-recirculation mode remains deactivated.
Press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
Turn temperature control : or D anti-clockwise or clockwise (Y page 123).
Press the K or I button.
Operating the climate control system
127
Demisting the windows
Windows misted up on the inside
Activate the ¿ cooling with air dehumidification function.
X Activate the à mode button.
X If the windows continue to mist up, activate
the ¬ "Windscreen demisting" function.
i You should only select this setting until the
windscreen is clear again.
Windows misted up on the outside
Switch on the windscreen wipers.
Press the _ button repeatedly until the
P or O symbol appears in the display.
i You should only select this setting until the
windscreen is clear again.
X
X
Rear window heating
General notes
The rear window heating has a high current
draw. You should therefore switch it off as soon
as the window is clear. The rear window heating
otherwise switches off automatically after several minutes.
If the battery voltage is too low, the rear window
heating may switch off.
Switching on/off
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
X Press the ¤ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¤ button lights
up or goes out.
X
Climate control
X
Operating the climate control system
128
Problems with the rear window heating
Climate control
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The rear window heating The on-board voltage is too low because too many electrical consumhas switched off prema- ers are switched on.
turely or cannot be
X Switch off any consumers that are not required, e.g. reading lamps,
switched on.
interior lighting or the seat heating.
When the battery is sufficiently charged, the rear window heating
can be switched on again.
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode
Convenience opening/closing using
the air-recirculation button
General notes
G WARNING
If you activate air-recirculation mode, the windows can mist up more quickly, in particular at
low temperatures. Only use air-recirculation
mode briefly to prevent the windows from misting up.
When using convenience closing, you could
become trapped within the sweep of the closing window. There is a risk of injury.
Monitor the entire closing procedure when
using convenience closing. When closing,
make sure that no one has any parts of the
body within the closing area.
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
X To activate: press the g button.
The indicator lamp in the g button lights
up.
i Air-recirculation mode is automatically activated at high levels of pollution or at high outside temperatures. When air-recirculation
mode is activated automatically, the indicator
lamp in the g button is not lit. Outside air
is added after about 30 minutes.
X To deactivate: press the g button.
The indicator lamp in the g button goes
out.
i Air-recirculation mode is deactivated automatically:
Rafter around five minutes at outside temperatures below approximately 5 †
Rafter approximately five minutes if "Cooling
with air dehumidification" is deactivated
Rafter approximately 30 minutes at outside
temperatures above approximately 5 † if
the "Cooling with air dehumidification"
function is activated
X
G WARNING
During convenience opening parts of the body
could be drawn in or become trapped
between the side window and window frame.
There is a risk of injury.
When opening, make sure that nobody is
touching the side window. If someone
becomes trapped, immediately press
the W switch in the door to stop the movement of the side windows. To continue closing
the side window, pull on the W switch.
X
Convenience closing feature: press and
hold the g button until the side windows
are fully closed.
The indicator lamp in the g button lights
up. Air-recirculation mode is activated.
If parts of the body are in the closing area during
convenience closing, proceed as follows:
X Release the g button.
The side windows stop.
X Press the W button to open or close the
side windows.
i Notes on the reversing feature for the side
windows (Y page 90).
Adjusting the air vents
Switching the residual heat on/off
General notes
It is possible to make use of the residual heat of
the engine to continue heating the stationary
vehicle for up to 30 minutesafter the engine has
been switched off. The heating time depends on
the set interior temperature.
Switching on/off
Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition lock
or remove it (Y page 132).
X To switch on: press the Ì button.
The indicator lamp in the Ì button lights
up.
i The blower will run at a low speed regardless
of the airflow setting.
X
i If you switch on the residual heat function at
high temperatures, only the ventilation will be
activated. The blower runs at medium speed.
X To switch off: press the Ì button.
The indicator lamp in the Ì button goes
out.
Residual heat is switched off automatically:
Rafter approximately 30 minutes
Rwhen the ignition is switched on
Rif the battery voltage drops
the immediate vicinity of the air vents. There
is a risk of injury.
Make sure that all vehicle occupants always
maintain a sufficient distance to the air outlets. If necessary, redirect the airflow to
another area of the vehicle interior.
G WARNING
When AIRSCARF is switched on, very hot air
can flow from the vents in the head restraints.
This could result in burns in the immediate
vicinity of the air vents. There is a risk of injury.
Reduce the heater output before it becomes
too hot.
In order to ensure the direct flow of fresh air
through the air vents into the vehicle interior,
please observe the following notes:
Rkeep the air inlet grille on the bonnet and in
the engine compartment on the frontpassenger side free of blockages, such as ice,
snow or leaves
Rnever cover the vents or ventilation grilles in
the vehicle interior
i You can move the adjusters for the air vents
vertically or horizontally to set the direction of
the airflow.
i Optimal climate control function is achieved
by opening the air vents fully and setting the
adjusters to the middle position.
Adjusting the centre air vents
Adjusting the air vents
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Very hot or very cold air can flow from the air
vents. This could result in burns or frostbite in
Z
Climate control
Convenience opening feature: press and
hold the g button until the side windows
are opened. The side windows move back to
their original positions.
The indicator lamp in the g button goes
out. Air-recirculation mode is deactivated.
i If you open the side windows manually after
closing them using the convenience closing
feature, they will remain in this position when
opened using the convenience opening feature.
X
129
Adjusting the air vents
130
To open the centre air vent: turn the
adjuster in one of centre air vents : to the
left.
X To close the centre air vent: turn the
adjuster in one of centre air vents : to the
right until it engages.
Climate control
X
Adjusting the side air vents
: Air vent thumbwheel
; Air vent
When automatic climate control is activated, the
glove compartment can be ventilated, for
instance to cool its contents. The level of airflow
depends on the airflow and air distribution settings.
X To open or close: turn thumbwheel : to the
right or left.
: Side window demister vent
; Side air vent
To open a side air vent: turn the adjuster in
side air vent ; to the left.
X To close a side air vent: turn the adjuster in
side air vent ; to the right until it engages.
X
Adjusting the glove compartment air
vent
! Close the air vent when heating the vehicle.
At high outside temperatures, open the air
vent and activate the "cooling with air dehumidification" function. Otherwise, temperature-sensitive items stored in the glove compartment could be damaged.
Setting the blower output of the AIRSCARF vents
G WARNING
When AIRSCARF is switched on, very hot air
can flow from the vents in the head restraints.
This could result in burns in the immediate
vicinity of the air vents. There is a risk of injury.
Reduce the heater output before it becomes
too hot.
You can adjust the blower output of AIRSCARF
vents : using the AIRSCARF button
(Y page 105).
Driving
Important safety notes
In certain driving and driving safety systems, the
sensors adjust automatically while a certain distance is being driven after the vehicle has been
delivered or after repairs. Full system effectiveness is not reached until the end of this teach-in
process.
Brake pads/linings and discs that are either new
or have been replaced only achieve optimum
braking effect after several hundred kilometres
of driving. Compensate for the reduced braking
effect by applying greater force to the brake
pedal.
The first 1,500 km
If you treat the engine with sufficient care from
the very start, you will be rewarded with excellent performance for the remainder of the
engine's life.
RDrive at varying vehicle speeds and engine
speeds for the first 1,500 km.
RAvoid overstraining the vehicle during this
period, e.g. driving at full throttle.
RChange gear in good time, before the rev
counter needle is Ô of the way to the red area
of the rev counter.
RDo not shift down a gear manually in order to
brake.
RTry to avoid depressing the accelerator pedal
beyond the point of resistance (kickdown).
Additional notes on running in Mercedes-AMG
vehicles:
RDo not drive at speeds above 140 km/h for
the first 1500 km.
ROnly briefly allow the engine to reach a maximum engine speed of 4,500 rpm.
RDrive the vehicle mainly in drive program C for
the first 1500 km.
After 1500 km, you can increase the engine
speed gradually and accelerate the vehicle to
full speed.
You should also observe these notes on runningin if the engine or parts of the drive train on your
vehicle have been replaced.
Self-locking rear axle differential
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Your vehicle is equipped with a self-locking differential on the rear axle.
Change the oil to improve protection of the rear
axle differential:
Rafter a running-in period of 3000 km
Revery 50,000 km or 3 years
These oil changes prolong the service life of the
differential. Have the oil change carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Driving
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
G WARNING
Unsuitable footwear can hinder correct usage
of the pedals, e.g.:
Rshoes
with thick soles
with high heels
Rslippers
There is a risk of an accident.
Wear suitable footwear to ensure correct
usage of the pedals.
Rshoes
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
Z
Driving and parking
Running-in notes
131
132
Driving
Driving and parking
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
Key positions
Key
G WARNING
If the parking brake has not been fully
released when driving, the parking brake can:
Roverheat
and cause a fire
its hold function.
There is a risk of fire and an accident. Release
the parking brake fully before driving off.
Rlose
! Do not warm up the engine when the vehicle
is stationary. Drive off immediately. Avoid
high engine speeds and driving at full throttle
until the engine has reached its operating
temperature.
Only shift the automatic transmission to the
desired drive position when the vehicle is stationary.
Where possible, avoid spinning the drive
wheels when pulling away on slippery roads.
You could otherwise damage the drive train.
! Mercedes-AMG vehicles: at low engine oil
temperatures (below +20 †), the maximum
engine speed is restricted in order to protect
the engine. To protect the engine and maintain smooth engine operation, avoid driving at
full throttle when the engine is cold.
g To remove the key
1 Power supply for some consumers, such as
the windscreen wipers
2 Ignition (power supply for all consumers)
and drive position
3 To start the vehicle
i If the key does not belong to the vehicle, it
can still be turned in the ignition lock. However, the ignition will not be switched on. The
engine cannot be started.
KEYLESS-GO
General notes
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO are equipped with a
key featuring an integrated KEYLESS-GO start
function and a detachable Start/Stop button.
The Start/Stop button must be inserted in the
ignition lock and the key must be in the vehicle.
When you insert the Start/Stop button into the
ignition lock, the system needs approximately
two seconds recognition time. You can then use
the Start/Stop button.
Pressing the Start/Stop button several times in
succession corresponds to the different key
positions in the ignition lock. This is only the
case if you are not depressing the brake pedal.
If you depress the brake pedal and press the
Start/Stop button, the engine starts immediately.
A check which periodically establishes a radio
connection between the vehicle and the key
determines whether a valid key is in the vehicle.
This occurs, for example, when starting the
engine.
To start the vehicle without actively using the
key:
Rthe Start/Stop button must be inserted in the
ignition lock
Rthe key must be in the vehicle
Rthe vehicle must not be locked with the key or
KEYLESS-GO (Y page 78)
Do not keep the key:
Rwith electronic devices, e.g. a mobile phone
or another key
Rwith metallic objects, e.g. coins or metal film
Rinside metallic objects, e.g. a metal case
This can affect the function of the key with KEYLESS-GO.
If you lock the vehicle with the key's remote
control or with KEYLESS-GO, after a short time:
Ryou will not be able to switch on the ignition
with the Start/Stop button
Ryou will not be able to start the engine with the
Start/Stop button until the vehicle is
unlocked again
The engine can be switched off while the vehicle
is in motion by pressing and holding the Start/
Stop button for three seconds. This function
operates independently of the ECO start/stop
automatic engine switch-off function.
Key positions with KEYLESS-GO
X
To switch on the power supply: press
Start/Stop button : once.
The power supply is switched on. You can now
activate the windscreen wipers, for example.
The power supply is switched off again if:
Rthe driver's door is opened and
Ryou press Start/Stop button : twice when
in this position
X
To switch on the ignition: press Start/Stop
button : twice.
The ignition is switched on.
If you press Start/Stop button : once when
in this position, the ignition is deactivated
again.
Removing the Start/Stop button
You can remove the Start/Stop button from the
ignition lock and start the vehicle as normal
using the key.
X Remove Start/Stop button : from ignition
lock ;.
You do not have to remove the Start/Stop button from the ignition lock when you leave the
vehicle. You should, however, always take the
key with you when leaving the vehicle. As long as
the key is in the vehicle:
Rthe vehicle can be started using the Start/
Stop button
Rthe electrically powered equipment can be
operated
Starting the vehicle
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they can:
: Start/Stop button
; Ignition lock
Ropen doors and endanger other persons or
When you switch on the ignition, all of the indicator lamps in the instrument cluster light up.
Further information on situations where an indicator lamp either fails to go out after starting the
engine or lights up while driving (Y page 245).
If Start/Stop button : has not yet been
pressed, this corresponds to the key being
removed from the ignition.
Rclimb
road users
out and be injured by the traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and, for example, trap themselves.
Z
133
Driving and parking
Driving
Driving
134
Children could also set the vehicle in motion,
for example by:
Driving and parking
Rreleasing
the parking brake
Rshifting the automatic transmission out of
park position P
Rstarting the engine.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle. Always
keep the key out of reach of children.
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling
these exhaust gases leads to poisoning. There
is a risk of fatal injury. Therefore never leave
the engine running in enclosed spaces without sufficient ventilation.
Starting procedure with the key
To start the engine using the key instead of KEYLESS-GO, pull the Start/Stop button out of the
ignition lock.
X Turn the key to position 3 in the ignition lock
(Y page 132) and release it as soon as the
engine is running.
Using KEYLESS-GO to start the engine
The Start/Stop button can be used to start the
vehicle manually without inserting the key into
the ignition lock. The key must be in the vehicle
and the Start/Stop button must be inserted in
the ignition lock. This mode for starting the
engine operates independently of the ECO
start/stop automatic engine start function.
X Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Press the Start/Stop button once
(Y page 132).
The engine starts.
G WARNING
Flammable materials introduced through
environmental influence or by animals can
ignite if in contact with the exhaust system or
parts of the engine that heat up. There is a risk
of fire.
Carry out regular checks to make sure that
there are no flammable foreign materials in
the engine compartment or in the exhaust
system.
The catalytic converter is preheated for up to
30 seconds after a cold start. The sound of the
engine may change during this time.
Automatic transmission
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
Transmission position display P is shown in
the multifunction display.
i You can start the engine in transmission
position P and N.
X
Pulling away
General notes
G WARNING
If the engine speed is above the idling speed
and you engage transmission position D or R,
the vehicle could pull away suddenly. There is
a risk of an accident.
When engaging transmission position D or R,
always firmly depress the brake pedal and do
not simultaneously accelerate.
Depress the accelerator carefully when pulling
away.
The vehicle locks centrally once you have pulled
away. The locking knobs in the doors drop down.
You can open the doors from the inside at any
time.
You can also deactivate the automatic locking
feature (Y page 211).
It is only possible to shift the transmission from
position P to the desired position if you depress
the brake pedal. Only then is the shift lock
released.
Driving
after a cold start. This helps the catalytic converter to reach its operating temperature
more quickly.
Information on automatically releasing the electrical parking brake (Y page 155).
Hill start assist
automatically. The vehicle may begin moving.
There is a risk of accident and injury.
If you wish to exit the vehicle, always turn off
the ignition and secure the vehicle against
rolling away.
General notes
Hill start assist helps you when pulling away forwards or in reverse on an uphill gradient. It holds
the vehicle for a short time after you have
removed your foot from the brake pedal. This
gives you enough time to move your foot from
the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal and
depress it before the vehicle begins to roll.
G WARNING
After a while, hill start assist no longer holds
the vehicle and it may roll away. There is a risk
of an accident and injury.
Therefore, quickly move your foot from the
brake pedal to the accelerator pedal. Never
leave the vehicle when it is held by hill start
assist.
Hill start assist is not active if:
are pulling away on a level road or a
downhill gradient
Rthe transmission is in position N
Rthe electric parking brake is applied
RESP® is malfunctioning
Ryou
ECO start/stop function
Introduction
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle is stopped
under certain conditions.
When pulling away again, the engine starts automatically. The ECO start/stop function thereby
helps you to reduce the fuel consumption and
emissions of your vehicle.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the engine is switched off automatically and
you exit the vehicle, the engine is restarted
: ECO start/stop display
The ECO start/stop function is switched on
whenever you start the engine using the key or
the Start/Stop button.
If the è ECO symbol is shown in the multifunction display, the ECO start/stop function
switches the engine off automatically if the vehicle stops moving.
If the ECO start/stop function has been manually switched off (Y page 136) or a malfunction
has caused the system to be switched off, the
è or ç ECO symbol is not displayed.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: the ECO start/stop
function is only available in drive program C.
Automatic engine switch-off
If the vehicle is braked to a standstill with the
transmission in D or N, the ECO start/stop function switches off the engine automatically.
The ECO start/stop function is operational and
the è ECO symbol is displayed in the multifunction display, if:
Rthe indicator lamp in the ECO button is lit
green
Rthe outside temperature is within the range
that is suitable for the system
Rthe engine is at normal operating temperature
Rthe set temperature for the vehicle interior
has been reached
Rthe battery is sufficiently charged
Rthe system detects that the windscreen is not
misted up when the air-conditioning system is
switched on
Z
Driving and parking
i Upshifts take place at higher engine speeds
135
136
Driving
Rthe
bonnet is closed
driver's door is closed and the driver's
seat belt is fastened
If all conditions for automatic engine switch-off
are not fulfilled, the ç ECO symbol is shown.
All of the vehicle's systems remain active when
the engine is switched off automatically.
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles): the engine can be switched off automatically a maximum of four times (initial stop, then
three subsequent stops) in succession. The
ç ECO symbol is shown in the multifunction
display after the engine has been started automatically for the fourth time. When the è
ECO symbol is shown in the multifunction display, automatic engine switch-off is possible
again.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: the number of times
that the engine can be switched off automatically is unlimited.
The HOLD function can be activated if the
engine has been switched off automatically. It is
then not necessary to continue applying the
brakes during the automatic stop phase. When
you depress the accelerator pedal, the engine
starts automatically and the braking effect of
the HOLD function is deactivated.
Driving and parking
Rthe
Automatic engine start
The engine is started automatically if:
Ryou switch off the ECO start/stop function by
pressing the ECO button
Rin transmission position D or N, the brake
pedal is released and the HOLD function is not
active
Ryou depress the accelerator pedal
Ryou engage reverse gear R
Ryou move the transmission out of position P
Ryou switch to drive program S+
Ryou switch to drive program S or M
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Ryou unfasten your seat belt or open the driver's door
Rthe vehicle starts to roll
Rthe brake system requires this
Rthe temperature in the vehicle interior deviates from the set range
Rthe
system detects moisture on the windscreen when the air-conditioning system is
switched on
Rthe battery's charge status is too low
Shifting the transmission to position P does not
start the engine.
If you shift the transmission from R to D, the
ECO start/stop function is available again as
soon as the è ECO symbol reappears in the
multifunction display.
Switching the ECO start/stop function
off/on
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
X
To switch off: press ECO button :.
Indicator lamp ; and the è or ç ECO
symbol in the multifunction display go out.
To switch on: press ECO button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. If all conditions
for the automatic engine switch-off
(Y page 135) are fulfilled, the è ECO symbol is shown in the multifunction display.
If all conditions for the automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 135) are not fulfilled, the
ç ECO symbol is shown in the multifunction display. If this is the case, the ECO start/
stop function is not available.
If indicator lamp ; is off, the ECO start/stop
function has been switched off manually or as
the result of a malfunction. The engine will then
not be switched off automatically when the vehicle stops.
X
Driving
137
X
or
X
Driving and parking
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
To switch off: in drive program C, press ECO
button :.
Switch to drive program S, S+ or M
(Y page 140).
Indicator lamp ; and the è or ç ECO
symbol in the multifunction display go out.
To switch on: press ECO button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up.
If drive program S, S+ or M is active, the automatic transmission switches to drive program
C.
If all conditions for the automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 135) are fulfilled, the è
ECO symbol is shown in the multifunction display.
If all conditions for the automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 135) are not fulfilled, the
ç ECO symbol is shown in the multifunction display. If this is the case, the ECO start/
stop function is not available.
If indicator lamp ; is off, the ECO start/stop
function has been switched off manually or as
the result of a malfunction. The engine will then
not be switched off automatically when the vehicle stops.
X
Z
138
Driving
Driving and parking
Problems with the engine
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine does not
start.
The HOLD function or Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is activated.
X Deactivate the HOLD function (Y page 172) or Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC (Y page 167).
X Try to start the engine again.
The engine does not
start. The starter motor
can be heard.
The engine does not
start. You cannot hear
the starter motor.
RThere
is a malfunction in the engine electronics.
is a malfunction in the fuel supply.
Before attempting to start the engine again:
X Turn the key back to position 0 in the ignition lock.
or
X Press the Start/Stop button repeatedly until all indicator lamps in
the instrument cluster go out.
X Restart the engine again (Y page 133). Avoid excessively long and
frequent attempts to start the engine, as this will drain the battery.
If the engine does not start after several attempts:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
RThere
The on-board voltage is too low because the battery is too weak or
discharged.
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 296).
If the engine does not start despite attempts to jump-start it:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The starter motor was exposed to a thermal load that was too high.
X Allow the starter motor to cool down for approximately two minutes.
X Try to start the engine again.
If the engine still does not start:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The engine is not running There is a malfunction in the engine electronics or in a mechanical
smoothly and is misfircomponent of the engine management system.
ing.
X Only depress the accelerator pedal slightly.
Otherwise, non-combusted fuel may get into the catalytic converter
and damage it.
X Have the cause rectified immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
DYNAMIC SELECT button (all vehicles except Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The coolant temperature The coolant level is too low. The coolant is too hot and the engine is no
display is showing more longer being cooled sufficiently.
than 120 †. The coolant X Stop as soon as possible and allow the engine and the coolant to
warning lamp may also
cool down.
be on and a warning tone
X Check the coolant level (Y page 279). Observe the warning notes
may sound.
as you do so and top up the coolant if necessary.
If the coolant level is correct, the engine radiator fan may be faulty. The
coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled sufficiently.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue driving
to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
DYNAMIC SELECT button (all vehicles
except Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Use the DYNAMIC SELECT button to change the
drive program. Depending on the drive program
selected, the following vehicle characteristics
will change:
Rthe drive (engine and transmission management)
Rthe suspension
Rthe steering
Rthe curve tilting function (vehicles with Active
Body Control)
Rthe control thresholds of ESP®
If the ignition is switched off for less than four
hours, the previously selected drive program is
activated when the engine is next started. If the
ignition is switched off for more than four hours,
drive program C is activated when the engine is
next started.
Press DYNAMIC SELECT controller : as
many times as necessary until the desired
drive program is selected.
The selected drive program appears in the
multifunction display. After a short time the
display goes out and the status icon of the
selected drive program appears.
In addition, the current drive program settings
are displayed briefly in the display of the multimedia system.
i In a few countries, the ECO start/stop function is deactivated at the factory due to the
quality of the available fuel. In this case, the
ECO start/stop function is not available in any
drive program, regardless of the display in the
multimedia system display.
Available drive programs:
X
C Comfort
Comfortable and economical driving characteristics
S Sport
Sporty driving characteristics
S+ Sport Plus
Particularly sporty driving
characteristics
I Individual
Individual settings
Z
Driving and parking
Problem
139
Driving and parking
140
DYNAMIC SELECT controller (Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
E Economy
(vehicles with
adjustable
damping)
Particularly economical
driving characteristics
CV CURVE
(vehicles with
Active Body
Control)
Particularly economical
driving characteristics with
cornering function
Additional information for drive programs
(Y page 145).
Additionally, in drive program I you can configure the respective vehicle characteristics using
the multimedia system. You can find information on this in the Digital Owner's Manual.
If the ignition is switched off for less than four
hours, the previously selected drive program is
activated when the engine is next started. If the
ignition is switched off for more than four hours,
drive program C is activated when the engine is
next started.
Selecting the drive program
DYNAMIC SELECT controller
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
General notes
Select the drive program using the DYNAMIC
SELECT controller.
Available drive programs:
I Individual
Individual settings
C Comfort
Comfort-orientated, engine
and transmission settings
optimised for economy
S Sport
Sporty engine and transmission settings
S+ Sport Plus
Particularly sporty transmission settings
RACE
Maximum sportiness and
engine and transmission
settings suitable for the
racetrack
Depending on the drive program selected, the
following vehicle characteristics will change:
Rthe drive (engine management)
Rthe transmission management
RESP®
Rthe suspension
Rthe steering
Rthe availability of the ECO start/stop function
Rthe driver assistance systems
Rthe availability of gliding mode
Further information for automatic drive program
characteristics (Y page 145).
X
Turn DYNAMIC SELECT controller : as many
times as necessary until the desired drive
program is selected.
The status icon of the selected drive program
is shown in the multifunction display.
In addition, the current drive program settings
are displayed briefly in the display of the multimedia system.
The drive program indicator on DYNAMIC
SELECT controller : lights up in red.
Additional information for drive programs
(Y page 145).
Automatic transmission
Additional settings
141
cle from rolling away by applying the parking
brake.
Selector lever
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
! If the engine speed is too high or if the vehiECO start/stop function (Y page 135)
ESP® (Y page 67)
Suspension (Y page 179)
To permanently activate manual gearshifting (Y page 147)
When you press buttons : - ? the corresponding setting is selected. The DYNAMIC
SELECT controller setting is overwritten.
These settings will also be maintained if you use
the DYNAMIC SELECT controller to change to
drive program RACE, S+, S or C.
If you switch to drive program I, all stored characteristics will be adopted. This is also the case
if you have previously pressed buttons : - ?.
:
;
=
?
cle is rolling, do not shift the transmission
directly from D to R, from R to D or directly to
P.
Do not open the driver's door while the vehicle is in motion. At low speeds in transmission
position D or R, park position P is otherwise
engaged automatically.
The transmission could be damaged.
Automatic transmission
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the engine speed is above the idling speed
and you engage transmission position D or R,
the vehicle could pull away suddenly. There is
a risk of an accident.
When engaging transmission position D or R,
always firmly depress the brake pedal and do
not simultaneously accelerate.
G WARNING
The automatic transmission switches to neutral position N when you switch off the engine.
The vehicle may roll away. There is a risk of an
accident.
After switching off the engine, always switch
to parking position P. Prevent the parked vehi-
j
k
i
h
Park position
Reverse gear
Neutral
Drive
The selector lever always returns to its original
position. The current transmission position P, R,
N or D appears in the transmission position display in the multifunction display.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
! If the engine speed is too high or if the vehicle is rolling, do not shift the transmission
directly from D to R, from R to D or directly to
P.
Do not open the driver's door while the vehicle is in motion. At low speeds in transmission
position D or R, park position P is otherwise
engaged automatically.
The transmission could be damaged.
Z
Driving and parking
Overview of transmission positions
142
Automatic transmission
Driving and parking
The current transmission position and drive program appear in the multifunction display.
In addition to drive program ; being shown in
the multifunction display, the currently selected
drive program is indicated in red on the
DYNAMIC SELECT controller (Y page 140).
Engaging park position P
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
j
k
i
h
Park position
Reverse gear
Neutral
Drive
The selector lever always returns to its original
position. The current transmission position P, R,
N or D appears in the transmission position display in the multifunction display.
Transmission position and drive program display
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal.
X Press button :.
X
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
: Transmission position
; Gear
= Drive program
The current transmission position and drive program appear in the multifunction display.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
: Transmission position
; Drive program
When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal.
X Press button :.
X
Automatic transmission
Park position P is automatically engaged if:
Ryou
switch off the engine using the key and
remove the key
Ryou switch off the engine using the key or
using the Start/Stop button and open the
driver's door or front-passenger door
Ryou open the driver's door when the vehicle is
stationary or when driving at a very low speed
and the transmission is in position D or R
Under certain conditions, the automatic transmission shifts automatically to transmission
position P if the HOLD function or Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC is activated. Observe the information on the HOLD function (Y page 173) and on
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC (Y page 165).
Engaging reverse gear R
! Only shift the automatic transmission to R
when the vehicle is stationary.
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Push the selector lever forwards past the first
point of resistance.
The ECO start/stop function is not available
when reverse gear is engaged. Further information on the ECO start/stop function
(Y page 135).
X
Shifting to neutral N
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they can:
Ropen doors and endanger other persons or
road users
Rclimb out and be injured by the traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and, for example, trap themselves.
Children could also set the vehicle in motion,
for example by:
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle. Always
keep the key out of reach of children.
When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal.
X Push the selector lever forwards or back to
the first point of resistance.
If you switch the engine off with the transmission in position R or D, the automatic transmission shifts to N automatically.
With the key: if you then open the driver's door
or the front-passenger door or remove the key
from the ignition, the automatic transmission
shifts to P automatically.
With KEYLESS-GO: if you then open the driver's
or front-passenger door, the automatic transmission shifts to P.
If you want the automatic transmission to
remain in neutral N, e.g. when having the vehicle
cleaned in an automatic car wash with a towing
system:
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: remove the
Start/Stop button from the ignition lock.
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
X All vehicles: switch the ignition on.
X Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift to neutral N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch off the ignition and leave the key in the
ignition lock.
X
Engaging drive position D
When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal.
X Push the selector lever back past the first
point of resistance.
X
Rreleasing
the parking brake
the automatic transmission out of
park position P
Rstarting the engine.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
Rshifting
Z
Driving and parking
Engaging park position P automatically
143
144
Automatic transmission
Transmission positions
Driving and parking
B
Park position
This prevents the vehicle from rolling
away when stopped.
Only shift the transmission into position P when the vehicle is stationary
(Y page 141). The parking lock
should not be used as a brake when
parking. In order to secure the vehicle, always apply the electric parking
brake in addition to the parking lock.
If the key is removed from the ignition
lock, the transmission is locked.
The automatic transmission shifts
into P automatically:
Rwhen
the key is removed from the
ignition lock
Rwhen the engine is switched off
with the transmission in position R
or D and one of the doors is
opened
In the event of a malfunction of the
vehicle's electronics, the transmission may lock in position P. Have the
vehicle electronics checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
C
A
Reverse gear
Only shift the transmission into position R when the vehicle is stationary.
Neutral
Do not shift the transmission to N
while driving. Otherwise, the automatic transmission could be damaged.
No power is transmitted from the
engine to the drive wheels.
Releasing the brake pedal will allow
you to move the vehicle freely, e.g. to
push it or tow it.
If ESP® is deactivated or faulty: shift
the transmission only to position N if
the vehicle is in danger of skidding,
e.g. on icy roads.
! Rolling in neutral N can lead to
damage to the transmission.
7
Drive
The automatic transmission changes
gear automatically. All forward gears
are available.
Driving tips
Changing gear
The automatic transmission shifts to the individual gears automatically when it is in transmission position D. Gearshifting is determined
by:
Rthe selected drive program
Rthe position of the accelerator pedal
Rthe road speed
Accelerator pedal position
Your style of driving influences how the automatic transmission shifts gear:
Rlittle throttle: early upshifts
Rmore throttle: late upshifts
Automatic transmission
Use kickdown for maximum acceleration.
X Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
X Ease off the accelerator pedal once the
desired speed is reached.
The automatic transmission shifts back up.
Drive programs
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG
vehicles)
Drive program C (Comfort)
Drive program C is characterised by the following:
Rthe vehicle pulls away more gently in forward
and reverse gears unless the accelerator
pedal is depressed fully.
Rlow fuel consumption resulting from the automatic transmission shifting up sooner. The
vehicle is driven in the low engine speed range
and the wheels are less likely to spin.
Rthe suspension exhibits comfortable damping
settings.
Rthe steering exhibits a comfortable steering
curve.
RESP® provides the optimum compromise
between traction and stability. Further information on ESP® (Y page 67).
i Select this drive program for difficult road
conditions, e.g. snow and ice or wet road surfaces.
Drive program S (Sport)
Drive program S is characterised by the following:
Rthe vehicle exhibits sporty driving characteristics.
Rthe vehicle pulls away in first gear.
Rthe automatic transmission shifts up later. As
a result of the later automatic transmission
shift points, the fuel consumption may be
higher.
Rthe suspension exhibits firm damping settings.
Rthe
steering exhibits a sporty steering curve.
provides the optimum compromise
between traction and stability. Further information on ESP® (Y page 67).
RESP®
Drive program S+ (Sport Plus)
Drive program S+ is characterised by the following:
Rthe vehicle exhibits particularly sporty driving
characteristics.
Rthe vehicle pulls away in first gear.
Rthe automatic transmission shifts up later. As
a result of the later automatic transmission
shift points, the fuel consumption may be
higher.
Rthe suspension exhibits particularly firm
damping settings (vehicles with adaptive
adjustable damping).
Rthe suspension exhibits firm damping settings (vehicles with Active Body Control).
Rthe steering exhibits a sporty steering curve.
RESP® emphasises the vehicle's own oversteering and understeering characteristics.
This enables a more active driving style. This
drive program requires more interaction from
the driver. Further information on ESP®
(Y page 67).
i Only select this drive program if the road
conditions are good, e.g. the road is dry and
the route ahead is clearly visible.
Drive program I (Individual)
In drive program I the following properties of the
drive program can be selected:
Rthe drive (engine and transmission management)
Rthe suspension
Rthe steering
Rthe control thresholds of ESP®
Information on configuring drive program I with
the multimedia system can be found in the Digital Owner's Manual.
Z
Driving and parking
Kickdown
145
146
Automatic transmission
Driving and parking
Vehicles with adaptive adjustable damping: drive program E (Economy)
Drive program E is characterised by the following:
Rthe vehicle exhibits particularly economical
driving characteristics.
Rthe vehicle pulls away more gently in forward
and reverse gears unless the accelerator
pedal is depressed fully.
Roptimal fuel consumption resulting from the
automatic transmission shifting up sooner.
The vehicle is driven in the low engine speed
range and the wheels are less likely to spin.
Rthe suspension exhibits comfortable damping
settings.
Rthe steering exhibits a comfortable steering
curve.
Rduring deceleration, the engine is disconnected from the drive train. The vehicle uses
kinetic energy and consumes less fuel (gliding
mode).
RESP® provides the optimum compromise
between traction and stability. Further information on ESP® (Y page 67).
Vehicles with Active Body Control: drive
program CURVE
Drive program CURVE is characterised by the
following:
Rincreased driving comfort on bends.
Rthe vehicle tilts actively into the bend. Further
information on the cornering function
(Y page 176).
Rthe vehicle exhibits particularly economical
driving characteristics.
Rthe vehicle pulls away more gently in forward
and reverse gears unless the accelerator
pedal is depressed fully.
Rcomfortable suspension setting.
Rthe steering exhibits a comfortable steering
curve.
Roptimal fuel consumption resulting from the
automatic transmission shifting up sooner.
Rthe automatic transmission shifts up sooner.
This results in the vehicle being driven at
lower engine speeds and the wheels being
less likely to spin.
Rduring deceleration, the engine is disconnected from the drive train. The vehicle uses
kinetic energy and consumes less fuel (gliding
mode).
RESP® provides the optimum compromise
between traction and stability. Further information on ESP® (Y page 67).
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
Drive program RACE
Drive program RACE is characterised by the following:
Rthe vehicle exhibits driving characteristics
suitable for the racetrack.
Rall vehicle systems are set for maximum
sportiness.
Rthe gearshift recommendation gives you
information for slowly warming up the drive
assemblies and for adopting a fuel-efficient
driving style (Y page 147). You can follow the
gearshift recommendations at all times and
change gear accordingly using the steering
wheel gearshift paddles. On the basis of the
gearshift recommendation, using the steering
wheel gearshift paddles, you can optimise the
drive train and engine operating mode at any
time.
Rif you have selected a gear manually, this will
be maintained until the vehicle speed significantly increases or decreases.
Rthe vehicle pulls away in first gear.
Rthe automatic transmission shifts up later. As
a result of the later automatic transmission
shift points, the fuel consumption may be
higher.
Rthe suspension exhibits particularly firm
damping settings.
Rgliding mode is not available.
Rthe ECO start/stop function is not available.
RESP® switches to SPORT handling mode. The
M handling mode warning lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up. The SPORT han‐
dling mode message appears in the multifunction display. Observe the important
safety notes for the SPORT handling mode
(Y page 70).
RESP® only improves driving stability to a limited degree. The engine's torque is only
restricted to a limited degree and the drive
wheels can spin. Further information on ESP®
(Y page 70).
Automatic transmission
Drive program S (Sport)
Drive program S is characterised by the following:
Rthe vehicle exhibits sporty driving characteristics.
Rthe vehicle pulls away in first gear.
Rthe automatic transmission shifts up later. As
a result of the later automatic transmission
shift points, the fuel consumption may be
higher.
Rthe suspension exhibits particularly firm
damping settings.
Rgliding mode is not available.
Rthe ECO start/stop function is not available.
RESP® provides the optimum compromise
between traction and stability. Further information on ESP® (Y page 67).
Drive program C (Comfort)
Drive program C is characterised by the following:
Rthe vehicle exhibits comfortable, economical
driving characteristics.
Rthe vehicle pulls away more gently in forward
and reverse gears unless the accelerator
pedal is depressed fully.
Rthe vehicle has improved driving stability, for
example on slippery road surfaces.
Roptimal fuel consumption resulting from the
automatic transmission shifting up sooner.
The vehicle is driven in the low engine speed
range and the wheels are less likely to spin.
Rgliding
mode is available.
ECO start/stop function is available.
RESP® provides the optimum compromise
between traction and stability. Further information on ESP® (Y page 67).
Rthe
Drive program I (Individual)
In drive program I the following properties of the
drive program can be selected:
Rthe drive (engine management)
Rthe transmission management
RESP®
Rthe suspension
Information on configuring drive program I with
the multimedia system can be found in the Digital Owner's Manual.
i To permanently shift the gears manually in
drive program I using the steering wheel paddles, select the M (manual) setting for the
transmission.
Manual gearshifting
General notes
You can change gear yourself using the steering
wheel gearshift paddles. The transmission must
be in position D.
Depending on which gearshift paddle is pulled,
the automatic transmission immediately shifts
into the next gear up or down, if permitted.
To use manual shifting, you have two options:
Rtemporary setting
Rpermanent setting
If you activate manual gearshifting, the multifunction display will show the current gear
instead of transmission position D.
If manual gearshifting is deactivated, the gears
will be selected automatically.
Z
Driving and parking
Drive program S+ (Sport Plus)
Drive program S+ is characterised by the following:
Rthe vehicle exhibits particularly sporty driving
characteristics.
Rthe vehicle pulls away in first gear.
Rthe automatic transmission shifts up later. As
a result of the later automatic transmission
shift points, the fuel consumption may be
higher.
Rthe suspension exhibits particularly firm
damping settings.
Rgliding mode is not available.
Rthe ECO start/stop function is not available.
RESP® provides the optimum compromise
between traction and stability. Further information on ESP® (Y page 67).
147
Automatic transmission
148
Temporary setting
To activate: shift the selector lever to position D.
X Press button :.
X
X
To deactivate: press button :.
Driving and parking
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
To activate: shift the selector lever to position D.
X Pull steering wheel gearshift paddle : or ;.
X
The temporary setting will be active for a certain
amount of time. Under certain conditions the
minimum amount of time is extended, e.g. in the
case of lateral acceleration, during an overrun
phase or when driving on steep terrain.
X To deactivate: pull steering wheel gearshift
paddle ; and hold it in place.
or
X Use the lever to switch the transmission position.
or
X All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles): use the DYNAMIC SELECT button to
change the drive program.
X Mercedes-AMG vehicles: use the DYNAMIC
SELECT controller to change the drive program.
To activate: shift the selector lever to position D.
X Press button :.
X
X
or
X
To deactivate: press button :.
If position D (automatic transmission) is
selected for the transmission in drive program I: shift to drive program I with the
DYNAMIC SELECT controller.
Shifting gears
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Permanent setting
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
X
To shift up: pull steering wheel gearshift paddle ;.
The automatic transmission shifts up to the
next gear.
If the maximum engine speed on the currently
engaged gear is reached and you continue to
Automatic transmission
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
! If manual gearshifting is permanently acti-
vated, the automatic transmission does not
shift up automatically even when the engine
limiting speed for the current gear is reached.
When the engine limiting speed is reached,
the fuel supply is cut to prevent the engine
from overrevving. Always make sure that the
engine speed does not reach the red area of
the rev counter. There is otherwise a risk of
engine damage.
To shift up: pull steering wheel gearshift paddle ;.
The automatic transmission shifts up to the
next gear.
X To shift down: pull steering wheel gearshift
paddle :.
The automatic transmission shifts down to
the next gear.
Automatic downshifting occurs when coasting.
If the engine exceeds the maximum engine
speed when shifting down, the automatic
transmission protects against engine damage
by not shifting down.
X
Gearshift recommendation
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
The gearshift recommendations assist you in
adopting an economical driving style. The recommended gear is shown in the multifunction
display.
X Shift to recommended gear ; according to
gearshift recommendation : when shown in
the multifunction display of the instrument
cluster.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
The gearshift recommendations assist you in
adopting an economical driving style. The recommended gear is shown in the multifunction
display.
X Shift to recommended gear ; according to
gearshift recommendation : when shown in
the multifunction display of the instrument
cluster.
Upshifting (Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
! If manual gearshifting is permanently acti-
vated, the automatic transmission does not
shift up automatically even when the engine
limiting speed for the current gear is reached.
When the engine limiting speed is reached,
the fuel supply is cut to prevent the engine
from overrevving. Always make sure that the
engine speed does not reach the red area of
the rev counter. There is otherwise a risk of
engine damage.
Z
Driving and parking
accelerate, the automatic transmission automatically shifts up in order to prevent engine
damage.
X To shift down: pull steering wheel gearshift
paddle :.
The automatic transmission shifts down to
the next gear.
Automatic downshifting occurs when coasting.
If the engine exceeds the maximum engine
speed when shifting down, the automatic
transmission protects against engine damage
by not shifting down.
149
Automatic transmission
Driving and parking
150
: Gear indicator
; Upshift indicator
Before the engine speed reaches the red area,
an upshift indicator will be shown in the multifunction display.
X When the UP message appears in the multifunction display, pull on the right-hand steering wheel gearshift paddle.
Kickdown
For maximum acceleration, depress the
accelerator pedal beyond the pressure point.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
X Shift back up once the desired speed is
reached.
During kickdown, you cannot shift gears using
the steering wheel gearshift paddles.
If you apply full throttle, the automatic transmission shifts up to the next gear when the
maximum engine speed is reached. This prevents the engine from overrevving.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: kickdown is only
possible in the temporary setting.
X
Refuelling
151
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The transmission has
problems shifting gear.
The transmission is losing oil.
X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop
immediately.
The acceleration ability
is deteriorating.
The transmission no longer changes gear.
The transmission is in emergency mode.
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles): it is only partially
possible to engage the gears, or the transmission is in position N.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: it is only possible to shift into second gear
and reverse gear.
X Stop.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Switch off the engine.
X Wait at least ten seconds before restarting the engine.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: if D is selected, the transmission shifts
into second gear; if R is selected, the transmission shifts into
reverse gear.
X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop
immediately.
Refuelling
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you or others come into contact with fuel,
observe the following:
RWash the fuel off any affected areas of skin
with water and soap immediately.
Fuel is highly flammable. If you handle fuel
incorrectly, there is a risk of fire and explosion.
You must avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Switch off the engine
and, if applicable, the auxiliary heating before
refuelling.
RIf you get fuel in your eyes, rinse them thor-
G WARNING
Fuels are poisonous and hazardous to health.
There is a danger of injury.
Do not swallow fuel or let it come into contact
with skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale fuel
vapours. Keep fuels out of the reach of children.
G WARNING
Electrostatic charge can cause sparks and
thereby ignite fuel vapours. There is a risk of
fire and explosion.
Always touch the vehicle body before opening
the fuel filler flap or touching the fuel pump
nozzle. This discharges any electrostatic
charge that may have built up.
oughly with clean water immediately. Seek
immediate medical attention.
RIf fuel is swallowed, seek immediate medical attention. Do not induce vomiting.
RChange any clothing that has come into
contact with fuel immediately.
Z
Driving and parking
Problems with the transmission
152
Refuelling
Do not get into the vehicle again during the refuelling process. Otherwise, electrostatic charge
could build up again.
Opening the fuel filler flap
Driving and parking
! Do not use diesel to refuel vehicles with a
petrol engine. Do not switch on the ignition if
you accidentally refuel with the wrong fuel.
Otherwise, the fuel will enter the fuel system.
Even small amounts of the wrong fuel can
result in damage to the fuel system and the
engine. Notify a qualified specialist workshop
and have the fuel tank and fuel lines drained
completely.
! Overfilling the fuel tank could damage the
fuel system.
! Take care not to spill any fuel on painted
surfaces. You could otherwise damage the
paintwork.
! Use a filter when adding fuel from a fuel can.
The fuel lines and/or the fuel injection system
could otherwise be blocked by particles from
the fuel can.
If you overfill the fuel tank, some fuel may spray
out when you remove the fuel pump nozzle.
Further information on fuel and fuel quality
(Y page 322).
Refuelling
General notes
The fuel filler flap is unlocked or locked automatically when you unlock or lock the vehicle
with the key or using KEYLESS-GO.
The position of the 8 fuel filler cap is displayed in the instrument cluster. The arrow next
to the filling pump indicates the side of the vehicle.
To open the fuel filler flap
To insert the fuel filler cap
Tyre pressure table
Instruction label on the fuel type to be refuelled
X Switch off the engine.
X Remove the key from the ignition lock.
X Press the fuel filler flap in the direction of
arrow :.
The fuel filler flap swings up.
X Turn the fuel filler cap anti-clockwise and
remove it.
X Insert the fuel filler cap into the holder
bracket on the inside of fuel filler flap ;.
X Completely insert the filler neck of the fuel
pump nozzle into the tank, hook in place and
refuel.
X Only fill the tank until the pump nozzle
switches off.
i Do not add any more fuel after the pump
stops filling for the first time. Otherwise, fuel
may leak out.
:
;
=
?
Closing the fuel filler flap
Replace the cap on the filler neck and turn
clockwise until it engages audibly.
X Close the fuel filler flap.
X
i Close the fuel filler flap before locking the
vehicle.
Parking
153
Problems with the fuel and fuel tank
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Fuel is leaking from the
vehicle.
The fuel line or the fuel tank is faulty.
The fuel filler flap cannot The fuel filler flap is not unlocked.
be opened.
X Unlock the vehicle (Y page 77).
The key battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
Unlock the vehicle using the emergency key element (Y page 79).
X
The fuel filler flap is unlocked, but the opening mechanism is jammed.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Parking
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Flammable material such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact with
hot parts of the exhaust system or exhaust
gas flow. There is a risk of fire.
Park the vehicle so that no flammable material can come into contact with hot vehicle
components. In particular, do not park on dry
grassland or harvested grain fields.
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P
Rstart the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
! Always secure the vehicle correctly against
rolling away. Otherwise, the vehicle or its drivetrain could be damaged.
To ensure that the vehicle is safeguarded
against rolling away unintentionally:
Rthe electric parking brake must be applied
Rthe transmission must be in position P
Rthe key must be removed from the ignition
lock.
Rthe front wheels must be turned towards the
kerb on steep uphill or downhill gradients
Switching off the engine
G WARNING
The automatic transmission switches to neutral position N when you switch off the engine.
The vehicle may roll away. There is a risk of an
accident.
After switching off the engine, always switch
to parking position P. Prevent the parked vehiZ
Driving and parking
G WARNING
There is a risk of fire or explosion.
X Turn the key to position 0 immediately and remove it (Y page 132).
X Do not restart the engine under any circumstances.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Parking
154
cle from rolling away by applying the parking
brake.
Apply the electric parking brake.
Shift the transmission to position P
(Y page 142).
X With the key: turn the key to position 0 in the
ignition lock and remove it.
The immobiliser is activated.
X With KEYLESS-GO: press the Start/Stop
button (Y page 132).
The engine stops and all the indicator lamps in
the instrument cluster go out.
When the driver's door is closed, this corresponds to key position 1. When the driver's
door is open, this corresponds to key position
0 (Y page 132).
X
Driving and parking
X
The engine can be switched off while the vehicle
is in motion by pressing and holding the Start/
Stop button for about three seconds. This function operates independently of the ECO start/
stop automatic engine switch-off function.
The function of the electric parking brake is
dependent on the on-board voltage. If the onboard voltage is low or if there is a malfunction
in the system, it may not be possible to apply the
released parking brake.
X If this is the case, only park the vehicle on
level ground and secure it to prevent it from
rolling away.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position
P.
It may not be possible to release an applied
parking brake if the on-board voltage is low or if
there is a malfunction in the system. Contact a
qualified specialist workshop.
The electric parking brake carries out a function
check at regular intervals when the engine is
switched off. Noises that occur are normal.
Applying or releasing manually
Electric parking brake
General notes
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
X
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P
the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
Rstart
To apply: push handle :.
When the electric parking brake is applied,
the red ! indicator lamp lights up in the
instrument cluster.
The electric parking brake can also be applied
when the key is removed.
To release: pull handle :.
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
The electric parking brake can only be released:
Rwhen the key is in position 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 132) or
Rif the ignition was switched on using the
Start/Stop button
X
Driving tips
The electric parking brake is automatically
applied when the transmission is in position P
and:
Rthe engine is switched off or
Rthe driver is not wearing a seat belt and the
driver's door is opened
To prevent the electric parking brake from being
automatically applied, pull handle :.
The electric parking brake is also applied automatically if:
RDistance Pilot DISTRONIC brings the vehicle
to a standstill or
Rthe HOLD function is keeping the vehicle stationary
In addition, at least one of the following conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe engine is switched off
Rthe driver is not wearing a seat belt and the
driver's door is opened
Rthere is a system malfunction
Rthe power supply is insufficient
Rthe vehicle is stationary for a lengthy period
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up.
The electric parking brake is not automatically
applied if the engine is switched off by the ECO
start/stop function.
Releasing automatically
The electric parking brake is released automatically when all of the following conditions are
fulfilled:
Rthe engine is running
Rthe transmission is in position D or R
Rthe driver's seat belt is fastened
Ryou depress the accelerator pedal
If the transmission is in position R, the boot lid
must be closed.
If your seat belt is not fastened, the following
conditions must be fulfilled to automatically
release the electric parking brake:
Rthe driver's door is closed
Ryou have shifted out of P or you have previously driven faster than 3 km/h
Ensure that you do not depress the accelerator
pedal unintentionally. Otherwise, the parking
brake will be released and the vehicle will start
to move.
Emergency braking
The vehicle can also be braked during an emergency by using the electric parking brake.
X While driving, push handle : of the electric
parking brake.
The vehicle is braked for as long as the handle
of the electric parking brake is pressed. The
longer the electric parking brake handle is
depressed, the greater the braking force.
During braking:
Ra warning tone sounds
Rthe Release parking brake message
appears
Rthe red ! indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster flashes
When the vehicle has been braked to a standstill, the electric parking brake is applied.
Parking up the vehicle
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer than
four weeks, the battery may be damaged by
exhaustive discharging.
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer than
six weeks, it may suffer from lack of use.
X Contact a qualified specialist workshop and
seek advice.
i You can obtain information about trickle
chargers from a qualified specialist workshop.
Driving tips
General notes
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
Z
Driving and parking
Applying automatically
155
156
Driving tips
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
The ECO display consists of three sections, with
an inner and outer area. The sections correspond to the following three categories:
:
Acceleration (evaluation of all acceleration processes):
Rthe outer area fills up and the inner
area lights up green: moderate
acceleration, especially at higher
speeds
Rthe outer area empties and the
inner area is grey: sporty acceleration
;
Coasting (evaluation of all deceleration processes):
Rthe outer area fills up and the inner
area lights up green: anticipatory
driving, keeping your distance and
early release of the accelerator.
The vehicle can coast without use
of the brakes.
Rthe outer area empties and the
inner area is grey: frequent heavy
braking
=
Constant (continuous evaluation
over the entire journey):
Rthe outer area fills up and the inner
area lights up green: constant
speed and avoidance of unnecessary acceleration and deceleration
Rthe outer area empties and the
inner area is grey: fluctuations in
speed
Driving and parking
Drive sensibly – save fuel
Observe the following tips to save fuel:
RThe tyres should always be inflated to the recommended tyre pressure.
RRemove unnecessary loads.
RWarm up the engine at low engine speeds.
RAvoid frequent acceleration or braking.
RObserve the service intervals in the Service
Booklet or in the service interval display. Have
all the maintenance work carried out in
accordance with Daimler AG regulations.
Fuel consumption also increases when driving in
cold weather, in stop-start traffic, on short journeys and in hilly terrain.
ECO display
The ECO display shows you how economical
your driving style is. The ECO display assists you
in achieving the most economical driving style
for the selected settings and prevailing conditions. Consumption can be significantly influenced by your driving style.
:
;
=
?
Acceleration
Coasting
Constant
Additional range achieved
Range ? is shown under Bonus fr. start and
represents the additional range achieved since
the beginning of the journey as a result of an
adapted driving style.
If the fuel level has dropped into the reserve
range, the Reserve fuel message is shown in
the multifunction display instead of range ?. In
addition, the 8 warning lamp in the instrument cluster lights up (Y page 249).
The three inner areas display the current driving
style and light up green as a result of a particularly economical driving style. Depending on the
driving situation, up to two areas may light up
simultaneously.
At the beginning of the journey, the three outer
areas are empty and fill up as a result of economical driving. A higher level indicates a more
economical driving style. If the three outer areas
are completely filled at the same time, the driver
has adopted the most economical driving style
for the selected settings and prevailing conditions. The ECO display border lights up.
The ECO display does not indicate the actual fuel
consumption. The additionally achieved range
displayed under Bonus fr. start does not
indicate a fixed consumption reduction.
Driving tips
Braking
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you shift down on a slippery road surface in
an attempt to increase the engine's braking
effect, the drive wheels could lose their grip.
This increases the risk of skidding and having
an accident.
Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface.
Downhill gradients
Change into a lower gear in good time on long
and steep downhill gradients. Take particular
note of this when driving a laden vehicle.
This also applies if you have activated cruise
control, the limiter or Distance Pilot DISTRONIC.
This will use the braking effect of the engine, so
less braking will be required to maintain vehicle
speed. This relieves the load on the brake system and prevents the brakes from overheating
and wearing too quickly.
Heavy and light loads
G WARNING
The braking system can overheat if you leave
your foot on the brake pedal while driving.
This increases the braking distance and could
even cause the braking system to fail. There is
a risk of an accident.
Never use the brake pedal as a footrest. Do
not simultaneously depress both the brake
pedal and the accelerator pedal while driving.
! Depressing the brake pedal constantly
results in excessive and premature wear to
the brake pads.
If the brakes have been subjected to a heavy
load, do not stop the vehicle immediately, but
drive on for a short while. This allows the airflow
to cool the brakes more quickly.
If the brakes have been used only moderately,
you should occasionally test their effectiveness.
To do this, brake more firmly from a higher
speed while paying attention to the traffic conditions. This improves the grip of the brakes.
Wet road surfaces
If you have driven for a long time in heavy rain
without braking, there may be a delayed reaction from the brakes when braking for the first
time. This may also occur after a car wash or
after driving through deep water.
You will have to depress the brake pedal more
firmly. Maintain a greater distance to the vehicle
in front.
After driving on a wet road or having the vehicle
washed, brake firmly while paying attention to
the traffic conditions. This will warm up the
brake discs, thereby drying them more quickly
and protecting them against corrosion.
Z
Driving and parking
In addition to driving style, the actual consumption is affected by other factors, such as:
Rload
Rtyre pressure
Rcold start
Rchoice of route
Rthe use of electrical consumers
These factors are not included in the ECO display.
An economical driving style involves driving at a
moderate engine speed.
To achieve a higher value in the categories
"Acceleration" and "Constant":
Robserve the gearshift recommendation
Rdrive the vehicle in drive program C or E.
On long journeys at a constant speed, e.g. on the
motorway, only the outer area for "Constant"
will change.
The ECO display summarises the driving style
from the start of the journey to its completion.
Therefore, there are more marked changes in
the outer areas at the start of a journey. During
a prolonged driving time, these changes are
smaller. For more marked changes, perform a
manual reset (Y page 203).
Further information on the ECO display
(Y page 202).
157
158
Driving tips
Driving and parking
Limited braking performance on salttreated roads
If you drive on salt-treated roads, a layer of salt
may form on the brake discs and pads. This can
increase the braking distance considerably.
RIn order to prevent any salt build-up, apply the
brakes occasionally while paying attention to
the traffic conditions.
RCarefully depress the brake pedal at the end
of the journey and when starting the next
journey.
RMaintain a much greater distance to the vehicle in front.
Brake pads/linings and discs that are either new
or have been replaced only achieve optimum
braking effect after several hundred kilometres
of driving. Compensate for the reduced braking
effect by applying greater force to the brake
pedal. Always be aware of this and adapt your
driving and braking accordingly during the running-in period.
Excessive heavy braking results in correspondingly high brake wear. Observe the brake system
warning lamp in the instrument cluster and note
any brake status messages in the multifunction
display. If you regularly drive at high speeds, it is
particularly important to have the brake system
checked and maintained regularly.
New brake pads/linings
Brake pads/linings and discs that are either new
or have been replaced only achieve optimum
braking effect after several hundred kilometres
of driving. Compensate for the reduced braking
effect by applying greater force to the brake
pedal.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only have brake pads/linings
fitted to your vehicle which have been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or which correspond to an equivalent quality standard. Brake
pads/linings which have not been approved for
Mercedes-Benz vehicles or which are not of an
equivalent quality could affect your vehicle's
operating safety.
High-performance and ceramic brake
system (Mercedes-AMG vehicle)
The AMG brake systems are designed for heavy
loads. This may lead to noise when braking. This
is dependent on:
Rspeed
Rbraking force
Rambient conditions, e.g. temperature and
humidity
The wear of individual components of the brake
system, such as the brake pads/linings or brake
discs, depends on the individual driving style
and operating conditions.
For this reason, it is impossible to state a mileage (service life) that will be valid under all circumstances. An aggressive driving style will
lead to high wear. You can obtain more information on this from a qualified specialist workshop.
Driving on wet roads
Aquaplaning
If water has accumulated to a certain depth on
the road surface, there is a danger of aquaplaning occurring, even if:
Ryou are driving at low speeds
Rthe tyres have adequate tread depth
For this reason, drive in the following manner in
the event of heavy rain or in conditions in which
aquaplaning can occur:
Rlower your speed
Ravoid tyre ruts
Ravoid sudden steering movements
Rbrake carefully
Driving on flooded roads
! Bear in mind that vehicles travelling in front
or in the opposite direction create waves. This
may cause the maximum permissible water
depth to be exceeded.
These notes must be observed under all circumstances. You could otherwise damage
the engine, the electronics or the transmission.
If you must drive on stretches of road on which
water has collected, please bear in mind that:
Rin the case of standing water, the water level
must be no higher than the lower edge of the
vehicle body
Ryou should drive no faster than walking pace
Winter driving
G WARNING
If you shift down on a slippery road surface in
an attempt to increase the engine's braking
effect, the drive wheels could lose their grip.
This increases the risk of skidding and having
an accident.
Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface.
G DANGER
If the exhaust pipe is blocked or adequate
ventilation is not possible, poisonous gases
such as carbon monoxide (CO) may enter the
vehicle. This is the case, e.g. if the vehicle
becomes trapped in snow. There is a risk of
fatal injury.
If you leave the engine or the auxiliary heating
running, make sure the exhaust pipe and area
around the vehicle are clear of snow. To
ensure an adequate supply of fresh air, open a
window on the side of the vehicle that is not
facing into the wind.
! Take care not to damage the sealing strip
and the moulding on the side of the rear window when scraping ice off the rear window.
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop at the onset of winter.
You should drive particularly carefully on slippery road surfaces. Avoid sudden acceleration,
steering and braking manoeuvres. Do not use
cruise control.
If the vehicle threatens to skid or cannot be
stopped when moving at low speed:
X Shift the transmission to position N.
X Try to bring the vehicle under control by using
corrective steering.
The outside temperature indicator is not
designed to serve as an ice-warning device and
is therefore unsuitable for that purpose.
Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay.
Indicated temperatures just above the freezing
point do not guarantee that the road surface is
free of ice. The road may still be icy, especially in
wooded areas or on bridges. The vehicle could
skid if you fail to adapt your driving style. Always
adapt your driving style and drive at a speed to
suit the prevailing weather conditions.
You should pay special attention to road conditions when temperatures are around freezing
point.
Further information on driving with snow chains
(Y page 307).
Further information on driving with summer
tyres (Y page 306).
Observe the notes in the "Winter operation" section (Y page 306).
Driving systems
Cruise control
General notes
Cruise control maintains a constant road speed
for you. It brakes automatically in order to avoid
exceeding the set speed. On long and steep
downhill gradients, especially if the vehicle is
laden, you must select a lower gear in good time.
By doing so, you will make use of the braking
effect of the engine. This relieves the load on the
brake system and prevents the brakes from
overheating and wearing too quickly.
Use cruise control only if road and traffic conditions make it appropriate to maintain a steady
speed for a prolonged period. You can set any
road speed above 30 km/h.
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style, cruise control can neither reduce the risk of accident nor
override the laws of physics. Cruise control cannot take road, weather and traffic conditions
into account. Cruise control is only an aid. You
are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in
front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good time
and for maintaining lane.
Do not use cruise control:
Rin road and traffic conditions which do not
allow you to maintain a constant speed, e.g.
heavy traffic or winding roads.
Ron slippery roads. Braking or accelerating
may cause the drive wheels to lose traction
and the vehicle could then skid.
Rwhen there is poor visibility, e.g. due to fog,
heavy rain or snow.
Z
159
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
160
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the stored speed.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow A.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever goes out. Cruise control is selected.
Cruise control lever
Driving and parking
Storing, maintaining and calling up a
speed
Storing and maintaining the speed
Accelerate the vehicle to the desired speed.
Briefly press the cruise control lever up : or
down ?.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
Cruise control is activated. The vehicle automatically maintains the stored speed.
You can store the current speed if you are driving faster than 30 km/h.
X
X
: To store the current speed or a higher speed
; LIM indicator lamp
= To store the current speed or call up the last
stored speed
? To store the current speed or a lower speed
A To switch between cruise control and variable limiter
B To deactivate cruise control
You can operate cruise control and the variable
limiter with the cruise control lever.
LIM indicator lamp ; on the cruise control lever
indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM indicator lamp ; off: cruise control is
selected.
RLIM indicator lamp ; on: variable limiter is
selected.
When you activate cruise control, the stored
speed is shown in the multifunction display for
five seconds. The speed is then permanently
displayed in the status indicator together with
the ¯ symbol.
In vehicles with a segment circle in the speedometer, the segments between the currently
stored speed and the end of the segment circle
light up.
If you have activated the permanent limiter and
a speed is stored, the segments up to the stored
speed light up.
Selecting cruise control
X
Check whether LIM indicator lamp ; is off.
If it is off, cruise control is already selected.
i Cruise control may be unable to maintain
the stored speed on uphill gradients. The
stored speed is resumed when the gradient
evens out. Cruise control maintains the
stored speed on downhill gradients by automatically braking the vehicle.
Storing or calling up the speed
G WARNING
If you call up a stored speed and this is different from the current speed, the vehicle
accelerates or brakes. If you do not know
what the stored speed is, the vehicle may
accelerate or brake unexpectedly. There is a
risk of an accident.
Take the traffic conditions into account
before calling up the stored speed. If you do
not know what the stored speed is, store the
desired speed again.
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you =.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
The first time cruise control is activated, it
stores the current speed or regulates the
speed of the vehicle to the previously stored
speed.
X
Driving systems
Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ? for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until the
desired speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored.
X To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control lever
up : to the pressure point for a higher speed
or down ? for a lower speed.
The last speed stored is increased or reduced.
X To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control lever
up : beyond the pressure point for a higher
speed, or down ? for a lower speed.
The last speed stored is increased or reduced.
X
i The speed indicated in the speedometer
or
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow ;.
The variable limiter is selected. LIM indicator
lamp : in the cruise control lever lights up.
Cruise control is automatically deactivated if:
apply the electric parking brake
Ryou are driving at less than 30 km/h
RESP® intervenes or you deactivate ESP®
RBrake Assist intervenes
Ryou shift from transmission position D.
If cruise control is deactivated, you will hear a
warning tone. You will see the Cruise con‐
trol off message in the multifunction display
for approximately five seconds.
Ryou
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the engine.
may differ slightly from the speed stored.
i Cruise control is not deactivated if you
depress the accelerator pedal. For example, if
you accelerate briefly to overtake, cruise control adjusts the vehicle's speed to the last
speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
Deactivating cruise control
There are several ways to deactivate cruise control:
X Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards
=.
or
X Brake.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
General notes
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC regulates the speed
and automatically helps you maintain the distance to the vehicle detected in front. Vehicles
are detected with the aid of the radar sensor
system. Distance Pilot DISTRONIC brakes automatically to avoid exceeding the set speed or to
maintain the designated distance from the vehicle in front.
You must select a lower gear in good time on
long and steep downhill gradients, especially if
the vehicle is laden. By doing so, you will make
use of the braking effect of the engine. This
relieves the load on the brake system and prevents the brakes from overheating and wearing
too quickly.
If Distance Pilot DISTRONIC detects that there is
a risk of a collision, you will be warned visually
and acoustically. Without your intervention, Distance Pilot DISTRONIC cannot prevent a collision. An intermittent warning tone will then
sound and the distance warning lamp will light
up in the instrument cluster. Brake immediately
to increase the distance to the vehicle driving in
front, or take evasive action, provided it is safe
to do so.
For Distance Pilot DISTRONIC to assist you
when driving, the radar sensor system must be
operational.
Z
Driving and parking
Setting a speed
161
162
Driving systems
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC operates in the range
between 0 km/h and 200 km/h.
Do not use Distance Pilot DISTRONIC while driving on roads with steep gradients.
Driving and parking
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC does not recognise
Rpeople
or animals
Rstationary objects on the road, e.g. stopped
or parked vehicles
vehicles or crossing traffic
As a result, Distance Pilot DISTRONIC may
neither give warnings nor intervene in such
situations. There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Roncoming
G WARNING
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC cannot always
clearly identify other road users and complex
traffic situations.
In such cases, Distance Pilot DISTRONIC may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning and then
brake the vehicle
Rneither give a warning nor intervene
Raccelerate or brake unexpectedly
There is a risk of an accident.
Continue to drive carefully and be ready to
brake, especially if Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
warns you.
G WARNING
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC brakes your vehicle
with up to 50% of the maximum possible
deceleration. If this deceleration is not sufficient, Distance Pilot DISTRONIC alerts you
with a visual and acoustic warning. There is a
risk of an accident.
Apply the brakes yourself in these situations
and try to take evasive action.
! When Distance Pilot DISTRONIC or the
HOLD function is activated, the vehicle
brakes automatically in certain situations.
To avoid damage to the vehicle, deactivate
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC and the HOLD
function in the following or similar situations:
Rwhen towing away
Rin a car wash
If you fail to adapt your driving style, Distance
Pilot DISTRONIC can neither reduce the risk of
an accident nor override the laws of physics.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC cannot take into
account road, weather or traffic conditions. Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is only an aid. You are
responsible for the distance to the vehicle in
front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good time
and for staying in lane.
Do not use Distance Pilot DISTRONIC:
Rin road and traffic conditions which do not
allow you to maintain a constant speed, e.g. in
heavy traffic or on winding roads
Ron smooth or slippery roads. Braking or accelerating can cause the drive wheels to lose
traction and the vehicle could then skid
Rwhen visibility is poor, e.g. due to fog, heavy
rain or snow
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC may not detect narrow vehicles driving in front, e.g. motorcycles, or
vehicles driving on a different line.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can be
impaired in the case of:
Rdirt on the sensors or obscured sensors
Rsnow or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rthe possibility of strong radar reflections, for
example, in multi-storey car parks
If Distance Pilot DISTRONIC no longer detects a
vehicle in front, it may unexpectedly accelerate
to the speed stored.
This speed can:
Rbe too high for a filter lane or a slip road
Rbe so high in the right lane that you pass vehicles driving on the left
Rbe so high in the left lane that you pass vehicles driving on the right
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the speed stored.
Driving systems
Cruise control lever
163
Activating Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
and storing, maintaining and calling up
a speed
Important safety notes
Cruise control lever
: To store the current speed or a higher speed
; To set the specified minimum distance
= LIM indicator lamp
? To store the current speed or call up the last
stored speed
A To store the current speed or a lower speed
B To switch between Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC and variable limiter
C To deactivate Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
You can operate Distance Pilot DISTRONIC and
the variable limiter with the cruise control lever.
LIM indicator lamp = on the cruise control lever
indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM indicator lamp = off: Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp = on: variable limiter is
selected.
Selecting Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
X
Check whether LIM indicator lamp = is off.
If it is off, Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is already
selected.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow B.
LIM indicator lamp = in the cruise control
lever goes out. Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is
selected.
HOLD function is activated, the vehicle
brakes automatically in certain situations.
To avoid damage to the vehicle, deactivate
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC and the HOLD
function in the following or similar situations:
Rwhen towing away
Rin a car wash
To activate Distance Pilot DISTRONIC, the following conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe engine must be running. It may take up to
two minutes of driving before Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC is ready for use.
Rthe electric parking brake must be released.
RESP® must be switched on, but not intervening.
RActive Parking Assist must not be activated.
Rthe transmission must be in position D.
Rthe driver's door must be closed when you
shift from P to D or your seat belt must be
fastened.
Rthe front-passenger door must be closed.
Rthe vehicle must not be skidding.
Activating
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ?, up : or down A.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is activated.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed up : or
down A until the desired speed is set.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
Your vehicle adapts its speed to that of the
vehicle in front, but only up to the desired
stored speed.
X
i If you do not fully release the accelerator
pedal, the Distance Pilot passive message appears in the multifunction display. The
set distance to a slower-moving vehicle in
front will then not be maintained. The position
of the accelerator pedal will determine the
speed.
You can also activate Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
when stationary. The lowest speed that can be
set is 30 km/h.
Z
Driving and parking
! When Distance Pilot DISTRONIC or the
Driving systems
164
Driving and parking
Activating at the current speed/last
stored speed
G WARNING
If you call up a stored speed and this is different from the current speed, the vehicle
accelerates or brakes. If you do not know
what the stored speed is, the vehicle may
accelerate or brake unexpectedly. There is a
risk of an accident.
Take the traffic conditions into account
before calling up the stored speed. If you do
not know what the stored speed is, store the
desired speed again.
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ?.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
The first time Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is
activated, it stores the current speed or regulates the speed of the vehicle to the previously stored speed.
X
Pulling away and driving
If you want to pull away with Distance
Pilot DISTRONIC: remove your foot from the
brake pedal.
X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ?.
or
X If Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is activated:
accelerate briefly.
Your vehicle pulls away and adapts its speed
to that of the vehicle in front. If no vehicle is
detected in front, your vehicle accelerates to
the set speed.
The vehicle can also pull away when it is facing
an unidentified obstacle or is driving on a different line from another vehicle. The vehicle then
brakes automatically. Be ready to brake at all
times.
If there is no vehicle in front, Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC operates in the same way as cruise
control.
If Distance Pilot DISTRONIC detects a slowermoving vehicle in front, it brakes your vehicle. In
this way, the distance you have selected is maintained.
If Distance Pilot DISTRONIC detects a fastermoving vehicle in front, it increases the driving
X
speed. However, the vehicle is only accelerated
up to the speed you have stored.
Selecting the drive program
All vehicles (except AMG vehicles): Distance
Pilot DISTRONIC supports a sporty driving style
when you have selected the S or S+ drive program (Y page 139). Acceleration behind the
vehicle in front or to the set speed is then noticeably more dynamic. If you have selected the C or
E drive program, the vehicle accelerates more
gently. This setting is recommended in stopstart traffic.
AMG vehicles: Distance Pilot DISTRONIC supports a sporty driving style when you have selected the S, S+ or M drive program (Y page 140).
Acceleration behind the vehicle in front or to the
set speed is then noticeably more dynamic.
When you select the C drive program, the vehicle accelerates more gently. This setting is recommended in stop-start traffic.
Changing lanes
If when driving on multilane roads you wish to
change to the overtaking lane, Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC supports you if:
Ryou are driving faster than 70 km/h
RDistance Pilot DISTRONIC is maintaining the
distance to a vehicle in front
Ryou switch on the respective turn signal
RDistance Pilot DISTRONIC does not currently
detect a danger of collision
If these conditions are met, your vehicle is accelerated. Acceleration will be interrupted if changing lanes takes too long or if the distance
between your vehicle and the vehicle in front
becomes too small.
Road and traffic conditions
Driving systems
all countries.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC uses additional information from your navigation system so that it
can adapt to certain traffic situations. This is the
case if, while following a vehicle, Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC is active and you:
Rapproach or drive around a roundabout
Rapproach a T-junction
Rturn off at a motorway exit
Even if the vehicle in front leaves the detection
range, Distance Pilot DISTRONIC temporarily
maintains the current driving speed and does
not accelerate. This is based on the current map
data in the navigation system.
Afterwards, the vehicle accelerates back to the
speed you set.
The system takes into account the fact that
overtaking on the right is not permitted on
motorways or high-speed major roads at speeds
above 80 km/h. The driving speed is adjusted to
the speed of the queue of vehicles in the adjacent lane to the left.
i Prevention of overtaking on the right applies
to countries where traffic drives on the right.
In countries where traffic drives on the left,
overtaking on the left is prevented accordingly.
Stopping
If Distance Pilot DISTRONIC detects that the
vehicle in front is stopping, it brakes your vehicle
until it is stationary.
Once your vehicle is stationary, it remains stationary and you do not need to depress the
brake. After a short period, the vehicle is
secured by the electric parking brake, thus
relieving the service brake.
Depending on the specified minimum distance,
your vehicle will come to a standstill at a sufficient distance behind the vehicle in front. The
specified minimum distance is set using the
control on the cruise control lever.
The electric parking brake secures the vehicle
automatically if Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is
activated and:
Rthe driver's door is open and the driver's seat
belt is unfastened
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is automatically switched off by the ECO start/stop
function
Ra
system fault occurs
power supply is insufficient
If a malfunction in the electric parking brake
occurs, then the transmission may also be shifted into position P automatically.
Rthe
Setting a speed
Bear in mind that it may take a brief moment
until the vehicle has accelerated or braked to
the set speed.
X Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down A for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until the
desired speed is reached or press the cruise
control lever repeatedly until the desired
speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored. Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC is activated and adjusts the vehicle's speed to the new speed stored.
X To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control lever
up : to the pressure point for a higher speed
or down A for a lower speed.
The last speed stored is increased or reduced.
X To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control lever
up : beyond the pressure point for a higher
speed, or down A for a lower speed.
The last speed stored is increased or reduced.
Setting the specified minimum distance
You can set the specified minimum distance for
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC by varying the time
span between one and two seconds. With this
function you can set the minimum distance that
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC maintains to the vehicle in front, dependent on vehicle speed. You
can see this distance in the multifunction display (Y page 166).
The specified minimum distance can be
changed when Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is activated or deactivated.
Make sure that you maintain a sufficient and
safe distance from the vehicle in front. Adjust
the distance to the vehicle in front if necessary.
Z
Driving and parking
i The following function is not operational in
165
Driving systems
166
Driving and parking
Display when Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is
deactivated
Cruise control lever
To increase: turn control = in direction ;.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC then maintains a
greater distance between your vehicle and
the vehicle in front.
X To decrease: turn control = in direction :.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC then maintains a
shorter distance between your vehicle and
the vehicle in front.
X
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC displays in
the instrument cluster
Displays in the speedometer
When Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is activated,
one or more segments ; in the set speed range
light up.
If Distance Pilot DISTRONIC detects a vehicle in
front, segments ; between speed of the vehicle in front = and stored speed : light up.
i For design reasons, the speed displayed in
the speedometer may differ slightly from the
speed set for Distance Pilot DISTRONIC.
: Vehicle in front, if detected
; Distance indicator: current distance to the
vehicle in front
= Specified minimum distance to the vehicle
in front; adjustable
? Own vehicle
X
Select the Assistance graphic function
using the on-board computer (Y page 207).
Display when Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is
activated
: Vehicle in front, if detected
; Specified minimum distance to the vehicle
in front; adjustable
= Own vehicle
? Distance Pilot DISTRONIC activated
Select the Assistance graphic function
using the on-board computer (Y page 207).
You will initially see the stored speed for about
five seconds when you activate Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC.
X
Driving systems
If Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is automatically
deactivated, you will hear a warning tone. The
Distance Pilot off message will appear in
the multifunction display for approximately five
seconds.
Tips for driving with Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC
General notes
Cruise control lever
There are several ways to deactivate Distance
Pilot DISTRONIC:
X Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards :.
or
X Brake, unless the vehicle is stationary.
or
X Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow =.
The variable limiter is selected. LIM indicator
lamp ; in the cruise control lever lights up.
When you deactivate Distance Pilot DISTRONIC,
the Distance Pilot off message will appear
in the multifunction display for approximately
five seconds.
The following contains descriptions of certain
road and traffic conditions in which you must be
particularly attentive. In such situations, brake if
necessary. Distance Pilot DISTRONIC will then
be deactivated.
Cornering, entering and exiting a bend
i The last speed stored remains stored until
The ability of Distance Pilot DISTRONIC to
detect vehicles when cornering is limited. Your
vehicle may brake unexpectedly or late.
i Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is not deactivated
Vehicles which are not driving in the middle of their lane
you switch off the engine.
if you depress the accelerator pedal. If you
accelerate to overtake, Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC adjusts the vehicle's speed to the
last speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is automatically deactivated if:
Ryou apply the electric parking brake or if the
vehicle is automatically secured with the electric parking brake
RESP® intervenes or you deactivate ESP®
Rthe transmission is in the P, R or N position
Ryou pull the cruise control lever towards you
in order to pull away and the front-passenger
door is open
Rthe vehicle has skidded
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC may not detect vehicles which are not driving in the middle of their
lane. The distance to the vehicle in front will be
too short.
Z
Driving and parking
Deactivating Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
167
168
Driving systems
Other vehicles changing lane
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC will not brake for
them.
Driving and parking
Crossing vehicles
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC has not detected the
vehicle cutting in yet. The distance to this vehicle will be too short.
Narrow vehicles
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC may mistakenly
detect vehicles that are crossing your lane.
If you activate Distance Pilot DISTRONIC in the
following situations, the vehicle could pull away
unintentionally:
RAt traffic lights with crossing traffic, for example.
RWith a vehicle ahead on the other side of a
junction and the HOLD function active.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC with Steering
Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC has not yet detected
the vehicle in front on the edge of the carriageway because of its narrow width. The distance to
the vehicle in front will be too short.
General notes
Obstructions and stationary vehicles
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC does not brake for
obstacles or stationary vehicles. If, for example,
the detected vehicle turns a corner and an
obstacle or stationary vehicle is then revealed,
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC with Steering Pilot
and Stop&Go Pilot aids you in keeping the vehicle in the centre of the driving lane by means of
moderate steering interventions in a speed
range from 0 - 200 km/h.
It monitors lane markings and vehicles in front of
your vehicle by means of camera system : at
the top of the windscreen.
In a speed range from 0 - 60 km/h, Stop&Go
Pilot focuses on the vehicle in front, taking into
account lane markings, e.g. when following vehicles in a traffic jam.
At speeds of more than 60 km/h, the Steering
Pilot focuses on detected lane markings (left
and right), only focusing on the vehicle in front if
detected lane markings are not present at
speeds of up to 130 km/h.
If these conditions are not present, Steering
Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot cannot provide assistance.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC must be active in
order for the function to be available.
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style, Distance
Pilot DISTRONIC with Steering Pilot and
Stop&Go Pilot can neither reduce the risk of an
accident nor override the laws of physics. It cannot take into account road, weather or traffic
conditions. Distance Pilot DISTRONIC with
Steering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot is only an aid.
You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good
time and for staying in lane.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC with Steering Pilot
and Stop&Go Pilot does not detect road and
traffic conditions and does not detect all road
users. If you are following a vehicle which is
driving towards the edge of the carriageway,
your vehicle could come into contact with the
kerb or other road boundaries. Be particularly
aware of other road users, e.g. cyclists, that are
directly next to your vehicle.
Obstacles such as traffic pylons on the lane or
projecting into the lane are not detected.
An inappropriate steering intervention, e.g. after
intentionally driving over a lane marking, can be
corrected at any time if you steer slightly in the
opposite direction.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC with Steering Pilot
and Stop&Go Pilot cannot continuously keep
your vehicle in the lane. In some cases, the
steering intervention is not sufficient to bring
the vehicle back to the lane. In such cases, you
must steer the vehicle yourself to ensure that it
does not leave the lane.
The support offered by the system may be
impaired if:
Rthere is poor visibility, e.g. due to insufficient
illumination of the road, or due to snow, rain,
fog or spray
Rthere is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic, the
sun or reflection from other vehicles (e.g. if
the road surface is wet)
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up, damaged
or covered, for instance by a sticker, in the
vicinity of the camera
Rthere are no lane markings, or several unclear
lane markings are present, e.g. around construction sites
Rthe lane markings are worn away, dark or covered up, e.g. by dirt or snow
Rthe distance to the vehicle in front is too short
and thus the lane markings cannot be detected
Rthe lane markings change quickly, e.g. lanes
branch off, cross one another or merge
Rthe road is narrow and winding
Rthere are highly variable shade conditions on
the road
The system is switched to passive and no longer
assists you by performing steering interventions
if:
Ryou actively change lanes
Ryou switch on the turn signal
Ryou take your hands off the steering wheel or
do not steer for a prolonged period of time
i After you have finished changing lanes,
Steering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot are automatically active again.
Steering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot cannot provide
assistance:
Ron very sharp corners
Ra loss of tyre pressure or a defective tyre has
been detected and displayed
Pay attention also to the important safety notes
on Distance Pilot DISTRONIC (Y page 162).
The steering interventions are carried out with a
limited steering moment. The system requires
the driver to keep his hands on the steering
wheel and to steer himself.
If you do not steer yourself or if you take your
hands off the steering wheel for a prolonged
period of time, the system will first alert you with
a visual warning. A steering wheel symbol
appears in the multifunction display. If you have
Z
169
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
170
Driving and parking
still not started to steer and have not taken hold
of the steering wheel after five seconds at the
latest, a warning tone also sounds to remind you
to take control of the vehicle. Steering Pilot and
Stop&Go Pilot then switch to passive mode. Distance Pilot DISTRONIC remains active.
Activating Steering Pilot and Stop&Go
Pilot
X
Activate Distance Pilot DISTRONIC with
Steering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot function
using the on-board computer (Y page 207).
The Steering Pilot on message appears in
the multifunctional display. The Steering Pilot
and Stop&Go Pilot are switched on.
Information in the multifunction display
If Steering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot are activated
but not ready for a steering intervention, steering wheel symbol : appears in grey. If the system provides you with support by means of
steering interventions, symbol : is shown in
green.
effect of the engine. This relieves the load on the
brake system and prevents the brakes from
overheating and wearing too quickly.
You can set a variable or permanent limit speed:
Rvariable for maximum permissible speeds,
e.g. in built-up areas
Rpermanent for long-term speed restrictions,
e.g. when driving with winter tyres fitted
(Y page 172)
i The speed indicated in the speedometer
may differ slightly from the speed stored.
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style, the limiter
can neither reduce the risk of an accident nor
override the laws of physics. The limiter cannot
take into account road, weather or traffic conditions. The limiter is only an aid. You are
responsible for the distance to the vehicle in
front, for vehicle speed and for braking in good
time.
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the speed stored.
Variable speed limiter
Cruise control lever
Deactivating Steering Pilot and Stop&Go
Pilot
Deactivate Distance Pilot DISTRONIC with
Steering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot function
using the on-board computer (Y page 207).
The Steering Pilot off message appears
in the multifunction display. Steering Pilot and
Stop&Go Pilot are deactivated.
When the Distance Pilot is deactivated or not
available, Steering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot are
deactivated automatically.
X
Speed limiter
General notes
The limiter brakes automatically so that you do
not exceed the set speed. On long and steep
downhill gradients, especially if the vehicle is
laden, you must select a lower gear in good time.
By doing so, you will make use of the braking
Cruise control lever
: To store the current speed or a higher speed
; LIM indicator lamp
= To store the current speed or call up the last
stored speed
? To store the current speed or a lower speed
A To switch between cruise control or Dis-
tance Pilot DISTRONIC and variable limiter
B To deactivate the variable limiter
Driving systems
Selecting the variable speed limiter
X
Check whether LIM indicator lamp ; is on.
If it is on, the variable limiter is already selected.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow A.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever is on. The variable limiter is selected.
Storing the current speed
Briefly press the cruise control lever up : or
down ?.
The current speed is stored. You will see the
stored speed for five seconds in the multifunction display.
Vehicles with cruise control: the stored speed
is permanently displayed in the status indicator.
Vehicles with Distance Pilot DISTRONIC: the
segments from the start of the scale up to the
stored speed light up in the speedometer.
You can use the cruise control lever to limit the
speed to any speed above 30 km/h while the
engine is running.
X
X
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you =.
Setting a speed
X
or
To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control lever
up : past the pressure point for a higher
speed, or down ? for a lower speed.
X
Keep the cruise control lever pressed beyond
the pressure point until the desired speed is
set. Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ? for a lower speed.
X
To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control lever
up : to the pressure point for a higher speed,
or down ? for a lower speed.
or
X
Keep the cruise control lever pressed to the
pressure point until the desired speed is set.
Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ? for a lower speed.
Switching the speed limiter to passive
If you depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point (kickdown), the limiter is
switched to passive mode. The following message appears in the multifunction display: Lim‐
iter passive.
passive
You can then exceed the stored speed. The limiter is activated again if you:
Rdrive slower than the stored speed without
kickdown
Rset a new speed or
Rcall up the last speed stored again
The Limiter passive message in the multifunction display disappears.
Storing the current speed or calling up the
last stored speed
G WARNING
If you call up the stored speed and it is lower
than the current speed, the vehicle decelerates. If you do not know the stored speed, the
vehicle could decelerate unexpectedly. There
is a risk of an accident.
Pay attention to the road and traffic conditions before calling up the stored speed. If you
do not know the stored speed, store the
desired speed again.
Z
Driving and parking
You can operate cruise control or Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC and the variable limiter with the
cruise control lever.
LIM indicator lamp ; on the cruise control lever
indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM indicator lamp ; off: cruise control or
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp ; on: variable limiter is
selected.
You can use the cruise control lever to limit the
speed to any speed above 30 km/h while the
engine is running.
171
172
Driving systems
Switching off the speed limiter
HOLD function
Driving and parking
General notes
Cruise control lever
There are several ways to deactivate the variable limiter:
X Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards
=.
or
X Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow ;.
LIM indicator lamp : in the cruise control
lever goes out. The variable limiter is deactivated.
Cruise control or Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is
selected.
It is not possible to deactivate the variable limiter by braking.
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the engine.
Permanent limiter
If you wish to restrict the maximum speed of the
vehicle for an extended period (e.g. when driving
with winter tyres), the desired maximum speed
can be set with the permanent limiter.
You can use the on-board computer to limit the
speed to a value between 160 km/h and
240 km/h(Y page 211).
Shortly before the stored speed is reached, it
appears in the multifunction display. When you
confirm the message with a or %, display
messages no longer appear when switching off
the engine. The speed will only be displayed
again once the engine has been restarted.
The permanent limiter remains active even if the
variable limiter is deactivated. The driven speed
will remain below the stored speed even in the
event of kickdown.
The HOLD function can assist the driver in the
following situations:
Rwhen pulling away, especially on steep slopes
Rwhen manoeuvring on steep slopes
Rwhen waiting in traffic
The vehicle is kept stationary without the driver
having to depress the brake pedal.
The braking effect is cancelled and the HOLD
function is deactivated when you depress the
accelerator pedal to pull away.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When leaving the vehicle, it can still roll away
despite being braked by the HOLD function if:
Rthere
is a malfunction in the system or in
the voltage supply
Rthe HOLD function is deactivated by the
accelerator pedal being depressed, e.g. by
a vehicle occupant
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses are tampered with
Rthe battery is disconnected
There is a risk of an accident.
Before leaving the vehicle, always deactivate
the HOLD function and secure the vehicle
from rolling away.
! When Distance Pilot DISTRONIC or the
HOLD function is activated, the vehicle
brakes automatically in certain situations.
To avoid damage to the vehicle, deactivate
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC and the HOLD
function in the following or similar situations:
Rwhen towing away
Rin a car wash
Deactivating the HOLD function (Y page 173).
Driving systems
You can activate the HOLD function if all of the
following conditions are fulfilled:
Rthe vehicle is stationary
Rthe engine is running or if it has been automatically switched off by the ECO start/stop
function
Rthe driver's door is closed or your seat belt is
fastened
Rthe electric parking brake is released
Rthe transmission is in position D, R or N
RDistance Pilot DISTRONIC is deactivated
Activating the HOLD function
When the HOLD function is activated, the transmission is shifted automatically to position P if:
Rthe
driver's seat belt is not fastened and the
driver's door is open
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is automatically switched off by the ECO start/stop
function
The electric parking brake secures the vehicle
automatically if the HOLD function is activated,
the vehicle is stationary and:
Ra system fault occurs
Rthe power supply is insufficient
If a malfunction in the electric parking brake
occurs, then the transmission may also be shifted into position P automatically.
RACE START
Important safety notes
i RACE START must not be used on normal
Make sure that the activation conditions are
met.
X Depress the brake pedal.
X Quickly depress the brake pedal further
until : appears in the multifunction display.
The HOLD function is activated. You can
release the brake pedal.
X
i If depressing the brake pedal the first time
does not activate the HOLD function, wait
briefly and then try again.
Deactivating the HOLD function
The HOLD function is deactivated automatically
if:
Ryou depress the accelerator and the transmission is in position D or R.
Rthe transmission is in position P.
Ryou depress the brake pedal again with a certain amount of pressure until HOLD disappears
from the multifunction display.
Ryou secure the vehicle using the electric parking brake.
Ryou activate Distance Pilot DISTRONIC.
roads. RACE START must only be activated
and used on dedicated road circuits, outside
of public road use.
i RACE START is only available in
Mercedes‑AMG vehicles.
RACE START enables optimum acceleration
from a standing start. For this, a suitably highgrip road surface is required, along with the
tyres and vehicle being in good condition.
G WARNING
If you use RACE START, individual tyres may
get into a spin and the vehicle could skid.
Depending on the selected ESP® mode, there
is an increased risk of skidding and having an
accident. Make sure that no persons, animals
or obstacles are within range of the vehicle.
i Observe the safety notes on driving safety
systems (Y page 62).
Be sure to read the safety notes and information on ESP® (Y page 67).
i After a short period, the vehicle is secured
by the electric parking brake, thus relieving
the service brake.
Z
Driving and parking
Activation conditions
173
174
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Activation conditions
You can activate RACE START if:
Rthe doors are closed
Rthe engine is running and the engine and
transmission are at operating temperature.
This is the case when the oil temperature
gauge in the multifunction display is shown in
white (Y page 213).
RESP® is functioning correctly (Y page 67)
Rthe drive program S, S+ or Race is selected
(Y page 140)
Rthe steering wheel is in the straight-ahead
position
Rthe vehicle is stationary and the brake pedal is
depressed (left foot)
Rthe transmission is in position D
Activating RACE START
i When manual mode (Y page 147) is active,
the transmission automatically shifts up to
RACE START in the drive program. This function supports maximum acceleration with
RACE START. After going through an accelerating process once from a stationary position,
this function is automatically deactivated.
X Depress the brake pedal with your left foot
and keep it depressed.
X Pull and hold both steering wheel gearshift
paddles.
X The RACE START Confirm: Paddle UP
Cancel: Paddle DOWN message appears in
the multifunction display.
X Release both steering wheel gearshift paddles.
i If the activation conditions are no longer fulfilled, RACE START is cancelled. The RACE
START not possible See Owner's Man‐
ual message appears in the multifunction
display.
X To cancel: pull the left steering wheel shift
paddle (Y page 147).
or
X To confirm: pull the right steering wheel shift
paddle (Y page 147).
The RACE START available Depress
accelerator message appears in the multifunction display.
i If you do not depress the accelerator pedal
within a few seconds, RACE START is cancel-
led. The RACE START cancelled message
appears in the multifunction display.
X Fully depress the accelerator pedal.
The engine speed increases.
The RACE START Release brake to start
message appears in the multifunction display.
i If the brake pedal is not released after a
short while, RACE START is cancelled. The
RACE START cancelled message appears in
the multifunction display.
X Take your foot off the brake, but keep the
accelerator pedal depressed.
The vehicle pulls away at maximum acceleration.
The RACE START active message appears in
the multifunction display.
RACE START is deactivated when the vehicle
reaches a speed of approximately 50 km/h.
RACE START is deactivated immediately if you
release the accelerator pedal during RACE
START or if any of the activation conditions are
no longer fulfilled. The RACE START not pos‐
sible See Owner's Manual or RACE START
cancelled message appears in the multifunction display.
i After using it several times in short succession, RACE START will be unavailable until a
certain distance has been driven.
Adaptive Damping System
General notes
Suspension with the adaptive adjustable damping provides improved driving comfort and continuously controls the calibration of the dampers. The damping characteristics adapt to the
current operating and driving situation.
The damping is tuned individually to each wheel
and depends on:
Ryour driving style, e.g. sporty
Rthe road surface conditions
Rthe selected drive program (Y page 139).
Driving systems
In the Comfort and Economy drive programs,
the driving characteristics of your vehicle are
more comfortable. Select one of these drive
programs if you prefer a more comfortable driving style. Also select these drive programs when
driving fast on straight roads, e.g. on straight
stretches of motorway.
X Press DYNAMIC SELECT button : repeatedly until the Comfort or Economy drive program is selected.
Selecting Sport mode
The firmer setting of the suspension tuning in
the Sport drive program ensures even better
contact with the road. Select this drive program
when employing a sporty driving style, e.g. on
winding country roads.
X Press DYNAMIC SELECT button : as many
times as necessary until the Sport drive program is selected.
Selecting Sport Plus mode
The firmer suspension settings in the Sport
Plus drive program ensures even better contact
with the road. Select this mode when employing
a sporty driving style, e.g. on winding country
roads or, ideally, when driving on closed race
circuits.
X Press DYNAMIC SELECT button : as many
times as necessary until the Sport Plus drive
program is selected.
Activating the driving dynamics display
Using the driving dynamics display in the multimedia system display, you can see the drive
program you selected as well as additional information on the vehicle's operating state.
X Switch on the multimedia system. You can
find further information in the separate
COMAND Online operating instructions.
X Press button : .
The driving dynamics display appears in the
multimedia system display.
The following information on the vehicle's operating status is displayed in the driving dynamics
display:
RDrive program selected (Y page 139)
RAccelerator pedal position shown in %
RBrake pedal position shown in %
RSteering angle
RDamping setting selected
RG-FORCE cross displaying longitudinal and
lateral acceleration (only available in Sport or
Sport Plus drive programs)
Active Body Control ABC (except
Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Setting the vehicle level
General notes
The vehicle level can be set using the DYNAMIC
SELECT button (Y page 139) or the level button.
The setting always corresponds to the last
selected function.
In order to reduce fuel consumption and
improve the driving dynamics, the vehicle is lowered as its speed increases. In the Sport and
Sport Plus drive programs, it is lowered by up to
Z
Driving and parking
Selecting the Comfort or Economy drive
programs
175
176
Driving systems
Driving and parking
13 mm compared to the normal vehicle level. In
the Comfort and CURVE drive programs, it is
lowered by up to 5 mm compared to the normal
vehicle level. As the speed is reduced, the vehicle is raised to the set vehicle height.
Select the normal level for normal road surfaces
and the raised level for driving with snow chains
or on particularly poor road surfaces.
Setting the raised level
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The vehicle is slightly lowered if you:
Rhave
selected the SPORT suspension tuning at normal level and
Rswitch off the engine
Persons in the vicinity of the wheel arch or the
underbody may thus become trapped. There
is a risk of injury.
Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity of the
wheel arch or the underbody when you switch
off the engine.
! When the engine is switched off, the vehicle
is lowered if SPORT suspension tuning has
been selected at the normal level. The vehicle
is automatically lowered by approximately
10 mm. Make sure when parking that you
position your vehicle so that it does not make
contact with the kerb as the vehicle is lowered. Your vehicle could otherwise be damaged.
Make sure that the engine is running or that it
has been switched off by the ECO start/stop
function.
X Make sure that a speed of 120 km/h is not
exceeded.
X If indicator lamp ; is not lit: press button :.
If the engine has been switched off by the ECO
start/stop function, it is now restarted.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. The vehicle is
raised by 50 mm.
X
Setting the normal level
Make sure that the engine is running or that it
has been switched off by the ECO start/stop
function.
X If indicator lamp ; is lit: press button :.
Indicator lamp ; goes out. The vehicle is
adjusted to the normal level.
The "Raised level" setting is cancelled if you:
Rdrive faster than approximately 120 km/h
Rdrive for approximately three minutes at a
speed over 80 km/h
Ror switch to the drive program while the vehicle is in motion.
X
Suspension settings
General notes
The electro-hydraulically controlled suspension
features improved driving dynamics, driving
safety and ride comfort. You can also choose
between a sporty, a particularly sporty, a comfortable and a comfortable mode with cornering
function (CURVE).
Driving systems
Selecting Comfort mode
In the Comfort drive program, the driving characteristics of your vehicle are more comfortable. Select this mode if you prefer a more comfortable driving style.
X Press DYNAMIC SELECT button : as many
times as necessary until the Comfort drive
program is selected.
Selecting the CURVE setting
In the CURVE drive program, the curve tilting
function is activated. The vehicle inclines
inwards by up to 2.65 degrees on bends. The tilt
function and the comfort suspension tuning
increase driving comfort in corners. CURVE is
available in the speed range between 15 km/h
and 180 km/h. Select this mode on winding
roads in particular. Outside this speed range,
the CURVE drive program is the same as the
Comfort drive program.
The curve tilting function monitors the area in
front of your vehicle by means of a camera
attached at the top of the windscreen. This function is automatically active if you select the
CURVE drive program. The system is operational at speeds of up to 180 km/h.
X Press DYNAMIC SELECT button : as many
times as necessary until the CURVE drive
program is selected.
The system is deactivated if you select a different drive program.
The system may be impaired or may not function
if:
Rif you are driving slower than 15 km/h or
faster than 180 km/h.
Rif the vehicle is fully laden.
Rif you drive with very high lateral acceleration.
Activating the driving dynamics display
Selecting Sport mode
The firmer setting of the suspension tuning in
the Sport drive program ensures even better
contact with the road. Select this mode if you
prefer a firmer suspension setting.
X Press DYNAMIC SELECT button : as many
times as necessary until the Sport drive program is selected.
Selecting Sport Plus mode
The firmer setting of the suspension tuning in
the Sport Plus drive program ensures even better contact with the road. Select this mode if you
prefer a firmer suspension setting.
X Press DYNAMIC SELECT button : as many
times as necessary until the Sport Plus drive
program is selected.
Using the driving dynamics display in the multimedia system display, you can see the drive
program you selected as well as additional information on the vehicle's operating state.
Z
Driving and parking
The suspension is continuously tuned to each
wheel individually and depends on:
Rthe road surface condition, e.g. bumps
Rthe vehicle load
Rthe drive program selected
If the ignition is switched off for less than four
hours, the previously selected drive program is
activated when the engine is next started. If the
ignition is switched off for more than four hours,
the Comfort drive program is activated when
the engine is next started.
177
Driving systems
178
Switch on the multimedia system. You can
find further information in the separate
COMAND Online operating instructions.
X Press button : .
The driving dynamics display appears in the
multimedia system display.
The following information on the vehicle's operating status is displayed in the driving dynamics
display:
RDrive program selected (Y page 139)
RAccelerator pedal position shown in %
RBrake pedal position shown in %
RSteering angle
RActivity of the ABC spring struts
RVehicle level display (Y page 175)
RLevel settings animation
RG-FORCE cross displaying longitudinal and
lateral acceleration (only available in Sport or
Sport Plus drive programs)
Driving and parking
X
Active Body Control ABC (MercedesAMG vehicles)
Important safety notes
The vehicle is slightly lowered when the engine
is switched off.
G WARNING
People's limbs may become trapped if they
are located underneath the vehicle or
between the vehicle body and the tyres when
the vehicle is lowering. There is a danger of
injury.
When lowering the vehicle, make sure no one
is underneath the vehicle or in the immediate
vicinity of the wheel arches.
! If you have selected the normal level and
switched the engine off, the vehicle is lowered. The vehicle is automatically lowered by
approximately 10 mm. Make sure when parking that you position your vehicle so that it
does not make contact with the kerb as the
vehicle is lowered. Your vehicle could otherwise be damaged.
Setting the raised level
Setting the vehicle level
General notes
The vehicle level can be set using the DYNAMIC
SELECT controller (Y page 140) or the on-board
computer (Y page 178). The setting always corresponds to the last selected function.
In order to reduce fuel consumption and
improve the driving dynamics, the vehicle is lowered as its speed increases. In the Sport and
Sport Plus drive programs it is lowered by up to
13 mm, and in the Comfort drive program by up
to 5 mm compared to the normal vehicle level.
As the speed is reduced, the vehicle is raised to
the set vehicle height.
If the ignition is switched off for less than four
hours, the previously selected drive program is
activated when the engine is next started. If the
ignition is switched off for more than four hours,
the Comfort drive program is activated when
the engine is next started.
Select the normal level for normal road surfaces
and the raised level for driving with snow chains
or on particularly poor road surfaces.
Make sure that the engine is running or that it
has been switched off by the ECO start/stop
function.
X Make sure that a speed of 120 km/h is not
exceeded.
X If symbol ; is not shown: press =
or ; on the steering wheel to select the
Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Vehicle level.
level
X Press the a button.
The following message appears: : Vehicle
level Raise with OK.
OK
X Press the a button.
If the engine has been switched off by the ECO
start/stop function, it is now restarted.
X
Driving systems
Adjusting to normal level
Your selection remains stored even if you
remove the key from the ignition lock.
If the ignition is switched off for less than four
hours, the previously selected setting is activated when the engine is next started. If the ignition is switched off for more than four hours, the
comfortable setting is activated when the
engine is next started.
Driving and parking
Symbol ; appears. The vehicle height is
adjusted to the raised level.
Selecting the sporty setting
Make sure that the engine is running or that it
has been switched off by the ECO start/stop
function.
X If symbol ; is shown: press = or ;
on the steering wheel to select the Assist.
menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Vehicle level.
level
X Press the a button.
The following message appears: : Vehicle
level Lower with OK.
OK
X Press the a button.
Symbol ; is faded out. The vehicle is adjusted to the normal level.
The "Raised level" setting is cancelled if you:
Rdrive faster than approximately 120 km/h.
Rdrive for approximately three minutes at a
speed over 80 km/h.
Ror switch to the drive program while the vehicle is in motion.
X
The firmer setting of the suspension tuning in
sports mode ensures even better contact with
the road. Select this mode if you prefer a firmer
suspension setting.
X Make sure that the engine is running or that it
has been switched off by the ECO start/stop
function.
X If indicator lamp ; is not lit: press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. The sports suspension setting is selected.
The AMG Ride Control SPORT message
appears in the multifunction display.
Selecting the comfort setting
Suspension settings
General notes
The electro-hydraulically controlled suspension
features improved driving dynamics, driving
safety and ride comfort. You can also choose
between a particularly sporty or a comfortable
tuning.
The suspension is continuously adjusted for
each wheel individually and depends on:
Rthe road surface condition, e.g. bumps
Rthe vehicle load
Rthe drive program selected
179
In comfort mode, the driving characteristics of
your vehicle are more comfortable. Select this
Z
Driving and parking
180
Driving systems
mode if you prefer a more comfortable driving
style.
X Make sure that the engine is running or that it
has been switched off by the ECO start/stop
function.
X If indicator lamp ; is lit: press button :.
Indicator lamp ; goes out. The comfortable
suspension setting is selected.
The AMG Ride Control COMFORT message
appears in the multifunction display.
Activating the driving dynamics display
in the COMAND display
Using the driving dynamics display in the multimedia system display, you can see the drive
program you selected as well as additional information on the vehicle's operating status.
X Switch on COMAND Online. You can find further information in the separate COMAND
Online operating instructions.
The following information on the vehicle's operating status is displayed in the driving dynamics
display:
RDrive program selected (Y page 140)
RAccelerator pedal position shown in %
RBrake pedal position shown in %
RSteering angle
RVehicle level display (Y page 178)
RActivity of the ABC spring struts
RLevel settings animation
RG-FORCE cross to display longitudinal and lateral acceleration (only available in Sport,
Sport Plus and RACE drive programs)
ROverrun mode animation
there are no persons, animals or objects in
range while manoeuvring and parking.
! When parking, pay particular attention to
objects above or below the sensors, such as
flower pots or trailer drawbars. PARKTRONIC
does not detect such objects when they are in
the immediate vicinity of the vehicle. You
could damage the vehicle or the objects.
The sensors may not detect snow and objects
which absorb ultrasonic sources.
Ultrasonic sources, such as an automatic car
wash, a lorry's compressed-air brakes or a
pneumatic drill, could cause PARKTRONIC to
malfunction.
PARKTRONIC may not function correctly on
uneven terrain.
PARKTRONIC is activated automatically when
you:
Rswitch on the ignition
Rshift the transmission to position D, R or N
Rrelease the electric parking brake
PARKTRONIC is deactivated at speeds above
18 km/h. It is reactivated at lower speeds.
Range of the sensors
General notes
PARKTRONIC does not take into account obstacles located:
Rbelow the detection range, e.g. persons, animals or objects
Rabove the detection range, e.g. overhanging
loads, tail sections or loading ramps of goods
vehicles
PARKTRONIC
Important safety notes
PARKTRONIC is an electronic parking aid with
ultrasonic sensors. It monitors the area around
your vehicle using six sensors in the front
bumper and six sensors in the rear bumper.
PARKTRONIC indicates visually and audibly the
distance between your vehicle and an object.
PARKTRONIC is only an aid. It is not a substitute
for your attention to the immediate surroundings. The responsibility for safe manoeuvring
and parking remains with you. Make sure that
: Example: sensors in the front bumper, left-
hand side
The sensors must be free of dirt, ice and slush.
Otherwise, they may not function correctly.
Driving systems
Clean the sensors regularly, taking care not to
scratch or damage them (Y page 285).
181
Warning displays
Warning display for the front area
: Segments on the left-hand side of the vehi-
cle
; Segments on the right-hand side of the vehi-
cle
= Segments showing operational readiness
Front sensors
Centre
Approx. 100 cm
Corners
Approx. 60 cm
Rear sensors
Centre
Approx. 120 cm
Corners
Approx. 80 cm
Minimum distance
Centre
Approx. 20 cm
Corners
Approx. 15 cm
If there is an obstacle within this range, the relevant warning displays light up and a warning
tone sounds. If the distance falls below the minimum, the distance may no longer be shown.
The warning displays show the distance
between the sensors and the obstacle. The
warning display for the front area is located on
the dashboard above the centre air vents. The
warning display for the rear area is located on
the cover behind the seats in the rear compartment.
The warning display for each side of the vehicle
is divided into five yellow and two red segments.
PARKTRONIC is operational if yellow segments
showing operational readiness = light up.
The selected transmission position and the
direction in which the vehicle is rolling determine which warning display is active when the
engine is running.
Transmission posi- Warning display
tion
D
Front area activated
R, N or the vehicle is Rear and front areas
activated
rolling backwards
P
No areas activated
One or more segments light up as the vehicle
approaches an obstacle, depending on the vehicle's distance from the obstacle.
Z
Driving and parking
range
Driving and parking
182
Driving systems
From the:
Rsixth segment onwards, you will hear an intermittent warning tone for approximately two
seconds.
Rseventh segment onwards, you will hear a
warning tone for approximately two seconds.
This indicates that you have now reached the
minimum distance.
Deactivating/activating PARKTRONIC
: Deactivating/activating PARKTRONIC
; Indicator lamp
If indicator lamp ; lights up, PARKTRONIC is
deactivated. Active Parking Assist is then also
deactivated.
i PARKTRONIC is automatically activated
when you turn the key to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
Driving systems
183
Problems with PARKTRONIC
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Only the red segments in PARKTRONIC has malfunctioned and has switched off.
the PARKTRONIC warn- X If problems persist, have PARKTRONIC checked at a qualified speing displays are lit. You
cialist workshop.
also hear a warning tone
for approximately two
seconds.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated after approximately five seconds,
and the indicator lamp in
the PARKTRONIC button
lights up.
Only the red segments in The PARKTRONIC sensors are dirty or there is interference.
the PARKTRONIC warn- X Clean the PARKTRONIC sensors (Y page 285).
ing displays are lit.
X Switch the ignition back on.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated after approxThe problem may be caused by an external source of radio or ultraimately five seconds.
sound waves.
X See if PARKTRONIC functions in a different location.
Active Parking Assist
General notes
Active Parking Assist is an electronic parking aid
with ultrasound. It measures the road on both
sides of the vehicle. A parking symbol indicates
a suitable parking space. Active steering intervention can assist you during manoeuvring and
parking. You may also use PARKTRONIC
(Y page 180).
Important safety notes
Active Parking Assist is only an aid. It is not a
substitute for your attention to the immediate
surroundings. The responsibility for safe
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that no persons, animals or objects
are in the manoeuvring range.
When PARKTRONIC is deactivated, Active Parking Assist is also unavailable.
G WARNING
While parking or pulling out of a parking
space, the vehicle swings out and can drive
onto areas of the oncoming lane. This could
cause you to collide with other road users.
There is a risk of an accident.
Pay attention to other road users. Stop the
vehicle if necessary or cancel the Active Parking Assist parking procedure.
! If unavoidable, you should drive over obsta-
cles such as kerbs slowly and not at a sharp
angle. Otherwise, you may damage the
wheels or tyres.
Active Parking Assist may also display spaces
not suitable for parking, e.g.:
Rparking or stopping restrictions
Rin front of driveways or entrances and exits
Runsuitable surfaces
Parking tips:
Ron narrow roads, drive as closely as possible
past the parking space
Rparking spaces that are littered or overgrown
might be identified or measured incorrectly
Rparking spaces that are partially occupied by
trailer drawbars might not be identified as
such or be measured incorrectly
Z
Driving and parking
Problem
184
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Rsnowfall
or heavy rain may lead to a parking
space being measured inaccurately
Rpay attention to the PARKTRONIC
(Y page 181) warning messages during the
parking procedure
Rat any time, you can intervene in the steering
procedure to correct it. Active Parking Assist
will then be cancelled.
Rwhen transporting a load which protrudes
from your vehicle, you should not use Active
Parking Assist
Rnever use Active Parking Assist when snow
chains are fitted
Rmake sure that the tyre pressures are always
correct. This has a direct influence on the
parking characteristics of the vehicle
Use Active Parking Assist for parking spaces
that are:
Rparallel or at right angles to the direction of
travel
Ron straight roads, not bends
Ron the same level as the road, e.g. not on the
pavement
Active Parking Assist does not assist you parking in spaces at right angles to the direction of
travel if:
Rtwo parking spaces are located directly next
to one another
Rthe parking space is directly next to a low
obstacle such as a low kerb
Ryou forward park
Active Parking Assist does not assist you parking in spaces that are parallel or at right angles
to the direction of travel if:
Rthe parking space is on a kerb
Rthe system reads the parking space as being
blocked, for example by foliage or grass paving blocks
Rthe area is too small for the vehicle to
manoeuvre into
Rthe parking space is bordered by an obstacle,
e.g. a tree, a post or a trailer
Detecting parking spaces
Objects located above the height range of Active
Parking Assist will not be detected when the
parking space is measured. These are not taken
into account when the parking procedure is calculated, e.g. overhanging loads, tail sections or
loading ramps of goods vehicles.
G WARNING
If objects are located above the detection
range, Active Parking Assist may start to steer
into the parking space too soon. As a result,
you could cause a collision. There is a risk of
an accident.
If objects are located above the detection
range, stop the vehicle and switch Active
Parking Assist off.
For further information on the detection range
(Y page 180).
: Detected parking space on the left
; Parking symbol
= Detected parking space on the right
Active Parking Assist is activated automatically
when driving forwards. The system is operational at speeds of up to approximately
35 km/h. While in operation, the system independently locates and measures parking spaces
on both sides of the vehicle.
Active Parking Assist will only detect parking
spaces:
Rparallel or at right angles to the direction of
travel
Rthat are parallel to the direction of travel and
are at least 1.5 m wide
Rthat are parallel to the direction of travel and
at least 1.0 m longer than your vehicle
Rthat are at right angles to the direction of
travel and at least 1.0 m wider than your vehicle
i Note that Active Parking Assist cannot
measure the size of a parking space if it is at
right angles to the direction of travel. You will
Driving systems
Parking
G WARNING
Active Parking Assist merely aids you by intervening actively in the steering. There is a risk
of accident if you do not apply the brakes
yourself.
Always apply the brakes yourself when parking and manoeuvring.
Stop the vehicle when the parking symbol
shows the desired parking space in the instrument cluster.
X Shift the transmission to position R.
The Start Park Assist? Yes: OK No:
% message appears in the multifunction
display.
X To cancel the procedure: press the %
button on the multifunction steering wheel or
pull away.
or
X To park using Active Parking Assist: press
the a button on the multifunction steering
wheel.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
X Release the multifunction steering wheel.
X Reverse the vehicle, being ready to brake at
all times. When reversing, drive at a speed
X
below 10 km/h. Otherwise, Active Parking
Assist will be cancelled.
X Stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
Manoeuvring may be required in tight parking
spaces.
The Park Assist active Select D
Observe surroundings message appears in
the multifunction display.
X Shift the transmission to position D while the
vehicle is stationary.
Active Parking Assist immediately steers in
the other direction.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
i You will achieve the best results by waiting
for the steering procedure to complete before
pulling away.
X Drive forwards and be ready to brake at all
times.
X Stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
The Park Assist active Select R
Observe surroundings message appears in
the multifunction display.
As soon as the parking procedure is complete,
the Park Assist switched off message
appears in the multifunction display and a warning tone sounds. The vehicle is now parked.
Active Parking Assist no longer supports you
with steering interventions. When Active Parking Assist is finished, you must steer again yourself. PARKTRONIC is still available.
Parking tips:
RThe way your vehicle is positioned in the parking space after parking is dependent on various factors. These include the position and
shape of the vehicles parked in front and
behind it and the conditions of the location. It
may be the case that Active Parking Assist
guides you too far into a parking space, or not
far enough into it. In some cases, it may also
lead you across or onto the kerb. If necessary,
you should cancel the parking procedure with
Active Parking Assist.
RYou can also preselect transmission position
D. The vehicle redirects and does not drive as
far into the parking space. Should the transmission change take place too early, the parking procedure will be cancelled. A sensible
Z
Driving and parking
need to judge whether your vehicle will fit in
the parking space.
When driving at speeds below 30 km/h, you will
see parking symbol ; as a status indicator in
the instrument cluster. When a parking space
has been detected, an arrow towards the right or
the left also appears. Active Parking Assist only
displays parking spaces on the front-passenger
side as standard. Parking spaces on the driver's
side are displayed as soon as the turn signal on
the driver's side is activated. When parking on
the driver's side, this must remain activated
until you confirm the use of Active Parking Assist
by pressing the a button on the multifunction steering wheel. The system automatically
determines whether the parking space is parallel or at right angles to the direction of travel.
A parking space is displayed while you are driving past it, and until you are approximately 15 m
away from it.
185
186
Driving systems
parking position can no longer be achieved
from this position.
Driving and parking
Exiting a parking space
In order that Active Parking Assist can assist you
when exiting the parking space:
Rthe border of the parking space must be high
enough at the front and the rear. A kerb stone
is too small, for example.
Rthe border of the parking space must not be
too wide, as the position of the vehicle must
not exceed an angle of 45° to the starting
position as it is manoeuvred into the parking
space.
Ra manoeuvring distance of at least 1.0 m must
be available.
Active Parking Assist can only assist you with
exiting a parking space if you have parked the
vehicle parallel to the direction of travel using
Active Parking Assist.
X Start the engine.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch on the turn signal in the direction you
will drive out of the parking space.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R.
The Start Park Assist? Yes: OK No:
message appears in the multifunction display
%.
X To cancel the procedure: press the %
button on the multifunction steering wheel or
pull away.
or
X To exit a parking space using Active Parking Assist: press the a button on the multifunction steering wheel.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
X Release the multifunction steering wheel.
X Pull away, being ready to brake at all times. Do
not exceed a maximum speed of approximately 10 km/h when exiting a parking
space. Otherwise, Active Parking Assist will
be cancelled.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R as
required or according to the message while
the vehicle is stationary.
Active Parking Assist immediately steers in
the other direction. The Park Assist
active Accelerate and brake Observe
surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
i You will achieve the best results by waiting
for the steering procedure to complete before
pulling away.
If you reverse after activation, the steering
wheel is moved to the straight-ahead position.
X Drive forwards and reverse as prompted by
the PARKTRONIC warning displays, several
times if necessary.
Once you have exited the parking space completely, the steering wheel is moved to the
straight-ahead position. You hear a tone and the
Park Assist switched off message appears
in the multifunction display. You will then have
to steer and merge into traffic on your own.
PARKTRONIC is still available. You can take over
the steering before the vehicle has exited the
parking space completely. This is useful, for
example, when you recognise that it is already
possible to pull out of the parking space.
Cancelling Active Parking Assist
You can cancel Active Parking Assist at any
time.
X Stop the movement of the multifunction
steering wheel or steer yourself.
Active Parking Assist will be cancelled at
once. The Park Assist cancelled message appears in the multifunction display.
or
X Press the PARKTRONIC button on the centre
console (Y page 182).
PARKTRONIC is switched off and Active Parking Assist is immediately cancelled. The
Park Assist cancelled message appears
in the multifunction display.
Active Parking Assist is cancelled automatically
if:
Rparking using Active Parking Assist is no longer possible
Ryou are driving faster than 10 km/h
Ra wheel spins and ESP® intervenes or fails.
The ÷ ESP® warning lamp lights up in the
instrument cluster.
A warning tone sounds. The parking symbol
goes out and the Park Assist cancelled
message appears in the multifunction display.
Driving systems
Reversing camera
General notes
Rif
the camera lens is dirty or obstructed.
Observe the notes on cleaning
(Y page 285)
Rif the rear of your vehicle is damaged. In this
case, have the camera position and setting
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
The field of vision and other functions of the
reversing camera may be restricted due to additional accessories on the rear of the vehicle (e.g.
licence plate holder, bicycle rack).
For technical reasons, leaving the standard
height can result in inaccuracies in the guide
lines on vehicles with a height-adjustable chassis.
Activating/deactivating the reversing
camera
To activate: make sure that the key is in
position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Make sure that the Activation by R gear
function is selected in the multimedia system;
see the Digital Owner's Manual.
X Engage reverse gear.
The multimedia system shows the area
behind the vehicle with guide lines.
The image from the reversing camera is available throughout the manoeuvring process.
To deactivate: the reversing camera deactivates if you shift the transmission to P or after
driving forwards a short distance.
X
Reversing camera : is an optical parking and
manoeuvring aid. It shows the area behind your
vehicle with guide lines in the multimedia system.
The area behind the vehicle is displayed as a
mirror image, as in the rear-view mirror.
i The text shown in the multimedia system
display depends on the language setting. The
following are examples of reversing camera
messages in the multimedia system.
Important safety notes
The reversing camera is only an aid. It is not a
substitute for your attention to the immediate
surroundings. The responsibility for safe
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that there are no persons, animals or
objects in range while manoeuvring and parking.
Under the following circumstances, the reversing camera will not function, or will function in a
limited manner:
Rif the boot lid is open
Rin heavy rain, snow or fog
Rat night or in very dark places
Rif the camera is exposed to very bright light
Rif the area is lit by fluorescent bulbs or LED
lighting (the display may flicker)
Rif there is a sudden change in temperature,
e.g. when driving into a heated garage in winter
Displays in the multimedia system
The reversing camera may show a distorted view
of obstacles or show them incorrectly or not at
all. Obstacles are not shown by the reversing
camera in the following locations:
Rvery close to the rear bumper
Runder the rear bumper
Rin the area immediately above the handle on
the boot lid
! Objects not at ground level may appear to
be further away than they actually are, e.g.:
bumper of a parked vehicle
Rthe drawbar of a trailer
Rthe ball coupling of a trailer tow hitch
Rthe rear section of an HGV
Ra slanted post
Rthe
Z
Driving and parking
When Active Parking Assist is cancelled, you
must steer again yourself.
187
188
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Use the guidelines only for orientation.
Approach objects no further than the bottommost guideline.
: Front warning display
; Additional PARKTRONIC measurement
operational readiness indicator
: Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 4.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
; White guide line without turning the steering
wheel, vehicle width including the exterior
mirrors (static)
= Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
including the exterior mirrors, for current
steering wheel angle (dynamic)
? Yellow lane marking the course the tyres will
take at the current steering wheel angle
(dynamic)
= Rear warning display
Vehicles with PARKTRONIC: when
PARKTRONIC is operational (Y page 181), additional measurement operational readiness indicator ; appears in the multimedia system. If
the PARKTRONIC warning displays are active or
light up, warning displays : and = are also
active or light up correspondingly in the multimedia system.
"Reverse parking" function
Reversing straight into a parking space
without turning the steering wheel
A Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 1.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
B Vehicle centre axis (locating aid)
C Bumper
D Red guide line at a distance of approximately
0.30 m from the rear of the vehicle
The guide lines are shown when the transmission is in position R.
The distance specifications only apply to
objects that are at ground level.
: White guide line without turning the steering
wheel, vehicle width including the exterior
mirrors (static)
; Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
including the exterior mirrors, for current
steering wheel angle (dynamic)
= Yellow guide line at a distance of approximately 1.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
? Red guide line at a distance of approximately
0.30 m from the rear of the vehicle
Driving systems
Make sure that the reversing camera is
switched on (Y page 187).
The lane and the guide lines are shown.
X With the help of white guide line :, check
whether the vehicle will fit into the parking
space.
X Using white guide line : as a guide, carefully
reverse until you reach the end position.
Red guide line ? is then at the end of the
parking space. The vehicle is almost parallel
in the parking space.
189
Reverse perpendicular parking with the
steering wheel at an angle
: Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
including the exterior mirrors, for current
steering wheel angle (dynamic)
X Stop the vehicle when it is almost exactly in
front of the parking space.
The white lane should be as close to parallel
with the parking space marking as possible.
: Parking space marking
; Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
including the exterior mirrors, for current
steering wheel angle (dynamic)
X Drive past the parking space and bring the
vehicle to a standstill.
X Make sure that the reversing camera is
switched on (Y page 187).
The lane and the guide lines are shown.
X While the vehicle is at a standstill, turn the
steering wheel in the direction of the parking
space until yellow guide line ; reaches parking space marking :.
X Keep the steering wheel in that position and
reverse carefully.
: White guide line at current steering wheel
angle
; Parking space marking
X
Turn the steering wheel to the centre position
while the vehicle is stationary.
Z
Driving and parking
X
Driving systems
190
ATTENTION ASSIST
Driving and parking
General notes
ATTENTION ASSIST helps you during long,
monotonous journeys such as on motorways
and trunk roads. It is active in the 60 km/h to
200 km/h speed range. If ATTENTION ASSIST
detects typical indicators of fatigue or increasing lapses in concentration on the part of the
driver, it suggests taking a break.
: Red guide line at a distance of approximately
0.30 m from the rear of the vehicle
; White guide line without turning the steering
wheel
= End of parking space
X
Reverse carefully until you have reached the
end position.
Red guide line : is then at the end of parking
space =. The vehicle is almost parallel in the
parking space.
180° view
: Symbol for the 180° view function
; Own vehicle
= PARKTRONIC warning displays
You can also use the reversing camera to select
a 180° view.
When PARKTRONIC is operational (Y page 181),
a symbol for your own vehicle appears in the
multimedia system. If the PARKTRONIC warning
displays are active, warning displays = light up
in the multimedia system in yellow or red
accordingly.
Important safety notes
ATTENTION ASSIST is only an aid. It may not
always detect fatigue or lapses in concentration
until too late, or may not detect them at all. The
system is not a substitute for a well-rested and
attentive driver.
The functionality of ATTENTION ASSIST is
restricted, and warnings may be delayed or not
occur at all:
Rif the length of the journey is less than approximately 30 minutes
Rif the road condition is poor, e.g. if the surface
is uneven or if there are potholes
Rif there is a strong side wind
Rif you have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds or high rates of acceleration
Rif you are predominantly driving at a speed
below 60 km/h or above 200 km/h
Rif you are driving with the Steering Pilot of
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC activated
Rif the time has been set incorrectly
Rin active driving situations, such as when you
change lanes or change your speed
The evaluation of your attention level is deleted
and restarted when continuing the journey, if:
Ryou switch off the engine
Ryou take off your seat belt and open the driver's door, e.g. for a change of drivers or to
take a break
Driving systems
Displaying the attention level
191
corresponds to the last selection activated
(standard/sensitive).
You can have current status information displayed in the assistance menu (Y page 207) of
the on-board computer.
X Select the assistance graphic display for
ATTENTION ASSIST using the on-board computer (Y page 207).
The following information is displayed:
Rthe length of the journey since the last break
Rthe attention level determined by ATTENTION
ASSIST, displayed in a bar display in five levels
from high to low
Rif ATTENTION ASSIST is unable to calculate
the attention level and cannot output a warning, the System suspended message
appears. The bar display then changes the
display, e.g. if you are driving at a speed below
60 km/h or above 200 km/h.
Activating ATTENTION ASSIST
Activate ATTENTION ASSIST using the onboard computer (Y page 208).
The system determines the attention level of
the driver depending on the setting selected:
Standard selected: the sensitivity with which
the system determines the attention level is set
to normal.
Sensitive selected: the sensitivity is set higher.
The attention level detected by ATTENTION
ASSIST is adapted accordingly and the driver is
warned earlier.
When ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated, the
À symbol and OFF appear in the multifunction display in the assistance graphics display
when the engine is running.
When ATTENTION ASSIST has been deactivated,
it is automatically reactivated after the engine
has been switched off. The sensitivity selected
If fatigue or increasing lapses in concentration
are detected, a warning appears in the multifunction display: Attention Assist: Take a
break!
In addition to the message shown in the multifunction display, you will then hear a warning
tone.
X If necessary, take a break.
X Confirm the message by pressing the a
button on the steering wheel.
On long journeys, take regular breaks in good
time to allow yourself to rest. If you do not take
a break, you will be warned again after
15 minutes at the earliest. This will only happen
if ATTENTION ASSIST still detects typical indicators of fatigue or increasing lapses in concentration.
Vehicles with COMAND Online: if a warning is
output in the multifunction display, a service
station search is performed in COMAND Online.
You can select a service station and navigation
to this service station will then begin. This function can be activated and deactivated in
COMAND Online.
Traffic Sign Assist
General notes
X
Traffic Sign Assist displays the maximum speed
permitted and overtaking restrictions to the
driver in the instrument cluster. Driving onto a
section of road in the wrong direction triggers a
warning. Traffic Sign Assist detects traffic signs
with camera system : attached behind the top
Z
Driving and parking
Warning in the multifunction display
Driving and parking
192
Driving systems
of the windscreen. The data and general traffic
regulations stored in the navigation system are
also used to determine the current speed limit.
If a traffic sign that is relevant to your vehicle is
passed, the display of the speed limits and overtaking restrictions is updated.
The display can also be updated without a visible
traffic sign if:
Rthe vehicle changes roads (e.g. motorway exit
or slip road)
Ra village or town boundary is passed which is
stored in the digital map
Rthe last traffic sign detected by the camera
has not been repeated
If a sign indicating the end of a restriction (speed
limit or overtaking restriction) is passed, the
sign is displayed for five seconds. The currently
applicable traffic regulation continues to be
shown in the assistance graphic display.
The camera also detects traffic signs with a
restriction indicated by an additional sign (e.g. in
wet conditions).
The traffic signs are only displayed with the
restrictions if:
Rthe regulation must be observed with the
restriction, or
RTraffic Sign Assist is unable to determine
whether the restriction applies
If Traffic Sign Assist is unable to determine a
maximum permitted speed from any of the available sources, no speed limit is displayed in the
instrument cluster either.
The system may be either functionally impaired
or temporarily unavailable if:
Rvisibility is poor, e.g. due to snow, rain, fog or
spray
Rthere is glare, e.g. from the sun being low in
the sky
Rthere is dirt, ice or misting on the windscreen
in the vicinity of the camera
Rtraffic signs are hard to detect (dirt, ice, snow)
Rthe traffic signs are insufficiently lit at night
Rsigns are ambiguous (e.g. traffic signs on construction sites or in adjacent lanes)
Rthe information in the digital street map of the
navigation system is incorrect or out of date
Switching the message function on/off
If you have activated the Traffic Sign Assist display in the on-board computer, the traffic regulations (speed limits and overtaking restrictions)
are displayed in the instrument cluster for five
seconds respectively. The wrong-way warning
and the traffic sign display for speed limits and
overtaking restrictions remain active even when
the display has been deactivated.
X Switch on the Traffic Sign Assist message
function via the on-board computer
(Y page 207).
Instrument cluster display
Showing the assistance graphic
Call up the assistance graphics display function using the on-board computer
(Y page 207).
X Select the Traffic Sign Assist display.
Detected traffic signs are displayed in the
instrument cluster.
X
Traffic Sign Assist is not available in all countries. In this case, symbol : is shown in the
assistance graphic display (Y page 207).
Important safety notes
Traffic Sign Assist is only an aid and is not always
able to correctly display speed limits and overtaking restrictions. Traffic signs always have priority over the Traffic Sign Assist display.
Driving systems
Speed limit with unknown restriction
193
Active Blind Spot Assist
: Maximum permitted speed
; Maximum permitted speed for vehicles for
which the restriction in the additional sign is
relevant
= Additional sign for unknown restriction
A maximum permitted speed of 80 km/h
(80 mph) and a speed limit of 60 km/h (60 mph)
with an unknown restriction apply.
No entry (wrong-way warning)
Important safety notes
Active Blind Spot Assist is only an aid and is not
a substitute for attentive driving.
G WARNING
Active Blind Spot Assist does not react to
vehicles:
Rovertaking
If no entry signs are passed, a warning message
is displayed in the instrument cluster should
Traffic Sign Assist detect that you are driving in
the wrong direction. You will then also hear a
warning tone. You should immediately check
your direction of travel in order to avoid danger
to yourself and other road users.
i This function is not available in all countries.
too closely on the side, placing
them in the blind spot area
Rif the difference in the speed of approach
and overtaking is too great
As a result, Active Blind Spot Assist may neither give warnings nor intervene in such situations. There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and maintain a safe distance at the side
of the vehicle.
Radar sensors
Active Driving Assistance package
General notes
The Active Driving Assistance package consists
of Distance Pilot DISTRONIC (Y page 161),
Steering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot, Active Blind
Spot Assist (Y page 193) and Active Lane Keeping Assist (Y page 195).
The radar sensors for Active Blind Spot Assist
are integrated in the rear bumper and in the
radiator trim. Make sure that the bumpers and
radiator trim are free from dirt, ice and slush.
The rear sensors must not be covered, e.g. by
bicycle racks or overhanging loads. Following a
severe impact or in the event of damage to the
bumpers, have the function of the radar sensors
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Active Blind Spot Assist may otherwise no longer function properly.
Z
Driving and parking
General notes
Active Blind Spot Assist monitors the areas on
either side of the vehicle that are not directly
visible to the driver with two lateral, rear-facing
radar sensors. A warning light in the exterior
mirrors draws your attention to vehicles detected in the monitored area. If you then switch on
the corresponding turn signal to change lanes,
you will also receive a visual and audible collision warning. If a risk of side impact is detected,
corrective braking may help you avoid a collision. Active Blind Spot Assist evaluates the free
space in the direction of travel and to the side
before making a course-correcting brake application. For this, Active Blind Spot Assist uses
the forward-facing radar sensors.
Active Blind Spot Assist supports you from a
speed of approximately 30 km/h.
194
Driving systems
Monitoring range
Driving and parking
G WARNING
Active Blind Spot Assist does not detect all
traffic situations and road users. There is a
risk of an accident.
Always make sure that there is sufficient distance to the side for other traffic or obstacles.
Due to the nature of the system:
Rwarnings may be issued in error when driving
close to crash barriers or similar solid lane
borders
Rwarnings may be interrupted when driving
alongside particularly long vehicles, for example lorries, for a prolonged time
Indicator and warning display
: Yellow indicator lamp/red warning lamp
Active Blind Spot Assist monitors the area up to
3.0 m behind your vehicle and directly next to
your vehicle, as shown in the diagram.
The detection of vehicles may be impaired in the
case of:
Rdirt on the sensors or obscured sensors
Rpoor visibility, e.g. due to rain, snow or spray
Vehicles in the monitoring range are then not
indicated.
Active Blind Spot Assist may not detect narrow
vehicles, such as motorcycles or bicycles, or
may only detect them too late.
If the lanes are narrow, vehicles driving in the
lane beyond the lane next to your vehicle may be
indicated, especially if the vehicles are not driving in the middle of their lane. This may be the
case if there are vehicles at the edge of their lane
nearest your vehicle.
Active Blind Spot Assist is not active at speeds
below approximately 30 km/h. Vehicles in the
monitoring range are then not indicated.
If Active Blind Spot Assist is activated, indicator
lamp : in the exterior mirrors lights up yellow
up to a speed of 30 km/h. At speeds above
30 km/h, the indicator lamp goes out and Active
Blind Spot Assist is operational.
If a vehicle is detected within the monitoring
range at speeds above 30 km/h, warning
lamp : on the corresponding side lights up red.
This warning always occurs when a vehicle
enters the monitoring range from behind or from
the side. When you overtake a vehicle, the warning only occurs if the difference in speed is less
than 12 km/h.
The yellow indicator lamp goes out if reverse
gear is engaged. Active Blind Spot Assist is then
no longer active.
The brightness of the indicator/warning lamps
is adjusted automatically according to the ambient light.
Visual and acoustic collision warning
If you switch on the turn signals to change lanes
and a vehicle is detected in the side monitoring
range, you receive a visual and acoustic collision
warning. You will then hear a double warning
tone and red warning lamp : flashes. If the turn
signal remains on, detected vehicles are indica-
Driving systems
Course-correcting brake application
If Active Blind Spot Assist detects a risk of a side
impact in the monitoring range, a course-correcting brake application is carried out. This is
designed to help you avoid a collision.
G WARNING
A course-correcting brake application cannot
always prevent a collision. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always steer, brake or accelerate yourself,
especially if Active Blind Spot Assist warns
you or makes a course-correcting brake application. Always maintain a safe distance at the
sides.
Ryou
have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds
Ryou clearly brake or accelerate
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP® or PRE-SAFE® Brake
RESP® is deactivated
Ra loss of tyre pressure or a defective tyre is
detected
Activating Active Blind Spot Assist
Make sure that Active Blind Spot Assist is
activated (Y page 208).
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock.
Warning lamps : in the exterior mirrors light
up red for approximately 1.5 seconds and
then turn yellow.
X
Active Lane Keeping Assist
If a course-correcting brake application occurs,
red warning lamp : flashes in the exterior mirror and a dual warning tone sounds. In addition,
display ; underlining the danger of a side collision appears in the multifunction display.
In very rare cases, the system may make an
inappropriate brake application. A course-correcting brake application may be interrupted at
any time if you steer slightly in the opposite
direction or depress the accelerator pedal more
firmly.
The course-correcting brake application is available within a speed range between 30 km/h and
200 km/h.
Either a course-correcting brake application
appropriate to the driving situation, or none at
all, may occur if:
Rthere are vehicles or obstacles, e.g. crash
barriers, on both sides of your vehicle
Ra vehicle approaches too closely on the side
General notes
Active Lane Keeping Assist monitors the area in
front of your vehicle by means of multifunction
camera : at the top of the windscreen. Various
different areas to the front, rear and side of your
vehicle are also monitored with the aid of the
radar sensor system. Active Lane Keeping
Assist detects lane markings on the road and
Z
Driving and parking
ted by the flashing of red warning lamp :.
There are no further warning tones.
195
Driving and parking
196
Driving systems
can warn you before you leave your lane unintentionally. If you do not react to the warning, a
lane-correcting application of the brakes can
bring the vehicle back into the original lane.
This function is available within a speed range
between 60 km/h and 200 km/h.
For Active Lane Keeping Assist to assist you
when driving, the radar sensor system must be
operational.
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style, Active Lane
Keeping Assist can neither reduce the risk of an
accident nor override the laws of physics. Active
Lane Keeping Assist cannot take into account
road, weather or traffic conditions. Active Lane
Keeping Assist is only an aid. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front, for
vehicle speed, for braking in good time and for
staying in lane.
Active Lane Keeping Assist cannot continuously
keep your vehicle in its lane.
G WARNING
Active Lane Keeping Assist cannot always
clearly detect lane markings.
In such cases, Active Lane Keeping Assist
can:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning and then
make a course-correcting brake application
to the vehicle
Rneither give a warning nor intervene
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay particular attention to the traffic
situation and keep within the lane, especially
if Active Lane Keeping Assist alerts you. Terminate the intervention in a non-critical driving situation.
The system may be impaired or may not function
if:
Rthere is poor visibility, e.g. due to insufficient
illumination of the road, or due to snow, rain,
fog or spray
Rthere is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic, the
sun or reflection from other vehicles (e.g. if
the road surface is wet)
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up, damaged
or covered, for instance by a sticker, in the
vicinity of the camera
Rthere are no lane markings or several unclear
lane markings, e.g. around construction sites
Rthe lane markings are worn away, dark or cov-
ered up, e.g. by dirt or snow
Rthe distance to the vehicle in front is too small
and the lane markings thus cannot be detected
Rthe lane markings change quickly, e.g. lanes
branch off, cross one another or merge
Rthe road is narrow and winding
Rthere are highly variable shade conditions on
the roadway
Rno vehicle is detected in the adjacent lane and
there are broken lane markings
Warning vibration through the steering
wheel
A warning may be given if a front wheel passes
over a lane marking. It will warn you by means of
intermittent vibration in the steering wheel for
up to 1.5 seconds.
In order that you are warned only when necessary and in good time if you cross the lane marking, the system detects certain conditions and
warns you accordingly.
The warning vibration occurs earlier if:
Ryou approach the outer lane marking on a
bend
Rthe road has very wide lanes, e.g. a motorway
Rthe system detects solid lane markings
The warning vibration occurs later if:
Rthe road has narrow lanes
Ryou cut the corner on a bend
Lane-correcting brake application
G WARNING
A lane-correcting brake application cannot
always bring the vehicle back into the original
lane. There is a risk of an accident.
Always steer, brake or accelerate yourself,
especially if Active Lane Keeping Assist warns
you or makes a lane-correcting brake application.
G WARNING
Active Lane Keeping Assist does not detect
traffic conditions or road users. In very rare
cases, the system may make an inappropriate
Driving systems
If you leave your lane under certain circumstances, the vehicle will brake briefly on one side.
This is intended to help you return the vehicle to
the original lane.
If a lane-correcting brake application occurs,
display : appears in the multifunction display.
A lane-correcting brake application can be made
after driving over a lane marking recognised as
being solid or broken. Before this, a warning
must have been issued by means of intermittent
vibration through the steering wheel. In addition, a lane with lane markings on both sides
must be detected.
In the case of a broken lane marking being
detected, a lane-correcting brake application
can only be made if a vehicle has been detected
in the adjacent lane. The following vehicles can
have an influence on brake application: oncoming traffic, vehicles that are overtaking and vehicles that are driving parallel to your vehicle.
i A further lane-correcting brake application
can only occur after your vehicle has returned
to the original lane.
No lane-correcting brake application occurs if:
Ryou clearly and actively steer, brake or accelerate
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend
Ryou have switched on the turn signal
Ra
driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP®, PRE-SAFE® Brake or Active Blind Spot
Assist
Ryou have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds or high rates of acceleration
RESP® is deactivated
Rthe transmission is not in position D
Ran obstacle has been detected in the lane in
which you are driving
Ra loss of tyre pressure or a defective tyre has
been detected and displayed
There is a possibility that the Active Lane Keeping Assist could misjudge the given traffic situation. An inappropriate brake application may
be interrupted at any time if:
Ryou steer slightly in the opposite direction
Ryou switch on the turn signal
Ryou clearly brake or accelerate
A lane-correcting brake application is interrupted automatically if:
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP®, PRE-SAFE® Brake or Active Blind Spot
Assist
Rlane markings are no longer detected
Activating Active Lane Keeping Assist
X
Activate Active Lane Keeping Assist using the
on-board computer; to do so, select Stand‐
ard or Adaptive (Y page 208).
If you drive at speeds above 60 km/h and lane
markings are detected, the lines in the assistance graphic display (Y page 207) are
shown in green. Active Lane Keeping Assist is
ready for use.
If Standard is selected, no warning vibration
occurs if:
Ryou have switched on the turn signals. In
this event, the warnings are suppressed for
a certain period of time.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ABS, BAS or ESP®.
When Adaptive is selected, no warning vibration occurs if:
Ryou have switched on the turn signals. In
this event, the warnings are suppressed for
a certain period of time.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ABS, BAS or ESP®.
Ryou accelerate hard, e.g. kickdown.
Z
Driving and parking
brake application, e.g. after intentionally driving over a solid lane marking. There is a risk of
an accident.
An inappropriate brake application may be
interrupted at any time if you steer slightly in
the opposite direction. Always make sure that
there is sufficient distance to the side for
other traffic or obstacles.
197
198
Driving systems
Ryou
brake hard.
steer actively, e.g. swerve to avoid an
obstacle or change lane quickly.
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend.
Driving and parking
Ryou
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
You must observe the legal requirements for the
country in which you are currently driving when
operating the on-board computer.
G WARNING
If the instrument cluster has failed or malfunctioned, you may not recognise function
restrictions relevant to safety. The operating
safety of your vehicle may be impaired. There
is a risk of an accident.
Drive on carefully. Have the vehicle checked
at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
The on-board computer only shows messages or
warnings from certain systems in the multifunction display. You should therefore make sure
your vehicle is operating safely at all times.
If the operating safety of your vehicle is
impaired, park the vehicle safely as soon as possible. Contact a qualified specialist workshop.
For an overview, see the instrument cluster illustration (Y page 32).
Displays and operation
X
Turn the brightness control knob clockwise or
anti-clockwise.
If you turn the light switch (Y page 113) to the
Ã, T or L position, the brightness
will depend upon the brightness of the ambient light.
The light sensor in the instrument cluster
automatically controls the brightness of the
multifunction display. In daylight, the displays
in the instrument cluster are not illuminated.
Speedometer with segments
The segments in the speedometer indicate
which speed range is available.
RCruise control activated (Y page 159):
The segments light up from the stored speed
to the maximum speed.
RVariable speed limiter is activated
(Y page 170):
The segments light up from the start of the
scale to the selected limit speed.
RDistance Pilot DISTRONIC is activated
(Y page 161):
One or two segments in the set speed range
light up.
RDistance Pilot DISTRONIC detects a vehicle in
front moving more slowly than the stored
speed:
The segments between the speed of the vehicle in front and the stored speed light up.
Rev counter
! Do not drive in the overrevving range. Doing
so will damage the engine.
The red band in the rev counter indicates the
engine's overrevving range.
The fuel supply is interrupted to protect the
engine when the red band is reached.
Instrument cluster lighting
The lighting in the instrument cluster, in the displays and the controls in the vehicle interior can
be adjusted using the brightness control knob.
The brightness control knob is located on the
bottom left of the instrument cluster
(Y page 32).
Outside temperature display
You should pay special attention to road conditions when temperatures are around freezing
point.
Bear in mind that the outside temperature display indicates the measured air temperature
and not the road surface temperature.
Z
199
On-board computer and displays
Displays and operation
On-board computer and displays
200
Displays and operation
The outside temperature display is in the multifunction display (Y page 201).
A change in the outside temperature is shown in
the multifunction display after a delay.
Operating the on-board computer
Overview
Coolant temperature gauge
G WARNING
If you open the bonnet while the engine is
overheating or while there is a fire in the
engine compartment, you could come into
contact with hot gases or other leaking service products. There is a danger of injury.
Allow an overheating engine to cool down
before opening the bonnet. If there is a fire in
the engine compartment, leave the bonnet
closed and notify the fire brigade.
The coolant temperature gauge is in the instrument cluster on the right-hand side (Y page 32).
Under normal operating conditions and at the
correct coolant level, the coolant temperature
may rise to 120 †.
At high outside temperatures and when driving
uphill, the coolant temperature may rise to the
end of the scale.
: Multifunction display
; Right control panel
= Left control panel
X
To activate the on-board computer: turn
the key to position 1 in the ignition lock.
You can control the multifunction display and
the settings in the on-board computer using the
buttons on the multifunction steering wheel.
Left control panel
=
;
RCalls
9
:
Press briefly:
up the menu and menu bar
RScrolls
through lists
a submenu or function
RIn the Audio menu: selects the
previous or next station, when the
preset list or station list is active,
or an audio track or video scene
RIn the Tel (telephone) menu:
switches to the phone book and
selects a name or telephone number
RSelects
Displays and operation
9
:
Press and hold:
a
RConfirms
%
Press briefly:
Multifunction display
the Audio menu: selects a preset list or a station list in the
desired frequency range, or an
audio track or video scene using
rapid scrolling
RIn the Tel (Telephone) menu:
starts rapid scrolling if the phone
book is open
the selection or display
message
RIn the Tel (Telephone) menu:
switches to the telephone book
and starts dialling the selected
number
RBack
off LINGUATRONIC
RHides display messages or calls up
the last Trip menu function used
the telephone book/redial
memory
RExits
Press and hold:
RCalls up the standard display in the
Trip menu
Right control panel
~
RRejects
6
RMakes
W
X
RAdjusts
8
RMute
?
RSwitches
or ends a call
the telephone book/redial
memory
RExits
or accepts a call
to the redial memory
RSwitches
the volume
on LINGUATRONIC
Further information on LINGUATRONIC is available in the separate operating instructions.
Drive program (Y page 142)
Transmission position (Y page 142)
Text field
Menu bar
Time
Outside temperature or speed
(Y page 209)
Set the time using the multimedia system (see
the separate operating instructions).
X To display menu bar ?: press the =
or ; button on the steering wheel.
If you do not press the buttons any longer,
menu bar ? is faded out after a few seconds.
Text field = shows the selected menu or submenu and display messages.
Possible displays in the multifunction display:
:
;
=
?
A
B
RZ
Gearshift recommendation, when shifting
manually (Y page 149)
Rj Parking Pilot (Y page 183)
R¯ Cruise control (Y page 159)
RÈ Speed limiter (Y page 170)
R_ Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus
(Y page 116)
Rè ECO start/stop function (Y page 135)
Rë HOLD function (Y page 172)
Ra Steering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot
(Y page 161)
R120 km/h! Maximum permissible speed
exceeded (only for certain countries)
Z
On-board computer and displays
RIn
RSwitches
%
201
Menus and submenus
202
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
Menu overview
Using the = or ; button on the steering
wheel, open the menu bar.
Operating the on-board computer (Y page 200).
Depending on the vehicle equipment, you can
select the following menus:
RTrip
menu (Y page 202)
instructions)
RNavi menu (navigation
(Y page 203)
RAudio
menu (Y page 204)
menu (telephone) (Y page 205)
RAssist. menu (assistance) (Y page 207)
RServ. menu (service) (Y page 208)
RSettings menu (Y page 208)
RAMG menu (Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
(Y page 213)
RTel
Trip menu
Standard display
X
Press and hold the % button on the steering wheel until the Trip menu with trip
meter : and total distance recorder ;
appears.
Trip computer "From start" or "From
reset"
: Distance
; Driving time
= Average speed
? Average fuel consumption
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
From start or From reset.
reset
X
The values in the From start submenu are calculated from the start of a journey whilst the
values in the From reset submenu are calculated from the last time the submenu was reset
(Y page 203).
In the following cases, the trip computer is automatically reset From start:
start
Rthe ignition has been switched off for more
than four hours
R999 hours have been exceeded.
R9,999 kilometres have been exceeded.
When 9,999 hours or 99,999 kilometres have
been exceeded, the trip computer is automatically reset From reset.
reset
ECO display
The ECO display is not available in MercedesAMG vehicles.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select ECO
DISPLAY.
DISPLAY
If the ignition remains switched off for longer
than four hours, the ECO display will be automatically reset.
Further information on the ECO display
(Y page 156).
Displaying the range and current fuel
consumption
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: the menu only displays approximate range :.
Menus and submenus
Digital speedometer
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
digital speedometer.
A gearshift recommendation Z may also
appear in the display.
Observe the information on gearshift recommendation when shifting manually
(Y page 149).
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: a gearshift recommendation is shown in the status bar of the
multifunction display and not in the digital
speedometer display.
X
Resetting values
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
function that you wish to reset.
X Press a to confirm your selection.
X Press : to select Yes and press a to
confirm.
You can reset the values of the following functions:
RTrip meter
R"From start" trip computer
R"From reset" trip computer
RECO display
If you reset the values in the "ECO display", the
values in the "From start" trip computer are also
reset. If you reset the values in the "From start"
trip computer, the values in the "ECO display"
are also reset.
Navigation menu
Displaying navigation instructions
The multifunction display shows navigation
instructions in the Navi menu.
Observe the additional information on navigation in the separate operating instructions for
the multimedia system.
X Switch on the multimedia system (see separate operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Navi menu.
Route guidance not active
: Direction of travel
; Current road
Route guidance active
No change of direction announced
X
:
;
=
?
Distance to the destination
Distance to the next change of direction
Current road
Symbol indicating "follow the road's course"
Z
On-board computer and displays
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press 9 or : to select the display with
approximate range : and current fuel consumption ;.
Approximate range : that can be covered is
calculated according to your current driving
style and the amount of fuel in the tank. If
there is only a small amount of fuel left in the
fuel tank, a vehicle being refuelled C
appears instead of approximate range :.
Recuperation display = shows you if energy
has been recuperated from the kinetic energy
in overrun mode and saved in the battery.
Recuperation display = depends on the
engine installed and is therefore not available
in all vehicles.
X
203
On-board computer and displays
204
Menus and submenus
Change of direction announced without a
lane recommendation
Other status indicators of the navigation system
: Road to which the change of direction leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
The navigation system displays additional information and the vehicle status.
Possible displays
distance display
= Change-of-direction symbol
When a change of direction is announced, you
will see change-of-direction symbol = and distance graphic ;. This shortens towards the top
of the display as you approach the point of the
announced change of direction.
Change of direction announced with a
lane recommendation
: Road to which the change of direction leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
RNew
route... or Calculating route...
A new route is calculated.
RRoad not mapped
The vehicle position is inside the area of the
digital map but the road is not recognised, e.g.
new roads, car parks or private land.
RNo route
No route could be calculated to the selected
destination.
RO
You have reached the destination or an intermediate destination.
Audio menu
Selecting a radio station
distance display
= Lanes not recommended
? Recommended lane and new lane during a
change of direction
A Change-of-direction symbol
On multilane roads, new lane recommendations
can be displayed for the next change of direction
if the digital map supports this data. During the
change of direction, new lanes may be added.
Lane not recommended =: you will not be able
to complete the next change of direction if you
stay in this lane.
Recommended lane and new lane during a
change of direction ?: in this lane you will be
able to complete the next two changes of direction without changing lane.
: Active station list
; Station with preset position
The multifunction display shows station ; with
station frequency or station name. The preset
position is only displayed along with station ; if
this has been stored.
X Switch on the multimedia system and select
radio (see the separate operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Audio menu.
Menus and submenus
DAB radio mode (Digital Audio Broadcasting) is
an optimised digital transmission standard
designed for the mobile reception of radio transmissions.
Audio player or audio media operation
Audio files from various audio players or media
can be played, depending on the equipment fitted in the vehicle.
X Switch on the multimedia system and select
audio CD or MP3 mode (see the separate
operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select the next/previous track: briefly
press the 9 or : button.
X To select a track from the track list (rapid
scrolling): press and hold the 9 or :
button until desired track : appears.
If you press and hold the 9 or : button,
the rapid scrolling speed is increased. Not all
audio players or media support this function.
If track information is saved on the audio
player or media, the multifunction display will
show the number and title of the track.
Video DVD operation
Switch on the multimedia system and select
video DVD (see the separate operating
instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select the next or previous scene:
briefly press the 9 or : button.
X To select a scene from the scene list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the 9
or : button until desired scene :
appears.
X
TV operation
The preset position is only displayed along with
channel : if this has been stored. You can save
channels in the multimedia system.
X Switch on the multimedia system and select
TV (see the separate operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select a saved channel: briefly press the
9 or : button.
X To select a channel from the channel list:
press and briefly hold the 9 or : button.
Depending on the digital TV broadcaster,
radio stations can also be received. The multifunction display shows TV (Radio).
(Radio)
Telephone menu
Introduction
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
Z
On-board computer and displays
To select a preset list or station list: press
and briefly hold the 9 or : button until
the preset list or station list in the desired
frequency range is shown.
X To select a station: briefly press 9
or :.
X
205
Menus and submenus
206
On-board computer and displays
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
When telephoning, you must observe the legal
requirements for the country in which you are
currently driving.
X Switch on the mobile phone (see the manufacturer's operating instructions).
X Switch on the multimedia system
(Y page 253).
X Insert the mobile phone into the bracket
(Y page 268).
or
X Establish a Bluetooth® connection to the multimedia system (Y page 256).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Tel menu.
You will see one of the following display messages in the multifunction display:
RTelephone
ready or the name of the network provider: the mobile phone has found a
network and is ready to receive.
RTelephone No service
service: there is no network
available or the mobile phone is searching for
a network.
You can obtain further information about suitable mobile phones and connecting mobile
phones via Bluetooth®:
Ron the Internet at http://www.mercedesbenz.com/connect
Rat any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
Accepting a call
If someone calls you when you are in the Tel
menu, a display message appears in the multifunction display.
You can accept a call at any time irrespective of
the selected menu.
X Press the 6 button on the steering wheel
to accept an incoming call.
Rejecting or ending a call
X
Press the ~ button on the steering wheel
to reject or end an incoming call.
Selecting an entry in the phone book
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 9, : or a button to
switch to the phone book.
X Authorise access to the phone book on the
phone.
X Press : or 9 to select the names one
after the other.
or
X To start rapid scrolling: press and hold :
or 9 for longer than one second.
The names in the phone book are displayed
quickly one after the other.
Rapid scrolling stops when you release the
button or reach the end of the list.
X If only one telephone number is stored for
a name: press the 6 or a button to
start dialling.
or
X If there is more than one number for a
particular name: press the 6 or a
button to display the numbers.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
number you want to dial.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
or
X To exit the telephone book: press the ~
or % button.
X
Redialling
The on-board computer saves the last names or
numbers dialled in the redial memory.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 6 button to switch to the redial
memory.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name or number.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
or
X To exit the redial memory: press the ~
or % button.
Menus and submenus
RActive
Assistance menu
Depending on your vehicle's equipment, in the
Assist. menu, you have the following options:
RShowing the assistance graphic
(Y page 207)
RMercedes-AMG vehicles: setting the vehicle
level (Y page 178)
RActivating/deactivating the Traffic Sign
Assist message function (Y page 207)
RActivating/deactivating Steering Pilot and
Stop&Go Pilot (Y page 207)
RActivating/deactivating Active Brake Assist
(Y page 207)
RActivating/deactivating Active Brake Assist
with cross-traffic function (Y page 207)
RActivating/deactivating ATTENTION ASSIST
(Y page 208)
RActivating/deactivating Active Blind Spot
Assist (Y page 208)
RActivating/deactivating Active Lane Keeping
Assist (Y page 208)
Showing the assistance graphic
Brake Assist (Y page 64)
with cross-traffic func-
RActive Brake Assist
tion (Y page 72)
RATTENTION
ASSIST (Y page 190)
Lane Keeping Assist (Y page 195)
X Press : to display the ATTENTION ASSIST
assessment.
RActive
Traffic Sign Assist
In the Traffic Sign Assist menu, you can
switch the Traffic Sign Assist message function
on or off. When the message function is activated, detected traffic signs and information
appear in the multifunction display for five seconds.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Traffic Sign Assist.
Assist
X Press a to confirm.
The current selection appears.
X To activate/deactivate the message function: press a again.
Further information on Traffic Sign Assist
(Y page 191).
Activating/deactivating Steering Pilot
and Stop&Go Pilot
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Steering
Pilot.
Pilot
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
The current selection appears.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a button again.
When Steering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot are
activated, the multifunction display shows the
Steering Pilot On message.
Further information on Steering Pilot and
Stop&Go Pilot (Y page 168).
X
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Assist.
graphic.
graphic
X Press a to confirm your selection.
The multifunction display shows the Distance
Pilot DISTRONIC distance display in the assistance graphic display.
The assistance graphic shows you the status
of and/or information from other driving systems or driving safety systems:
RTraffic Sign Assist (Y page 191)
RDistance Pilot DISTRONIC (Y page 161)
X
Activating/deactivating Active Brake
Assist
You can use this function to activate or deactivate Active Brake Assist.
Z
On-board computer and displays
Introduction
207
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
208
You can use the function to activate or deactivate Active Brake Assist or, on vehicles with the
Driving Assistance Plus package, to activate or
deactivate Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic
function.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Brake Assist.
Assist
X Press a to confirm.
The current selection appears.
X To activate/deactivate: press a again.
If Active Brake Assist or Active Brake Assist
with cross-traffic function is deactivated, the
æ symbol appears in the assistance
graphic display of the multifunction display.
Further information on Active Brake Assist
(Y page 64).
Further information on Active Brake Assist with
cross-traffic function (Y page 72).
Setting ATTENTION ASSIST
Further information on Active Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 193).
Activating/deactivating Active Lane
Keeping Assist
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Lane Keeping Assist.
Assist
X Press a to confirm your selection.
The current selection appears.
X Press a again.
X Press the : or 9 button to set Off
Off,
Standard or Adaptive
Adaptive.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
When Active Lane Keeping Assist is activated,
the multifunction display shows the lane
markings as bright lines in the assistance
graphic.
Further information on Active Lane Keeping
Assist (Y page 195).
X
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Attention Assist.
Assist
X Press a to confirm.
The current selection appears.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to set Off
Off,
Standard or Sensitive
Sensitive.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
When ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated, the
é symbol appears in the multifunction display in the assistance graphic display.
Further information on ATTENTION ASSIST
(Y page 190).
Depending on the equipment fitted in the vehicle, you have the following options in the Serv.
menu:
RCalling up display messages (Y page 216)
RRestarting the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 309)
RChecking the tyre pressure electronically
(Y page 309)
RCalling up the service due date
(Y page 281)
Activating/deactivating Active Blind
Spot Assist
Introduction
X
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Blind Spot Assist.
Assist
X Press a to confirm your selection.
The current selection appears.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a button again.
X
Service menu
Settings menu
Depending on the equipment fitted in the vehicle, in the Settings menu you have the following options:
RChanging the instrument cluster settings
(Y page 209)
RChanging the light settings (Y page 209)
RChanging the vehicle settings (Y page 211)
RChanging the convenience settings
(Y page 211)
RRestoring the factory settings (Y page 212)
Menus and submenus
Lights
Selecting the distance unit
Setting the daytime driving lights
The Display unit Speed-/odometer: function allows you to choose whether certain displays appear in kilometres or miles in the multifunction display.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instrument cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Display unit Speed-/odometer function.
The current setting km or miles appears.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
The Daytime driving lights function can
only be switched on with the engine switched
off.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Daytime driving lights function.
If the Daytime driving lights function has
been switched on, the cone of light and the
W symbol in the multifunction display are
shown in orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
The selected unit of measurement for distance
applies to the:
Rdigital
speedometer in the Trip menu
Rtotal distance recorder and trip meter
Rtrip computer
Rcurrent consumption and the range
Rnavigation instructions in the Navi menu
Rcruise control
Rspeed limiter
RDistance Pilot DISTRONIC
RASSYST PLUS service interval display
Selecting permanent display
United Kingdom: this function is unavailable.
The Permanent display: function allows you
to choose whether the multifunction display
always shows the outside temperature or the
speed.
The speed display is inverse to your speedometer.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instrument cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Permanent display: function.
The current setting, outside temperature
or Dig. speedo [mph]:,
[mph]: appears.
X To change the setting: press a again.
Further information on daytime driving lights
(Y page 113).
Switching the Intelligent Light System
on/off
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Intell. Light System function.
If the Intell. Light System function has
been switched on, the multifunction display
shows the cone of light and the L symbol
in orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
When you activate the Intell. Light System
System,
you activate the following functions:
RMotorway mode
RActive light function
RCornering light function
RExtended range foglamps
If you set the dipped-beam headlamps for driving on the right/left, the multifunction display
shows the Intell. Light System: System
inoperative Inactive for left-side
traffic or Intell. Light System: System
inoperative Inactive for right-side
traffic display message instead of the
Intell. Light Sys. function in the Light
submenu (Y page 210). This display message
will only appear if the setting for driving on the
Z
On-board computer and displays
Instrument cluster
209
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
210
left/right is set opposite to your vehicle's country version.
Further information on the Intelligent Light System (Y page 115).
Setting the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the left/right
You can use this function to switch between
symmetrical and asymmetrical dipped beam
(Y page 113).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Dipped beams Setting for: function.
The current setting Right-side traffic or
Left-side traffic appears.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
If you change the setting, conversion does not
take place until the next time the vehicle is
stationary.
If you set the dipped-beam headlamps for driving on the right/left, then motorway mode and
the extended range foglamps are unavailable.
These are only deactivated if the setting for driving on the left/right is set opposite to your vehicle's country version.
A qualified specialist workshop can set the
dipped-beam headlamps for driving on the left/
right.
Setting the brightness of the ambient
lighting
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Amb. light +/- function.
The current setting appears.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to adjust the
brightness to any level from Off to Level 5
(bright).
X Press the a or % button to save the
setting.
X
Setting the ambient lighting colour
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Amb. light col. function.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to set the colour to SOLAR
SOLAR, SOLAR orange or SOLAR red.
red
X Press the a or % button to save the
setting.
X
Activating/deactivating the surround
lighting and exterior lighting delayed
switch-off
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the Surround
lighting function.
If the Surround lighting function is activated, the multifunction display shows the light
cone and the area around the vehicle in
orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Deactivating delayed switch-off of the exterior
lighting temporarily:
X Before leaving the vehicle, turn the key to
position 0 in the ignition lock.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock.
The exterior lighting delayed switch-off is
deactivated.
Delayed switch-off of the exterior lighting is
reactivated the next time you start the engine.
If you have activated the Surround lighting
function and you turn the light switch to Ã,
the following functions are activated when it is
dark:
Rsurround lighting: the exterior lighting
remains lit for 40 seconds after unlocking
with the key. If you start the engine, the surround lighting is switched off and automatic
headlamp mode is activated (Y page 113).
Rexterior lighting delayed switch-off: the
exterior lighting remains lit for 60 seconds
after the engine is switched off. If you close all
Menus and submenus
Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off
If you activate the Lighting delayed sw.-off
function, the interior lighting remains on for
20 seconds after you remove the key from the
ignition lock.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lighting delayed sw.-off function.
When the Lighting delayed sw.-off function is activated, the vehicle interior is displayed in orange in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Vehicle
Setting the permanent speed limiter
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the Limit
speed (winter tyres): function.
The current setting appears.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to adjust the
permanent speed limiter in increments of ten
(160
160 km/h to 240 km/h).
km/h The Off setting
switches the permanent speed limiter off.
X Press the a button to store the entry.
X
Further information on the permanent speed
limiter (Y page 172).
Activating/deactivating the automatic
locking feature
If you activate the Automatic door locks
function, the vehicle is centrally locked above a
speed of approximately 15 km/h.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Automatic door locks function.
When the Automatic door locks function is
activated, the multifunction display shows the
left-hand vehicle door in orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Further information on the automatic locking
feature (Y page 84).
Activating/deactivating the acoustic
locking confirmation
If you switch on the Acoustic Lock function, an
acoustic signal sounds when you lock the vehicle.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Acoustic Lock function.
If the Acoustic Lock function is activated,
the & symbol in the multifunction display
lights up orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Comfort
Activating/deactivating the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature
G WARNING
When the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature adjusts
the steering wheel, you and other vehicle
occupants – particularly children – could
become trapped. There is a risk of injury.
While the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature is making adjustments, make sure that no one has
Z
On-board computer and displays
the doors and the boot lid, the exterior lighting
goes off after 15 seconds.
Depending on your vehicle's equipment, when
the surround lighting and delayed switch-off
exterior lighting are on, the following light up:
Rside lamps
Rdipped-beam headlamps
Rdaytime driving lights
Rsurround lighting in the exterior mirrors
211
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
212
any body parts in the sweep of the steering
wheel.
If someone is trapped:
Rpress
one of the memory function position
buttons, or
Rmove the switch for steering wheel adjustment in the opposite direction to that in
which the steering wheel is moving.
The adjustment process is stopped.
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Using : or 9, select the Easy Entry/
Exit function.
If the Easy Entry/Exit function is activated,
the multifunction display shows the steering
wheel in orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Further information on the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT
feature (Y page 106).
Switching belt adjustment on/off
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Belt adjustment function.
When the Belt adjustment function is activated, the seat belt is displayed in orange in
the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Further information on belt adjustment
(Y page 43).
Switching the fold mirrors in when locking function on/off
This function is only available when the vehicle is
equipped with the electrical fold-in function.
When you activate the Auto. fold-in mir‐
rors function, the exterior mirrors are folded in
when the vehicle is locked.
If you have switched on the Auto. fold-in
mirrors function and you fold in the exterior
mirrors using the button on the door
(Y page 109), they will not fold out automatically. The exterior mirrors can then only be folded out using the button on the door.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Auto. fold-in mirrors function.
If the Auto. fold-in mirrors function is
switched on, the multifunction display shows
the exterior mirror in orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Resetting to factory settings
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Factory setting submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
The Reset all settings? function
appears.
X Press the : or 9 button to select No or
Yes.
Yes
X Press the a button to confirm the selection.
If you have selected Yes and confirmed, the
multifunction display shows a confirmation
message.
For safety reasons, not all functions are reset:
the Limit speed (winter tyres): function
of the permanent speed limiter can only be set in
the Vehicle submenu. If you want to reset the
Daytime driving lights function in the
Lights submenu, you must turn the key to position 1 in the ignition lock.
X
AMG menu (Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Warm-up
:
;
=
?
A
B
X
Digital speedometer
Gear indicator
Upshift indicator
Engine oil temperature
Coolant temperature
Transmission oil temperature
Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the AMG menu.
Upshift indicator: upshift indicator UP =
indicates that the engine has reached the
overrevving range when in the manual drive
program.
Engine and transmission oil temperature:
when the engine and transmission are at normal operating temperature, oil temperature ? and B are displayed in white in the
multifunction display.
If the multifunction display shows oil temperature ? or B in blue, the engine or the
transmission are not yet at normal operating
temperature. Avoid using the full output of the
engine during this time.
SETUP
SETUP displays the following information, functions and settings:
Rthe digital speedometer
Rthe gear indicator
Rthe engine mode
Rthe suspension mode
Rthe transmission position
Rthe ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) mode
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel to
select the AMG menu.
X Press 9 repeatedly until SETUP appears.
RACETIMER
Displaying and starting the RACETIMER
The RACETIMER is only intended for use on a
closed race circuit. Do not use the function on
public roads.
: Lap
; RACETIMER
You can start the RACETIMER when the engine is
running or if the key is in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel to
select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
RACETIMER appears.
X To start: press the a button to start the
RACETIMER.
Displaying the intermediate time
:
;
=
?
Engine mode C, S, S+ or M
Suspension setting SPORT or COMFORT
Transmission position D/MM
ESP® mode (On
On/Off
Off)
Z
213
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
214
Press the = or ; button to select
Interm. Time.
Time
X Press a to confirm.
The intermediate time is shown for five seconds.
On-board computer and displays
X
Deleting all laps
Starting a new lap
: RACETIMER
; Fastest lap time (best lap)
= Lap
X
Press a to confirm New Lap.
Lap
A maximum of 16 laps may be stored. The 16th
lap can only be completed with Finish Lap.
Lap
Stopping the RACETIMER
If you switch off the engine, the RACETIMER is
reset to "0" after 30 seconds. All laps are
deleted.
You cannot delete individual stored laps. If you
have stopped 16 laps, the current lap does not
have to be reset.
X Reset the current lap.
X Press a to confirm Reset
Reset.
Reset Race Timer? appears in the multifunction display.
X Press the : button to select Yes and press
the a button to confirm.
All laps are deleted.
Overall evaluation
X
X
Press the % button on the steering wheel.
Confirm Yes with a.
The RACETIMER interrupts timing if you stop the
vehicle and turn the key to position 1 in the ignition lock. If you turn the key to position 3 and
then press a to confirm Start
Start, timing is
continued.
Resetting the current lap
Stop the RACETIMER.
Press the = or ; button to select
Reset Lap.
Lap
X Press a to reset the lap time to "0".
X
X
:
;
=
?
A
RACETIMER overall evaluation
Total time driven
Average speed
Distance covered
Maximum speed
If you store at least one lap and stop the RACETIMER, an overall evaluation will then be available.
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel to
select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
overall evaluation appears.
Menus and submenus
215
:
;
=
?
A
On-board computer and displays
Lap evaluation
Lap
Lap time
Average lap speed
Lap length
Top speed during lap
This function is only available if you have stored
at least two laps and have stopped the RACETIMER.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the lap
evaluation is shown.
Each lap is shown in a separate submenu. The
fastest lap is indicated by flashing symbol :.
X Press the 9 or : button to select a different lap evaluation.
Z
Display messages
216
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Introduction
General notes
Display messages appear in the multifunction display.
Display messages with graphic symbols are simplified in the Owner's Manual and may differ from
the symbols in the multifunction display.
Please respond in accordance with the display messages and follow the additional notes in this
Owner's Manual.
Certain display messages are accompanied by an audible warning tone or a continuous tone.
When you stop and park the vehicle, please observe the notes on:
RHOLD function (Y page 172)
RParking (Y page 153)
Hiding display messages
Press the a or % button on the steering wheel.
The multifunction display fades the display message out.
High-priority display messages are shown by the multifunction display in red. Some high-priority
display messages cannot be hidden.
The multifunction display shows these messages continuously until the causes for the messages
have been remedied.
X
Message memory
The on-board computer saves certain display messages in the message memory. You can call up
the display messages:
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Service menu.
If there are display messages, the multifunction display shows 2 messages,
messages for example.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the entry, e.g. 2 messages.
messages
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the 9 or : button to scroll through the display messages.
X
When the ignition is switched off, all display messages are deleted apart from some high-priority
display messages. Once the causes of the high-priority display messages have been rectified, these
display messages are deleted as well.
Display messages
217
Safety systems
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!÷
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) and ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) are temporarily unavailable.
currently unavaila‐ Other driving and driving safety systems may also be faulty.
ble See Owner's Man‐
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in the
ual
instrument cluster.
Possible causes:
Rself-diagnosis is not yet complete
Rthe on-board voltage may be insufficient
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you brake
hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected.
The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering
movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned above
are available again.
If the multifunction display still shows the display message:
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
!÷
ABS and ESP® are faulty.
Other driving and driving safety systems may also be faulty.
inoperative See Own‐
In addition, the J, ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in
er's Manual
the instrument cluster.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you brake
hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected.
The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
218
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
÷
ESP® is temporarily unavailable.
Other driving and driving safety systems may also be faulty.
currently unavaila‐
ble See Owner's Man‐ In addition, the ÷ and å warning lamps light up in the instrument cluster.
ual
The self-diagnosis function, for example, may not be complete.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering
movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned above
are available again.
If the multifunction display still shows the display message:
Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
X
÷
ESP® is faulty.
Other driving and driving safety systems may also be faulty.
inoperative See Own‐
In addition, the ÷ and å warning lamps light up in the instruer's Manual
ment cluster.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
T!
÷
EBD (electronic brake force distribution), ABS and ESP® are faulty.
Other driving and driving safety systems may also be faulty.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in the
inoperative See Own‐ instrument cluster and a warning tone sounds.
er's Manual
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore lock,
for example, if you brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected.
The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
!
The red ! indicator lamp lights up.
You attempted to release the electric parking brake while the ignition
was switched off.
X Key: turn the key to position 1 in the ignition lock.
X KEYLESS-GO: switch on the ignition.
!
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and a warning tone sounds. A
condition for automatic release of the electric parking brake is not
fulfilled (Y page 154).
You are driving with the electric parking brake applied.
X Release the electric parking brake manually.
Turn on the igni‐
tion to release the
parking brake
Release parking
brake
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and a warning tone sounds.
You are making an emergency stop using the electric parking brake
(Y page 154).
!
Parking brake See
Owner's Manual
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To apply:
Switch the ignition off.
Press the electric parking brake lever for at least ten seconds.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
X
Z
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
219
220
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The yellow ! warning lamp and the red ! indicator lamp are lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To release:
X
X
or
X
Switch the ignition off and then on again.
Release the electric parking brake manually.
Release the electric parking brake automatically (Y page 154).
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
X Do not drive on.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and the yellow ! warning lamp
is lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To release:
X
X
Switch the ignition off and then on again.
Release the electric parking brake manually.
To apply:
X
X
Switch the ignition off and then on again.
Apply the electric parking brake manually.
If the red ! indicator lamp continues to flash:
Do not drive on.
Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 313).
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Turn the front wheels towards the kerb.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
X
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. The red ! indicator lamp
flashes for about ten seconds after the electric parking brake has been
applied or released. It then goes out or remains lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
X Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 313).
If it is not possible to apply the electric parking brake:
Shift the transmission to position P.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
If it is not possible to release the electric parking brake:
X Release the electric parking brake automatically (Y page 154).
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. If you manually apply or
release the electric parking brake, the red ! indicator lamp
flashes.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning. It is not possible to apply
the electric parking brake manually.
X Shift the transmission to position P, as the electric parking brake is
not applied automatically.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
!
Parking brake inop‐
erative
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. The red ! indicator lamp
flashes for about ten seconds after the electric parking brake has been
applied or released. It then goes out or remains lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning, e.g. because of overvoltage or undervoltage.
X Rectify the cause of the overvoltage or undervoltage, e.g. by charging the battery or restarting the engine.
X Apply or release the electric parking brake.
If the electric parking brake still cannot be applied or released:
X Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
X Apply or release the electric parking brake.
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If it is still not possible to apply the electric parking brake:
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up and the red ! indicator
lamp flashes.
It is not possible to apply the electric parking brake manually.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
J
Check brake fluid
level
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
In addition, the red J warning lamp lights up in the instrument
cluster and a warning tone sounds.
G WARNING
Braking efficiency may be impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Do not top up the brake fluid. This does not correct the fault.
Z
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
221
On-board computer and displays
222
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
The brake pads/linings have reached their wear limit.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
G
One or more main features of the Mercedes connect me system are
malfunctioned.
X Have the Mercedes connect me system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
PRE-SAFE inopera‐
tive See Owner's
Manual
Important PRE-SAFE® functions have failed. All other occupant safety
systems, e.g. airbags, remain available.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Active Brake Assist
Functions currently
limited See Owner's
Manual
Active Brake Assist is temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
RThe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or
other sources of electromagnetic radiation.
RThe system is outside the operating temperature range.
RThe on-board voltage is too low.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Active Brake Assist is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Restart the engine.
Check brake pad wear
Inoperative
Active Brake Assist
Functions limited
See Owner's Manual
Active Brake Assist is unavailable due to a malfunction.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Active Brake Assist
Functions currently
limited See Owner's
Manual
Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function or PRE‑SAFE® PLUS is
deactivated and temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
RThe system is outside the operating temperature range.
RThe on-board voltage is too low.
RThe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or
other sources of electromagnetic radiation.
RMercedes-AMG vehicles: ESP® is deactivated.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function and PRE‑SAFE® PLUS
are functional again.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Restart the engine.
X Mercedes-AMG vehicles: reactivate ESP® (Y page 70).
Act. Brake Assist
Functions limited
See Owner's Manual
Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function or PRE‑SAFE® PLUS is
not available due to a fault.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
223
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
224
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Radar sensors dirty
See Owner's Manual
The radar sensor system is malfunctioning.
Possible causes:
Rdirt on sensors
Rheavy rain or snow
Rwhen driving on inter-urban roads without traffic or infrastructure,
e.g. in desert-like areas
At least one driving system or driving safety system is malfunctioning
or is temporarily unavailable:
RActive Brake Assist
RActive Brake Assist with cross-traffic function
RDistance Pilot DISTRONIC
RSteering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot
RActive Lane Keeping Assist
RActive Blind Spot Assist
RPRE-SAFE® PLUS
If the front radar sensor system is dirty, Active Blind Spot Assist will
not perform a course-correcting brake application.
Once the cause of the problem is no longer present, the driving and
driving safety systems will be available again. The display message
disappears.
If the display message does not disappear:
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Switch off the engine.
X Clean all sensors (Y page 285).
X Restart the engine.
The display message disappears.
A
The roll bars are faulty.
Malfunction Consult
workshop
6
Restraint sys. mal‐
function Consult
workshop
G WARNING
The roll bars will then possibly not be extended in the event of an
accident.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
The restraint system is malfunctioning. The 6 warning lamp also
lights up in the instrument cluster.
G WARNING
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally
or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Further information about the restraint system (Y page 40).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
6
The restraint system is malfunctioning at the front on the left or right.
The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
Front left malfunc‐
tion Consult work‐
shoporFront
shop
Front right
malfunction Consult
workshop
6
Left windowbag mal‐
function Consult
workshoporRight
workshop
Right
windowbag malfunc‐
tion Consult work‐
shop
G WARNING
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally
or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
The left or right headbag is malfunctioning. The 6 warning lamp
also lights up in the instrument cluster.
G WARNING
The left or right headbag may either be triggered unintentionally or, in
the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
225
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
226
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Front-passenger
airbag disabled See
Owner's Manual
The front-passenger front airbag and front-passenger kneebag are
disabled during the journey, although:
Ran adult
or
Ra person of the corresponding stature is on the front-passenger seat
If additional forces are applied to the seat, the weight the system
detects may be too low.
G WARNING
The front-passenger front airbag does not deploy during an accident.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Switch the ignition off.
X Have the occupant on the front-passenger seat step out of the
vehicle.
X Make sure that the seat is unoccupied, close the front-passenger
door and switch on the ignition.
X Observe the PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lamps in the centre
console and the multifunction display and check the following:
Seat unoccupied and ignition switched on:
Ra self-diagnosis is carried out. The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamps must light up simultaneously for approximately six seconds.
Rthe PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp must then light up
and remain lit after the self-diagnosis. If the indicator lamp is on,
the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system
has disabled the front-passenger front airbag (Y page 46)
Rthe Front-passenger airbag enabled See Owner's Manual
or Front-passenger airbag disabled See Owner's Manual
display messages must not be shown in the multifunction display
X Wait for a period of at least 60 seconds until the necessary system
checks have been completed.
X Make sure that the display messages do not appear in the multifunction display.
If these conditions are met, the front-passenger seat can be occupied
again. Whether the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF or ON indicator lamp
remains lit or goes out depends on how the automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system classifies the occupant.
If the conditions are not met, the system is not operating correctly.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Further information on the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation feature (Y page 46).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Front-passenger
airbag enabled See
Owner's Manual
The front-passenger front airbag and front-passenger kneebag are
enabled during the journey, although:
Ra child, a small adult or an object weighing less than the system
weight threshold is located on the front-passenger seat
or
Rthe front-passenger seat is not occupied
The system may detect objects or forces that are adding to the weight
applied to the seat.
G WARNING
The airbag may deploy unintentionally.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Switch the ignition off.
X Open the front-passenger door.
X Remove the child and the child restraint system from the frontpassenger seat.
X Make sure there are no objects applying additional force to the seat.
The system may otherwise detect the additional force and interpret
the seat occupant's weight as greater than it actually is.
X Make sure that the seat is unoccupied, close the front-passenger
door and switch on the ignition.
X Observe the PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lamps in the centre
console and the multifunction display and check the following:
Seat unoccupied and ignition switched on:
Ra self-diagnosis is carried out. The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamps must light up simultaneously for approximately six seconds.
Rthe PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp must then light up
and remain lit after the self-diagnosis. If the indicator lamp is on,
the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system
has disabled the front-passenger front airbag (Y page 46)
Rthe Front-passenger airbag enabled See Owner's Manual
or Front-passenger airbag disabled See Owner's Manual
display messages must not be shown in the multifunction display
X Wait for a period of at least 60 seconds until the necessary system
checks have been completed.
X Make sure that the display messages do not appear in the multifunction display.
If these conditions are met, the front-passenger seat can be occupied
again. Whether the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF or ON indicator lamp
remains lit or goes out depends on how the automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system classifies the occupant.
If the conditions are not met, the system is not operating correctly.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
227
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
228
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Further information on the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation feature (Y page 46).
Lights
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The corresponding bulb is faulty.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
or
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 118).
LED light bulbs: the display message for the corresponding lamp only
appears when all the LEDs in the lamp have failed.
b
The Intelligent Light System is faulty. The lights remain available without the Intelligent Light System.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Left dipped beam
(Example)
Intell. Light Sys‐
tem inoperative
b
Malfunction See Own‐
er's Manual
X
The exterior lighting is faulty.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
b
The light sensor is faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The lights are still switched on when you leave the vehicle. A warning
tone also sounds.
X Turn the light switch to the à position.
Adaptive Highbeam
Assist Plus cur‐
rently unavailable
See Owner's Manual
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus is deactivated and temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
RThe windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision.
RVisibility is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog.
X Clean the windscreen.
If the system detects that the camera is fully operational again, the
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus available again message is
displayed.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus is operational again.
Adaptive Highbeam
Assist Plus inoper‐
ative
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus is faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
AUTO lights inoper‐
ative
Switch off lights
Display messages
229
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
The coolant level is too low.
Top up coolant See
Owner's Manual
! Avoid making long journeys with too little coolant in the engine
cooling system. The engine will otherwise be damaged.
Top up the coolant, observing the warning notes before doing so
(Y page 279).
X If the coolant needs topping up more often than usual, have the
engine coolant system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
?
The fan motor is faulty.
If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue driving
to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
?
The coolant is too hot.
A warning tone also sounds.
Coolant Stop vehi‐
cle Switch engine
off
X
G WARNING
Never drive with an overheated engine. Driving when your engine is
overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into the
engine compartment to catch fire.
In addition, steam from an overheated engine can cause serious
burns, which can occur just by opening the bonnet.
There is a risk of injury.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic
conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until the
engine has cooled down.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not blocked,
e.g. by frozen slush.
X Do not start the engine again until the display message goes out and
the coolant temperature is below 120 †. The engine may otherwise
be damaged.
X Pay attention to the coolant temperature gauge, observing the
warning notes (Y page 279).
X If the temperature increases again, consult a qualified specialist
workshop immediately.
Under normal operating conditions and with the specified coolant
level, the coolant temperature may rise to 120 †.
Z
On-board computer and displays
Engine
On-board computer and displays
230
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
The battery is not being charged.
A warning tone also sounds.
Possible causes:
Rfaulty alternator
Rtorn poly-V-belt
Ra malfunction in the electronics
See Owner's Manual
! Do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat.
X
Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic
conditions, and switch off the engine.
X
Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
#
The battery is no longer being charged and the charge status is too
low.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic
conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Observe the instructions in the # See Owner's Manual display
message.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
4
The engine oil level has dropped to the minimum level.
A warning tone also sounds.
4
Mercedes-AMG vehicles:
The engine oil level is too low.
Stop vehicle See
Owner's Manual
Check eng. oil lev.
when next refuelling ! Avoid long journeys when there is too little coolant in the cooling
system. Otherwise the engine will be damaged.
X Check the oil level when next refuelling, at the latest (Y page 278).
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 278).
X Have the engine checked at a qualified specialist workshop if the
engine oil needs topping up more often than usual.
Information on approved engine oils can be obtained from a qualified
specialist workshop or on the Internet at http://bevo.mercedesbenz.com.
Add 1 litre engine
oil when next refu‐
elling
! Avoid long journeys when there is too little coolant in the cooling
system. Otherwise the engine will be damaged.
Check the oil level when next refuelling, at the latest (Y page 278).
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 278).
X Have the engine checked at a qualified specialist workshop if the
engine oil needs topping up more often than usual.
Information on approved engine oils can be obtained from a qualified
specialist workshop or on the Internet at http://bevo.mercedesbenz.com.
X
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
4
Mercedes-AMG vehicles:
The engine oil level is too low.
There is a risk of engine damage.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic
conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Check the engine oil level (Y page 278).
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 278).
Engine oil level
Stop vehicle Switch
engine off
8
Reserve fuel level
C
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
Refuel at the nearest filling station.
X
There is very little fuel in the fuel tank.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station without fail.
Driving systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ABC Malfunction
The Active Body Control (ABC) function is restricted.
G WARNING
The vehicle's suspension settings may be affected.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Do not drive at speeds above 80 km/h.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
ABC Malfunction
Stop Vehicle
The Active Body Control (ABC) vehicle level is too low.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
After a few seconds, the vehicle level is adjusted and the display
message disappears.
The vehicle is leaking oil.
The multifunction display continuously shows the display message.
G WARNING
The vehicle's suspension settings may be affected.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
231
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
232
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Active Body Control (ABC) is malfunctioning.
The multifunction display continuously shows the display message.
G WARNING
The suspension settings are thus affected.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Do not drive at speeds above 80 km/h.
X Make only slight steering movements. Otherwise, the front wings or
the tyres could be damaged if the steering movement is too great.
X Listen for scraping sounds.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
À
Attention Assist:
Take a break!
À
Attention Assist
inoperative
Based on certain criteria, ATTENTION ASSIST has detected fatigue or
a lack of concentration on the part of the driver. A warning tone also
sounds.
X If necessary, take a break.
During long journeys, take regular breaks in good time so that you get
enough rest.
ATTENTION ASSIST is inoperative.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Traffic Sign Assist Traffic Sign Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative.
currently unavaila‐ Possible causes:
ble See Owner's Man‐
RThe windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision.
ual
RVisibility is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog.
X Clean the windscreen.
If the system detects that the camera is fully operational, the display
message disappears.
Traffic Sign Assist is operational again.
Traffic Sign Assist
inoperative
ë
Off
Traffic Sign Assist is faulty.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The HOLD function is deactivated. The vehicle is skidding.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Reactivate the HOLD function later (Y page 172).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Active Lane Keeping Active Lane Keeping Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative.
Assist currently
Possible causes:
unavailable See Own‐
RThe windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision.
er's Manual
RVisibility is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog.
RThere have been no lane markings for an extended period.
RThe lane markings are worn, dark or covered, e.g. by dirt or snow.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Active Lane Keeping Assist is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Clean the windscreen.
Active Lane Keeping
Assist inoperative
Active Lane Keeping Assist is faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Active Blind Spot Assist is temporarily inoperative.
Active Blind Spot
Assist currently
Possible causes:
unavailable See Own‐
RThe radar sensor system is outside the operating temperature
er's Manual
range.
RThe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or
other sources of electromagnetic radiation.
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Active Blind Spot Assist is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Clean the sensors (Y page 285).
X Restart the engine.
Active Blind Spot
Assist inoperative
Active Blind Spot Assist is faulty.
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Parking Pilot can‐
celled
The driver's door is open and the driver's seat belt has not been fastened.
X Repeat the parking process with the seat belt fastened and the
driver's door closed.
Z
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
233
234
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
You inadvertently touched the multifunction steering wheel while
steering intervention was active.
X While steering intervention is active, make sure not to touch the
multifunction steering wheel.
The vehicle has started to skid and ESP® has intervened.
X Use the Parking Pilot again later (Y page 183).
Parking Pilot inop‐
erative
You have just carried out a large number of turning or parking manoeuvres.
Parking Pilot will become available again after approximately ten
minutes (Y page 183).
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Switch off and restart the engine.
If the multifunction display still shows the display message:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Parking Pilot is malfunctioning.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Parking Pilot ended
The vehicle is parked. A warning tone also sounds.
The display message disappears automatically.
Distance Pilot off
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is deactivated (Y page 161).
If it was deactivated automatically, a warning tone also sounds.
Distance Pilot
available again
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is operational again after having been temporarily unavailable. You can now reactivate Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC (Y page 161).
Distance Pilot cur‐
rently unavailable
See Owner's Manual
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is temporarily inoperative.
Steering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot are also temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
RThe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or
other sources of electromagnetic radiation.
RThe system is outside the operating temperature range.
RThe on-board voltage is too low.
A warning tone also sounds.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Restart the engine.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Distance Pilot inop‐ Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is faulty.
erative
The following may have also failed:
RBrake Assist with cross-traffic function
RActive Brake Assist with cross-traffic function
RSteering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot
A warning tone also sounds.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Distance Pilot pas‐
sive
You have depressed the accelerator pedal. Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
is no longer controlling the speed of the vehicle.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
Distance Pilot - - km/h
A condition for activating Distance Pilot DISTRONIC has not been met.
X Check the activation conditions for Distance Pilot DISTRONIC
(Y page 161).
Distance Pilot and
Limiter inoperative
Distance Pilot DISTRONIC and speed limiter are faulty.
Steering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot are therefore also unavailable.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Steering Pilot cur‐
rently unavailable
See Owner's Manual
Steering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot are temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
RThe windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision.
RVisibility is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog.
RThere have been no lane markings for an extended period.
RThe lane markings are worn, dark or covered, e.g. by dirt or snow.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Steering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot are operative again.
If the display message does not disappear:
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Clean the windscreen.
Steering Pilot inop‐ Steering Pilot and Stop&Go Pilot are faulty.
erative
However, the Distance Pilot DISTRONIC functions are still available.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Limiter passive
If you depress the accelerator pedal beyond the pressure point (kickdown), the speed limiter is switched to passive mode (Y page 171).
Z
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
235
On-board computer and displays
236
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Speed limit (winter
tyres) - - - km/h
You have reached the stored speed limit for winter tyres. Exceeding
this speed is not possible. You can block the message from being
displayed by pressing the a button. The message only appears
again when you next switch on the ignition.
Cruise control off
Cruise control has been deactivated.
If a warning tone also sounds, cruise control has deactivated automatically (Y page 159).
Cruise control - - km/h
Cruise control cannot be activated since not all of the activation conditions have been met.
X Check the activation conditions for cruise control (Y page 159).
Cruise control and
Limiter inoperative
Cruise control and speed limiter are faulty.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Only for certain countries: the maximum speed has been exceeded.
120 km/h
Maximum speed excee‐ In addition, display ð appears in the multifunction display.
ded
X Drive more slowly.
Display messages
237
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Tyre pressure Check
tyre(s)
The tyre pressure loss warning system has detected a significant loss
in pressure.
A warning tone also sounds.
Possible causes:
Ryou have changed the positions of the wheels and tyres or fitted new
wheels and tyres
RThe tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped
G WARNING
Underinflated tyres pose the following risks:
Rthe tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may greatly
impair tyre traction
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be
greatly impaired
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a flat
tyre (Y page 289).
X Check the tyre pressures and, if necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system when the tyre pressure is correct (Y page 309).
Check tyre pres‐
sures then restart
Run Flat Indicator
Run Flat Indicator
inoperative
Rectify tyre pres‐
sure
The tyre pressure loss warning system generated a display message
and has not been restarted since.
X Set the correct tyre pressure in all four tyres.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 309).
The tyre pressure loss warning system is faulty.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The tyre pressure is too low in at least one of the tyres, or the tyre
pressure difference between the wheels is too great.
X Check the tyre pressures at the next opportunity (Y page 309).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
X Restart the tyre pressure monitor (Y page 311).
Z
On-board computer and displays
Tyres
238
Display messages
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Check tyres
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped significantly. The
wheel position is shown in the multifunction display.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
Underinflated tyres pose the following risks:
Rthe tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may greatly
impair tyre traction
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be
greatly impaired
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a flat
tyre (Y page 289).
X Check the tyre pressure (Y page 309).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Caution, tyre
defect
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped suddenly. The
wheel position is shown in the multifunction display.
G WARNING
If you drive with a flat tyre, there is a risk of the following hazards:
Ra flat tyre affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle
Ryou could lose control of the vehicle
Rcontinued driving with a flat tyre will cause excessive heat build-up
and possibly a fire
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a flat
tyre (Y page 289).
Tyre press. monitor
currently unavaila‐
ble
No signals can be received from the tyre pressure sensors due to
strong RF interference. The tyre pressure monitor is temporarily malfunctioning.
X Drive on.
The tyre pressure monitor restarts automatically as soon as the
cause has been rectified.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Wheel sensor(s)
missing
There is no signal from the tyre pressure sensor of one or several
wheels. The pressure of the affected tyre does not appear in the multifunction display.
X Have the faulty tyre pressure sensor replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyre press. monitor
inoperative No
wheel sensors
The wheels fitted do not have suitable tyre pressure sensors. The tyre
pressure monitor is deactivated.
X Fit wheels with suitable tyre pressure sensors.
The tyre pressure monitor is activated automatically after driving for
a few minutes.
Tyre press. monitor
inoperative
The tyre pressure monitor is faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicle
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
To start the
engine, shift to
either P or N
You have attempted to start the engine with the transmission in position R or D.
X Shift the transmission to position P or N.
Apply brake to dese‐ You have attempted to move the transmission selector lever to posilect Park (P) posi‐ tion D, R or N without depressing the brake pedal.
tion
X Depress the brake pedal.
To shift out of P
or N, depress brake
and start engine
With the engine switched off, you have attempted to shift the transmission out of position P or N into another transmission position.
X Depress the brake pedal.
X Start the engine.
Risk of vehicle
rolling Driver door
open transmission
not in P
The driver's door is not fully closed and the transmission is in position
R, N or D.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
The vehicle may roll away.
There is a risk of an accident.
X When parking the vehicle, shift the transmission to position P.
Only select Park
(P) when vehicle is
stationary
The vehicle is moving.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
Z
239
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
240
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Apply brake to
select R
You attempted to shift from position D to position R.
X Depress the brake pedal.
X Shift the transmission to position R.
Without changing
gear, consult work‐
shop
You cannot change the transmission position due to a malfunction.
A warning tone also sounds.
If transmission position D is selected:
X
Drive to a qualified specialist workshop without shifting the transmission from position D.
If transmission position R, N or P is selected:
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Reversing not poss.
Consult workshop
You cannot shift into the transmission position R due to a malfunction.
The transmission positions P, N or D continue to be available.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Transmission Mal‐
function Stop
A malfunction has occurred in the mechanical transmission components.
A warning tone also sounds. The transmission shifts automatically to
position N.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Stop vehicle Leave
engine running Wait
Transmission cool‐
ing
The transmission has overheated. Pulling away can be temporarily
impaired or not possible.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Wait until the display message disappears before pulling away.
Auxiliary battery
malfunction
The auxiliary battery for the automatic transmission is no longer being
charged.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop at the next opportunity.
X Until then, set the transmission to position P before you switch off
the engine.
X Before leaving the vehicle, apply the electric parking brake.
N
The boot lid is open.
X Close the boot lid.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
M
The bonnet is open.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
The open bonnet may then block your view when the vehicle is in
motion.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Close the bonnet.
Active bonnet mal‐
function See Own‐
er's Manual
C
Ð
Power steering mal‐
function See Own‐
er's Manual
The active bonnet (pedestrian protection) is not active due to a malfunction or because it has already been triggered.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds.
Close all doors.
X
The power steering assistance is faulty.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
You will need to use more force to steer.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Check whether you are able to apply the extra force required.
X If you are able to steer safely: carefully drive on to a qualified
specialist workshop.
X If you are unable to steer safely: do not drive on. Contact the
nearest qualified specialist workshop.
J
The boot separator is open.
The boot is loaded too high and the load is preventing automatic closClose boot separator ing of the boot separator.
X Stow the load such that the boot separator can close unhindered
and is not pushed upwards.
X Close the boot separator (Y page 95).
*
Close centre com‐
partment
The stowage space under the armrest is open. The interior motion
sensor is not primed.
X Close the stowage space under the armrest (Y page 262).
Telephone No service Your vehicle is outside the network provider's transmitter/receiver
range.
X Wait until the mobile phone operational readiness symbol appears
in the multifunction display.
Z
241
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
242
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
K
You attempted to open the roof while the vehicle was in motion.
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Open the roof (Y page 94).
K
The roof is not fully opened or closed. The hydraulics are depressurised.
X Fully open or close the roof (Y page 94).
Decrease speed
Vario-roof lowering
K
Open/close varioroof completely
K
Start engine See
Owner's Manual
X
The roof is not locked.
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Push or pull and hold the roof switch until the roof is fully open or
closed (Y page 94).
X
The on-board voltage is too low.
Start the engine.
X After approximately ten seconds, repeat the opening or closing
procedure (Y page 94).
X
The roof has been opened and closed several times in a row. The roof
drive has been switched off automatically for safety reasons.
You can open and close the roof again after approximately ten
minutes.
X Switch the ignition off and then on again.
X Repeat the opening or closing procedure (Y page 94).
Close rear side win‐ You leave the vehicle and at least one rear side window is open.
dows
X Close the side windows (Y page 91).
¥
Top up washer fluid
The washer fluid level in the washer fluid reservoir has dropped below
the minimum.
X Top up the washer fluid (Y page 280).
Wiper malfunction‐
ing
The windscreen wipers are defective.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Hazard warning
lamps malfunction‐
ing
The hazard warning lamps are faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
243
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Â
You have put the wrong key in the ignition lock.
X Use the correct key.
Key does not belong
to vehicle
Â
Replace key
The key needs to be replaced.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Â
The key battery is discharged.
X Change the battery (Y page 80).
Â
The key is not in the vehicle.
A warning tone also sounds.
If the engine is switched off, you can no longer lock the vehicle centrally or start the engine.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Locate the key.
X Press a on the steering wheel to confirm the display message.
Change key batteries
Key not detected
(red display message)
Because there is interference from a strong source of radio waves, the
key is not detected whilst the engine is running.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Insert the key into the ignition lock and bring into key mode.
Â
Key not detected
(white display message)
The key is currently undetected.
Change the location of the key in the vehicle.
X
If the key still cannot be detected:
Insert the key into the ignition lock and turn it to the desired position.
X
Â
The key is continually undetected.
KEYLESS-GO is temporarily malfunctioning or is defective. A warning
Remove starting but‐ tone also sounds.
ton, then insert key
X Insert the key into the ignition lock and turn it to the desired position.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
On-board computer and displays
Key
244
Warning and indicator lamps
Warning and indicator lamps
On-board computer and displays
General notes
Some systems carry out a self-diagnosis when the ignition is switched on. Several warning and
indicator lamps can thereby temporarily light up or flash. This behaviour is non-critical. These
warning and indicator lamps only indicate a malfunction if they light up or flash after the engine is
started or during a journey.
Safety
Seat belts
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ü
N Only for certain countries: the red seat belt warning lamp lights up for 6 seconds
after the engine starts.
The seat belt warning lamp reminds the driver and front passenger to fasten their
seat belts.
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 42).
ü
N Only for certain countries: the red seat belt warning lamp lights up after the
engine starts. In addition, a warning tone sounds for up to 6 seconds.
The driver's seat belt is not fastened.
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 42).
The warning tone ceases.
ü
N The red seat belt warning lamp lights up after the engine starts, as soon as the
driver's or the front-passenger door is closed.
The driver or passenger has not fastened their seat belt.
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 42).
The warning lamp goes out.
There are objects on the front-passenger seat.
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow them in a secure
place.
The warning lamp goes out.
ü
N The red seat belt warning lamp flashes and an intermittent audible warning
sounds.
The driver or passenger has not fastened their seat belt. At the same time, you are
driving faster than 25 km/h or have briefly driven faster than 25 km/h.
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 42).
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone ceases.
There are objects on the front-passenger seat. At the same time, you are driving
faster than 25 km/h or have briefly driven faster than 25 km/h.
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow them in a secure
place.
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone ceases.
Warning and indicator lamps
245
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
J
N The red brake system warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
The brake boosting effect is malfunctioning and the braking characteristics may be
affected.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road
and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving under any circumstances.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
J
N The red brake system warning lamp is lit while the engine is running. A warning
tone also sounds.
G WARNING
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
Braking efficiency may be impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road
and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving under any circumstances.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Do not top up the brake fluid. Topping up will not rectify the fault.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
J
N The yellow brake system warning lamp lights up while the engine is running or
the ECO start/stop function is activated.
G WARNING
The brake system is malfunctioning and the braking characteristics may be affected.
There is a risk of an accident.
X If the multifunction display shows a display message, please observe this.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
On-board computer and displays
Safety systems
On-board computer and displays
246
Warning and indicator lamps
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
N The yellow ABS warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) is faulty.
An additional warning tone indicates that EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
is faulty.
Other driving and driving safety systems may also be faulty.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed
above. The front and rear wheels could therefore lock, for example, if you brake
hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking
distance may increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
If the ABS control unit is faulty, there is also a possibility that other systems, such
as the navigation system or the automatic transmission, will be unavailable.
J÷
å!
N The red brake system warning lamp and the yellow ESP®, ESP® OFF and ABS
warning lamps are lit while the engine is running.
ABS and ESP® are faulty.
Other driving and driving safety systems may also be faulty.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed
above. The front and rear wheels could therefore lock, for example, if you brake
hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking
distance may increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
÷
N The yellow ESP® warning lamp flashes while the vehicle is in motion.
ESP® or traction control has intervened because there is a risk of skidding or at
least one wheel has started to spin.
Cruise control or Distance Pilot DISTRONIC is deactivated.
X Only depress the accelerator pedal as far as necessary when pulling away.
X Accelerate more gently while the vehicle is in motion.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
X Do not deactivate ESP®.
In rare cases (Y page 70) it may be better to deactivate ESP®.
Observe the important safety notes on ESP® (Y page 67).
֌
N The yellow ESP® and ESP® OFF warning lamps are lit while the engine is running.
ESP® is faulty.
Other driving and driving safety systems may also be faulty.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed
above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
å
N The yellow ESP® OFF warning lamp is lit while the engine is running or the ECO
start/stop function is activated.
ESP® is deactivated.
G WARNING
If ESP® is deactivated, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
Further driving systems or driving safety systems are thus restricted, e.g. Active
Blind Spot Assist. The system does not perform course-correcting braking applications.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Reactivate ESP®.
In rare cases (Y page 70) it may be better to deactivate ESP®.
Observe the important safety notes on ESP® (Y page 67).
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
If ESP® cannot be activated:
X Drive on carefully.
X Have ESP® checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
247
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps
On-board computer and displays
248
Warning and indicator lamps
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
M
N Mercedes-AMG vehicles only:
The yellow SPORT handling mode warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
SPORT handling mode is activated.
G WARNING
When SPORT handling mode is activated, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Only switch to SPORT handling mode in accordance with the conditions described in the "Activating/deactivating ESP®" section (Y page 70).
!
N The red indicator lamp for the electric parking brake flashes or is lit and/or the
yellow warning lamp for the electric parking brake is lit.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
6
N The red restraint system warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
The restraint system is malfunctioning.
G WARNING
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the
event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Contact a qualified specialist workshop immediately and have the restraint system checked.
For further information on the restraint system, see (Y page 40).
Warning and indicator lamps
249
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
;
N The yellow engine diagnostics warning lamp lights up while the engine is running.
There may be a fault, for example:
Rin the engine management
Rin the fuel injection system
Rin the exhaust system
Rin the ignition system
Rin the fuel system
The emission limit values may be exceeded and the engine may be running in
emergency mode.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
8
N The yellow reserve fuel warning lamp is on while the engine is running.
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
?
N The red coolant warning lamp lights up while the engine is running and the
coolant temperature gauge is at the start of the scale.
The temperature sensor for the coolant temperature gauge is faulty.
The coolant temperature is no longer being monitored. There is a risk of engine
damage if the coolant temperature is too high.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions,
and switch off the engine. Do not continue driving under any circumstances.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
On-board computer and displays
Engine
On-board computer and displays
250
Warning and indicator lamps
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
N The red coolant warning lamp comes on while the engine is running.
The coolant level is too low.
If the coolant level is correct, the airflow to the engine radiator may be blocked or
the electric engine radiator fan may be malfunctioning.
The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled sufficiently.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions,
and switch off the engine.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until the engine has
cooled down.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant, observing the warning notes
(Y page 279).
X If you have to top up the coolant frequently, have the engine cooling system
checked.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not blocked, e.g. by frozen
slush.
X Do not start the engine again until the coolant temperature is below 120 †. The
engine may otherwise be damaged.
X Drive to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in mountainous terrain
and stop-start traffic.
?
N The red coolant warning lamp comes on while the engine is running.
The coolant temperature has exceeded 120 †. The airflow to the engine radiator
may be blocked or the coolant level may be too low.
G WARNING
The engine is not being cooled sufficiently and may be damaged.
Never drive with an overheated engine. Driving when your engine is overheated
can cause some fluids which may have leaked into the engine compartment to
catch fire.
In addition, steam from an overheated engine can cause serious burns, which can
occur just by opening the bonnet.
There is a risk of injury.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions,
and switch off the engine.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until the engine has
cooled down.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant, observing the warning notes
(Y page 279).
X If you have to top up the coolant frequently, have the engine cooling system
checked.
Warning and indicator lamps
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not blocked, e.g. by frozen
slush.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue driving to the
nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in mountainous terrain
and stop-start traffic.
X
Driving systems
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
·
N The red distance warning lamp lights up while the vehicle is in motion.
The distance to the vehicle in front is too small for the speed selected.
X Increase the distance.
·
N The red distance warning lamp lights up while the vehicle is in motion. A warning
tone also sounds.
You are approaching a vehicle, a pedestrian or a stationary obstacle in your line of
travel at too high a speed.
X Be prepared to brake immediately.
X Pay careful attention to the traffic situation. You may have to brake or take
evasive action.
Further information on Distance Pilot DISTRONIC (Y page 161).
Further information on Active Brake Assist (Y page 64).
Further information on Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function (Y page 72).
Z
On-board computer and displays
Warning/
indicator
lamp
251
252
Warning and indicator lamps
On-board computer and displays
Tyres
Warning/
indicator
lamp
N Signal type
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
h
N The yellow tyre pressure monitor warning lamp (pressure loss/malfunction) is
lit.
The tyre pressure monitor has detected a loss of pressure in at least one of the
tyres.
G WARNING
Underinflated tyres pose the following risks:
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed increase
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may greatly impair tyre
traction
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be greatly
impaired
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking manoeuvres.
Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 153).
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a flat tyre
(Y page 289).
X Check the tyre pressure (Y page 309).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Rthe
h
N The yellow tyre pressure monitor warning lamp (pressure loss/malfunction)
flashes for approximately one minute and then remains lit.
The tyre pressure monitor is faulty.
G WARNING
The system is possibly unable to detect or register low tyre pressure.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Operating system
The multimedia system section in this manual
describes the basic principles for operation.
More information can be found in the Digital
Owner's Manual.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
You must observe the legal requirements for the
country in which you are currently driving when
operating the multimedia system.
The multimedia system calculates the route to
the destination without taking the following into
account, for example:
Rtraffic lights
Rstop and give way signs
Rparking or stopping restrictions
Rroad narrowing
Rother road and traffic rules and regulations
The multimedia system may give incorrect driving recommendations if the actual road/traffic
situation does not correspond with the digital
map data.
For example:
Ra diverted route
Rthe road layout or the direction of a one-way
street has been changed
For this reason, you must always observe road
and traffic rules and regulations during your
journey. Road and traffic rules and regulations
always have priority over multimedia system
driving recommendations.
Function restrictions
For safety reasons, some functions are restricted or unavailable while the vehicle is in motion.
You will notice this, for example, because either
you will not be able to select certain menu items
or a message will appear to this effect.
Operating system
Overview
General notes
! Do not use the space in front of the display
for storage. Objects placed here could damage the display or impair its function. Avoid
any direct contact with the display surface.
Pressure on the display surface may result in
impairments to the display, which could be
irreversible.
Wearing polarised sunglasses may impair your
ability to read the display.
The display has an automatic temperature-controlled switch-off feature. The brightness is
automatically reduced if the temperature is too
high. If necessary, the display may temporarily
switch off completely.
Cleaning instructions
! Do not touch the display. The display has a
very sensitive high-gloss surface; there is a
risk of scratching. If you have to clean the
screen, however, use a mild cleaning agent
and a soft, lint-free cloth.
The display must be switched off and have
cooled down before you start cleaning. Do not
apply pressure to the display surface when
cleaning it, as this could cause irreversible damage to the display.
Switching the multimedia system
on/off
X
Press the q control knob.
Z
Multimedia system
General notes
253
Operating system
254
Adjusting the volume
Back button
Turn the q control knob.
The volume is adjusted:
Rfor the currently selected media source
Rduring traffic or navigation announcements
Rin hands-free mode during a phone call
You can use the % button to exit a menu or to
call up the basic display of the current operating
mode.
X To exit the menu: briefly press the %
button.
The multimedia system changes to the next
higher menu level in the current operating
mode.
X To call up the basic display: press the %
button for longer than two seconds.
The multimedia system changes to the basic
display of the current operating mode.
X
Switching the sound on/off
Press the 8 button on the control panel.
If the audio output is switched off, the status
line will show the 8 symbol. If you switch
the media source or set the volume, the sound
is automatically switched on.
i Navigation messages will be heard even if
the sound is muted.
Multimedia system
X
Functions
The multimedia system has the following functions:
RRadio mode
RMedia mode with media search
RSound systems
RNavigation system
COMAND Online: navigation via the hard drive
Audio 20: navigation via SD card
RCommunication functions
RVehicle functions with system settings
RFavourites functions
Favourites
Calling up and exiting favourites
To call up: press the ò button on the controller.
X Select a favourite, e. g. Vehicle
Vehicle.
The favourites are displayed.
X To exit: press the ò button again.
X
Adding favourites
Adding a predefined favourite
Controller
The controller in the centre console lets you:
menu items on the display
Renter characters
Rselect a destination on the map
Rsave entries
The controller can be:
Rturned 3
Rslid left or right 1
Rslid forwards or back 4
Rslid diagonally 2
Rpressed briefly or pressed and held 7
Rselect
:
;
=
?
To add a new favourite
To rename a selected favourite
To move a selected favourite
To delete a selected favourite
Press the ò button.
Slide 6 the controller.
The menu bar is shown.
X Select Reassign
Reassign.
The categories are displayed.
X Select a category.
The favourites are displayed.
X
X
Operating system
X
Select a favourite.
Add a favourite at the desired position.
If a favourite has already been added at this
position, it will be overwritten.
Adding your own favourite
Select Vehicle
VehicleQClimate
Climate control.
control
Press and hold the ò button until the
favourites are displayed.
X Add a favourite at the desired position.
If a favourite has already been added at this
position, it will be overwritten.
X
X
Navigation mode
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
You must observe the legal requirements for the
country in which you are currently driving when
operating the navigation system.
General notes
Correct functioning of the navigation system
depends, amongst other things, on GPS reception. In certain situations, GPS reception may be
impaired, there may be interference or there
may be no reception at all, e.g. in tunnels or
multi-storey car parks.
Audio 20 is equipped with Garmin® MAP PILOT
(see the manufacturer's operating instructions).
The Garmin® MAP PILOT operating instructions
are stored on the SD memory card as a PDF file.
The SD card box contains a quick guide.
The following descriptions apply to navigation
with COMAND Online. Further information can
be found in the Digital Owner's Manual.
Selecting a route type and route options
Multimedia system:
Select Navi
NaviQNavigation
Navigation.
The map displays the current vehicle position.
X Slide 6 the controller.
X Select Options
OptionsQRoute
Route settings.
settings
Notes for route types:
X
REco
route
route
Traffic reports on the route for the route guidance are taken into account.
RDynamic route only after request
You can decide whether or not current traffic
reports should be taken into account for route
calculation.
RCalculate alternative routes
Different routes are being calculated. In order
to do so, instead of Start
Start, select the menu
item Continue
Continue.
Notes for route options:
RDynamic
RUse
toll roads
The route calculation includes roads which
require you to pay a usage fee (toll).
RUse vignette roads (not available in all
countries)
The route calculation includes roads which
require you to pay a time-based fee (vignette).
A vignette allows temporary use of the route
network, e. g. 10 days or 1 year.
Entering an address
Multimedia system:
Select Navi
NaviQNavigation
Navigation.
The map displays the current vehicle position.
X Slide 6 the controller.
X Select Destination
DestinationQAddress
Address entry.
entry
Enter an address, e.g. as follows:
Rtown or postcode, street, house number
Rcountry, town or postcode
Rtown or postcode, centre
Rstreet, town or postcode, junction
X Select Town
Town.
The town in which the vehicle is currently
located (current vehicle position) is at the top.
Below this, you will see locations for which
route guidance has already been carried out.
X
Z
Multimedia system
X
255
Operating system
256
Enter the town.
The G symbol: the location is contained on
the digital map multiple times.
X To switch to the list: slide 5 the controller.
X Select the location.
If available, the postcode is shown. If there
are different postcodes available for the location, the corresponding digits are displayed
with an X.
X Enter the street and house number.
The address is in the menu.
Further options for destination entry:
destination and opens the intermediate destinations list.
Multimedia system
X
Rsearch
for a keyword
The keyword search finds destinations using
fragments of words.
Rselect the last destination
Rselect a contact
Rselect a POI
You can search for a POI by location, name or
telephone number.
Rselect destination on the map
Renter intermediate destination
You can map the route to the destination
yourself with up to four intermediate destinations.
Rselect travel guide destination (only available
for selected European countries)
Rselect destinations from Mercedes-Benz
Apps
Rselect geo-coordinates
Calculating the route
Prerequisite: the address has been entered and
is in the menu.
X Select Start or Continue
Continue.
The route is calculated with the selected route
type and the selected route options.
If route guidance has already been activated,
a prompt will appear asking whether you wish
to end the current route guidance.
X Select Yes or Set as intermediate des‐
tination.
tination
Yes cancels the current route guidance and
starts route calculation to the new destination.
Set as intermediate destination adds
the new destination in addition to the existing
Connecting the mobile phone
Requirements
For telephony via the Bluetooth® interface, you
require a Bluetooth®-capable mobile phone. The
mobile phone must support Hands-Free Profile
1.0 or above.
Multimedia system:
Select Vehicle
VehicleQSystem
System set‐
tingsQActivate
tings
Activate Bluetooth.
Bluetooth
X Activate Bluetooth® O.
X
Mobile phone:
X
Activate Bluetooth® and, if necessary, Bluetooth® visibility for other devices (see the
manufacturer's operating instructions).
The Bluetooth® device names for all of one manufacturer's products might be identical. To
make it possible to clearly identify your mobile
phone, change the device name (see the manufacturer's operating instructions).
If the mobile phone supports the PBAP (Phone
Book Access Profile) and MAP (Message
Access Profile) Bluetooth® profiles, the following information will be transmitted after you
connect:
RPhone book
RCall lists
RText messages and e-mails
i Further information on suitable mobile
phones can be obtained on the Internet at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.com/
connect
Searching for and authorising (connecting) a mobile phone
Before using your mobile phone with the multimedia system for the first time, you will need to
search for the phone and then authorise (connect) it. Depending on the mobile phone, authorisation takes place by means of Secure Simple
Pairing or by entering a passkey. The multimedia
system automatically makes the procedure that
is relevant for your mobile phone available. The
mobile phone is always connected automati-
Operating system
Select Tel/
Tel/®QConnect
Connect
device Search for phones
deviceQSearch
phonesQStart
Start
search.
search
The available mobile phones are displayed.
Symbols in the device list
X
Symbol
Explanation
Ï
New mobile phone found, not yet
authorised.
Ñ
Mobile phone is authorised, but is
not connected.
#
Mobile phone is authorised and
connected.
Connecting the mobile phone
Authorisation using Secure Simple Pairing:
X Select the mobile phone.
A code is displayed in the multimedia system
and on the mobile phone.
X If codes match: select Yes on the multimedia
system.
X Confirm the code on the mobile phone.
Depending on the mobile phone used, confirm the connection to the multimedia system
and for the PBAP and MAP Bluetooth® profiles. The prompt to confirm may take up to
two minutes to be displayed (see the manufacturer's operating instructions).
X If the codes are different: select No on the
multimedia system.
The process is cancelled.
Repeat authorisation.
Authorisation by entering a passkey (passcode):
Select the Bluetooth® name of the mobile
phone.
The input menu for the passkey is displayed.
X Choose a one- to sixteen-digit number combination as a passkey.
X Enter the passkey on the multimedia system.
X Press ¬ to confirm.
X Enter and confirm the passkey on the mobile
phone. Depending on the mobile phone used,
confirm the connection to the multimedia system and for the PBAP and MAP Bluetooth®
profiles. The prompt to confirm may take up
to two minutes to be displayed (see the manufacturer's operating instructions).
X
i Mobile phones that are connected to the
optionally available telephone module with
Bluetooth® (SAP profile) are displayed separately in the device list. These are found below
the entry MB SAP module phones.
phones
Switching between mobile phones
If you have authorised more than one mobile
phone, you can switch between the individual
phones.
Multimedia system:
X
X
Select Connect device.
device
Select a mobile phone from the device list.
Telephone module with Bluetooth®
(SAP profile)
Introduction
The module can be used as a permanently installed telephone with its own SIM card
(Y page 258) or in conjunction with a mobile
phone (Y page 259).
If you wish to use the module in conjunction with
your mobile telephone, the mobile phone must
support the Bluetooth® SAP profile (SIM Access
Profile).
The following functions are available using the
module:
Rhands-free mode
Rdata modem mode (Y page 259)
Rsending and receiving text messages
(Y page 260)
Z
Multimedia system
cally after authorisation. Further information on
using a mobile phone with the multimedia system (see the Digital Owner's Manual).
If the multimedia system does not detect your
mobile phone, this may be due to particular
security settings on your mobile phone (see the
manufacturer's operating instructions).
Only one mobile phone can be connected to the
multimedia system at any one time.
Searching for a mobile phone
Multimedia system:
257
258
Operating system
Raccess to the phone book of the mobile phone
(if supported by the mobile phone)
(Y page 259)
Rcharging a mobile phone via the USB connection (Y page 260)
Activating and connecting the module
i The module is not available in all vehicles,
depending on the equipment.
Multimedia system
Installing the module
Multimedia system:
Select Tel/
Tel/® .
Module: install (Y page 258).
X Press and hold button ;.
X As soon as indicator lamp : starts flashing
yellow, release the button.
The indicator lamp continues to flash yellow.
X
X
Mounting the module in the stowage compartment of the centre console
X Slide module ; into bracket : until it audibly engages.
Connecting the module using a USB
cable (COMAND Online)
Multimedia system:
Select Connect deviceQConnect
device Connect MB
SAP moduleQStart
module Start search.
search
The module is searched for and connected.
X To authorise a mobile phone: select Start
search and follow the instructions of the multimedia system. Further information on
authorising and connecting mobile phones
(Y page 256).
X
SIM card mode
Inserting a SIM card
Mounting the module in the stowage compartment of the centre console
X Insert USB cable : into the module.
X Slide the module into the bracket until it audibly engages.
X Connect the USB cable to the USB port.
X
With the contact surface facing down, insert
SIM card : into the SIM card slot until it
engages.
After a SIM card is inserted in the module, a
Bluetooth® connection with another mobile
Operating system
Connecting the mobile phone
General notes
Before using your mobile phone with the module
and the multimedia system for the first time, you
will need to search for the phone and then
authorise it.
Requirements
The mobile phone can be authorised and connected to the module if:
Rthe module is installed (Y page 258) and activated in the multimedia system
(Y page 258)
Rno SIM card is inserted in the module
Rthe mobile phone has no active Bluetooth®
connection to another device
Rthe mobile phone supports the Bluetooth®
SAP profile (SIM Access Profile)
Depending on the type of mobile phone, different settings must be changed on the mobile
phone (see the manufacturer's operating
instructions).
RBluetooth® must be activated on the mobile
phone and must be made visible to other devices
Rthe Bluetooth® SIM Access Profile of the
mobile phone must be activated
Switching between mobile phones
If you have authorised more than one mobile
phone on the module, you can switch between
the individual phones.
X Select the mobile phone under MB SAP mod‐
ule phones.
phones
X Confirm the connection request (see the manufacturer's operating instructions).
X Where necessary, enter the SIM card PIN into
the multimedia system and confirm.
Data modem mode
X
or
Connect the mobile phone to the module
(Y page 259).
Insert the SIM card into the SIM card slot on
the module (Y page 258).
X Before connecting for the first time, enable
the module for Internet access and select the
network provider in the multimedia system
(see the manufacturer's operating instructions).
Use as a data modem is automatically activated.
X Activate/deactivate data roaming (see the
manufacturer's operating instructions).
For further information on data mode without
telephony with COMAND Online (see the manufacturer's operating instructions).
X
Settings
Authorising and connecting a mobile
phone
Storing/deleting the SIM card PIN
Multimedia system:
Select Connect device
deviceQMB
MB SAP module
phones
X Highlight the mobile phone.
X To select G: navigate to the right.
X Activate O or deactivate ªStore
Store PIN.
PIN
Select Connect deviceQSearch
device Search for
phonesQSAP
phones
SAP phoneQStart
phone Start
searchQMB
search
MB SAP module phones
X Select the mobile phone.
X Enter and confirm any 16-digit PIN.
X Enter and confirm the same PIN on the mobile
phone.
X Where necessary, enter the SIM card PIN into
the multimedia system and confirm.
i Please observe the messages in the mobile
phone. If necessary, you will be asked to confirm further profile requests.
X
Multimedia system:
X
Transferring the phone book
In order to use the phone book of the mobile
phone via the multimedia system, the phone
book must be transferred using the module.
The transfer of data may take up to ten minutes.
Transmission occurs automatically after a Bluetooth® connection is automatically established.
Z
Multimedia system
phone is no longer possible. Any existing
Bluetooth® connection is ended upon SIM
card insertion.
259
Operating system
260
Text messages
The following external media sources can be
used:
Requirements
The module is connected with the mobile phone
(Y page 259) or is being used in the SIM card
mode (Y page 258).
Multimedia system
Activating/deactivating text message
downloading from the mobile phone
Dial number
Function
00080
Text message downloading is deactivated.
00081
Text message downloading is activated.
RApple®
devices (e.g. iPhone®)
RUSB devices (e.g. USB stick, MP3 player)
RCD
RDVD (COMAND Online)
RSD cards
Rvia devices connected by Bluetooth®
i Information on the single CD/DVD drive or
DVD changer (see the Digital Owner's Manual).
Using the device list
Multimedia system:
Select Media
MediaQDevices
Devices.
The available media sources will be shown.
The # dot indicates the current setting.
X Select the media source.
Playable files are played back.
X
For further information on receiving text messages when using the telephone module (see
the manufacturer's operating instructions).
Charging a mobile phone
Inserting/removing SD memory card
Important safety notes
Slide cover ; on the module in the direction
of the arrow and remove it.
X Connect the mobile phone with a USB data
cable to USB socket :.
X
Media mode
General notes
If you wish to play external media sources, the
default display must already be turned on. Further information on media mode (see the Digital
Owner's Manual).
G WARNING
SD memory cards are small parts. They can be
swallowed and cause asphyxiation. This
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
Keep SD memory cards out of the reach of
children. If an SD memory card is swallowed,
seek immediate medical attention.
! If you are no longer using the SD memory
card, you should remove it and take it out of
the vehicle. High temperatures can damage
the card.
Inserting an SD memory card
The SD card slot is on the control panel.
X Insert the SD memory card into the SD card
slot until it engages. The side with the contacts must face downwards.
Ejecting an SD memory card
Press the memory card.
The memory card is ejected.
X Remove the memory card.
X
Operating system
261
Connecting USB devices
Multimedia system
There are two USB ports in the stowage space
under the armrest.
X Connect the USB device to the USB port.
X Select the media source (Y page 260).
Z
Stowage areas
262
Stowage areas
Stowage compartments
Important safety notes
Stowing and features
G WARNING
If objects in the passenger compartment are
stowed incorrectly, they can slide or be
thrown around and hit vehicle occupants. In
addition, cupholders, open stowage spaces
and mobile phone brackets cannot always
retain all objects they contain. There is a risk
of injury, particularly in the event of sudden
braking or a sudden change in direction.
RAlways stow objects so that they cannot be
thrown around in such situations.
RAlways make sure that objects do not protrude from stowage spaces, parcel nets or
stowage nets.
RClose the lockable stowage spaces before
starting a journey.
RAlways stow and secure heavy, hard, pointed, sharp-edged, fragile or bulky objects in
the boot.
The glove compartment can be locked and
unlocked using the emergency key element.
X To lock: insert the emergency key element
into the lock and turn it to position 2.
X To unlock: insert the emergency key element
into the lock and turn it to position 1.
Stowage compartment/telephone
compartment under the armrest
Glove compartment
X
To open: press button :.
Armrest ; folds out.
There is a stowage tray and a mobile phone
bracket the stowage compartment.
i Depending on the vehicle equipment, a USB
To open: pull handle : and open glove compartment flap ;.
X To close: fold glove compartment flap ;
upwards until it engages.
In the glove compartment, there is a coin holder,
a map holder and a pen holder.
X
i The glove compartment can be ventilated
(Y page 130).
port and a Media Interface is installed in the
stowage compartment. A Media Interface is a
universal interface for mobile audio equipment, e.g. for an iPod® or MP3 Player .
Stowage areas
X
To open: press marking :.
Spectacles compartment ; opens.
Make sure that the spectacles compartment is
always closed while the vehicle is in motion.
Stowage compartment in the centre
console
Umbrella holder
Example: left side of the vehicle
There are umbrella holders in the door stowage
compartments on both sides of the vehicle. One
compact umbrella can be stowed per side.
X To remove: take hold of strap ; and pull
umbrella holder : out of the stowage compartment in the direction of the arrow.
X To insert: push umbrella holder : in the
opposite direction to the arrow and into the
stowage compartment until it engages.
You can remove the umbrella holder to clean it.
Wash it with clean, lukewarm water only.
Stowage compartment in the rear
centre console
To open: briefly press the trim of cover :.
To remove the rubber mat: grip the rubber
mat by its tabs and pull it upwards.
X To insert the rubber mat: push the rubber
mat into the casing.
X To close: fold cover : downwards until it
engages.
You can remove the rubber mat for the stowage
compartment to clean it. Wash it with clean,
lukewarm water only.
Depending on the vehicle's equipment, the
stowage compartment for the centre console
contains a cup holder and an ashtray.
X
X
To open: slide cover : in the direction of the
arrow.
On vehicles equipped with a fire extinguisher,
the fire extinguisher is fitted in the stowage
compartment (Y page 287).
On vehicles equipped with a bottle holder, the
bottle holder is located in the stowage compartment (Y page 267).
X
Z
Stowing and features
Spectacles compartment
263
264
Stowage areas
Stowage compartment in the rear compartment
Loading aid in the boot
Raising/lowering the roof
Stowing and features
G WARNING
Body parts can become trapped when the roof
is being raised or lowered. There is a risk of
injury.
When raising or lowering the roof, make sure
that no parts of the body are in the vicinity of
moving parts. Press the switch again if someone becomes trapped.
Only the left side of the vehicle features a rear
stowage compartment.
X Open the seat belt guide and remove the seat
belt (Y page 103).
X Move the left-hand front seat forwards
(Y page 104) and fold the seat backrest forwards.
X To open: press release button ;.
Cover : folds upwards.
X To close: fold down cover : and let it
engage.
X Fold back the seat backrest of the left-hand
front seat and move the seat back
(Y page 104).
X Insert the seat belt back into the seat belt
guide.
Stowage net
! Only close the boot once the roof is lowered
completely. Otherwise, you could damage the
roof.
To make it easier to load your luggage, you can
raise the stowed roof after you have opened the
boot lid.
You can only raise roof ; when the boot lid is
fully open.
X To raise the roof: press switch :.
Roof ; is raised slightly and boot separator
= moves to the open position. Switch :
lights up brightly.
X
There is a stowage net : in the front-passenger
footwell.
To lower the roof: press switch :.
The boot separator moves to the closed position and roof ; lowers slightly. Switch :
lights up dimly.
Vehicles with boot lid remote closing feature: when the boot lid is opened, the loading
aid rises automatically. It lowers automatically when the boot lid is closed.
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO and HANDSFREE ACCESS: when the boot lid is opened,
the loading aid rises automatically. When the
roof is closed, the boot separator remains in
the open position. The boot separator moves
Stowage areas
265
Stowing and features
to the closed position automatically when the
roof is lowered.
Z
Features
266
Problems with the loading aid
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
It is no longer possible to You cannot close the boot any more.
lower the stowed roof in X Call a qualified specialist workshop.
the boot using the loading aid.
Stowing and features
Stowage well under the boot floor
RClose
lockable stowage compartments
while driving.
RStow and secure objects that are heavy,
hard, pointy, sharp-edged, fragile or too
large in the boot.
! Only use the cup holders for containers of
the right size and which have lids. The drinks
could otherwise spill.
! Do not expose drinks bottles in the cup
holder in the centre console to continuous,
strong and direct sunlight. The passenger
compartment in the area of the centre console can otherwise be damaged by the concentrated and reflected sunlight.
To open: open boot separator ;
(Y page 95).
X Swing boot floor = upwards using loop :.
X
The TIREFIT kit, tyre-change tool kit, etc. is located in the stowage compartment.
Cup holder in the centre console
Features
Cup holders
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you do not correctly store objects in the
vehicle interior, they can slip or be flung
around, thus striking vehicle occupants.
There is a risk of injury, especially when braking or abruptly changing directions.
RAlways store objects so that they cannot be
flung around in these or in similar situations.
RAlways make sure that objects do not protrude from stowage compartments, luggage nets or stowage nets.
To open: open stowage compartment =
(Y page 263).
X To remove the insert: slide catches :
inwards in the direction of the arrow.
X Remove the cup holder insert upwards.
X To refit the insert: place the insert in stowage compartment =.
X Slide catches : outwards in the direction of
the arrow until they engage.
X
Features
You can remove the rubber mat of the cup
holder to clean it. Wash it with clean, lukewarm
water only.
Reducer ; can be removed. In this way, you
can place large and small containers in the cup
holder.
X To remove: grip reducer ; and pull out
upwards in the direction of the arrow.
X To insert: place reducer ; into the cup
holder and push it downwards against the
direction of the arrow to the stop.
267
Sun visors
Overview
Bottle holders
:
;
=
?
A
Mirror light
Retainer
Retaining strip, e.g. for a car park ticket
Vanity mirror
Mirror cover
Stowing and features
Observe the "Important safety notes" in the
"Stowage compartments" section (Y page 262).
Ashtray
To open: open the stowage compartment
(Y page 263).
X To remove the insert: slide catches :
inwards in the direction of the arrow.
X Lift bottle holder insert ; up and remove.
X To refit the insert: place insert ; in the
stowage compartment.
X Slide catches : outwards in the direction of
the arrow until they engage.
The bottle holder does not secure bottles; it
merely prevents them from tipping over.
X
To open: open stowage compartment :
(Y page 263).
X To remove the insert: pull insert ; up in the
direction of the arrow, out of the cup holder.
X To refit the insert: push insert ; on the lefthand side into the cup holder.
X
i Only refit insert ; on the left-hand side of
the cup holder.
Z
Features
268
Cigarette lighter
G WARNING
You can burn yourself if you touch the hot
heating element or the socket of the cigarette
lighter.
In addition, flammable materials can ignite if:
hot cigarette lighter falls
child holds the hot cigarette lighter to
objects, for example
There is a risk of fire and injury.
Always hold the cigarette lighter by the knob.
Always make sure that the cigarette lighter is
out of reach of children. Never leave children
unattended in the vehicle.
If you use the sockets for long periods when the
engine is switched off, the battery may discharge.
i An emergency cut-off ensures that the on-
board voltage does not drop too low. If the onboard voltage is too low, the power to the
sockets is automatically cut. This ensures
that there is sufficient power to start the
engine.
Rthe
Stowing and features
Ra
Socket in the front-passenger footwell
X
Lift up the cover of socket :.
Socket in the boot
Your attention must always be focused on the
traffic conditions. Only use the cigarette lighter
when road and traffic conditions permit.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
X To open: open stowage compartment :
under the armrest (Y page 262).
X Press in cigarette lighter ;.
Cigarette lighter ; will pop out automatically
when the heating element is red-hot.
12 V sockets
General notes
Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
The sockets can be used for accessories with a
maximum draw of 180 W (15 A). Accessories
include such items as mobile phone chargers.
X
X
Lift up the cover of socket :.
Mobile phone
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating mobile communications equipment while driving distracts you from paying
attention to traffic conditions. This could also
Features
i You must observe the legal requirements for
the country in which you are currently driving
when operating mobile communications
equipment in the vehicle.
If it is permitted by law to operate communications equipment while the vehicle is in
motion, you may only do so if the traffic situation permits. You may otherwise be distracted from the traffic conditions, cause an
accident and injure yourself and others.
Excessive levels of electromagnetic radiation
may cause damage to your health and to the
health of others. The use of an exterior aerial
takes into consideration the scientific discussion surrounding the possible health risk posed
by electromagnetic fields.
Mercedes-Benz recommends the use of an
approved exterior aerial. This ensures:
Roptimal mobile phone reception quality in the
vehicle
Rthat mutual interference between the vehicle
electronics and mobile phones is minimised
An exterior aerial has the following advantages:
Rit conducts the electromagnetic fields generated by a wireless device to the exterior
Rthe field strength in the vehicle interior is
lower than in a vehicle that does not have an
exterior aerial
Information on retrofitting two-way radios and
mobile phones (RF transmitters) (Y page 320).
More information on suitable mobile phones,
mobile phone brackets and on connecting Bluetooth®-capable mobile phones with COMAND
Online can be obtained:
Rat your Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
Ron the Internet at https://www.mercedesbenz.com/de/mercedes-me/
konnektivitaet/
i The functions and services available when
you use the phone depend on your mobile
phone model and service provider.
Using a mobile phone
If the mobile phone is inserted in the mobile
phone bracket, the mobile phone will be
charged and connected with the exterior aerial.
X Open the telephone compartment
(Y page 262).
X Place the mobile phone bracket into the preinstalled fitting; see the separate installation
instructions for the mobile phone fitting.
X Insert the mobile phone into the mobile phone
bracket; see the separate installation instructions for the mobile phone fitting.
Operating the mobile phone
You can operate the telephone using the 6
and ~ buttons on the multifunction steering
wheel. You can operate other mobile phone
functions via the on-board computer
(Y page 205).
When you remove the key from the ignition lock,
the mobile phone is disconnected from the
hands-free system. Active calls will first be
transferred to the mobile phone directly.
General notes
There are various mobile phone brackets that
may be fitted in your vehicle; in some cases,
these are country-specific.
You can connect a Bluetooth®-capable mobile
phone with COMAND Online through the Bluetooth® interface. This also applies if your vehicle
is equipped with convenience telephony.
Garage door opener
General notes
The HomeLink® garage door opener integrated
in the rear-view mirror allows you to operate up
to three different door and gate systems.
Once programmed, the integrated garage door
opener in the rear-view mirror will assume the
function of the garage door system's remote
control. Please also read the operating instructions for the garage door system.
Z
Stowing and features
cause you to lose control of the vehicle. There
is a risk of an accident.
Use this device only when the vehicle is stationary.
269
270
Features
Stowing and features
When programming a garage door opener, park
the vehicle outside the garage. Do not run the
engine while programming.
The garage door opener is only available for certain countries. Observe the legal requirements
for each individual country.
The HomeLink® garage door opener is compatible with most European garage and gate opener
drives. More information on HomeLink® and/or
compatible products is available:
Rat a qualified specialist workshop
Rvia the HomeLink® Hotline
(0) 08000 466 354 65 or alternatively
+49 (0) 6838 907-277
Ron the Internet at http://www.homelink.com
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When you operate or program the garage door
with the integrated garage door opener, persons in the range of movement of the garage
door can become trapped or struck by the
garage door. There is a risk of injury.
When using the integrated garage door
opener, always make sure that nobody is
within the range of movement of the garage
door.
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling
these exhaust gases leads to poisoning. There
is a risk of fatal injury. Therefore never leave
the engine running in enclosed spaces without sufficient ventilation.
Programming
Programming buttons
Pay attention to the "Important safety notes"
(Y page 270).
Garage door remote control A is not included
with the integrated garage door opener.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
X Select one of buttons ; to ? to control the
garage door drive.
X To start programming mode: press and
hold one of buttons ; to ? of the integrated
garage door opener.
The garage door opener is now in programming mode. After a short time, indicator
lamp : begins to light up yellow.
Indicator lamp : lights up yellow immediately the first time button ;, = or ? is programmed. If the selected button has already
been programmed, indicator lamp : lights
up yellow after ten seconds have elapsed.
X Release button ;, = or ?. Indicator
lamp : flashes yellow.
X To program the remote control: point
garage door remote control A towards buttons ; to ? on the rear-view mirror at a distance of 5 to 20 cm.
X Press and hold button B on remote control
A until indicator lamp : lights up green.
When indicator lamp : lights up green: programming is finished.
When indicator lamp : flashes green: programming was successful. The next step is to
synchronise the rolling code (Y page 271).
X Release button B of remote control A of the
garage door drive.
If indicator lamp : lights up red: repeat the
programming process for the corresponding
button on the rear-view mirror. When doing
so, vary the distance between remote control
A and the rear-view mirror.
The required distance between remote control A and the integrated garage door opener
depends on the garage door drive system.
Features
Synchronising the rolling code
Observe the "Important safety notes"
(Y page 270).
If the garage door system uses a rolling code,
you will also have to synchronise the garage
door system with the integrated garage door
opener in the rear-view mirror. To do this, you
will need to use the programming button on the
door drive control panel. The programming button may be placed at different locations depending on the manufacturer. It is usually located on
the door drive unit on the garage ceiling.
Familiarise yourself with the garage door drive
operating instructions, e.g. under "Programming of additional remote controls", before carrying out the following steps.
Your vehicle must be within range of the garage
door or gate opener drive. Make sure that neither your vehicle nor any persons/objects are
present within the sweep of the door or gate.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
X Get out of the vehicle.
X Press the programming button on the door
drive unit.
Usually, you now have 30 seconds to initiate
the next step.
X Get into the vehicle.
X Press previously programmed button ;, =
or ? of the integrated garage door opener
until the door closes.
The rolling code synchronisation is then complete.
Problems when programming
If you have problems when programming the
integrated garage door opener, please note the
following:
RCheck the transmitter frequency used by
garage door drive remote control A and
whether it is supported. The transmitter frequency can usually be found on the back of
remote control A for the garage door drive.
RReplace the batteries in garage door remote
control A. This increases the likelihood that
garage door remote control A will transmit a
strong and precise signal to the integrated
garage door opener in the rear-view mirror.
RWhen
programming, hold remote control A
at varying distances and angles from buttons ; to ? which you are programming. Try
various angles at a distance between 5and
20 cm or at the same angle but at varying
distances.
RIf another remote control A is available for
the same garage door drive, perform the programming steps again using this remote control A. Before performing these steps, make
sure that new batteries have been fitted in
garage door drive remote control A.
RNote that some remote controls transmit only
for a limited period (the indicator lamp on the
remote control goes out). Press button B on
remote control A again before transmission
ends.
RAlign the aerial cable of the garage door
opener unit. This can improve signal reception/transmission.
Opening or closing the garage door
Once programmed, the integrated garage door
opener will assume the function of the garage
door system's remote control. Please also read
the operating instructions for the garage door
system.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
X Press button ;, = or ? which you have
programmed to operate the garage door.
Garage door system with a fixed code: indicator lamp : lights up green.
Garage door system with a rolling code: indicator lamp : flashes green.
The transmitter will transmit a signal for as
long as the button is pressed. The transmission is halted after a maximum of ten seconds
and indicator lamp : lights up yellow.
X Press button ;, = or ? again if necessary.
Clearing the memory
Make sure that you clear the memory of the
integrated garage door opener before selling the
vehicle.
Z
Stowing and features
Several attempts may be required. You
should test every position for at least
25 seconds before trying another position.
271
Features
272
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
X Press and hold buttons ; and ?.
The indicator lamp initially lights up yellow
and then green.
X Release buttons ; and ?.
The memory of the integrated garage door
opener in the rear-view mirror is cleared.
X
Frequencies
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
DE (Germany)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 7519301
29 April 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
EE (Estonia)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 11 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
ES (Spain)
000438/2005,
000439/2005,
000440/2005
000441/2005,
000445/2005,
000446/2005
000447/2005
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
Stowing and features
Europe
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
AD (Andorra)
20 July 2005
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
AT (Austria)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
FI (Finland)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 10668 13
May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
FR (France)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 12 April
07
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 10668 13
May 05
27, 30, 40, 433, 868
GI (Gibraltar)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 14357 27
May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 10668 13
May 05 (UK)
MHz: 27, 40, 418, 433, 868
GR (Greece)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
11409/18/4/2005 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
HR (Croatia)
SDR 224/06
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
BE (Belgium)
BG (Bulgaria)
CH (Switzerland)
CY (Cyprus)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 5 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
CZ (Czech
Republic)
General Licence GL-30/R/
2000 Reg No. 844 13 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433
DK (Denmark)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 20 April
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
HU (Hungary) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
Features
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
IC (Canary
Islands)
000438/2005,
000439/2005
000440/2005,
000441/2005
000445/2005,
000446/2005
000447/2005, 3rd June
2005
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
LV (Latvia)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
27.4-1B-1609 26 April 06
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
NL (Netherlands)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
NO (Norway)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
05/02424-SA644 18 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
PL (Poland)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 21 April
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
PT (Portugal)
ANCOM-S08399/05
27, 40, 433, 868
RO (Romania)
Article 6.4 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
RU (Russian
Federation)
POCC DE.MJ05.H00015 13
May 05
MHz: 433
LT (Lithuania) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
27.4-1B-1609 6 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
SE (Sweden)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
LU (Luxembourg)
SI (Slovenia)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
500-1/2005-437 9 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
IS (Iceland)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
IT (Italy)
DGPGSR/II/347487/FOR/
15347
DGPGSR/II/347487/FOR/
15348
DGPGSR/II/347487/FOR/
15350
DGPGSR/II/347487/FOR/
15357
DGPGSR/II/347487/FOR/
15358
DGPGSR/II/347487/FOR/
15359
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
LI (Liechtenstein)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 14357 27
May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
150405/9538 24 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
Z
Stowing and features
MC (Monaco) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 10668 13
May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
MT (Malta)
IE (Ireland)
273
274
Features
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
SK (Slovakia)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
Slovak
206/11/2005 4 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
MQ (Martinique)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 11 July 05
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
MX (Mexico)
MHz: 280 to 390
Stowing and features
UK (United
Kingdom)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 418, 433, 868
Africa
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
Asia
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
AE (United
Arab Emirates)
1623/5/10-2/26/76
MHz: 433
JO (Jordan)
TRC/LPD/2005/23
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
EG (Egypt)
W-KLE-17/08 Mar. 06
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 418, 433,
868
KW (Kuwait)
RE (Réunion)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 11 July 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
5 October 2005
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 418, 433,
868
SA (Saudi
Arabia)
11_02_05/5024-5-6
MHz: 418, 433
ZA (South
Africa)
11 October 2005
MHz: 27, 40, 433
SY (Syria)
279/4/14 / 05 March 06
TR (Turkey)
National Certification 23 July
07
MHz: 433
America
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
BB (Barbados)
Registration not required
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
CL (Chile)
38447/F-23 No.3.3634
MHz: 40, 433
3943/DFRS05165/F-50
MHz: 280 to 433
GF (French
Guyana)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 10668 13
May 05
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
GP (Guadeloupe)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 10668 13
May 05
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
Australia
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
AU (Australia)
28 June 2005
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
NZ (New Zea- 20 March 06
land)
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433
Floormats
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the oper-
Features
275
Stowing and features
ating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
Slide the seat backwards.
To fit: lay the floormat in the footwell.
X Press studs : onto retainers ;.
X To remove: pull the floormat away from
retainers ;.
X Remove the floormat.
X
X
Retrofitted anti-glare film
Retrofitted anti-glare film on the inside of the
windows can interfere with radio/mobile telephone reception. This is particularly the case for
conductive or metallic-coated films. You can
obtain information about anti-glare film from a
qualified specialist workshop.
Z
276
Engine compartment
Engine compartment
Important safety notes
G WARNING
An unlocked bonnet may open up when the
vehicle is in motion and block your view. There
is a risk of an accident.
Never unlock the bonnet when driving. Before
every trip, ensure that the bonnet is locked.
Maintenance and care
jewellery and watches
items of clothing and hair, for example, away from moving parts.
Rkeep
Bonnet
G WARNING
When being opened and closed, the bonnet
may suddenly fall into the closed position.
There is a risk of injury to persons in the range
of movement of the bonnet.
Open and close the bonnet only when nobody
is in the range of movement.
G WARNING
If you open the bonnet while the engine is
overheating or while there is a fire in the
engine compartment, you could come into
contact with hot gases or other leaking service products. There is a danger of injury.
Allow an overheating engine to cool down
before opening the bonnet. If there is a fire in
the engine compartment, leave the bonnet
closed and notify the fire brigade.
G WARNING
There are moving components in the engine
compartment. Certain components may continue to move or suddenly move again even
after the ignition has been switched off, e.g.
the radiator fan. There is a risk of injury.
If you have to carry out work in the engine
compartment:
Rswitch
Rremove
off the ignition
Rnever touch the dangerous areas surround-
ing moving components, e.g. the rotation
area of the fan
Active bonnet (pedestrian protection)
Operating principle
! An active bonnet that had been triggered
must be repaired at a qualified specialist
workshop. The active bonnet function will
then be available again. The additional pedestrian protection provided by the active bonnet
will then be restored.
The active bonnet is only available in certain
countries.
The active bonnet can reduce the risk of injury to
pedestrians in certain accident situations. Raising the active bonnet increases the clearance to
hard components, such as the engine.
If the active bonnet has been triggered, it is
raised at the rear in the area around the hinge by
approximately 85 mm. The active bonnet is triggered by pyrotechnics.
For the drive to the workshop, reset the triggered active bonnet yourself. If the active bonnet has been triggered, pedestrian protection
may be limited.
Resetting
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
Engine compartment
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
switched off.
X Pull release lever : on the bonnet.
The bonnet is released.
X
Opening the bonnet
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
G WARNING
When the bonnet is open, and the windscreen
wipers are set in motion, you can be injured by
the wiper linkage. There is a risk of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before opening the bonnet.
! Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
not folded away from the windscreen. Otherwise, you could damage the windscreen wipers or the bonnet.
X
Reach into the gap, pull bonnet catch handle ; up and lift the bonnet :.
If you lift the bonnet by approximately 40 cm,
the bonnet is opened and held open automatically by the gas-filled struts.
Closing the bonnet
Lower the bonnet and let it fall from a height
of approximately 20 cm.
X Check that the bonnet has engaged properly.
If the bonnet can be raised slightly, it is not
properly engaged. Open it again and close it
with a little more force.
X
Engine oil
Notes on oil level
Depending on your driving style, the vehicle
consumes up to 0.8 litres of oil per 1,000 km.
The oil consumption may be higher than this
Z
Maintenance and care
With your hand flat, push down active bonnet : in the area around the hinges on both
sides (arrows) until you feel it engage.
If you can raise the active bonnet slightly in the
area around the hinges, it is not engaged correctly. Repeat the step.
X
277
Engine compartment
278
when the vehicle is new or if you frequently drive
at high engine speeds.
Depending on the engine, the oil dipstick may be
installed at a different location.
When checking the oil level:
Rpark the vehicle on a level surface
Rthe engine should be switched off for approximately five minutes if the engine is at normal
operating temperature
Rif the engine is not at normal operating temperature, e.g. if the engine was only started
briefly, wait approximately 30 minutes before
carrying out the measurement
Maintenance and care
Checking the oil level using the oil dipstick
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
Topping up engine oil
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
G WARNING
If engine oil comes into contact with hot components in the engine compartment, it may
ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Make sure that engine oil does not spill out
over the filler neck. Allow the engine to cool
down and thoroughly clean the components
that have come into contact with engine oil
before you start the engine.
H Environmental note
When topping up the oil, take care not to spill
any. If oil enters the soil or waterways, it is
harmful to the environment.
! Only use engine oils and oil filters that have
Example
Pull oil dipstick : out of the oil dipstick tube.
Wipe off oil dipstick :.
X Slowly slide oil dipstick : into the guide tube
to the stop, and take it out again.
If the level is between MIN mark = and MAX
mark ;, the oil level is correct.
X If the oil level has dropped to MIN mark = or
below, top up with 1.0 l of engine oil.
X
X
been approved for vehicles with a service system. You can obtain a list of the engine oils
and oil filters tested and approved in accordance with the Mercedes-Benz Specifications
for Service Products at any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Damage to the engine or exhaust system is
caused by the following:
Rusing engine oils and oil filters that have not
been specifically approved for the service
system
Rchanging the engine oil and oil filter after
missing the change interval required by the
service system
Rusing engine oil additives
! Do not add too much oil. If the oil level is
above the "max" mark on the dipstick, too
much oil has been added. This can lead to
damage to the engine or the catalytic converter. Have excess oil siphoned off.
Engine compartment
279
Let the engine cool down before you open the
cap. Wear gloves and eye protection. Open
the cap slowly to release the pressure.
Example: engine oil filler cap
Turn cap : anti-clockwise and remove it.
Top up the engine oil.
If the oil level is at or below the MIN mark on
the oil dipstick, top up with 1.0 l of engine oil.
X Replace cap : on the filler neck and turn
clockwise.
Make sure that the cap locks securely into
place.
X Check the oil level again with the oil dipstick
(Y page 278).
For further information on engine oil, see
(Y page 324).
X
X
Checking the coolant level
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
G WARNING
The cooling system is pressurised, particularly when the engine is warm. If you open the
cap, you could be scalded if hot coolant
sprays out. There is a risk of injury.
Park the vehicle on a level surface.
Only check the coolant level if the vehicle is
on a level surface and the engine has cooled
down.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the
Start/Stop button twice (Y page 132).
X Check the coolant temperature gauge in the
multifunction display.
The coolant temperature must be below
70 †.
X Turn the key to position 0 (Y page 132) in the
ignition lock.
X Slowly turn cap ; half a turn anti-clockwise
to allow excess pressure to escape.
X Turn cap ; further anti-clockwise and
remove it.
If the coolant is at the level of marker bar =
in the filler neck when cold, there is enough
coolant in coolant expansion tank :.
If the coolant level is approximately 1.5 cm
above marker bar = in the filler neck when
warm, there is enough coolant in coolant
expansion tank :.
X If necessary, top up with coolant that has
been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
X Replace cap ; and turn it clockwise as far as
it will go.
Further information on coolant (Y page 325).
X
Z
Maintenance and care
Checking and adding other service
products
Example
ASSYST PLUS
280
Topping up the windscreen washer system
Overview of the engine compartment
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
Maintenance and care
G WARNING
If windscreen washer concentrate comes into
contact with hot components of the engine or
the exhaust system, it can ignite. There is a
risk of fire and injury.
Make sure the windscreen washer concentrate does not come into contact with the filler
neck.
Example engine
: Oil dipstick
; Brake fluid reservoir
= Engine oil cap
? Coolant expansion tank
A Washer fluid reservoir
ASSYST PLUS
Service messages
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
informs you of the next service due date.
Information on the type of service and service
intervals (see the separate Service Booklet).
You can obtain further information from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
i The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
Example
To open: pull cap : upwards by the tab.
Top up with the premixed washer fluid.
X To close: press cap : onto the filler neck
until it engages.
The recommended minimum washer fluid level
is 1 litre.
If the washer fluid level drops below 1 litre, a
message appears in the multifunction display
prompting you to top up the washer fluid
(Y page 242).
Further information on windscreen washer
fluid/antifreeze (Y page 326).
X
X
does not show any information on the engine
oil level. Observe the notes on the engine oil
level (Y page 277).
The multifunction display shows a service message for a few seconds, e.g.:
RService
A in .. days
A due
RService A overdue by .. days
Depending on the operating conditions of the
vehicle, the remaining time or distance until the
next service due date is displayed.
The letter indicates which service is due. A
stands for a minor service and B for a major service. A number or another letter may be displayed after the letter.
Only for certain countries: the position after the
letter A or B indicates any necessary additional
maintenance work to be performed. If you notify
RService
Care
Hiding service messages
X
Press the a or % button on the steering
wheel.
Displaying service messages
Switch the ignition on.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
ASSYST PLUS submenu and confirm by pressing the a button.
The service due date appears in the multifunction display.
X
Information about service
Resetting the ASSYST PLUS service
interval display
! If the ASSYST PLUS service interval display
has been inadvertently reset, this setting can
be corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.
Have service work carried out as described in
the Service Booklet. This may otherwise lead
to increased wear and damage to the major
assemblies or the vehicle.
A qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, will reset the
ASSYST PLUS service interval display after the
service work has been carried out. You can also
obtain further information on maintenance
work, for example.
Special service requirements
The prescribed service interval is based on normal operation of the vehicle. Service work will
need to be performed more often if the vehicle is
operated under arduous conditions or increased
loads, for example:
Rregular city driving with frequent intermediate
stops
Rif the vehicle is primarily used to travel short
distances
Rfor frequent operation in mountainous terrain
or on poor road surfaces
Rif the engine is often left idling for long periods
In these or similar operating conditions, have,
for example, the air filter, engine oil and oil filter
changed more frequently. The tyres must be
checked more frequently if the vehicle is operated under increased loads. Further information
can be obtained at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Driving abroad
An extensive Mercedes-Benz Service network is
also available in other countries. You can obtain
further information from any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Care
Notes on care
H Environmental note
Dispose of empty packaging and cleaning
cloths in an environmentally responsible manner.
! For cleaning your vehicle, do not use any of
the following:
rough or hard cloths
Rabrasive cleaning agents
Rsolvents
Rcleaning agents containing solvents
Do not scrub.
Do not touch the surfaces or protective films
with hard objects, e.g. a ring or ice scraper.
Rdry,
Z
Maintenance and care
a qualified specialist workshop of this display,
you will receive a statement on the associated
costs.
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display does
not take into account any periods of time during
which the battery is disconnected.
Maintaining the time-dependent service schedule:
X Note down the service due date displayed in
the multifunction display before disconnecting the battery.
or
X After reconnecting the battery, subtract the
battery disconnection periods from the service date shown on the display.
281
282
Care
You could otherwise scratch or damage the
surfaces and protective film.
! Do not park up the vehicle for an extended
Maintenance and care
period straight after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
should drive for a few minutes after cleaning.
Braking heats the brake discs and the brake
pads/linings, thus drying them. The vehicle
can then be parked up.
Regular care of your vehicle is a condition for
retaining quality in the long term.
Use care products and cleaning agents recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Washing the vehicle and cleaning the
paintwork
Automatic car wash
G WARNING
Braking efficiency is reduced after the vehicle
has been washed. There is a risk of an accident.
After washing the vehicle, brake carefully
while paying attention to the traffic conditions
in order to restore full braking efficiency.
! When DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD func-
tion is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations.
To avoid damage to the vehicle, deactivate
DISTRONIC PLUS and the HOLD function in
the following or similar situations:
Rwhen towing away
Rin a car wash
! It is preferable to use car washes with
adjustable high-pressure pre-cleaning that
corresponds to the specification for the Cabriolet programme. In car washes that use high
water pressures, there is a risk that a small
amount of water may leak into the vehicle.
! Vehicles with HANDS-FREE ACCESS: if a
key with KEYLESS-GO is within the detection
range of the KEYLESS-GO antenna, the following situations could lead to the unintentional opening of the boot lid:
Rusing a car wash
Rusing a high-pressure cleaner
Make sure that the key is at least 2 m away
from the vehicle.
! Make sure that the automatic transmission
is in position N when washing your vehicle in
a tow-through car wash. Other transmission
positions may lead to damage to the vehicle.
! Make sure that:
Rthe
side windows and the roof are completely closed
Rthe climate control blower is switched off
Rthe windscreen wiper switch is at position
0
The vehicle could otherwise be damaged.
You can wash the vehicle in an automatic car
wash from the very start.
Wash off excess dirt before cleaning the vehicle
in an automatic car wash.
After using an automatic car wash, wipe wax off
the windscreen and the wiper blades. This will
prevent smears and reduce wiping noises
caused by residue on the windscreen.
Washing by hand
In some countries, washing by hand is only
allowed at specially equipped washing bays.
Observe the legal requirements for each individual country.
X Do not use hot water and do not wash the
vehicle in direct sunlight.
X Use a soft sponge to clean.
X Use a mild cleaning agent, such as a car
shampoo approved by Mercedes-Benz.
X Thoroughly hose down the vehicle with a gentle jet of water.
X Do not point the water jet directly towards the
air inlet.
X Use plenty of water and rinse out the sponge
frequently.
Care
High-pressure cleaning equipment
G WARNING
The water jet of circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) can cause damage not visible from the
outside to tyres or chassis components. Components damaged in this way can unexpectedly fail. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles to clean the vehicle. Have damaged tyres or chassis components replaced
immediately.
! Always maintain a distance of at least 30 cm
between the vehicle and the high-pressure
cleaner nozzle. Information about the correct
distance is available from the equipment
manufacturer.
Move the high-pressure cleaner nozzle
around when cleaning your vehicle.
Do not aim directly at any of the following:
Rtyres
Rdoor gaps, roof gaps, joints etc.
Rsoft top (Designo vario-roof)
Relectrical components
Rbattery
Rplug connectors
Rlights
Rseals
Rtrim elements
Rventilation slots
Damage to seals or electrical components
can lead to leaks or failures.
! Vehicles with HANDS-FREE ACCESS: if a
key with KEYLESS-GO is within the detection
range of the KEYLESS-GO antenna, the following situations could lead to the unintentional opening of the boot lid:
Rusing a car wash
Rusing a high-pressure cleaner
Make sure that the key is at least 2 m away
from the vehicle.
! Mille Miglia special model: parts of your
vehicle are covered with a decorative foil.
Maintain a distance of at least 70 cm between
the foil-wrapped parts of the vehicle and the
nozzle of the high pressure cleaner.
Information about the correct distance is
available from the equipment manufacturer.
Move the high-pressure cleaner nozzle
around when cleaning your vehicle.
Cleaning the paintwork
! Do not affix:
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rmagnetic
plates or similar items
to painted surfaces. You could otherwise
damage the paintwork.
Scratches, corrosive deposits, areas affected by
corrosion and damage caused by inadequate
care cannot always be completely repaired. In
such cases, visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X Remove impurities immediately, where possible, whilst avoiding rubbing too hard.
X Soak insect remains with insect remover and
rinse off the treated areas afterwards.
X Soak bird droppings with water and rinse off
the treated areas afterwards.
X Remove coolant, brake fluid, tree resins, oils,
fuels and greases by rubbing gently with a
cloth soaked in petroleum ether or lighter
fluid.
X Use tar remover to remove tar stains.
X Use silicone remover to remove wax.
Care and treatment of matt paintwork
! Never polish the vehicle or the light alloy
wheels. Polishing makes the paintwork shiny.
! The following may cause the paint to
become shiny and thus reduce the matt
effect:
Rvigorous rubbing with unsuitable materials
Rfrequent use of car washes
Rwashing the vehicle in direct sunlight
! Never use paint cleaner, buffing or polishing
products, or gloss preserver, e.g. wax. These
Z
Maintenance and care
Rinse the vehicle with clean water and dry
thoroughly with a chamois.
X Do not let the cleaning agent dry on the paintwork.
When using the vehicle in winter, remove all
traces of road salt deposits carefully and as
soon as possible.
X
283
284
Care
products are only suitable for high-gloss surfaces. Their use on vehicles with matt paintwork leads to considerable surface damage
(shiny, spotted areas).
Always have paintwork repairs carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
! Do not use wash programs with a hot wax
treatment under any circumstances.
Observe these notes if your vehicle has a clear
matt finish. This will help you to avoid damage to
the paintwork due to incorrect treatment.
These notes also apply to light-alloy wheels with
a clear matt finish.
i The vehicle should preferably be washed by
Maintenance and care
hand using a soft sponge, car shampoo and
plenty of water.
i Use only insect remover and car shampoo
from the range of recommended and
approved Mercedes-Benz care products.
Cleaning vehicle parts
Cleaning the wheels
G WARNING
The water jet of circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) can cause damage not visible from the
outside to tyres or chassis components. Components damaged in this way can unexpectedly fail. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles to clean the vehicle. Have damaged tyres or chassis components replaced
immediately.
! Do not use acidic wheel cleaning products
to remove brake dust. This could damage
wheel bolts and brake components.
! Do not park up your vehicle for a long period
of time immediately after cleaning, particularly after cleaning the wheel rim with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaner may lead to increased
corrosion of the brake discs and pads. You
should therefore drive for a few minutes after
cleaning. By heating up the brakes, the brake
discs and pads dry. The vehicle can then be
parked up for a long period of time.
Cleaning the windows
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers are set in motion
when cleaning the windscreen or wiper
blades, you could become trapped. There is a
danger of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before cleaning the windscreen or
wiper blades.
! Only fold the windscreen wipers away from
the windscreen when vertical. Otherwise, you
will damage the bonnet.
! Do not use dry cloths, abrasive cleaning
agents, solvents or solvent-based cleaning
agents to clean the inside of the windows/
windscreen. Do not touch the inside of the
windows/windscreen with hard items such
as an ice scraper or a ring. Otherwise, the
windows/windscreen could be damaged.
! Clean the water drainage channels of the
windscreen and the rear window at regular
intervals. Deposits such as leaves, petals and
pollen may under certain circumstances prevent water from draining away. This can lead
to corrosion damage and damage to electronic components.
X Clean the inside and outside of the windows
with a damp cloth and a cleaning agent that is
recommended and approved by MercedesBenz.
Cleaning the wiper blades
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers are set in motion
when cleaning the windscreen or wiper
blades, you could become trapped. There is a
danger of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before cleaning the windscreen or
wiper blades.
! Do not pull on the wiper blade. Otherwise,
the wiper blade could be damaged.
! Do not clean wiper blades too often and do
not rub them too hard. Otherwise, the graph-
Care
285
ite coating could be damaged. This could
cause wiper noise.
! Hold the wiper arm securely when folding
back. The windscreen could be damaged if
the wiper arm hits against it suddenly.
X Fold the wiper arms away from the windscreen.
X Clean the wiper blades carefully using a damp
cloth.
X Fold the windscreen wipers back again before
switching on the ignition.
Cleaning the exterior lighting
that are suitable for plastic lenses. Unsuitable
cleaning agents or cleaning cloths could
scratch or damage the plastic lenses of the
exterior lighting.
X Clean the plastic lenses of the exterior lighting using a wet sponge and a mild cleaning
agent, e.g. Mercedes-Benz car shampoo or
cleaning cloths.
X
Clean sensors : of the driving systems with
water, car shampoo and a soft cloth.
Cleaning the reversing camera
! Do not clean the camera lens and the area
around the reversing camera with a high-pressure cleaner.
Cleaning the mirror turn signal
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning cloths
that are suitable for plastic lenses. Unsuitable
cleaning agents or cleaning cloths could
scratch or damage the plastic lenses of the
mirror turn signals.
X Clean the plastic lenses of the mirror turn signals in the exterior mirror housing using a wet
sponge and mild cleaning agent, e.g.
Mercedes-Benz car shampoo or cleaning
cloths.
Cleaning the sensors
! If you clean the sensors with a high-pressure
cleaner, make sure that you keep a distance
of at least 30 cm between the vehicle and the
high-pressure cleaner nozzle. Information
about the correct distance is available from
the equipment manufacturer.
X
Use clean water and a soft cloth to clean
camera lens :.
Cleaning the exhaust pipe
G WARNING
The exhaust tail pipe and tail pipe trim can
become very hot. If you come into contact
with these parts of the vehicle, you could burn
yourself. There is a risk of injury.
Always be particularly careful around the
exhaust tail pipe and the tail pipe trim. Allow
Z
Maintenance and care
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning cloths
286
Care
these components to cool down before touching them.
! Do not clean the exhaust pipe with acid-
Maintenance and care
based cleaning agents, such as sanitary
cleanser or wheel cleaner.
X Clean the exhaust pipe with a chrome care
product tested and approved by MercedesBenz.
Impurities combined with the effects of road grit
and corrosive environmental factors may cause
flash rust to form on the surface. You can
restore the original shine of the exhaust pipe by
cleaning it regularly, especially in winter and
after washing the vehicle.
Where will I find...?
Where will I find...?
287
First-aid kit
Warning triangle
Removing the warning triangle
Setting up the warning triangle
X
X
Check the expiry date on the first-aid kit at least
once a year. Replace the contents if necessary,
and replace any missing items.
Fire extinguisher
G WARNING
When you brake heavily or change direction
suddenly, the fire extinguisher can be thrown
around the vehicle interior if the roller box is
left open. There is a risk of injury.
Keep the shutter of the roller box closed
whilst the vehicle is in motion.
Fold legs = out to the side.
Fold side reflectors ; upwards to form a triangle and lock them at the top using press
stud :.
Fire extinguisher ; is in the roller box behind
the centre console, between the seats.
X To remove: open cover :.
X Slide locking button ? in the direction of the
arrow.
Z
Breakdown assistance
Warning triangle : is located in a bracket on
the inside of the boot lid.
X Open the boot lid.
X Press catches ; in the direction of the
bracket and open the bracket in the direction
of the arrow.
X Pull the retaining clip of warning triangle : in
the centre of the bracket, outwards.
X Remove warning triangle : from the bracket.
First-aid kit : is located in the stowage well
under the boot floor.
X Swing the boot floor upwards (Y page 266).
X Remove first-aid kit :.
Where will I find...?
288
Lift and swing out bracket = from the side on
which locking button ? is located.
X Take fire extinguisher ; out of the roller box.
X To insert: insert fire extinguisher ; into the
roller box.
X Insert bracket = into the roller box on the
side opposite locking button ?.
X Then, insert bracket = completely.
X Slide locking button ? in the opposite direction to the arrow.
X Check whether bracket = is properly
engaged.
X Close cover :.
X
To remove towing eye :, lift the stowage tray
at recess A.
X Use the TIREFIT kit (Y page 290).
X
i The tyre inflation compressor weighs
approximately 1.2 kg.
The tyre inflation compressor is maintenancefree. If there is a malfunction, please contact
a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyre-change tool kit
The tyre-change tool kit can be found in the
stowage well under the boot floor (Y page 266).
Have the fire extinguisher refilled after each use
and checked every one or two years. It may otherwise fail in an emergency.
Breakdown assistance
Vehicle tool kit
General notes
The towing eye is located in the boot in a bracket
below the boot lid lock.
If the vehicle is equipped with a TIREFIT kit, it is
located in the stowage well under the floor of the
boot.
Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit
The TIREFIT kit is located in the stowage well
under the boot floor (Y page 266).
: Bag containing the tyre-changing tools
Bag : containing the tyre-changing tools contains:
Rjack
Rwheel wrench
Rcentring pin
Rwheel chock
Rgloves
Depending on the vehicle equipment, not all
vehicles will have the tools that are required for
changing a wheel, such as a jack or wheel
wrench. Tools approved for your vehicle are
available at a qualified specialist workshop.
i The jack weighs approximately 2.3 kg.
:
;
=
?
A
Towing eye
Tyre sealant filler bottle
Fuse allocation chart
Tyre inflation compressor
Stowage tray recess
The maximum load bearing capacity of the
jack can be found on the adhesive label on the
jack.
The jack is maintenance-free. If there is a
malfunction, please contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Flat tyre
Preparing the vehicle
Your vehicle may be equipped with:
Rtyres with run-flat characteristics
(MOExtended tyres) (Y page 289)
Vehicle preparation is not necessary on vehicles with MOExtended tyres.
Ra TIREFIT kit (Y page 288)
Ran emergency spare wheel (certain countries
only) (Y page 318)
Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It is therefore recommended that you additionally equip
your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit if you fit tyres that
do not feature run-flat characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT kit can be obtained from a
qualified specialist workshop.
Information on changing and fitting a wheel
(Y page 312).
X Stop the vehicle as far away as possible from
traffic on solid, non-slippery and level ground.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 153).
X If possible, bring the front wheels into the
straight-ahead position.
X Switch off the engine.
X Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove the
key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: open the driver's door.
The on-board electronics now have status 0.
This is the same as the key having been
removed.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: remove the
Start/Stop button from the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
X Make sure that the passengers are not endangered as they do so. Make sure that no one is
near the danger area while a wheel is being
changed. Anyone who is not directly assisting
in the wheel change should, for example,
stand behind the barrier.
X Get out of the vehicle. Pay attention to traffic
conditions when doing so.
X Close the driver's door.
X Place the warning triangle at a suitable distance (Y page 287). Observe legal requirements.
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
General notes
With MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat characteristics), you can continue to drive your vehicle even if there is a total loss of pressure in one
or more tyres. The affected tyre must not show
any clearly visible damage.
You can recognise MOExtended tyres by the
MOExtended marking which appears on the tyre
wall. You will find this marking next to the tyre
size designation, the load-bearing capacity and
the speed index.
MOExtended tyres may only be used in conjunction with an activated tyre pressure loss warning
system or tyre pressure monitor.
If a pressure loss warning message appears
in the multifunction display:
Robserve the instructions
sages (Y page 237)
in the display mes-
Rcheck
the tyre for damage
driving on, observe the following notes
The driving distance possible in run-flat mode is
approximately 80 km when the vehicle is partially laden and approximately 30 km when the
vehicle is fully laden.
In addition to the vehicle load, the driving distance possible depends upon:
Rvehicle speed
Rroad condition
Routside temperature
The driving distance possible in run-flat mode
may be reduced by extreme driving conditions/
manoeuvres, or it can be increased through a
moderate style of driving.
The driving distance possible in run-flat mode is
counted from the moment the tyre pressure loss
warning appears in the multifunction display.
You must not exceed a maximum speed of
80 km/h.
When replacing one or all tyres, observe the following specifications for your vehicle's tyres:
Rsize
Rtype and
Rthe "MOExtended" mark
If a tyre has gone flat and cannot be replaced
with an MOExtended tyre, a standard tyre may
be used as a temporary measure. Make sure
Rif
Z
Breakdown assistance
Flat tyre
289
290
Flat tyre
that you use the proper size and type (summer
or winter tyre).
Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It is therefore recommended that you additionally equip
your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit if you fit tyres that
do not feature run-flat characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT kit is available, for example,
from a qualified specialist workshop.
Important safety notes
Breakdown assistance
G WARNING
When driving in emergency mode, the driving
characteristics deteriorate, e.g. when cornering, accelerating quickly and when braking.
There is a risk of accident.
Do not exceed the stated maximum speed.
Avoid abrupt steering and driving manoeuvres, and driving over obstacles (kerbs, potholes, off-road). This applies in particular to a
laden vehicle.
Stop driving in emergency mode if:
Ryou
hear banging noises.
vehicle starts to shake.
Ryou see smoke and smell rubber.
Rthe
RESP®
is intervening constantly.
are tears in the sidewalls of the tyre.
After driving in emergency mode, have the
wheel rims checked at a qualified specialist
workshop with regard to their further use. The
faulty tyre must be replaced.
Rthere
TIREFIT kit
Important safety notes
TIREFIT is a tyre sealant.
You can use TIREFIT to seal punctures of up to
4 mm, particularly those in the tyre tread. You
can use TIREFIT at outside temperatures down
to Ò20 †.
G WARNING
In the following situations, the tyre sealant is
unable to provide sufficient breakdown assistance, as it is unable to seal the tyre properly:
Rthere
are cuts or punctures in the tyre
larger than those mentioned above.
Rthe wheel rim is damaged.
Ryou have driven at very low tyre pressures
or on a flat tyre.
There is a risk of an accident.
Do not drive any further. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
G WARNING
The tyre sealant is harmful and causes irritation. It must not come into contact with your
skin, eyes or clothing or be swallowed. Do not
inhale TIREFIT fumes. Keep tyre sealant away
from children. There is a risk of injury.
If you come into contact with the tyre sealant,
observe the following:
RRinse
off the tyre sealant from your skin
immediately with water.
RIf the tyre sealant comes into contact with
your eyes, immediately rinse them thoroughly with clean water.
RIf tyre sealant is swallowed, immediately
rinse your mouth out thoroughly and drink
plenty of water. Do not induce vomiting,
and seek medical attention immediately.
RImmediately change out of clothing which
has come into contact with tyre sealant.
RIf an allergic reaction occurs, seek medical
attention immediately.
! Do not operate the tyre inflation compres-
sor for longer than eight minutes at a time
without a break. It may otherwise overheat.
The tyre inflation compressor can be operated again once it has cooled down.
Comply with the manufacturer's safety instructions on the sticker on the tyre inflation compressor.
Flat tyre
291
Using the TIREFIT kit
Remove the cap from valve C on the faulty
tyre.
X Screw filler hose D onto the valve.
X
Pull plug ? with the cable and hose A out of
the housing.
X Screw hose A onto flange B of tyre sealant
bottle :.
X Place tyre sealant bottle : head downwards
into recess ; of the tyre inflation compressor.
X
Insert plug ? into the cigarette lighter socket
or into a 12 V socket in your vehicle.
X Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
X Press on and off switch = on the tyre inflation
compressor to I.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched on.
The tyre is inflated.
First, tyre sealant is pumped into the tyre. The
pressure may briefly rise to approximately
500 kPa (5.0 bar/73 psi).
Do not switch off the tyre inflation compressor during this phase.
X Let the tyre inflation compressor run for a
maximum of five minutes. The tyre should
then have attained a pressure of at least
180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi).
If a tyre pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi) has
been achieved after five minutes: (Y page 292).
If a tyre pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi) has
not been achieved after five minutes:
(Y page 291).
If tyre sealant leaks out, make sure you clean the
affected area as quickly as possible. It is preferable to use clear water.
If you get tyre sealant on your clothing, have it
cleaned as soon as possible with perchloroethylene.
X
Tyre pressure not reached
If a pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi) has not
been attained after five minutes:
X Switch off the tyre inflation compressor.
X Unscrew the filler hose from the valve of the
faulty tyre.
Z
Breakdown assistance
Do not remove any foreign objects which have
penetrated the tyre, e.g. screws or nails.
X Remove the tyre sealant bottle, the accompanying TIREFIT sticker and the tyre inflation
compressor from the stowage space under
the boot floor (Y page 288).
X Affix part : of the TIREFIT sticker to the
instrument cluster within the driver's field of
vision.
X Affix part ; of the TIREFIT sticker near the
valve on the wheel with the defective tyre.
X
Flat tyre
292
Please note that tyre sealant may leak out
when unscrewing the filler hose.
Very slowly drive forwards or reverse approximately 10 m.
X Pump up the tyre again.
After a maximum of five minutes the tyre
pressure must be at least 180 kPa (1.8 bar/
26 psi).
Breakdown assistance
X
G WARNING
If the required tyre pressure is not reached
after the specified time, the tyre is too badly
damaged. The tyre sealant cannot repair the
tyre in this instance. Damaged tyres and a tyre
pressure that is too low can significantly
impair the vehicle's braking and driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
Do not continue driving. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
Tyre pressure reached
G WARNING
A tyre temporarily sealed with tyre sealant
impairs the driving characteristics and is not
suitable for higher speeds. There is a risk of
accident.
You should therefore adapt your driving style
accordingly and drive carefully. Do not exceed
the specified maximum speed with a tyre that
has been repaired using tyre sealant.
The maximum speed for a tyre sealed with tyre
sealant is 80 km/h. The upper part of the
TIREFIT sticker must be affixed to the instrument cluster where it will be easily seen by the
driver.
! After use, excess tyre sealant may run out of
the filler hose. This could cause stains.
Therefore, place the filler hose in the plastic
bag which contained the TIREFIT kit.
H Environmental note
Have the used tyre sealant bottle disposed of
professionally, e.g. at a qualified specialist
workshop.
If a tyre pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi) has
been achieved after ten minutes:
X Switch off the tyre inflation compressor.
X Unscrew the filler hose from the valve of the
faulty tyre.
X Stow the tyre sealant bottle, the tyre inflation
compressor and the warning triangle.
X
X
Pull away immediately.
Stop after driving for approximately ten
minutes and check the tyre pressure with the
tyre inflation compressor.
The tyre pressure must now be at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/19 psi).
G WARNING
If the required tyre pressure is not reached
after driving for a short period, the tyre is too
badly damaged. The tyre sealant cannot
repair the tyre in this instance. Damaged tyres
and a tyre pressure that is too low can significantly impair the vehicle's braking and driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
Do not continue driving. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
i In your vehicle, you will find a sticker with
the Mercedes-Benz Service24h telephone
number, e.g. on the B-pillar on the driver's
side.
X Correct the tyre pressure if it is still at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/19 psi). See the tyre pressure table on the fuel filler flap for values.
X To increase the tyre pressure: switch on
the tyre inflation compressor.
Battery (vehicle)
Pull the tyre sealant bottle out of the tyre
inflation compressor.
The filler hose stays on the tyre sealant bottle.
X Drive to the nearest qualified specialist workshop and have the tyre changed there.
X Have the tyre sealant bottle replaced as soon
as possible at a qualified specialist workshop.
X Have the tyre sealant bottle replaced every
four years at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Battery (vehicle)
Important safety notes
Work on the battery, e.g. removing or fitting,
requires specialist knowledge and the use of
special tools. Therefore, always have work on
the battery carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
G WARNING
Work carried out incorrectly on the battery
can lead, for example, to a short circuit and
thus damage the vehicle electronics. This can
lead to function restrictions applying to
safety-relevant systems, e.g the lighting system, the ABS (anti-lock braking system) or the
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program). The operating safety of your vehicle may be restricted.
You could lose control of the vehicle, for
example:
Rwhen
braking
Rin the event of abrupt steering manoeuvres
and/or when the vehicle's speed is not
adapted to the road conditions
There is a risk of an accident.
In the event of a short circuit or a similar incident, contact a qualified specialist workshop
immediately. Do not drive any further. Always
have work on the battery carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Further information about ABS (Y page 62) and
ESP® (Y page 67).
G WARNING
Electrostatic build-up can lead to the creation
of sparks, which could ignite the highly explosive gases of a battery. There is a risk of an
explosion.
Before handling the battery, touch the vehicle
body to remove any existing electrostatic
build-up.
The highly flammable gas mixture is created
while the battery is charging and when jumpstarting.
Always make sure that neither you nor the battery is electrostatically charged. Electrostatic
charge is created, for example:
Rby wearing synthetic fibre clothing
Rby friction between clothing and the seat
Rwhen you pull or push the battery across carpet or other synthetic materials
Rwhen you rub the battery with a cloth
G WARNING
During the charging process, a battery produces hydrogen gas. If a short circuit occurs or
sparks are created, the hydrogen gas can
ignite. There is a risk of an explosion.
RMake sure that the positive terminal of a
connected battery does not come into contact with vehicle parts.
RNever place metal objects or tools on a battery.
RIt is important that you observe the described order of the battery terminals when
connecting and disconnecting a battery.
RWhen jump-starting, make sure that the
battery poles with identical polarity are
connected.
RIt is particularly important to observe the
described order when connecting and disconnecting the jump leads.
RNever connect or disconnect the battery
terminals while the engine is running.
Z
Breakdown assistance
To reduce the tyre pressure: depress pressure release button E next to pressure gauge
F.
X When the tyre pressure is correct, unscrew
the filler hose from the valve of the sealed
tyre.
X Screw the valve cap onto the tyre valve of the
sealed tyre.
X
293
294
Battery (vehicle)
G WARNING
Risk of explosion
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Do not breathe in any battery gases. Do not
lean over the battery. Keep the batteries out
of the reach of children. Immediately rinse off
battery acid thoroughly with plenty of clean
water and seek medical attention at once.
Fire, naked flames and smoking are
prohibited when handling the battery. Avoid creating sparks.
Breakdown assistance
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
! Have the battery checked regularly at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Observe the service intervals in the Service
Booklet or contact a qualified specialist workshop for more information.
! Always have work on the batteries carried
out at a qualified specialist workshop. Should
it, in exceptional circumstances, be absolutely necessary to disconnect the 12-volt
battery yourself, please observe the following:
Rsecure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling
away.
Rswitch the ignition off.
Rfirst, disconnect the negative terminal, followed by the positive terminal.
The transmission is locked in position P after
disconnecting the battery.
After the work has been completed, firmly
reinstall the battery and the cover of the positive terminal.
Comply with safety precautions and take protective measures when handling batteries.
Battery acid is caustic. Avoid contact
with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Wear suitable protective clothing, in
particular gloves, an apron and a
face mask.
Immediately rinse acid splashes off
with clean water. Consult a doctor if
necessary.
Wear eye protection.
Keep children away.
Observe this Owner's Manual.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use batteries which have
been tested and approved for your vehicle by
Mercedes-Benz. These batteries provide
increased impact protection to prevent vehicle
occupants from suffering acid burns should the
battery be damaged in the event of an accident.
In order for the battery to achieve the maximum
possible service life, it must always be sufficiently charged.
Like other batteries, the vehicle battery may
discharge over time if you do not use the vehicle.
In such cases, have the battery disconnected at
a qualified specialist workshop. You can also
charge the battery with a charger recommended
by Mercedes-Benz. For more information,
please contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Have the battery charge checked more frequently if you use the vehicle mainly for short
trips or if you leave it standing idle for a lengthy
period. Consult a qualified specialist workshop
if you wish to leave your vehicle parked up for a
long period of time.
When you park the vehicle, remove the key if you
do not require any electrical consumers. The
Battery (vehicle)
vehicle will then use very little energy, thus conserving battery power.
Charging the battery
G WARNING
During charging and jump-starting, explosive
gases can escape from the battery. There is a
risk of an explosion.
Particularly avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Ensure there is sufficient
ventilation while charging and jump-starting.
Do not lean over a battery.
295
battery. The service life of a battery that has
been thawed may be reduced. The starting characteristics may be impaired, especially at low
temperatures. Have the thawed battery
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Read the battery charger's operating instructions before charging the battery.
X Open the bonnet.
X Connect the battery charger to the positive
terminal and earth point in the same order as
when connecting the donor battery in the
jump-starting procedure (Y page 296).
Breakdown assistance
G WARNING
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Do not breathe in any battery gases. Do not
lean over the battery. Keep the batteries out
of the reach of children. Immediately rinse off
battery acid thoroughly with plenty of clean
water and seek medical attention at once.
G WARNING
A discharged battery can freeze at temperatures below freezing point. When jump-starting the vehicle or charging the battery, gases
can escape from the battery. There is a risk of
an explosion.
Allow the frozen battery to thaw out before
charging it or jump-starting.
! Only charge the installed battery with a battery charger which has been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. These battery
chargers allow the battery to be charged while
still installed in the vehicle.
! Only use battery chargers with a maximum
charging voltage of 14.8 V.
! Only charge the battery using the jump-start
connection point.
The jump-starting connection point is in the
engine compartment.
If the indicator/warning lamps do not light up at
low temperatures, it is very likely that the discharged battery has frozen. In this case you may
neither jump-start the vehicle nor charge the
Z
296
Jump-starting
Jump-starting
For the jump-starting procedure, use only the jump-starting connection point, consisting of a positive terminal and an earth point, in the engine compartment.
G WARNING
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing. Do not breathe in any battery gases. Do not lean over
the battery. Keep the batteries out of the reach of children. Immediately rinse off battery acid
thoroughly with plenty of clean water and seek medical attention at once.
G WARNING
During charging and jump-starting, explosive gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk
of an explosion.
Particularly avoid fire, naked flames, creating sparks and smoking. Ensure there is sufficient
ventilation while charging and jump-starting. Do not lean over a battery.
Breakdown assistance
G WARNING
During the charging process, a battery produces hydrogen gas. If a short circuit occurs or sparks
are created, the hydrogen gas can ignite. There is a risk of an explosion.
RMake sure that the positive terminal of a connected battery does not come into contact with
vehicle parts.
RNever place metal objects or tools on a battery.
RIt is important that you observe the described order of the battery terminals when connecting
and disconnecting a battery.
RWhen jump-starting, make sure that the battery poles with identical polarity are connected.
RIt is particularly important to observe the described order when connecting and disconnecting
the jump leads.
RNever connect or disconnect the battery terminals while the engine is running.
G WARNING
A discharged battery can freeze at temperatures below freezing point. When jump-starting the
vehicle or charging the battery, gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk of an explosion.
Allow the frozen battery to thaw out before charging it or jump-starting.
! Avoid repeated and lengthy starting attempts. Otherwise, the catalytic converter could be
damaged by the non-combusted fuel.
If the indicator/warning lamps do not light up at low temperatures, it is very likely that the discharged battery has frozen. In this case you may neither jump-start the vehicle nor charge the
battery. The service life of a battery that has been thawed may be reduced. The starting characteristics may be impaired, especially at low temperatures. Have the thawed battery checked at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Do not use a rapid charging device to start the vehicle. If your vehicle's battery is discharged, the
engine can be jump-started from another vehicle or from a second battery using jump leads.
Observe the following points:
RThe battery is not accessible in all vehicles. If the other vehicle's battery is not accessible, jumpstart the vehicle using a second battery or a jump-starting device.
RYou may only jump-start the vehicle when the engine and exhaust system are cold.
RDo not start the engine if the battery is frozen. Let the battery thaw first.
RJump-starting may only be performed using batteries with a nominal voltage of 12 V.
ROnly use jump leads that have a sufficient cross-section and insulated terminal clamps.
RIf the battery is fully discharged, leave the battery that is being used to jump-start connected for
a few minutes before attempting to start. This charges the empty battery a little.
RMake sure that the two vehicles do not touch.
Make sure that:
RThe jump leads are not damaged.
RNon-insulated parts of the terminal clamps do not come into contact with other metal parts while
the jump leads are connected to the battery.
RThe jump leads cannot come into contact with parts which can move when the engine is running,
such as the V-belt pulley or the fan.
X Secure the vehicle by applying the electric parking brake.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Make sure that the ignition is switched off . All indicator lamps in the instrument cluster must be
off. When using the key, turn the key to position 0 in the ignition lock and remove it (Y page 132).
X Switch off all electrical consumers, e.g. rear window heating, lighting etc.
X Open the bonnet.
Position number B identifies the charged battery of the other vehicle or an equivalent jump-starting
device.
X Press cover : of positive terminal ; down (in the direction of the arrow) and turn it clockwise.
To expose positive terminal ;, press cover : down further.
X Connect positive terminal ; on your vehicle to positive terminal = of donor battery B using the
jump lead, always beginning with positive terminal ; on your own vehicle first.
X Start the engine of the donor vehicle and run it at idling speed.
Z
297
Breakdown assistance
Jump-starting
Towing away and tow-starting
298
Connect negative terminal ? of donor battery B to earth point A of your vehicle using the jump
lead, connecting the jump lead to donor battery B first.
X Start the engine.
X Before disconnecting the jump leads, let the engines run for several minutes.
X First, remove the jump leads from earth point A and negative terminal ?, then from positive
clamp ; and positive terminal =. Begin each time at the contacts on your own vehicle first.
X After the jump lead is removed, return cover : of positive terminal ; to the original position.
Positive terminal ; is covered up and thus insulated again.
X Have the battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Jump-starting is not considered to be a normal operating condition.
X
i Jump-starting cables and further information regarding jump starting can be obtained at any
qualified specialist workshop.
Towing away and tow-starting
Important safety notes
Breakdown assistance
G WARNING
When towing or tow-starting another vehicle
and its weight is greater than the permissible
gross weight of your vehicle, the:
Rtowing
eye may be torn off
combination may swerve or
even overturn
There is a risk of an accident.
When towing or tow-starting another vehicle,
its weight should not be greater than the permissible gross weight of your vehicle.
Rcar/trailer
Details on the permissible gross vehicle weight
of your vehicle can be found on the vehicle identification plate (Y page 321).
! When Active Brake Assist, Distance Pilot
DISTRONIC or the HOLD function are activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations.
To avoid damage to the vehicle, deactivate
these systems in the following or similar situations:
Rwhen towing away
Rin a car wash
! Only secure the tow rope or towing bar to
the towing eyes. The vehicle may otherwise
be damaged.
! Observe the following points when towing
with a tow rope:
Rsecure the tow rope on the same side on
both vehicles.
Rmake sure that the tow rope is not longer
than legally permitted. Mark the tow rope in
the middle, e.g. with a white cloth
(30 x 30 cm). This makes other road users
aware that a vehicle is being towed.
Ronly secure the tow rope to the towing eye.
Robserve the brake lamps of the towing vehicle while driving. Always maintain a distance so that the tow rope does not sag.
Rdo not use steel cables or chains to tow
your vehicle. You could otherwise damage
the vehicle.
! Do not use the towing eye for recovery, this
could damage the vehicle. If in doubt, recover
the vehicle with a crane.
! When towing, pull away slowly and
smoothly. If the tractive power is too high, the
vehicles could be damaged.
! To tow vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, use the
key instead of the Start/Stop button. The
automatic transmission may otherwise
switch to position P when you open the driver's or front-passenger door which could
damage the transmission.
! Make sure that the electric parking brake is
released. If the electric parking brake is faulty,
visit a qualified specialist workshop.
! You may tow the vehicle for a maximum of
50km. A towing speed of 50 km/h must not
be exceeded.
Towing away and tow-starting
299
For towing distances over 50 km, the entire
vehicle must be lifted up and transported.
weight must not exceed the maximum permissible gross vehicle weight of your vehicle.
Observe the legal requirements for the relevant
countries when towing.
It is better to have the vehicle transported than
to have it towed.
The automatic transmission must be in position
N when the vehicle is being towed away.
The battery must be connected and charged.
Otherwise, you:
Rcannot turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock.
Rcannot shift the automatic transmission to
position N.
Deactivate the automatic locking feature before
towing the vehicle (Y page 211). You could otherwise be locked out when pushing or towing
the vehicle.
Deactivate tow-away protection before the vehicle is towed away (Y page 75).
Fitting/removing the towing eye
Fitting the towing eye
G WARNING
The exhaust tail pipe may be extremely hot.
There is a risk of burning when removing the
rear cover.
Do not touch the exhaust tail pipe. Use
extreme caution when removing the rear
cover.
The mountings for the removable towing eyes
are located in the bumpers. They are at the front
and at the rear under the covers.
X Remove the towing eye from the vehicle tool
kit (Y page 288).
X Front bumper: insert a finger into the recess
on the bottom edge of cover :.
X Pull cover : out of the bumper towards you
in the direction of the arrow.
Cover : is attached by a strap in the aperture.
X Rear bumper: press the mark on cover :
inwards in the direction of the arrow.
X Remove cover : from the opening.
X Screw in the towing eye clockwise as far as it
will go and tighten it.
Removing the towing eye
Loosen the towing eye and unscrew it.
Front bumper: position cover : on the
opening in the bumper.
X To close, press the lower section of cover :.
X Rear bumper: position cover : with the tab
on the opening in the bumper.
X To close, press the lower section of cover :
until it engages.
X Place the towing eye in the vehicle tool kit.
X
X
Z
Breakdown assistance
! If you tow or tow-start another vehicle, its
300
Towing away and tow-starting
Towing the vehicle with both axles on
the ground
Breakdown assistance
G WARNING
If the steering wheel lock is engaged, the vehicle can no longer be steered. There is a risk of
an accident.
Always switch on the ignition when towing
with a tow rope or a towing bar.
The automatic transmission automatically shifts
to position P when you open the driver's or frontpassenger door or when you remove the key
from the ignition lock.
In order to ensure that the automatic transmission stays in position N when towing away the
vehicle, you must observe the following points:
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 115).
X Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and
that the key is in position 0 in the ignition lock.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock.
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, use the key
instead of the Start/Stop button
(Y page 132).
X Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift the transmission to position N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Leave the key in position 2 in the ignition lock.
In order to signal a change of direction when
towing the vehicle with the hazard warning
lamps switched on, use the combination switch
as usual. In this case, only the turn signals for
the desired direction flash. When the combination switch is reset, the hazard warning lamps
start flashing again.
It is important that you observe the safety
instructions when towing away your vehicle
(Y page 298).
Towing the vehicle away with the rear
axle raised
! The ignition must be switched off if you are
towing the vehicle with the rear axle raised.
Intervention by ESP® could otherwise damage the brake system.
! Vehicles with automatic transmission must
not be towed with the rear axle raised. The
car/trailer combination may otherwise
swerve or even overturn.
Transporting the vehicle
Vehicles with automatic transmission
! When the vehicle is loaded for transport, the
front and rear axles must be stationary and on
the same transportation vehicle. Positioning
over the connection point of the transport
vehicle is not permitted. The drive train may
otherwise be damaged.
All vehicles
! You may only secure the vehicle by the
wheels, not by parts of the vehicle such as
axle or steering components. Otherwise, the
vehicle could be damaged.
The towing eye can be used to pull the vehicle
onto a trailer or transporter for transportation.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Shift the transmission to position N.
As soon as the vehicle is loaded:
Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away by
applying the electric parking brake.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition lock
and remove it.
X Secure the vehicle.
X
Electrical fuses
! Do not tow-start vehicles with automatic
transmission. You could otherwise damage
the automatic transmission.
You can find information on "Jump-starting"
under (Y page 296).
Electrical fuses
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you manipulate, bridge or replace a faulty
fuse with a fuse of a higher amperage, the
electric cables could be overloaded. This may
result in a fire. There is a risk of an accident
and injury.
Always replace faulty fuses with specified new
fuses of the correct amperage.
Blown fuses must be replaced with fuses of the
same rating, which you can recognise by the
colour and fuse rating. The fuse ratings are listed
in the fuse allocation chart.
The fuse allocation chart is located in the vehicle
tool kit in the stowage compartment under the
boot floor (Y page 288).
If the newly inserted fuse also blows, have the
cause traced and rectified at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
Before replacing a fuse
Switch off the engine.
Switch off all electrical consumers.
X Make sure that the ignition is switched off
(Y page 132).
or
X When using the key, turn the key to position 0
in the ignition lock and remove it
(Y page 132).
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 153).
All indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
must be off.
The fuses are located in various fuse boxes:
RFuse box in the engine compartment on the
right-hand side of the vehicle, when viewed in
the direction of travel
RDashboard fuse box
RFuse box in the rear compartment on the
right-hand side of the vehicle, when viewed in
the direction of travel
X
X
Dashboard fuse box
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 301).
! Do not use a pointed object such as a screw-
driver to open the cover in the dashboard. You
could damage the dashboard or the cover.
! Only use fuses that have been approved for
Mercedes-Benz vehicles and which have the
correct fuse rating for the system concerned.
Otherwise, components or systems could be
damaged.
! Make sure that no moisture can enter the
fuse box when the cover is open.
! When closing the cover, make sure that it is
lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair the operation of the fuses.
The fuses in your vehicle disconnect faulty circuits. If a fuse blows, all the components on the
circuit and their functions will fail.
Open the driver's door.
To open: pull cover : outwards in the direction of the arrow and remove it.
X To close: clip in cover : on the front of the
dashboard.
X Fold cover : inwards until it engages.
X
X
Z
Breakdown assistance
Tow-starting (emergency engine
starting)
301
Electrical fuses
302
Fuse box in the engine compartment
X
Close the bonnet.
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 301).
G WARNING
Breakdown assistance
When the bonnet is open, and the windscreen
wipers are set in motion, you can be injured by
the wiper linkage. There is a risk of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before opening the bonnet.
Fuse box in the rear
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 301).
The fuse box in the rear is located on the right-hand
side when viewed in the direction of travel.
Open the bonnet.
Remove any existing moisture from the fuse
box using a dry cloth.
X To open: open clamps ;.
X Fold cover : of the fuse box up in the direction of the arrow and remove it.
To open: open the seat belt guide on the
right-hand seat and remove the seat belt
(Y page 103).
X Move the right-hand seat as far forward as
possible (Y page 104).
X Insert your fingers at the bottom of front
cover ; between the cover and floor covering.
X Remove front cover ; by pulling it forward in
the direction of the arrow.
X Lift off top cover : by pulling it in the direction of the arrow.
To close: check whether the seal is lying correctly in cover :.
X Insert both openings = at the rear of
cover : into the brackets on the fuse box.
The brackets on the fuse box must be completely visible in both openings = on the fuse
box.
X Fold down cover :.
Fuses = are accessible through the two openings in the top of the fuse box.
X
X
X
X
X
Hook clamps ; into the fuse box and close.
Electrical fuses
303
To close: insert the securing tags underneath
top cover : in the recesses at the top of the
fuse box.
X Fold down top cover : until it engages audibly.
X Insert the securing tags underneath top
cover ; in the recesses at the front of the
fuse box.
X Push front cover ; towards the rear until it
engages audibly.
X Move the right-hand seat backwards
(Y page 104).
X Hook the seat belt into the seat belt guide on
the right-hand seat (Y page 103).
Breakdown assistance
X
Z
304
Operation
Rdesignation
Further information regarding wheels and tyres
can be found under "Wheel/tyre combinations"
(Y page 317).
You can ask for information regarding permitted
wheel-tyre combinations at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Information on tyre pressures can be found:
Rin the tyre pressure table in the fuel filler flap
(Y page 152)
Rin the "Tyre pressure" section
Modification work on the brake system and
wheels is not permitted. The use of spacers or
brake dust shields is not permitted. This invalidates the general operating permit for the vehicle.
Rtype
i Further information on wheels and tyres can
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If wheels and tyres of the wrong size are used,
the wheel brakes or suspension components
may be damaged. There is a risk of an accident.
Always replace wheels and tyres with those
that fulfil the specifications of the original
part.
When replacing wheels, make sure to fit the
correct:
When replacing tyres, make sure to fit the
correct:
Rdesignation
Rmanufacturer
Rtype
Wheels and tyres
G WARNING
A flat tyre severely impairs the driving, steering and braking characteristics of the vehicle.
There is a risk of accident.
Tyres without run-flat characteristics:
Rdo
not drive with a flat tyre.
replace the flat tyre with your
emergency spare wheel or spare wheel, or
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyres with run-flat characteristics:
Rimmediately
Rpay
attention to the information and warning notices on MOExtended tyres (tyres
with run-flat characteristics).
Accessories that are not approved for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz or are not being used correctly can impair the operating safety.
Before purchasing and using non-approved
accessories, visit a qualified specialist workshop and enquire about:
Rsuitability
Rlegal stipulations
Rfactory recommendations
be obtained at any qualified specialist workshop.
Operation
Information on driving
Check the tyre pressures when the vehicle is
heavily laden and adjust prior to a trip.
While driving, pay attention to vibrations, noises
and unusual handling characteristics, e.g. pulling to one side. This may indicate that the
wheels or tyres are damaged. If you suspect that
a tyre is defective, reduce your speed immediately. Stop the vehicle as soon as possible to
check the wheels and tyres for damage. Hidden
tyre damage could also be causing the unusual
handling characteristics. If you find no signs of
damage, have the tyres and wheels checked at a
qualified specialist workshop.
When parking your vehicle, make sure not to
squash the tyre sidewalls. If you cannot avoid
driving over obstacles, e.g. kerbs, do so slowly
and at an obtuse angle only. You could otherwise damage the wheel rims and tyres.
Regular checking of wheels and tyres
G WARNING
Damaged tyres can cause tyre inflation pressure loss. As a result, you could lose control of
your vehicle. There is a risk of accident.
Operation
Check wheels and tyres for damage at least
once a month. Check wheels and tyres after
driving off-road or on rough roads. Damaged
wheels can cause a loss of tyre pressure. Pay
particular attention to damage such as:
Rcuts in the tyres
Rpunctures
Rtears in the tyres
Rbulges on the tyres
Rdeformation or severe corrosion on wheels
Regularly check the tyre tread depth and the
condition of the tread across the whole width of
the tyre (Y page 305). If necessary, turn the
front wheels to full lock in order to inspect the
inner side of the tyre surface.
All wheels must have a valve cap to protect the
valve against dirt and moisture. Do not fit anything onto the valve other than the standard
valve cap or other valve caps approved for your
vehicle by Mercedes-Benz. Do not fit any other
valve caps or systems, e.g. tyre pressure monitoring systems.
Regularly check the pressure of all the tyres,
particularly prior to long trips. Adjust the tyre
pressure as necessary (Y page 307).
Observe the notes on the emergency spare
wheel (Y page 318).
The service life of tyres depends on various factors, including the following:
Rdriving style
Rtyre pressure
Rmileage
Notes on the tyre tread
G WARNING
Insufficient tyre tread will reduce tyre traction. The tyre is no longer able to dissipate
water. This means that on wet road surfaces,
the risk of aquaplaning increases, in particular
where speed is not adapted to suit the driving
conditions. There is a risk of accident.
If the tyre pressure is too high or too low, tyres
may exhibit different levels of wear at different locations on the tyre tread. Thus, you
should regularly check the tread depth and
the condition of the tread across the entire
width of all tyres.
Minimum tyre tread depth for:
Rsummer
tyres: 3 mm
tyres: 4 mm
For safety reasons, replace the tyres before
the legally prescribed limit for the minimum
tyre tread depth is reached.
RM+S
Selecting, fitting and replacing tyres
G WARNING
Exceeding the stated tyre load-bearing capacity and the approved maximum speed could
lead to tyre damage or the tyre bursting. There
is a risk of accident.
Therefore, only use tyre types and sizes
approved for your vehicle model. Observe the
tyre load rating and speed rating required for
your vehicle.
Pay special attention to country-specific
requirements for tyre approval. These requirements can stipulate a specific tyre type for your
vehicle. Furthermore, the use of certain tyre
types in certain regions and areas of operation
can be highly beneficial. You can find further
information regarding tyres at specialist tyre
retailers, at qualified specialist workshops or at
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
ROnly fit tyres and wheels of the same type and
make.
Exception: it is permissible to fit a different
type or make in the event of a flat tyre.
Observe the "MOExtended tyres (tyres with
run-flat characteristics)" section
(Y page 289).
ROnly fit tyres of the correct size onto the
wheels.
RRun in new tyres at moderate speeds for the
first 100 km. They only reach their full performance after this distance.
RDo not drive with tyres which have too little
tread depth. This otherwise significantly
Z
Wheels and tyres
Check the tyres regularly for signs of damage
and replace any damaged tyres immediately.
305
306
Winter operation
reduces the traction on wet roads (aquaplaning).
RReplace the tyres after six years at the latest,
regardless of wear.
Observe the notes on the emergency spare
wheel (Y page 318).
Wheels and tyres
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
With MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat characteristics), you can continue to drive your vehicle even if there is a total loss of pressure in one
or more tyres.
MOExtended tyres may only be used in conjunction with an activated tyre pressure loss warning
system or with an activated tyre pressure monitor and on wheels specifically tested by
Mercedes-Benz.
Notes on driving with MOExtended tyres with a
flat tyre (Y page 289).
Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It is therefore recommended that you additionally equip
your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit if you fit tyres that
do not feature run-flat characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT kit can be obtained from a
qualified specialist workshop.
Winter operation
General notes
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop at the onset of winter.
Observe the notes in the "Changing a wheel"
section (Y page 312).
Driving with summer tyres
At temperatures below +7 †, summer tyres lose
elasticity and therefore traction and braking
power. Change the tyres on your vehicle to
M+S tyres. Using summer tyres at very cold
temperatures could cause tears to form,
thereby damaging the tyres permanently.
Mercedes-Benz cannot accept responsibility for
this type of damage.
G WARNING
Damaged tyres can cause tyre inflation pressure loss. As a result, you could lose control of
your vehicle. There is a risk of accident.
Check the tyres regularly for signs of damage
and replace any damaged tyres immediately.
M+S tyres
G WARNING
M+S tyres with a tyre tread depth of less than
4 mm are not suitable for use in winter as they
do not provide sufficient traction. There is a
risk of accident.
M+S tyres with a tread depth of less than
4 mm must be replaced.
At temperatures below +7 †, use winter tyres or
all-season tyres. Both are marked with M+S.
Only winter tyres bearing the i snowflake
symbol in addition to the M+S marking provide
the best possible grip in wintry road conditions.
Only these tyres will allow driving safety systems such as ABS and ESP® to function optimally in winter. These tyres have been developed specifically for driving in snow.
Use M+S tyres of the same make and tread on all
wheels to maintain safe handling characteristics.
Always observe the maximum permissible
speed specified for the M+S tyres you have fitted.
If you fit M+S tyres that have a lower maximum
permissible speed than that of the maximum
design speed of the vehicle, affix a corresponding warning label in the driver's field of vision.
This can be obtained at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Under these circumstances, you should also
restrict the maximum design speed of the vehicle using permanent SPEEDTRONIC so that it
does not exceed the maximum permissible
speed for the M+S tyres (Y page 172).
Tyre pressure
Snow chains
G WARNING
If you have fitted snow chains to the front
wheels, they may scrape against the vehicle
body or chassis components. This could
cause damage to the vehicle or the tyres.
There is a risk of an accident.
To avoid hazardous situations:
Rnever
Rfit
fit snow chains on the front wheels
snow chains to the rear wheels in pairs.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use snow chains that have
been specifically approved for your vehicle by
Mercedes-Benz, or that are of a corresponding
standard of quality. For more information,
please contact a qualified specialist workshop.
If you intend to fit snow chains, please bear the
following points in mind:
Rsnow chains cannot be fitted to all wheel-tyre
combinations. Permissible wheel-tyre combinations (Y page 317).
Ronly use snow chains if the road surface is
completely snow-covered. Remove the snow
chains as soon as possible when you come to
a road that is not snow-covered.
Rlocal regulations may restrict the use of snow
chains. Observe the appropriate regulations if
you wish to fit snow chains.
Rdo not exceed the maximum permissible
speed of 50 km/h.
Ron vehicles with Active Body Control (ABC),
you must drive at a raised vehicle level if snow
chains have been fitted (Y page 175).
When pulling away with snow chains fitted, you
can deactivate ESP® (Y page 67). This way you
can allow the wheels to spin in a controlled
manner, achieving increased driving force (cutting action).
Information about driving with an emergency
spare wheel (Y page 318).
Tyre pressure
Tyre pressure specifications
G WARNING
Underinflated or overinflated tyres pose the
following risks:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load
and vehicle speed increase.
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or
unevenly, which may greatly impair tyre
traction.
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be greatly impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
Observe the recommended tyre pressure and
check the tyre pressure of all the tyres including the spare wheel:
Rat
least every two weeks
the load changes
Rbefore embarking on a longer journey
Rfor changed operating conditions, e.g. offroad driving
If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Rwhen
G WARNING
If you fit unsuitable accessories onto tyre
valves, the tyre valves may be overloaded and
malfunction, which can cause tyre pressure
loss. Due to their design, retrofitted tyre pressure monitors keep the tyre valve open. This
can also result in tyre pressure loss. There is a
risk of accident.
Only screw standard valve caps or valve caps
specifically provided by Mercedes-Benz for
your vehicle onto the tyre valve.
G WARNING
If the tyre pressure drops repeatedly, the
wheel, valve or tyre may be damaged. Tyre
pressure that is too low may result in a tyre
blow-out. There is a risk of accident.
Z
Wheels and tyres
When you have fitted the M+S tyres:
Check the tyre pressures (Y page 307).
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system
(Y page 309).
X Restart the tyre pressure monitor
(Y page 311).
Information about driving with an emergency
spare wheel (Y page 318).
X
307
308
Tyre pressure
RCheck
the tyre for foreign objects.
RCheck whether the wheel is losing air or the
valve is leaking.
If you are unable to rectify the damage, contact a qualified specialist workshop.
H Environmental note
Wheels and tyres
Check the tyre pressure regularly, at least
every 14 days.
The recommended tyre pressures for various
operating conditions can be found in the tyre
pressure table on the fuel filler flap
(Y page 152).
Operation with an emergency spare wheel:
information on operation with an emergency
spare wheel can be found in the general notes in
the "Emergency spare wheel" section
(Y page 318).
Additionally, the tyre pressure table may also
state tyre pressures for different load conditions. These are defined in the table as different
numbers of passengers and amounts of luggage. The actual number of seats may vary; for
more information, please refer to the vehicle's
registration documents.
If tyre sizes are not specified, the tyre pressures
stated on the tyre pressure table apply for all
tyres approved for this vehicle.
If possible, only correct tyre pressures when the
tyres are cold.
The tyres are cold:
Rif the vehicle has been parked with the tyres
out of direct sunlight for at least three hours
and
Rif the vehicle has not been driven further than
1.6 km
Depending on the ambient temperature, the
vehicle speed and the load on the tyres, the tyre
temperature and thus the tyre pressure changes
by approximately 10 kPa (0.1 bar/1.5 psi) per
10 †. Take this into account when checking the
pressure of warm tyres. Only correct the tyre
pressure if it is too low for the current operating
conditions.
Driving with tyre pressure that is too high or too
low can:
Rshorten the service life of the tyres
Rcause increased tyre damage
Rhave a negative effect on handling characteristics and thus driving safety (e.g. aquaplaning)
The tyre pressure values given for low loads are
minimum values which offer you good ride comfort characteristics.
However, you can also use the values given for
higher loads. These are permissible and will not
adversely affect the running of the vehicle.
Tyre pressure loss warning system
General notes
If a tyre size precedes a tyre pressure, the following tyre pressure information is only valid for
that tyre size.
Use a suitable pressure gauge to check the tyre
pressure. The outer appearance of a tyre does
not permit any reliable conclusion about the tyre
pressure. On vehicles fitted with the electronic
tyre pressure monitor, the tyre pressure can be
checked using the on-board computer.
While the vehicle is in motion, the tyre pressure
loss warning system monitors the set tyre pressure using the rotational speed of the wheels.
This enables the system to detect significant
pressure loss in a tyre. If the speed of rotation of
a wheel changes as a result of a loss of pressure,
a corresponding warning message will appear in
the multifunction display.
You can recognise the tyre pressure loss warning by the Run Flat Indicator active
Restart with OK message which appears in
the Serv. menu of the multifunction display.
Information on the message display can be
found in the "Restarting the tyre pressure loss
warning system" section (Y page 309).
Tyre pressure
The tyre pressure warning system does not warn
you of an incorrectly set tyre pressure. Observe
the notes on the recommended tyre pressure
(Y page 307).
The tyre pressure loss warning does not replace
the need to regularly check the tyre pressures.
An even loss of pressure on several tyres at the
same time cannot be detected by the tyre pressure loss warning system.
The tyre pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the tyre
is penetrated by a foreign object. In the event of
a sudden loss of pressure, bring the vehicle to a
halt by braking carefully. Avoid abrupt steering
manoeuvres.
The function of the tyre pressure loss warning
system is limited or delayed if:
Rsnow chains are fitted to your vehicle's tyres.
Rroad conditions are wintry.
Ryou are driving on sand or gravel.
Ryou adopt a very sporty driving style (cornering at high speeds or driving with high rates of
acceleration).
Ryou drive with a heavy load.
Restarting the tyre pressure loss warning system
Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system if
you have:
Rchanged the tyre pressure
Rchanged the wheels or tyres
Rfitted new wheels or tyres
X Before restarting, make sure that the tyre
pressures are set properly on all four tyres for
the respective operating conditions. The recommended tyre pressures can be found in the
tyre pressure table on the fuel filler flap.
The tyre pressure loss warning system can
only give reliable warnings if you have set the
correct tyre pressure. If an incorrect tyre
pressure is set, these incorrect values will be
monitored.
X Observe the notes in the section on tyre pressures (Y page 307).
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 132).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Serv. menu.
Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator active
Restart with OK message appears in the
multifunction display.
X
If you wish to confirm the restart:
Press the a button.
The Tyre press. now OK? message appears
in the multifunction display.
X Press the 9 or : button to select Yes
Yes.
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator restarted message appears in the multifunction display.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure loss
warning system will monitor the set tyre pressures of all four tyres.
X
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
or
Press the % button.
If the Tyre press. now OK? message
appears, use the 9 or : button to
select Cancel
Cancel.
X Press the a button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
X
Tyre pressure monitor
General notes
If a tyre pressure monitor system is fitted, the
vehicle's wheels have sensors fitted that monitor the tyre pressures in all four tyres. The tyre
pressure monitor warns you if the pressure
drops in one or more of the tyres. The tyre pressure monitor only functions if the corresponding
sensors are fitted to all wheels.
Information on tyre pressures is shown in the
multifunction display. After a few minutes of
driving, the current tyre pressure of each tyre is
shown in the Service menu of the multifunction
display.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Important safety notes
309
310
Tyre pressure
Example: current tyre pressure display
For further information on displaying this message, refer to the "Checking the tyre pressure
electronically" section (Y page 310).
Wheels and tyres
Important safety notes
It is the driver's responsibility to set the tyre
pressure to the recommended cold tyre pressure suitable for the operating situation
(Y page 307). Note that the correct tyre pressure for the current operating situation must
first be taught-in to the tyre pressure monitor. If
there is a substantial loss of pressure, the warning threshold for the warning message is aligned
to the reference values taught-in. Restart the
tyre pressure monitor after adjusting to the cold
tyre pressure (Y page 311). The current pressures are saved as new reference values. This
will ensure that a warning message will only
appear if the tyre pressure drops significantly.
The tyre pressure monitor does not warn you of
an incorrectly set tyre pressure. Observe the
notes on the recommended tyre pressure
(Y page 307).
The tyre pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the tyre
is penetrated by a foreign object. In the event of
a sudden loss of pressure, bring the vehicle to a
halt by braking carefully. Avoid abrupt steering
manoeuvres.
The tyre pressure monitor has a yellow warning
lamp in the instrument cluster for indicating a
pressure loss or malfunction. Depending on how
the warning lamp flashes or lights up, a tyre
pressure that is too low or a malfunction in the
tyre pressure monitor is indicated:
Rif the warning lamp is lit continuously, the tyre
pressure on one or more tyres is significantly
too low. The tyre pressure monitor is not malfunctioning.
Rif the warning lamp flashes for around a
minute and then remains lit constantly, the
tyre pressure monitor is malfunctioning.
In addition to the warning lamp, a message
appears in the multifunction display. Observe
the information on display messages
(Y page 237).
It may take up to ten minutes for a malfunction
of the tyre pressure monitor to be indicated. A
malfunction will be indicated by the tyre pressure warning lamp flashing for approximately
one minute and then remaining lit. When the
fault has been rectified, the tyre pressure warning lamp goes out after you have driven for a few
minutes.
The tyre pressure values indicated by the onboard computer may differ from those measured at a filling station using a pressure gauge.
The tyre pressures shown by the on-board computer refer to those measured at sea level. At
high altitudes, the tyre pressure values indicated by a pressure gauge are higher than those
shown by the on-board computer. In this case,
do not reduce the tyre pressures.
The operation of the tyre pressure monitor can
be affected by interference from radio transmitting equipment (e.g. radio headphones, two-way
radios) that may be being operated in or near the
vehicle.
Checking the tyre pressure electronically
Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 132).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Service menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The current tyre pressure for each wheel will
be displayed in the multifunction display.
If the vehicle has been parked for over
20 minutes, the Tyre pressures will be
displayed after a few minutes of driv‐
ing message appears.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure monitor automatically detects new wheels or new
sensors. As long as a clear allocation of the tyre
pressure values to the individual wheels is not
possible, the Tyre pressure monitor active
display message is shown instead of the tyre
pressure display. The tyre pressures are already
being monitored.
If an emergency spare wheel is fitted, for a few
minutes the system may continue to show the
X
Tyre pressure
Warning messages of the tyre pressure
monitor
If the tyre pressure monitor detects a pressure
loss in one or more tyres, a warning message is
shown in the multifunction display. The yellow
tyre pressure warning lamp then lights up:
RIf
the Rectify tyre pressure message
appears in the multifunction display, the tyre
pressure in at least one tyre is too low. The
tyre pressure must be corrected when the
opportunity arises.
RIf the Check tyre(s) message appears in the
multifunction display, the tyre pressure in at
least one tyre has dropped significantly. The
tyres must be checked.
RIf the Warning tyre defect message
appears in the multifunction display, the tyre
pressure in at least one tyre has dropped suddenly. The tyres must be checked.
Observe the instructions and safety notes in the
display messages in the "Tyres" section
(Y page 237).
If the position of the wheels are interchanged on
the vehicle, the tyre pressures may be displayed
in the wrong positions for a short time. After a
few minutes of driving, this is rectified and the
tyre pressures are displayed in the correct positions.
Restarting the tyre pressure monitor
When you restart the tyre pressure monitor, all
existing warning messages are deleted and the
warning lamps go out. The monitor uses the currently set tyre pressures as the reference values
for monitoring. In most cases, the tyre pressure
monitor will automatically detect the new reference values after you have changed the tyre
pressure. However, you can also set reference
values manually as described here. The tyre
pressure monitor then monitors the new tyre
pressure values.
X Use the table on the inside of the fuel filler flap
to ensure that the tyre pressure is set correctly in all four tyres for the current operating
conditions.
Also observe the notes in the section on tyre
pressures (Y page 307).
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering
wheel to select the Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The multifunction display shows the current
tyre pressure for the individual tyres or the
Tyre pressures will be displayed
after a few minutes of driving message.
X Press the : button.
The Use current pressures as new ref‐
erence values message appears in the multifunction display.
If you wish to confirm the restart:
X
Press the a button.
The Tyre press. monitor restarted message appears in the multifunction display.
After you have driven for a few minutes, the
system checks whether the current tyre pressures are within the specified range. The new
tyre pressures are then accepted as reference values and monitored.
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
Press the % button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
Radio type approval for the tyre pressure monitor
Country
Radio type approval number
Argentina
MW2433A
H-12337
GG4
H-12338
Brazil
2770-12-8001
Model: MW2433A
0381-13-8001
Model: GG4
Z
Wheels and tyres
tyre pressure of the wheel that has been
removed. If this occurs, note that the value displayed for the position where the spare wheel is
fitted is not the same as the current tyre pressure of the emergency spare wheel.
311
312
Changing a wheel
Country
Radio type approval number
Abu Dhabi TRA, Registered NO
ER0092100/12
Dubai
TRA, Registered NO
ER0099792/12
TRA, Registered NO
ER0076990/11
Dealer NO: DA0047074/10
Wheels and tyres
Jordan
Model: Gen Alpha Wal 2 TPMS
transmitter
Type Approval Number:
TRC/LPD/2012/114
Model: Gen Gamma Gen 4
433.92 Mhz.
Type Approval Number:
TRC/LPD/2012/190
Model: Corax 3 MRXMC34MA4
Type Approval Number:
TRC/LPD/2011/158
Type Number: LPD
Morocco
MR7319 ANRT 2012/
11/07/2012
MR7672 ANRT 2012/
23/11/2012
MR6706 ANRT 2011
Moldova
1024
Philippines
No: ESD-1206394C
No: ESD-1306871C
Serbia
И 011 12
Singapore Compliance with IDA Standard
DA- 103365
South
Africa
TA-2012/719
TA-2012/1540
TA-2011/1370
Changing a wheel
Flat tyre
You can find information on what to do in the
event of a flat tyre in the "Breakdown assistance" section (Y page 289). Information on
driving with MOExtended tyres in the event of a
flat tyre can be found under "Breakdown assistance" (Y page 289).
Interchanging the wheels
G WARNING
Interchanging the front and rear wheels may
severely impair the driving characteristics if
the wheels or tyres have different dimensions.
The wheel brakes or suspension components
may also be damaged. There is a risk of accident.
Interchange front and rear wheels only if the
wheels and tyres are of the same dimensions.
! On vehicles fitted with a tyre pressure mon-
itor, electronic components are located in the
wheel.
Tyre-fitting tools should not be applied in the
area of the valve, as this could damage the
electronic components.
Only have tyres changed at a qualified specialist workshop.
Interchanging front and rear wheels of differing
dimensions can render the general operating
permit invalid.
Always pay attention to the instructions and
safety notes when changing a wheel
(Y page 313).
The wear patterns on the front and rear tyres
differ depending on the operating conditions.
Interchange the wheels before a clear wear pattern has formed on the tyres. Front tyres typically wear more on the shoulders and the rear
tyres in the centre.
On vehicles that have the same size front and
rear wheels, you can interchange the wheels
every 5000 to 10,000 km depending on the
degree of tyre wear. Ensure the direction of
rotation is maintained.
Clean the contact surfaces of the wheel and the
brake disc thoroughly every time a wheel is
interchanged. Check the tyre pressure and, if
necessary, restart the tyre pressure loss warning system or the tyre pressure monitor.
Direction of rotation
Tyres with a specified direction of rotation have
additional benefits, e.g. if there is a risk of aquaplaning. These advantages can only be gained if
the tyres are fitted corresponding to the direction of rotation.
Changing a wheel
An arrow on the sidewall of the tyre indicates its
correct direction of rotation.
313
Securing the vehicle against rolling
away
Storing wheels
Store wheels that are not being used in a cool,
dry and preferably dark place. Protect the tyres
against oil, grease, petrol and diesel.
Fitting a wheel
Preparing the vehicle
i Apart from certain country-specific varia-
tions, vehicles are not equipped with a tyrechange tool kit. For information on which
tools are required to perform a wheel change
on your vehicle, consult a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Necessary tyre-changing tools may include,
for example:
Rjack
Rwheel chock
Rwheel wrench
If your vehicle is equipped with a wheel chock, it
can be found in the tyre-change tool kit
(Y page 288).
The folding wheel chock is an additional securing measure to safeguard the vehicle from rolling away, for example when changing a wheel.
X Fold both plates upwards :.
X Fold out lower plate ;.
X Insert the lugs on the lower plate fully into the
openings in base plate =.
Wheels and tyres
Stop the vehicle on solid, non-slippery and
level ground.
X Unload the vehicle. The jack can only be used
when the vehicle is unladen.
X Apply the electric parking brake manually.
X Move the front wheels to the straight-ahead
position.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Switch off the engine.
X Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove the
key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: open the driver's door.
The vehicle electronics now have status 0.
This is the same as the key having been
removed.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: remove the
Start/Stop button from the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
X If included in the vehicle equipment, remove
the tyre-change tool kit from the vehicle.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away.
X
X
Place chocks or other suitable items under
the front and rear of the wheel that is diagonally opposite the wheel you wish to change.
Raising the vehicle
G WARNING
If you do not position the jack correctly at the
appropriate jacking point of the vehicle, the
jack could tip over with the vehicle raised.
There is a risk of injury.
Only position the jack at the appropriate jacking point of the vehicle. The base of the jack
Z
314
Changing a wheel
Wheels and tyres
must be positioned vertically, directly under
the jacking point of the vehicle.
Observe the following when raising the vehicle:
Ronly use the vehicle-specific jack that has
been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz
to raise the vehicle. If the jack is used incorrectly, it could tip over while the vehicle is
raised.
Rthe jack is designed only to raise and hold the
vehicle for a short time while a wheel is being
changed. It is not permissible to use it to perform maintenance work under the vehicle.
Ravoid changing the wheel on uphill and downhill slopes.
Rbefore raising the vehicle, safeguard it from
rolling away by applying the parking brake and
positioning wheel chocks. Do not release the
parking brake while the vehicle is raised.
Rthe jack must be placed on a firm, flat and
non-slip surface. On a loose surface, a large,
flat load-bearing underlay must be used. On a
slippery surface, a non-slip underlay must be
used, e.g. rubber mats.
Rdo not use wooden blocks or similar objects
as a jack underlay. Otherwise, the jack will not
be able to achieve its load-bearing capacity
due to the restricted height.
Rmake sure that the distance between the
underside of the tyres and the ground does
not exceed 3 cm.
Rnever place your hands or feet under the
raised vehicle.
Rdo not lie under the vehicle.
Rdo not start the engine when the vehicle is
raised.
Rdo not open or close a door or the boot lid
when the vehicle is raised.
Rmake sure that no persons are present in the
vehicle when the vehicle is raised.
Vehicles with light-alloy wheels and hub
caps: the wheel bolts are covered by a hub cap.
Before you can unscrew the wheel bolts, you
must remove the hub cap. Two different variants
can be fitted.
To remove: take socket ; and wheel wrench
= from the vehicle tool kit (Y page 288).
X Position socket ; on hub cap :.
X Position wheel wrench = on socket ;.
X Using wheel wrench =, turn hub cap : anticlockwise and remove it.
X To fit: before fitting, check hub cap : and
the wheel area for dirt and clean if necessary.
X Put hub cap : in position and turn until it is in
the right position.
X Position socket ; on hub cap :.
X Attach wheel wrench = to socket ; and
tighten hub cap :.
The tightening torque must be 25 Nm.
X
i Note that the hub cap should be tightened
to the specified torque of 25 Nm. MercedesBenz recommends that you have the hub cap
fitted at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Using wheel wrench =, loosen the bolts on
the wheel you wish to change by about one
full turn. Do not unscrew the bolts completely.
Changing a wheel
The jacking points are located just behind the
front wheel arches and just in front of the rear
wheel arches (arrows).
Mercedes-AMG vehicles and vehicles with
AMG equipment: to protect the vehicle body,
the vehicle has covers fitted next to the jacking
points on the outer sills.
X
315
Make sure that the base of the jack is positioned vertically under the jacking point.
Turn crank C clockwise until jack B sits
completely on jacking point A. The base of
the jack must lie evenly on the ground.
X Turn crank C until the tyre is raised a maximum of 3 cm off the ground.
X
Removing a wheel
and fitting a wheel, the wheel rim may strike
the ceramic brake disc and damage it. Therefore, take precautions and have a second person assist you. Alternatively, you can use a
second centring pin.
! Do not place wheel bolts in sand or dirt. The
X
threads of the wheel bolts and wheel hubs
could otherwise be damaged when the bolts
are tightened.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles and vehicles
with AMG equipment: fold cover ?
upwards.
Unscrew the uppermost wheel bolt completely.
X Screw centring pin : into the thread instead
of the wheel bolt.
X Unscrew the remaining wheel bolts fully.
X Remove the wheel.
X
X
Position jack B at jacking point A.
Z
Wheels and tyres
! Mercedes AMG vehicles: when removing
316
Changing a wheel
Fitting a new wheel
G WARNING
Oiled or greased wheel bolts or damaged
wheel bolts/hub threads can cause the wheel
bolts to come loose. As a result, you could
lose a wheel while driving. There is a risk of
accident.
Never oil or grease wheel bolts. In the event of
damage to the threads, contact a qualified
specialist workshop immediately. Have the
damaged wheel bolts or hub threads
replaced/renewed. Do not continue driving.
G WARNING
Wheels and tyres
If you tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is raised, the jack could tip
over. There is a risk of injury.
Only tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is on the ground.
It is imperative to observe the instructions and
safety notes on "Changing a wheel"
(Y page 312).
Only use wheel bolts that have been designed
for the wheel and the vehicle. For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
only use wheel bolts which have been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and the respective
wheel.
! Mercedes AMG vehicles: when removing
and fitting a wheel, the wheel rim may strike
the ceramic brake disc and damage it. Therefore, take precautions and have a second person assist you. Alternatively, you can use a
second centring pin.
Clean the wheel and wheel hub contact surfaces.
X Slide the wheel to be mounted onto the centring pin and push it on.
X Tighten the wheel bolts until they are fingertight.
X Unscrew the centring pin.
X Tighten the last wheel bolt until it is fingertight.
X Vehicles with a collapsible emergency
spare wheel: inflate the collapsible emergency spare wheel (Y page 319).
Only then lower the vehicle.
X
Lowering the vehicle
G WARNING
The wheels could work loose if the wheel nuts
and bolts are not tightened to the specified
tightening torque. There is a risk of accident.
Have the tightening torque immediately
checked at a qualified specialist workshop
after a wheel is changed.
! Vehicles with a collapsible emergency
spare wheel: Inflate the collapsible emergency spare wheel using the tyre inflation
compressor before lowering the vehicle. The
rim could otherwise be damaged.
X Turn the crank of the jack anti-clockwise until
the vehicle is once again standing firmly on
the ground.
X Place the jack to one side.
Tighten the wheel bolts evenly in a crosswise
pattern in the sequence indicated (: to A).
The specified tightening torque is 130 Nm.
X Turn the jack back to its initial position.
X
Wheel and tyre combinations
Wheel and tyre combinations
You can ask for information regarding permitted
wheel-tyre combinations at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
! For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recom-
mends that you only use tyres and wheels
which have been approved by Mercedes-Benz
specifically for your vehicle.
These are specially adapted to the control
systems, such as ABS or ESP® and are
marked as follows:
RMO = Mercedes-Benz Original
RMOE = Mercedes-Benz Original Extended
(tyres featuring run-flat characteristics)
RMO1 = Mercedes-Benz Original (only certain AMG tyres)
Mercedes-Benz Original Extended tyres may
only be used on wheels that have been specifically approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Only use tyres, wheels or accessories tested
and approved by Mercedes-Benz. Certain
characteristics, e.g. handling, vehicle noise
emissions or fuel consumption, may otherwise be adversely affected. In addition, when
driving with a load, tyre dimension variations
could cause the tyres to come into contact
with the bodywork and axle components. This
could result in damage to the tyres or the
vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz accepts no liability for damage resulting from the use of tyres, wheels or
accessories other than those tested and
approved.
Further information about wheels, tyres and
approved combinations can be obtained from
any qualified specialist workshop.
! Retreaded tyres are neither tested nor recommended by Mercedes-Benz, since previous damage cannot always be detected on
retreaded tyres. As a result, Mercedes-Benz
cannot guarantee vehicle safety if retreaded
tyres are fitted. Do not fit used tyres if you
have no information about their previous
usage.
! Large wheels: the lower the section width
for a certain wheel size, the lower the ride
comfort is on poor road surfaces. Roll comfort
and suspension comfort are reduced and the
risk of damage to the wheels and tyres as a
result of driving over obstacles increases.
The recommended tyre pressures can be found
in the tyre pressure table on the fuel filler flap.
For further information on tyre pressure, see
(Y page 307). Check tyre pressures regularly
and only when the tyres are cold.
Notes on the vehicle equipment – always fit the
vehicle:
Rwith tyres of the same size across an axle
(left/right)
Rwith the same type of tyres at a given time
(summer tyres, winter tyres, MOExtended
tyres)
Exception: it is permissible to fit a different
type or make in the event of a flat tyre.
Observe the "MOExtended tyres (tyres with
run-flat characteristics)" section
(Y page 289).
Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It is therefore recommended that you additionally equip
your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit if you fit tyres that
do not feature run-flat characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT kit can be obtained from a
qualified specialist workshop.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Stow the jack and the rest of the tyre-change
tool kit in the boot again.
X Mercedes-AMG vehicles and vehicles
with AMG equipment: insert the cover into
the outer sill.
X Check the air pressure of the newly fitted
wheel and adjust accordingly.
Observe the recommended tyre pressure
(Y page 307).
Vehicles with a tyre pressure monitor: all fitted wheels must be equipped with functioning
sensors.
If you are driving with the emergency spare
wheel fitted, the tyre pressure loss warning system or the tyre pressure monitor cannot function reliably. Only restart the tyre pressure loss
warning system or tyre pressure monitor when
the defective wheel has been replaced with a
new wheel.
Vehicles with a tyre pressure monitor: all fitted wheels must be equipped with functioning
sensors.
X
317
318
Emergency spare wheel
Emergency spare wheel
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The wheel/tyre dimensions and the tyre type
of the spare wheel/emergency spare wheel
and the wheel to be replaced may differ. Fitting a spare wheel/emergency spare wheel
may severely impair the driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
To prevent hazardous situations:
RAdapt
your driving style accordingly and
drive carefully.
RNever fit more than one spare wheel/emergency spare wheel if the dimensions are
different to those of the wheel being
replaced.
ROnly use a spare wheel/emergency spare
wheel briefly if the dimensions are different
to those of the wheel being replaced.
not switch off ESP®.
the spare wheel/emergency spare
wheel in question replaced at the nearest
qualified specialist workshop. Make sure
that the wheel/tyre dimensions and tyre
type are correct.
RDo
Wheels and tyres
RHave
Replace the tyres after six years at the latest,
regardless of wear. This also applies to the
emergency spare wheel.
If you are driving with the emergency spare
wheel fitted, the tyre pressure loss warning system or the tyre pressure monitor cannot function reliably. Only restart the tyre pressure loss
warning system or tyre pressure monitor when
the defective wheel has been replaced with a
new wheel.
Vehicles with tyre pressure monitor: after
fitting an emergency spare wheel, the system
may still display the tyre pressure of the
removed wheel for a few minutes. The value displayed for the position where the emergency
spare wheel is fitted is not the same as the current tyre pressure of the emergency spare
wheel.
Removing the emergency spare wheel
Vehicles with a collapsible emergency
spare wheel located under the boot
floor
The collapsible emergency spare wheel is located in the stowage well under the boot floor
(Y page 266).
When using an emergency spare wheel or spare
wheel of a different size, you must not exceed
the maximum speed of 80 km/h.
Snow chains must not be fitted to emergency
spare wheels.
General notes
You can ask for information regarding permitted
emergency spare wheels at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
You should also regularly check the tyre pressure of the emergency spare wheel, particularly
prior to long trips, and correct the pressure as
necessary (Y page 307). The value on the wheel
is valid.
An emergency spare wheel may also be fitted
against the direction of rotation. Observe the
time restriction on use as well as the speed limitation specified on the emergency spare wheel.
X
Remove the emergency spare wheel bag with
collapsible emergency spare wheel :.
Observe the instructions and safety notes in the
"Fitting a wheel" section (Y page 313).
Vehicles with an emergency spare
wheel in an emergency spare wheel bag
The emergency spare wheel is enclosed in emergency spare wheel bag : and secured in the
boot.
Emergency spare wheel
Inflating the collapsible emergency
spare wheel
! Inflate the collapsible emergency spare
wheel using the tyre inflation compressor
before lowering the vehicle. The wheel rim
could otherwise be damaged.
! Do not operate the tyre inflation compres-
sor for longer than eight minutes at a time
without a break. It may otherwise overheat.
The tyre inflation compressor can be operated again once it has cooled down.
X Mount the collapsible emergency spare wheel
as described (Y page 313).
The collapsible emergency spare wheel must
be mounted before it is inflated.
X Remove the tyre inflation compressor from
the stowage space under the boot floor
(Y page 288).
Pull plug ? and the filler hose out of the
housing.
X Remove the cap from the valve on the collapsible emergency spare wheel.
X Screw union nut : on the filler hose onto the
valve.
X Make sure on/off switch A of the tyre inflation compressor is set to 0.
X Insert plug ? into the socket of the cigarette
lighter or into a 12 V power socket in your
vehicle.
X Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
X Press on/off switch A on the tyre inflation
compressor to I.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched on.
The tyre is inflated. The tyre pressure is shown
on pressure gauge =.
X Pump the tyre to the specified tyre pressure.
The specified tyre pressure is printed on the
yellow label of the emergency spare wheel.
X When the specified tyre pressure has been
reached, press on/off switch A on the electric air pump to 0.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched off.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition lock.
X If the tyre pressure is higher than the specified pressure, press button of pressure
release valve ; until the correct tyre pressure has been reached.
X Unscrew union nut : on the filler hose from
the valve.
X Screw the valve cap onto the collapsible
emergency spare wheel valve again.
X
Stow plug ? and the filler hose in the lower
section of the compressor housing.
X Stow the tyre inflation compressor in the vehicle.
X
Z
Wheels and tyres
Open the boot separator (Y page 95).
Loosen tensioning strap ; on both sides of
emergency spare wheel bag :.
X Unhook retaining spring hooks = of tensioning strap ; from the retainers.
X Remove emergency spare wheel bag : with
the emergency spare wheel.
X Open emergency spare wheel bag : and
remove the emergency spare wheel.
Observe the instructions and safety notes in the
"Fitting a wheel" section (Y page 313).
X
X
319
320
Vehicle electronics
Information on technical data
i The technical data was determined in
accordance with EU Directives. All data
applies to the vehicle's standard equipment.
The data may therefore differ for vehicles with
optional equipment. You can obtain further
information from a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
Vehicle electronics
Tampering with the engine electronics
! Only have work carried out on the engine
electronics and its associated parts, such as
control units, sensors, actuating components
and connector leads, at a qualified specialist
workshop. Vehicle components may otherwise wear more quickly and the vehicle's
operating permit may be invalidated.
Retrofitting two-way radios and
mobile phones (RF transmitters)
Technical data
G WARNING
If RF transmitters are tampered with or not
properly retrofitted, the electromagnetic radiation they emit can interfere with the vehicle
electronics. This may jeopardise the operational safety of the vehicle. There is a risk of an
accident.
You should have all work on electrical and
electronic components carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If you operate RF transmitters incorrectly in
the vehicle, the electromagnetic radiation
could interfere with the vehicle electronics,
e.g.:
Rif the RF transmitter is not connected to an
exterior aerial
exterior aerial has been fitted incorrectly or is not a low-reflection type
Rthe
This could jeopardise the operating safety of
the vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Have the low-reflection exterior aerial fitted at
a qualified specialist workshop. When operating RF transmitters in the vehicle, always
connect them to the low-reflection exterior
aerial.
! The operating permit may be invalidated if
the instructions for installation and use of RF
transmitters are not observed.
In particular, the following conditions must be
complied with:
Ronly approved wavebands may be used.
Robserve the maximum permissible output
in these wavebands.
Ronly approved aerial positions may be
used.
Excessive levels of electromagnetic radiation
may cause damage to your health and to the
health of others. The use of an exterior aerial
takes into consideration the scientific discussion surrounding the possible health risk posed
by electromagnetic fields.
Observe the notes on operating mobile phones
(Y page 268).
The following aerial positions may be used for
the correct installation of RF transmitters:
Approved aerial positions
: Rear wing
i On the rear wing, it is recommended that
you position the aerial on the side of the vehicle closest to the centre of the road.
Use Technical Specification ISO/TS 21609
(Road Vehicles – "EMC guidelines for fitting
aftermarket radio frequency transmitting equipment") when retrofitting RF (radio frequency)
Identification plates
Waveband
Maximum
transmission
output
Short wave
3 - 54 MHz
100 W
4 m waveband
74 - 88 MHz
30 W
2 m waveband
144 - 174 MHz
50 W
Trunked radio/Tetra
380 - 460 MHz
10 W
70 cm waveband
400 - 460 MHz
35 W
Mobile communications
(2G/3G/4G)
10 W
The following can be used in the vehicle without
restrictions:
RRF transmitters with a maximum transmission output of up to 100 mW
RRF transmitters with transmitter frequencies
in the 380 - 410 MHz waveband and a maximum transmission output of up to 2 W
(trunked radio/Tetra)
RMobile telephones (2G/3G/4G)
There are no restrictions when positioning the
aerial on the outside of the vehicle for the following wavebands:
RTrunked radio/Tetra
R70 cm waveband
R2G/3G/4G
Identification plates
Vehicle identification plate with vehicle identification number (VIN)
X
Open the right-hand door.
You will see vehicle identification plate :.
Example: vehicle identification plate
: Vehicle manufacturer (Daimler AG)
; EU type approval number (only for certain
countries)
= VIN
? Maximum permissible gross vehicle weight
(kg)
A Maximum permissible front axle load (kg)
B Maximum permissible rear axle load (kg)
C Paint code
i The data shown on the vehicle identification
plate is example data. This data is different for
every vehicle and can deviate from the data
shown here. You can find the data applicable
to your vehicle on the vehicle's identification
plate.
Z
Technical data
transmitters. Comply with the legal requirements for add-on parts.
If your vehicle has fittings for two-way radio
equipment, use the power supply or aerial connections intended for use with the basic wiring.
Be sure to observe the manufacturer's additional instructions when installing.
Deviations with respect to wavebands, maximum transmission outputs or aerial positions
must be approved by Mercedes-Benz.
The maximum transmission output (PEAK) at the
base of the aerial must not exceed the following
values:
321
Service products and capacities
322
Vehicle identification number (VIN)
Move the front-passenger seat to its rearmost
position.
X Fold up floor covering : in front of the frontpassenger seat.
VIN ; can be seen.
X
The VIN can also be found on the vehicle identification plate (Y page 321).
Service products and capacities
Important safety notes
Technical data
G WARNING
Service product can be poisonous and hazardous to health. There is a risk of injury.
Observe the instructions on the respective
original container when using, storing and disposing off service products. Always store service products in the sealed original container.
Always keep service products out of the reach
of children.
H Environmental note
Dispose of service products in an environmentally-responsible manner.
Service products include the following:
Rfuels
Rlubricants
Rcoolant
Rbrake
(e.g. engine oil, transmission oil)
fluid
Rwindscreen washer fluid
Rclimate control system refrigerant
When handling, storing and disposing of any
service products, please observe the relevant
regulations.
Components and service products must be
matched. Only use products recommended by
Mercedes-Benz. Damage which is caused by the
use of products which have not been recommended is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz
warranty or goodwill gestures. They are listed in
this Mercedes-Benz Owner's Manual in the
appropriate section.
You can identify service products approved by
Mercedes-Benz by the following inscriptions on
the container:
RMB-Freigabe (e.g. MB-Freigabe 229.51)
RMB-Approval (e.g. MB-Approval 229.51)
Other designations or recommendations indicate a level of quality or a specification in
accordance with an MB Sheet Number (e.g. MB
229.51). They have not necessarily been
approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Other identifications, for example:
R0 W-30
R5 W-30
R5 W-40
You can obtain further information at any qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
Fuel
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Fuel is highly flammable. If you handle fuel
incorrectly, there is a risk of fire and explosion.
You must avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Switch off the engine
and, if applicable, the auxiliary heating before
refuelling.
G WARNING
Fuels are poisonous and hazardous to health.
There is a danger of injury.
Do not swallow fuel or let it come into contact
with skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale fuel
Service products and capacities
RWash the fuel off any affected areas of skin
with water and soap immediately.
RIf you get fuel in your eyes, rinse them thor-
oughly with clean water immediately. Seek
immediate medical attention.
RIf fuel is swallowed, seek immediate medical attention. Do not induce vomiting.
RChange any clothing that has come into
contact with fuel immediately.
Tank capacity
The total capacity of the fuel tank may vary,
depending on the vehicle equipment.
Model
Total capacity
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
75.0 l
All other models
65.0 l
or
75.0 l
Model
Of which
reserve fuel
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
Approx.
14.0 l
Models with 65.0 l total
capacity
Approx. 8.0 l
Models with 75.0 l total
capacity
Approx. 9.0 l
Petrol
Fuel grade
! Do not use diesel to refuel vehicles with a
petrol engine. Do not switch on the ignition if
you accidentally refuel with the wrong fuel.
Otherwise, the fuel will enter the fuel system.
Even small amounts of the wrong fuel can
result in damage to the fuel system and the
engine. Notify a qualified specialist workshop
and have the fuel tank and fuel lines drained
completely.
! Only refuel using unleaded petrol with at
least 95 RON, which conforms to the European standard EN 228 or E DIN or an equivalent specification.
Fuel of this specification may contain up to
10% ethanol. Your vehicle is suitable for use
with E10 fuel. You may refuel your vehicle
using E10 fuel.
Fuel that does not conform to EN 228 can lead
to increased wear as well as damage to the
fuel system, engine and exhaust system.
! Only use the fuel recommended. Operating
the vehicle with other fuels can lead to damage to the fuel system, engine and exhaust
system.
! Do not use the following:
RE85
(petrol with 85% ethanol)
(100% ethanol)
RM15 (petrol with 15% methanol)
RM30 (petrol with 30% methanol)
RM85 (petrol with 85% methanol)
RM100 (100% methanol)
Rpetrol with additives containing metal
Rdiesel
Do not mix such fuels with the fuel recommended for your vehicle.
Usually you will find information about the fuel
grade on the pump. If you cannot find the label
on the petrol pump, ask the filling station staff.
As a temporary measure, if the recommended
fuel is not available, you may also use regular
unleaded petrol with an octane rating of
91 RON. This may reduce engine performance
and increase fuel consumption. Avoid driving at
full throttle and sudden acceleration. Never
refuel using fuel with a lower RON.
RE100
i In some countries, the available petrol may
not be sufficiently low in sulphur. This fuel can
temporarily produce unpleasant odours,
especially on short journeys. As soon as sulphur-free fuel (sulphur content < 10 ppm) is
used for refuelling, the odours are reduced.
Information on refuelling (Y page 152).
Z
Technical data
vapours. Keep fuels out of the reach of children.
If you or others come into contact with fuel,
observe the following:
323
324
Service products and capacities
SL 400
Additives in petrol
! Only refuel using super unleaded petrol with
! Operating the engine with fuel additives
at least 98 ROZ, if you want maximum performance from the engine. Alternatively, you
can also use unleaded petrol of at least
95 ROZ.
As a temporary measure, if the recommended
fuel is not available, you may also use regular
unleaded petrol with an octane rating of
91 ROZ. Doing so results in higher fuel consumption and significantly reduced performance. Never refuel using fuel with a lower
RON.
Fuel of this specification may contain up to
10% ethanol.
Fuel that does not conform to EN 228 or E DIN
51626–1 can lead to increased wear as well
as damage to the engine and exhaust system.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
! Only refuel using super unleaded petrol with
Technical data
at least 98 ROZ, that conforms to European
standard EN 228 or an equivalent specification.
You can otherwise impair engine output or
damage the engine.
Fuel of this specification may contain up to
10% ethanol. Your vehicle is suitable for use
with E10 fuel. You may refuel your vehicle
using E10 fuel.
added later can lead to engine failure. Do not
mix fuel additives with fuel. This does not
include additives for the removal and prevention of residue build-up. Petrol must only be
mixed with additives recommended by
Mercedes-Benz. Observe the instructions for
use in the product description. More information about recommended additives can be
obtained from any Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use fuel
brands that have additives.
The quality of the fuel available in some countries may not be sufficient. Residue could build
up in the fuel injection system as a result. In this
case, in consultation with a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, the petrol may be mixed with the
cleaning additive recommended by MercedesBenz. Always observe the notes and mixing
ratios specified on the container.
Engine oil
General notes
! As a temporary measure, if the recommen-
ded fuel is not available, you may also use
unleaded petrol with an octane rating of
95 RON. This may reduce engine performance and increase fuel consumption. As much
as possible, avoid driving at full throttle.
! As a temporary measure, if the recommen-
ded fuel is not available, you may also use
unleaded petrol in emergencies with an
octane rating of 91 RON.
Doing so results in noticeably higher fuel consumption, and the engine power output is
noticeably reduced. Avoid driving at full throttle.
If no fuel other than petrol with 91 RON or a
lower grade is available, you should have the
vehicle adapted to run on this fuel at a qualified specialist workshop.
When handling engine oil, observe the important
safety notes on service products (Y page 322).
The quality of the engine oil is decisive for the
function and service life of an engine. After
extensive tests, Mercedes-Benz approves
engine oils that correspond to the current technical standard.
Therefore, only Mercedes-Benz approved
engine oils may be used in Mercedes-Benz
engines.
Further information on tested and approved
engine oils can be obtained from any MercedesBenz Service Centre. Mercedes-Benz recom-
Service products and capacities
Model
MB-Freigabe or MB-Approval
All models
229.5
Mercedes‑AMG vehicles: use only SAE 0W-40
or SAE 5W-40 engine oils.
i If the engine oils listed in the table are not
available, you may add the following engine
oils until the next oil change:
RPetrol engines: MB-Freigabe or MBApproval 229.1, 229.3 or ACEA A3
This may only be added once and the amount
must not be greater than 1.0 l.
Capacities
The following values refer to an oil change,
including the oil filter.
Missing values were not available at the time of
going to print.
Model
Replacement
amount
SL 400
6.5 l
SL 500
8.0 l
Mercedes‑AMG
SL 63
Mercedes‑AMG
SL 65
Additives
! Do not use any additives with the engine oil.
This could damage the engine.
Brake fluid
G WARNING
The brake fluid continuously absorbs moisture from the air. This results in the boiling
point of the brake fluid lowering. If the boiling
point of the brake fluid is too low, vapour
pockets may form when the brakes are subjected to a heavy load. This would impair braking efficiency. There is a risk of an accident.
Have the brake fluid renewed at the prescribed intervals.
When handling brake fluid, observe the important safety notes on service products
(Y page 322).
The brake fluid change intervals can be found in
the Service Booklet.
Only use brake fluid approved by MercedesBenz in accordance with MB-Freigabe or MBApproval 331.0.
Information about approved brake fluid can be
obtained at any qualified specialist workshop or
on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
i Have the brake fluid regularly replaced at a
qualified specialist workshop and the replacement confirmed in the Service Booklet.
Coolant
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If antifreeze comes into contact with hot components in the engine compartment, it may
ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Let the engine cool down before you top up
the antifreeze. Make sure that antifreeze is
not spilled next to the filler neck. Thoroughly
clean the antifreeze from components before
starting the engine.
Z
Technical data
mends that you have the oil change carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop. MercedesBenz approval is indicated on the oil container
by the inscription "MB-Freigabe" or "MBApproval" and the corresponding designation,
e.g. MB-Freigabe or MB-Approval 229.51.
You can call up an overview of approved engine
oils on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com by entering
the designation, e.g. 229.5.
The table shows which engine oils have been
approved for your vehicle.
In certain countries, different engine oils can be
used, provided that the maintenance intervals
are reduced. For more information, please contact a qualified specialist workshop.
325
326
Service products and capacities
! Only add coolant that has been premixed
with the desired antifreeze protection. You
could otherwise damage the engine.
Further information on coolants can be found
in the Mercedes-Benz Specifications for Service Products, MB Specifications for Service
Products 310.1, e.g. on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com. Or contact
a qualified specialist workshop.
! Always use a suitable coolant mixture, even
in countries where high temperatures prevail.
Otherwise, the engine cooling system is not
sufficiently protected from corrosion and
overheating.
Technical data
i Have the coolant regularly replaced at a
qualified specialist workshop and the replacement confirmed in the Service Booklet.
Comply with the important safety precautions
for service products when handling coolant
(Y page 322).
The coolant is a mixture of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. It is responsible for
the following:
Ranti-corrosion protection
Rantifreeze protection
Rraising the boiling point
If antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor is present in the
correct concentration, the boiling point of the
coolant during operation will be approximately
130 †.
The antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor concentration in the engine cooling system should:
Rbe at least 50%. This will protect the engine
cooling system against freezing down to
approximately -37 †.
Rnot exceed 55% (antifreeze protection down
to -45 †). Heat will otherwise not be dissipated as effectively.
If the vehicle has lost coolant, top it up with
equal amounts of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor.
Mercedes-Benz recommends an antifreeze/
corrosion inhibitor concentrate in accordance
with MB Specifications for Service Products
310.1.
i When the vehicle is first delivered, it is filled
with a coolant mixture that ensures adequate
antifreeze and corrosion protection.
i The coolant is checked at every mainte-
nance interval at a qualified specialist workshop.
Windscreen washer system
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If windscreen washer concentrate comes into
contact with hot components of the engine or
the exhaust system, it can ignite. There is a
risk of fire and injury.
Make sure the windscreen washer concentrate does not come into contact with the filler
neck.
! Only use washer fluid that is suitable for
plastic lamp lenses, e.g. MB SummerFit or MB
WinterFit. Unsuitable washer fluid could damage the plastic lenses of the headlamps.
! Only the washer fluids SummerFit and WinterFit can be mixed. Otherwise, the spraying
nozzles could become blocked.
Do not use distilled or de-ionised water. Otherwise, the level sensor may give a false reading.
When handling washer fluid, observe the important safety notes on service products
(Y page 322).
At temperatures above freezing:
X Fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mixture of
water and washer fluid, e.g. MB SummerFit.
X Mix 1 part MB SummerFit to 100 parts water.
At temperatures below freezing:
Fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mixture of
water and washer fluid, e.g. MB WinterFit.
For the correct mixing ratio refer to the information on the antifreeze reservoir.
X
i Add washer fluid concentrate, e.g. MB Sum-
merFit or MB WinterFit, to the washer fluid all
year round.
Vehicle data
Vehicle data
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
General notes
Vehicle width including
exterior mirrors
Dimensions and weights
2099 mm
Vehicle width excluding
exterior mirrors
Vehicle height
1300 mm 1308 mm
Vehicle height when opening/closing the roof
1679 mm 1691 mm
Wheelbase
2584 mm
Maximum boot load
100 kg
All other models
Vehicle length
4631 mm
Vehicle length when opening/closing the roof
4787 mm
Vehicle width including
exterior mirrors
2099 mm
Vehicle width excluding
exterior mirrors
1877 mm
Wheelbase
2585 mm
Maximum boot load
100 kg
SL 400
Model
: Opening height
Mercedes-AMG
vehicles
1920 mm 1934 mm
All other models
1922 mm 1923 mm
Vehicle height
1314 mm
Vehicle height when opening/closing the roof
1695 mm
SL 500
Vehicle height
1315 mm
Vehicle height when opening/closing the roof
1696 mm
Missing values were not available at the time of
going to print.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
Vehicle length
4640 mm
Vehicle length when opening/closing the roof
Z
Technical data
Please note that for the specified vehicle data:
Rthe heights specified may vary as a result of
- tyres
- load
- condition of the suspension
- optional equipment
Roptional equipment reduces the maximum
payload
Rvehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 321).
Ronly for certain countries: you can find vehicle-specific vehicle data in the COC documents (CERTIFICATE OF CONFORMITY).
These documents are delivered with your
vehicle.
327
328